"I give thefe Books for the founding of a College in this Colony^'' Gift of Dr. Hiram. Bingham ofthe Class of 1898 1907 THE FIFTY YEAKS' WOEK OF THE ROYAL GEOGRAPHICAL SOCIETY. THE FIFTY YEAES' WOEK ROYAL GEOGRAPHICAL SOCIETY. CLEMENTS R. MARKHAM, C.B., F.R.S., SECRETARY. 1881. LONDON: JOHN MUKEAY, ALBEMAELE STEEET. PRINTED BY WILLIAM CLOWES AND SONS, LIMITED, STAMFORD STEEET AND CHARIKG CROSS. ANALYTICAL TABLE OF CONTENTS. CHAPTER I. THE FATHEK3 OF ENGLISH GEOGEAPHY. PAGE Plan of the Work 1 How geographical work was formerly done 2 Eiohard Eden . . ' 3 Eichard Hakluyt 4 Samuel Purchas 5 Henry Hexham 6 CHAPTER II. THE EOYAL SOCIETY. Geographical work of the Royal Society 7 Captain Cook, Phipps, Bruce .. 8 Major Rennell 8 Alexander Dalrymple 9 Collections of voyages and travels 9 CHAPTER III. THE AFRICAN ASSOCIATION. Sir Joseph Banks 11 Formation and objects of the Asso ciation 11 Ledyard, Lucas, Houghton .. .. 12 Mungo Park, Horneman . . . . 13 Renewal of Arctic discovery . . 13 Sir John Barrow's labours .. .14 CHAPTER IV. THE KALEIGH CLUB. Sir Arthur De Capell Broke .. 15 Objects of the Club 15 Notices of Members of the first Committee 16 The first List of Members . . . . 17 Tiie dinners 17 Results of the Rakigli Club . . 18 CHAPTER V. FOUNDATION OF THE EOYAL QEO- GKAPHICAL SOCIETY. PAGB Meeting of the Raleigh Club . . 19 Scheme for a Geographical Society 19 Provisional Committee 20 Notice of Sir John Barrow . . . . 20 Robert Brown . . . . 20 Roderick I. Murchison 21 Sir John C.Hobhouse .. 22 Mountstuart Elphinstone 22 Bartie Frere 23 The Founders of the Society . . 23 The Society constituted. Its rules 24 List of the first Council . . .24 Mr. Barrow's opening Address 25 The Members 25 List of Members on August 4th, 1830 2G CHAPTER VI. PRESIDENTS AND SECEETAEIES OF THE EOYAL GEOQEAPHICAL SOCIETY, 1830-50. Opening work 32 Merging of the African and Pales tine Associations 32 The Bombay Geographical So ciety 32 (and note) The first President and his Coun cil 33 Sir Francis Beaufort 33 Captain Horsburgh 34 Eeunell's nephew 34 Sir John Barrow 35 The first Secretaries — Captain Maconochie . . . . 35 Mr. Renouard 35 Captain Washington . . . . 36 )j 5) 39 VI Analytical Table of Contents. PAGE Mr. W. R. Hamilton 37 The first President's Address . . 37 Mr. Greenough 38 Colonel Jaclson 39 First Presidentship of Sir R. Mur chison 39 Lord Colchester 40 Mr. W. J. Hamilton 41 Secretaries, Mr. Long, Major S. Gierke 41,42 CHAPTER VII. PKESIDENTS AND SECEETAEIES OF THE EOYAL GEOGEAPmCAL SOCIETY, 1851 TO 1881. Admiral W. H. Smyth, o.B. . 48 Dr. Norton Shaw 44 Sir Roderick Murchison . . . . 45 Sir Roderick's Council, 1851 . . 46 The Hakluyt Society 46 Geographical Section ofthe British Association 46 Sir Roderick's Anniversary Ad dresses 47 Presidenlial Hospitality . . . . 47 The Earl of Ellesmere 47 Captain Blackwood, Sir W. Tre- velyan 48 The Government Grant for the Map Room 48 Admiral Eeechey 49 Mr. Francis Galton 50 The Geogi'aphical Club .. .. 50 Charter of Incorporation .. .. 51 Sir Roderick's final Presidency . . 51 „ Council in 1862 . 51 Honorary Secretaries 52 Sir Roderick's character and death 52, 53 John Crawfurd 53 Sir Roderick's Anniversary Ad dresses 54 Sir Henry Rawliuson 54 Sir Bartie Frere . ... 55 Sir Rutherford Alcock .... 55 Lord Dufferin, Lord Northbrook 56 Lord Aberdare . . . . . 56 CHAPTER VIII. EXPEDITIONS PEOMOTED BY THE EOYAL GEOGEAPHIOAL SOCIETY, AND GEANTS OF THE EOYAL AWAEDS, 1830-55. PAGE Measures for promoting discovery 57 Royal Award 57 Richard Lander, John Biscoe . . 58 Sir John Ross, Sir A. Burnes, Captain FitzEoy, Col. Chesney 58 Captain Alexander's Expedition 58 Schomburgk's Guiana Expedition 59 Ainsworth's Expedition . . . . 59 Australian Expeditions . . . . 60 Back's voyage in the Terror . . 60 The Society's Medals 61 Eawlinson, Wood, Symonds, Lay ard, Von Hiigel 61 H. Strachey, Wallin, Eiippell, Beke, Galton, Anderssen, Eyre 62 Strzelecki, Sturt, Leichhardt . . 63 Rajah Brooke 63 Dease and Simpson 64 Dr. John Rae . . 64 Ross's Antarctic Voyage . . . . 65 Franklin's Arctic Expedition . . 66 Lieutenant H. Raper .... 67 Robinson, Carl Ritter . . . . 67 Effect of the Royal Awards . . . . 67 CHAPTER IX. EXPEDITIONS PEOMOTED BY THE EOYAL GEOGRAPHICAL SOCIETY AND GEANTS OF THE EOYAL AWAEDS, 1855-1880. Sir Andrew Waugh and Major Montgomerie 69 Indian Native Explorers 70 Hay ward and Shaw 70 Captain Trotter 70 Explorers in China 71 Lieut. F. Garnier 71 Boutakoflf and Prejevalsky . . 71 Vambe'ry, Pal grave 72 Livingstone 72 Barth 73 Burton 74 Speke 75 Baker 75 Du Chaillu, Gerhard Eohlfs 76 Livingstone's last expedition 76 Analytical Table of Contents. Vll PAGE Livingstone's death 77 Search expeditions for Livingstone 77 Cameron 78 Schweinfurth 78 Stanley 79 Walker, Erskine, Mauch, Baines 79 Munzinger, Wiuwood Reade . . 80 African Exploration Fund . . . . 80 Keith Johnston 81 Joseph Thomson 82 Serpa Pinto 82 Explorers in Australia 83 O'Hara Burke, Macdouall Stuart 83 Gregory, Waiburton, Forrest, Giles 84 Explorers in America 84 Chandless and Musters . . . . 85 South American travellers . . . . 85 Searches for Sir John Franklin . . 86 Captain Austin's Expedition . 86 Naval Arctic sledge travelling . . 87 Sir Robert M'Clure 87 Sir Richard ColUnson 87 Sherard Osborn's Arctic works . . 88 Lady Franklin 88 Su- Leopold M'Clintock . 89 Allen Young 89 Kane 90 Hayes, Nordenskiold, Payer . . 90 Sherard Osborn's revival of Arctic research 90 Death of Sherard Osbom . . . . 92 Arctic Expedition of 1875 and its results 92 Sir George Nares, Captain Mark- ham 92 Su: George Back 93 Nordenskiold 93 Dutch expeditions, Markham, Leigh Smith 93 Sir Roderick Murchison and the Medal 94 Cartographers : Arrowsmith 94 Petermann and Keith Johnston 95 Lady Medallists 95 Colonel Yule 95 Mr. E. H. Bunbury 96 The Roll of Medallists 96 CHAPTER X. PUBLICATIONS OF THE SOCIETY — LIBBABT AND MAP BOOM — EDUCATIONAL MEA- SUBES. PAGE The Society's 'Journal' .. .. 97 The ' Proceedings ' (Old Series) . 98 The ' Geographical Magazine ' . . 98 The 'Proceedings' (New Series).. 99 Presidential Addresses, Hydro- grapber's Reports 99 Separate Volumes 99 The Library 100 Progress of the Library, Donations 101 Librarians 102 Library Committee 102 Admiral Sherard Osborn's gift . . 102 Aid from Government OfSces . . 103 Assistance from individuals . . . . 104 Usefulness of the Library . . . . 104 The Map Room 105 The Government Grant . . . . 106 Instruments 106 ' Hints to Travellers ' . ..106 Scientific lectures 107 Instruction to travellers . . . 108 Observatory on the roof .. .. 108 School Prizes 109 Recapitulation 110 CHAPTER XI. PEOGEESS OF THE SOCIETY. Finance — Members — Meetings — House Accommodation. A hopeful commencement .. .. Ill 3, Waterloo Place 112 Difaculties 112 Returning prosperity Ill Attention to finances Ill Council divided into Committees 112 15, Whitehall Place 112 Burlington House 112 Election of Fellows 112 Increasing prosperity 113 1, SavileRow 113 Hall of the Dniversity of London 113 Finances 114 Work of the Council 114 VIU Analytical Table of Contents. CHAPTER XII. COMPARATIVE VIEW OF GEOGEAPHIOAL KNOWLEDGE IN 1830 AND 1880, WITH A NOTICE OF THE WOEK THAT STILL EEMAINS TO BE DONE. PAGE The Arctic Regions 115 Work remaining to be done in the far North 116 Work in the Antarctic Regions . . 116 PAGE Work to be done in Africa . . . . 117 Asia .. ..118 „ „ South America 120 New Guinea 121 Hydrography 122 Physical Geography of the Sea . . 123 Conclusion 124 Appendix 127 THE FIFTY YEARS' WORK OF THE ROYAL GEOGRAPHICAL SOCIETY. BY CLEMENTS E. MARKHAM, C.B., F.R.S., SECRETARY. CHAPTEE I. THE FATHERS OF ENGLISH GEOGRAPHY. The Eoyal Geographical Society completed the fiftieth year of its existence on the 16th of July, 1880, and its fiftieth anniver sary meeting took place on the 31st of May, 1880. In order to celebrate this auspicious event, and also to supply a useful means of reference to Fellows, I have been commissioned by the Council to write the present brief history of the Society. My plan is to give, in four introductory chapters, a con densed view of the ways and means by which the work undertaken by the Society was performed previous to the date of its formation, and of the circumstances which immediately led to its being brought into existence. The fifth chapter contains a history of the original formation of the Geographical Society. The sixth and seventh chapters are devoted to memorial accounts of the Presidents, Secretaries, and other leading members of the governing body. The eighth and ninth review the career of the Geographical Society with reference to the expeditions which it has helped, or actively promoted, including grants-in-aid, and awards in recognition of the services of eminent geographers and travellers. The histoiy of the various publications of the Society, of the rise and progress of the library and map-room, and of the educational measures adopted by the Council, forms the subject of the tenth chapter ; and the eleventh reviews the progress of the Society as regards members, finances, places of meeting, and B ~ 2 The Fathers of English Geography. house accommodation. A comparative view of geographical knowledge when the Society was founded in 1830, and in 1880, with a notice of the work that still remains to be done, illustrates its career of laborious usefulness, and forms a fitting conclusion of the work. The original objects of the Society were to collect, digest, and publish interesting and useful geographical facts and dis coveries ; to accumulate a collection of books on geography, voyages, and travels, and of maps and charts ; to keep specimens of such instruments as are most serviceable to a traveller ; to afford assistance, instruction, and advice to explorers ; and to correspond with other bodies or individuals engaged in geo graphical pursuits. It is obvious that as soon as the people of England began to foster and encourage maritime enterprise and the discovery of unknown countries, the need for some provision or other through which these objects might in part at least be attained would be felt and, to some extent, supplied. The record and preser vation of the history of adventure and discovery, the utilisation of results, and the instruction of explorers by land and sea, became necessities so soon as England commenced her glorious career as a nation of discoverers and explorers. When Sebastian Cabot began to make the history of English maritime and inland discovery, it would have been strange indeed if some man or body of men had not arisen, at the same time, to write its first pages. The very fact that we can now enjoy the perusal of those early efforts of our countrymen is a proof that there was not wanting the will to perform, even then, the duties since undertaken by our Society. The fathers of English geo graphy, the forerunners of the Geographical Society, who, during nearly three centuries, performed our work with zeal and ability, though often with insufficient resources and scant encouragement, ought not to be forgotten by their successors. In truth, the history of ,the Society properly commences with the efforts of those industrious geographers who did our work amidst many difficulties, from the time when Englishmen first began to emulate the adventurous deeds of the Portuguese and Spaniards who preceded them in the field of discovery. Richard Eden is the Father of English Geography. He it was who first conceived the idea of performing, single-handed and with inadequate means, the duties which our Society proposed to itself more than two centuries afterwards. He it was who first collected together the records of geographical work, and provided the means of instruction to explorers and travellers. Coming up to London from Cambridge, where he had been a pupil of Sir Thomas Smith at Queen's College, youno- Eden liictiard Uden. 3 was a spectator of the gorgeous public entry of Philip and Mary. He describes himself as nearly lifted out of self- command by the excitement of the scene. He beheld the union of the Sovereign of the Indies with his own Queen, and he resolved, on the spot, to set about some work which might fitly commemorate the event. Eden wrote his ' Decades of the New World ' in 1555 — a little black-letter volume, which he found great difScuIty in getting printed, but which is a laborious and very precious collection of the geographical work of his day. He was the first Englishman who supplied to his countrymen the means of studying, in a collected form, the marvellous history of discovery which was then exciting the wonder and admiration of the age. Eden desired that England should emulate the deeds of those who were first in the field. He gave his countrymen transla tions from Peter Martyr, Oviedo, Gomara, Ramusio, Pigafetta ; and added the earliest narratives of English voyages to Guinea and to the north. His laudable object was that " some memory thereof might remain to posterity, if contempt of knowledge should hereafter bury in oblivion so worthy attempts." Eden was the intimate friend of Sebastian Cabot, and attended him in his last moments ; and he also knew the Arctic navigators Chancellor and Borough. It was at the request of Stephen Borough that Eden designed his translation of the 'Art of Navigation ' by Martin Cortes, " for the increase of skilful pilots whereof then there were very few." So that he strove to do the work now undertaken by the Geographical Society, both by preserving the records of accomplished work and by providing the means of performing eificient service, and of receiving instruction. A new edition of his ' History of Tra- vayle ' was published with additions by Willes in 1577, and his translation of Cortes went through ten editions between 1561 and 1615. The mantle of Eden fell upon a better known but not more zealous and conscientious worker in the cause of geography. Richard Hakluyt came of an old Herefordshire family, was educated at Westminster School, and elected a student of Christ Church in 1570. He very early took a deep interest in voyages and travels, and in all things connected with the naval glory of his countrymen, and he was indefatigable in collecting information. " His genius," says old Puller, " inclined him to the study of histoiy, and especially to the marine part thereof, which made him keep constant intelligence with the most noted seamen of Wapping, until the day of his death." Hakluyt, like Eden, has given us an interesting account of tlie origin and growth of his love for geography. "I do B 2 4 Richard Hakluyt. remember," he says, " that being a youth, and one of Her Majesty's scholars at Westminster, that fruitful nursery, it was my hap to visit the chamber of my cousin, a gentleman of the Middle Temple, at a time when 1 found lying upon his board certain books of cosmography, with an universal map. He seeing me somewhat curious in the view thereof began to instruct my ignorance. From the map he brought me to the Bible, and turning to the 107th Psalm, directed me to the 23rd and 24th verses where 1 read that they which go down to the sea in ships, they see the works of the Lord and His wonders in the deep. Which words of the Prophet, together with my cousin's discourse, took me in so deep an impression that I would, by God's assistance, prosecute that knowledge and kind of literature, the doors whereof (after a sort) were so happily opened before me." From that time Hakluyt devoted his life to the cause of geography. At an early age he was appointed to read lectures at Oxford on that branch of knowledge, and " he was the first that produced and showed both the older and imperfectly com posed, and the new lately reformed mappes, globes, spheres, and other instruments of this arte, for demonstration, in the common schooles, to the singular pleasure and general content ment of his auditory." In 1584 he went to Paris as chaplain to the Embassy, returning to England in 1588, and becoming Archdeacon of Westminster in 1602. While in Paris he trans lated the ' History of Florida ' from the French, and was inde fatigable in collecting geographical information. His great work, 'The Principal Navigations, Voyages, and Discoveries of Englishmen made by sea or over land to the most remote and farthest distant quarters of the earth,' was published in 1589 ; and the large edition in three volumes in 1598-1600. Under his auspices also appeared the translations of Peter Martyr by Lok, of Leo Africanus by Pory, of Pigafetta's Congo by Hartwell, and of Mendoza's China by Parke. Hak luyt corresponded with Ortelius and Mercator, and worked as hard at the educational interests of geography as at the preservation and utili.-iation of its records. Personally acquainted with the leading travellers and explorers, he was also foremost in the encouragement of science and in pro moting the construction of good maps and charts. He took a leading part in establishing the courses of lectures on navi gation which were delivered at Sir Thomas Smith's house in Philpot Lane, by Edward Wright and Dr. Hood. It was for Hakluyt that Wright prepared the famous map of the world on the new projection in 1600, and it was Hakluyt who helped Molyneux in the construction of his famous globes. He Hakluyt and Purchas. 5 it was, too, who as Historiographer of the East India Company, prepared instructions and drew up lists of commodities to be obtained from and in demand at the various ports of the East. Hakluyt had one great advantage over Eden. In the days of Elizabeth the interest of the nation was fully aroused on all questions relating to geographical research. Those were the times when the merchants of England were as liberal as they were wealthy ; when no man asked the fatuous question owi bono? but when all, high and low, generously applauded the efforts of explorers, and when it was the highest ambition of the flower of England's sons to add to her fame by achieving discoveries in distant lands. Nor were the students of scientific geography less zealous or less successful than the adventurers by sea and land. Hakluyt, as President of an Elizabethan Geographical Society, would have gathered around him, for a Council, men of action such as Hawkins, Raleigh, Drake, Frobisher, Lancaster, Jenkinson, Gilbert and Davis; and mathematicians and cosmographers such as Hood and Wright, Digges and Molyneux, Dee and Hues, Harriott and Briggs. These were the fathers of our science. Hakluyt died on the 23rd of November, 1 616, at the age of sixty-three, and was buried in Westminster Abbey. He left behind him a great number of manuscripts, which came into the hands of the Rev. Samuel Purchas, rector of St. Michael's on Ludgate Hill, in about the year 1620. These precious documents, with many others, much abridged and indifferently edited, were published in 1625 in the great work in five volume^, which its compiler entitled ' Hakluytus Posthumus or Purchas his Pilgrimes.' Want of funds is some excuse f.n- the abridgments and deplorable omissions, for Purchas appears to have been in very embarrassed circumstances when he died in 1626, only ten years after Hakluyt's decease. The forty years which intervened between the death of Purchas and the foundation of the Royal Society were troublous times, and geography could not flourish as in the days of the great Queen. Yet Englishmen were not altogether idle. The lectures at Gresham College were continued, one of its Pro fessors invented the Gunter's Scale and introduced the measuring chain, and the great work of Hondius received an English dress. For this useful service we are indebted to a very gallant soldier. Though trained in camps from his boyhood, Henry Hexham ever cultivated a love for literary pursuits. ^Yhen quite a young boy, he was the Governor's page during the siege of Ostend, and while Sir Francis Vere. roused suddenly from his bed, engaged a desperate storming party at push of pike, young Hexham calmly went on fastening his master's 6 Henry Hexham. points in the very thick of the fight. He also recorded the events of that memorable siege. He was at many a hard-fought battle and siege in after years, and he wrote the histories of the operations before Maestricht and Bois le Due. It is to this military writer that we owe the grandest geographical work of the first Stuart period. The ' Atlas or Geographicke descrip tion of the regions countries and kingdomes of the world, represented by new and exact maps,' by Henry Hondius and John Johnson, was translated into English by Henry Hexham in 1636, "enlarged and augmented out of many worthy authors of my own nation." This superb atlas, in two folio volumes, brings the record of geographical work up to the time of the outbreak of the great civil war in England. Geography under the Royal Society. CHAPTER IL THE EOYAL SOCIETY. The idea of forming a scientific Society in this country was entertained and partly developed during the Protectorate, and in 1665 the Royal Society was created for the improvement of natural knowledge. In the wide scope of its original objects the science of geography was included, but the share of attention that it received was never in proportion to its importance. From 1665 to 1848 the Royal Society printed 5336 papers in its ' Philosophical Transactions,' out of which only 77 were devoted to geography and topography, or very little over 1 per cent. The proportion in which the various sciences have received attention from the Royal Society is as follows : — • Papers. Medicine and Chemistry .. .. 1949 Astronomy 621 Mechanics 461 Zoology 420 Electricity and Magnetism . . 416 Geology and Mineralogy . . . . 384 Papers. Mathematics 285 Botany 280 Optics 206 Miscellaneous 120 Arohjeology 117 Geography and Topography .. 77 These seventy-seven papers include a table of places whose positions have been fixed by astronomical observations, some memoirs on the construction of maps, methods of estimating distances, an account of a lake in Carniola (1669), of the Hudson's Bay Settlements (1770), of the Falls of Niagara (1722), of the Patagonians (1770), the Falkland Islands (1776), the North American Indians (1773 and 1786), and of Bogle's Mission to Tibet (1777). Eden and Hakluyt each did more for geography in thirty years than the Royal Society did in a century. Still the science of geography owes much to the Royal Society. If little attention was given to the work of explorers, very much was done to improve the scientific methods by which explorers efficiently perform their work. The institution of the Green wich Observatory in 1676 originated in the extension of navi gation and the consequent importance of discovering a means of accurately determining longitude, and the Fellows of the Royal Society were appointed Visitors. The President of the Royal Society was an ex officio Member of the Board of Lpngi- tude which was established in 1713, and the Commissioners 8 Cook and Rennell. conceived and matured the plan of the Nautical Almanac under the auspices of Dr. Maskelyne, the Astronomer Royal, the publication of which was commenced in 1767 ; while, under their superintendence, the survey of the coasts of Great Britain and Irelaad was commenced in 1741. Rewards for northern dis covery began to be offered by the Government in 1745, at the instance of the Royal Society, Christopher Middleton having, four years previously, made important discoveries in Hudson's Bay, including the Wager River and Repulse Bay. But the most important geographical work which was done under the auspices of the Royal Society resulted from the necessity for observing the transit of Venus at far distant points on the earth's surface. The Government granted 4000L to the Society for expenses. In 1769 Captain Cook sailed on his first voyage, accompanied by Sir Joseph Banks, and in 1771 on his second voyage. The transit of Venus also led to the despatch of Mr. Wales to Hudson's Bay in 1769, who wintered at Churchill River, and contributed a paper on the Hudson's Bay Company's Territory to the ' Philosophical Transactions.' Mean while the persevering representations of Mr. Daines Barrington induced the Royal Society to submit a memorial to the Govern ment, urging the desirability of sending an expedition to discover how far navigation was practicable towards the North Pole. The expedition of Captain Phipps in 1773 was the result, and thus commenced the glorious history of modern Arctic enterprise, undertaken from the desire of increasing — not wealth, but knowledge. Three years afterwards Captain Cook sailed on his third and last voyage, during which further discoveries were made in the Arctic regions, on the Pacific side. The great African traveller, James Bruce, returned from Abyssinia in 1774 and published his narrative in 1790. The establishment of our Indian Empire also led to the necessity for surveys, and consequently to great advances in geographical knowledge. The careers of Rennell and Dal rymple were commenced in India, but their love for geography and their zealous devotion to its interests led them to continue their labours after their return home. In very different ways they were both geographers of the Elizabethan type. James Rennell, as a thoughtful and scientific scholar, stands amongst the foremost in the front rank of English geographers. Born in 1742, he commenced life in the navy, and afterwards took service in the army of Lord Clive and rose to the rank of Major. As Surveyor General of Bengal he mapped the Ganges and Brahmaputra rivers, and surveyed the districts of Bengal and Bahar between 1763 and 1782. His famous map of India was published in 1788, and the memoir followed in 1792. His Dalrymple. Collections of Voyages. 9 great works on the geographical system of Herodotus and on the retreat of the Ten Thousand appeared in 18U0 and 1816 ; and he devoted many years to the collection of log books, with a view to investigating the currents of the Atlantic. After he had reached his 87th year, Major Rennell still possessed all his intellectual faculties in full vigour, and devoted many hours of each day to his favourite pursuit. He was distinguished for true, patient, and persevering research; his critical judgment was seldom at fault, and his work is always reliable. He died on the 29th of March, 1830, a few months before the formation of the Geographical Society. Rennell, like Hakluyt, was buried in Westminster Abbey. Alexander Dalrymple was remarkable rather for his indefa tigable industry in collecting geographical materials than for original criticism or research. Born in 1737, he went out to Madras in 1752, and acquired much nautical experience during a voyage to the Eastern Archipelago in 1759. When he returned home in 1777 he received the appointment of Hydro- grapher to the East India Company, and his labours are repre sented by 58 charts, 740 plans, and 50 nautical memoirs. He also published translations of voyages in the South Pacific, and many geographical tracts. Dalrymple was the first Hydro- grapher to the Admiralty, a post which he held from its crea tion in 1795 until a few months before his death in June 1808. It has been seen that the Royal Society, by encouraging all investigations and discoveries which had for their object the advancement of scientific geography, and the improvement of methods of observation, and also by addressing the Govern ment with a view to the despatch of important expeditions, did a great deal to advance the special objects of geographers. It was in the work of utilising and publishing the narratives of voyages and travels that the Royal Society failed. In this respect the labours of Eden and Hakluyt were continued by various compilers and publishers through the last century ; for the demand for such information never slackened, as is clearly proved by the way in which these collections of voyages and travels continued to be published. 'Harris's Voyages,' in two large folio volumes, appeared in 1705, and a new edition came out in 1761. In the interval ' Astley's Voyages,' in four quarto volumes, were published in 1745-47; and 'Churchill's Collection of Voyages and Travels,' containing several hitherto unpublished narratives, was issued between 1707 and 1747, and consisted of eight large volumes. ' Pinkerton's Geography ' was published in 1802, and his ' Collection of Voyages and Travels,' in seventeen quarto volumes, followed in 1808-14; while ' Kerr's Collection,' in eighteen octavo volumes, came out 10 Collections of Voyages and Travels. at Edinburgh from 1811 to 1824. There were also three valu able collections having special reference to voyages in the Pacific and Indian Oceans. Dalrymple, in two volumes, gave the ' Spanish and Dutch Voyages in the South Pacific ' (1770- 71) ; Admiral Burney, who had served under Cook, supplied a more complete history of all the Pacific voyages in his valuable five volumes published from 1803 to 1817 ; and Dr. Hawkes- worth gave an account of the voyages of Byron, Wallis, Carteret, and Cook in his well-known three volumes published in 1773. During all this period, while the Royal Society and the publishers and map makers were, between them, doing the needful work at home, and explorers were actively at work abroad, there was very urgent need for some central organisa tion, to guide, control, and advance the business of geography, and to watch more closely over its interests. The Royal Society was much occupied with the advancement of other branches of science, and geography received less of its attention than any other. Yet Sir Joseph Banks, so many years the President of the Royal Society, was not only an ardent geographer, but also a great traveller ; and it will now be seen that he took a leading part in the establishment and conduct of a separate association, with the special object of promoting geographical discovery. Sir Joseph Banks. 11 CHAPTER III. THE AFRICAN ASSOCIATION. SiE Joseph Banks, during his long and useful life, was ever a warm and active friend to geography. Born in 1743, of a good Lincolnshire family, he inherited Revesby Abbey when he came of age. While still at Eton and Christ Church his love for natural history, and especially for botany, attracted attention ; and in 1766 he made a voyage to Newfoundland with his friend, Lieut. Phipps, the future Arctic explorer, to collect plants. Soon after his return he was appointed naturalist to Captain Cook's expedition, and was absent in the famous circumnavi gation of the globe from 1768 to 1771. In 1772 he made a voyage to Iceland, and was elected President of the Royal Society in 1778, from which time he devoted himself to the duties of his oJBBce with the utmost zeal. He was habitually consulted by the Government, and was created a Baronet in 1781, a Knight of the Bath in 1795, and a Privy Councillor in 1797. Sir Joseph Banks was the first Englishman upon whom an order of knighthood was conferred for scientific services. It was in 1788 that a company of ardent geographers, amongst whom was the President of the Royal Society, formed an association for promoting discovery in the interior of Africa. They saw that much of Asia, a still larger proportion of America, and almost the whole of Africa was unvisited and un known. The very remarkable overland journey of Forster from India had recently added considerably to the stock of know ledge respecting Asia, and valuable additions were also expected from America, while the map of the interior of Africa was still a wide extended blank. A few names of unexplored rivers and of uncertain nations were alone traced upon it, with hesitating hand, on the authority of Edrisi and Leo Africanus. Desirous of rescuing their age from a charge of ignorance, and strongly impressed with a conviction of the utility of thus enlarging the bounds of human knowledge, a small body of geographers formed the plan of an Association for promoting the discovery of the interior parts of Africa. Among the first members were the Earl of Galloway, Lord Rawdon, General Conway, Sir Joseph Banks, Sir Adam Fergusson, Major Rennell, and Mr. Beaufoy. The African Association was formed on June 12 The African Association. 9th, 1788, and a Committee was invested with its management, and with the choice of persons to whom geographical missions should be assigned. This was the germ of the more fully de veloped Geographical Society of after years. The first person who was selected for employment by the Association was Mr. Ledyard, an American by birth, who had been a corporal of marines in Cook's third voyage, and had become known to Sir J oseph Banks. Fired with a zeal for dis covery, he afterwards resolved to attempt to inake a journey across Europe and Siberia to Kamschatka, and thence overland to the east coast of America. But he was nearly destitute. He landed at Ostend with no more than ten guineas in his pocket, and made his way to Stockholm. Thence he walked northward across the Arctic Circle and round the Gulf of Bothnia to St. Petersburg. He obtained permission to accompany a detach ment of stores to Yakutsk, and thence to Okzakoff. But, for some unexplained reason, he was suddenly arrested, hurried into a sledge with two soldiers, conveyed across Siberia again in the depth of winter, and left on the frontier of Poland with a warn ing that he would be shot if again found on Russian territory. He was quite destitute and, having begged his way to Konigs- berg, where he ventured to draw a cheque for a small amount on his kind-hearted friend Sir Joseph Banks, he thus suc ceeded in reaching England again. In this resolute and fearless traveller. Sir Joseph hoped to find the very man to execute the instructions of the Association. On the offer being made to him, Ledyard stated that he had always intended to traverse the continent of Africa as soon as he had explored the interior of North America. He, therefore, set out in June 1788, with orders to make his way from Sennaar to the River Niger. But the career of this remarkable man was brought to a premature close. He died of fever at Cairo, soon after his arrival. The second emissary of the African Association was Mr. Lucas, -nho had been captured by a Salee rover, had been three years in captivity, and subsequently was Vice-Consul at Morocco. He undertook a journey to Fezzan, but only got as far as Mesurata, returning to Tripoli in April 1789. Mr. Lucas, however, collected a great deal of information at Mesurata re specting Fezzan and the countries to the south, which he forwarded to the Association. In March 1790 Major Rennell compiled a map of Africa from existing materials, including the reports of Lucas. The next explorer was Major Houghton, who was to attempt to reach the Niger by way of the Gambia. He left England in October 1790, and news was received of him up to July 1791, but he is believed to have perished miserably on the road The African Association. 13 to Timbuktu. As soon as the news of Major Houghton's death was confirmed, the Association at once engaged another ex plorer to follow the same route. This was Mungo Park, a young Scot of no mean talent, who had been regularly educated for the medical jjrofession, and had just returned from a voyage to India. He was also able to observe with Hadley's quadrant, to work by dead reckoning, and was a competent naturalist. He set out in May 1795, and soon afterwards reached the Gambia. On the 2nd of December he started from Pisania for the interior, made a most remarkable journey and returned safely in 1797, after an absence of two years, having discovered the Niger, and collected information as to its course. The geographical illustrations of the journey of Mungo Park were written for the Association by Major Rennell. It is well known that Park was employed by the Government in another expedition in 1805, in which he perished. Many years after wards his book of logarithms, long preserved by the natives, was brought down to the coast. It was presented by Sir John Glover to the Royal Geographical Society, and is now preserved in the Map Room as a precious relic of one of the glorious band of heroes who have perished in the cause of geography. From the formation of the Association in 1788 until 1797 Sir Joseph Banks was its Secretary. In the latter year his numerous other avocations obliged him to resign that office. He became Treasurer, while Mr. Bryan Edwards undertook the duties of Secretary. Mr. Edwards died in 1801, and was succeeded by Sir William Young. The Committee for 1797 consisted of the Earl of Moira, Sir Joseph Banks, the Bishop of Llandaff, Mr. Stuart, and the Secretary. In 1798 Mr. Horneman, a well-trained German, was sent to Cairo, with orders to penetrate across the desert to Fezzan. He made a journey to Sinah, visiting the temple of Jupiter Ammon, and went thence to Mourzouk, reaching Tripoli in August 1799. Thence he sent home accounts of the desert and the kingdom of Fezzan, respecting which Major Rennell again communicated valuable geographical illustrations. The next emissary was Mr. Nicliolls, who furnished an account of Old Calabar, where he died in 1807. Sir Joseph Banks did not confine his exertions in the cause of geography to the African Continent. He it was who obtained the order for forming a settlement at Botany Bay in Australia. It was also through his intervention that Manning obtained the aid and support of the East India Company, without which he could never have reached the capital of Tibet. Above all it was Sir Joseph Banks who, in conjunction with Mr. Barrow, the Secretary of the Admiralty, induced the Royal Society to resume the consideration of the question of 14 Sir John Barrow. Arctic research. The objects were geographical discovery : to circumnavigate Greenland, to ascertain the existence of Baffin's Bay, to solve the question of the continuity of sea round the northern coast of America; and to obtain other scientific results. They were noble and useful objects, fully justifying the despatch of expeditions to secure them. So thought the Royal Society, and so thought the Government. Sir Joseph Banks addressed a letter on the subject to Lord Melville, in November 1817, and the reply was favourable. This step in the cause of geography was one of the last important acts of the venerable President. He died on June 19th, 1820, after having presided over the Royal Society during a period of forty-two eventful years. In the interval of ten years between the death of Sir Joseph Banks and the foundation of the Royal Geographical Society, the tendency of events was to make such an institution a necessity. The commencement of trigonometrical surveys in Great Britain and iu British India, and the activity of surveyors both in the Royal Navy and the Bombay Marine, gave an extraordinary impetus to the work of instrument and map makers. Ramsden, DoUond, and Tronghton exerted their ingenuity and talents to meet the requirements of Colby and Lambtou ; while those able cartographers Arrowsmith and Walker, reproduced the ever-multiplying work of surveyors and explorers. Sir John Barrow, the Secretary of the Admiralty, took the position vacated by Sir Joseph Banks, as the foremost promoter of geographical research. Under his auspices the voyages of Parry, Lyon, Clavering, and Beechey, and the land journeys of Franklin were undertaken, which threw such a flood of light over Arctic geography, and excited such general interest in maritime adventure and discovery. He also procured the despatch of the Congo Expedition under Captain Tuckey, in 1816, and edited the narrative of its ill-fated leader. With equal interest he watched the journeys of Lyon and of Ritchie to Mourzouk, of Denham and Clapperton from Tripoli to Lake Chad ; and of the brave Clapperton in his second expedition, when he died at Sokatu in April 1827, but not until he had completed his route across Africa. Some heroic adventurers, like Tuckey and Clapperton, laid down their lives in the great cause. Many more returned home and gave their narratives to the world; and so it came to pass that, year by year, an increasing number of eminent explorers and geographers, as well as of educated men taking an interest in geographical subjects, was assembled in London at one time. This natui-ally gave rise to a desire for intercommunion and association, and to the formation in the first place of a Club, which was the harbinger of a great and flourishing Society. ticheme of Hir Arthur de Capell Broke. 15 CHAPTER IV. THE EALEIGH club. Captain Aetrue de Capell Beoke was the founder of the Raleigh Travellers' Club, the immediate forerunner of the Geographical Society. The eldest son of Sir Richard de Capell Broke of Great Oakley in Northamptonshire, whom he suc ceeded in 1829, Sir Arthur Broke, who was born in 1791, had served in the army, and had all the spirit of an adventurous traveller. He was the author of ' Travels through Sweden and Norway ' (1823), a work which gives a striking picture of the physical features of those northern lands. He also wrote ' A Winter in Lapland ' (1827), and ' Sketches in Spain and Morocco' (1831). Sir Arthur Broke conceived the idea of forming a most agree able dining society composed solely of travellers. The world was to be mapped out into so many divisions corresponding with the number of Members, each division being represented by at least one Member as far as it might be practicable, so that the society collectively should have visited nearly every part of the known globe. He first communicated his idea to four friends, Colonel Leake, Mr. Legh, Captain Mangles, and Lieut. Holman, who warmly approved of it. They prepared a general list of the most distinguished travellers, and, a selec tion having been carefully made in accordance with the above principle, a circular was sent out in the summer of 1826, dated from the Alfred Club in Albemarle Street, and signed Arthur de Capell Broke. The number was at first limited to forty, and the meetings were to take place once a fortnight, com mencing iu November. The principal object of these meetings was announced to be the attainment, at a moderate expense, of an agreeable, friendly, and rational society, formed by persons who had visited every part of the globe. The first dinner was held at Grillon's Hotel in Albemarle Street, and the second at Brunet's Hotel in Leicester Square. At the latter meeting it was resolved that the Club should be considered as constituted, and the name of the Raleigh Club, in honour of the illustrious Sir Walter Raleigh, was proposed by Captain Broke and adopted. Of the original Committee which formed the Raleigh Club, 16 Founders of the Raleigh Club. Sir Arthur Broke was for many years the President. He died at his seat of Oakley in Northamptonshire, in December 1858. His friend Colonel William Martin Leake was an older man. He was born in London in 1777, the grandson of John Martin Leake, Garter King at Arms. Entering the Artillery in 1794, he was appointed on a mission to instruct the Turks. After a residence at Constantinople until 1800, he travelled through Asia Minor, Palestine, and Egypt in an official capacity, making a general survey of the country, the results of which were embodied in a valuable report. He was afterwards com missioned to visit and report upon the European provinces of Turkey, and Greece. Retiring from the army in 1823, he pub lished several valuable works, including ' Researches in Greece,' ' Outline of the Greek Revolution,' ' Topography of Athens,' and 'Travels in the Morea and Northern Greece.' He died on January 6th, 1860, aged 83. Captain Mangles entered the navy in 1800, serving in the Narcissus under Captain Ross Donnelly in the West Indies, and seeing much active service until the peace in 1815. He then travelled in the East with his friend Captain the Hon. C. L. Irby, the results of their tour being privately printed under the title of ' Travels in Egypt, Nubia, Syria, and Asia Minor.' This most popular work was first published in 1844. Devoting himself to the study of geography and hydrography, he pub lished books on these subjects in 1849 and 1851. Captain Mangles died on November 18th, 1867. Lieutenant J. B. Holman, e.n., was the well-known " Blind Traveller." He was obliged to leave the service owing to an illness resulting in loss of sight, when he was only 25, and he received an appointment as a Naval Knight at Windsor, with permission to travel. From 1819 to 1821 he wandered over various parts of the Continent, and the narrative of his travels passed through four editions. His next journey, from 1822 to 1824, was through Russia and Siberia without any servant, but trusting to his own sagacity, and to the sympathy which never failed him wherever he went, for safe conduct through all emergencies and perils. His book of Russian travels went through three editions. In 1834 appeared his ' Voyage round the World,' which Sir Roderick Murchison pronounced to be an extraordinary literary monument of energy and perseverance. His last journeys were through Turkey in Europe. Lieut. Holman died in 1858. Sir Arthur Broke and his Committee worked so well during the winter of 1826, that by February 1827 the numbers of the Club were nearly completed. The following is a list of the original Members : — jutnuiKTs OJ uw jxaieigii \jiuu. I. Sir Arthur de Capell Broke. 20. Mr. Colebrooke. 2. Colonel Leake. 21. Captam Basil Hall, r.n. 3. Mr. Legh, m.p. 22. Mr. Andrew Knight. 4. Captain Mangles, r.n. 23. Mr. Marsden. 6. Lieut. Holman, e.n. 24. Mr. Murdoch. 6. Mr. 0. K. Cockerell. 25. Bir Murray Maxwell, b.n. 7. Mr. J. Eennie. 26. General Stratton. 8. Mr. G. Eennie. 27. Captain C. Cochrane, r.n. 9. Mr. Mackenzie. 28. Mr. John Cam Hobhouse, m.p. 10. Captain Oorry, b.n. 29. Captain Sabine, b.a. 11. Captain Owen, r.n. 30. Mr. Hanbury. 12. Captain Chapman, b.a. 31. Earl of Belmore. 13. Captain Colquhoun, b.a 32. Viscount Strangford. 14. Mr. Beechey. 38. Viscount Corry, m.p. 15. Major Abbey. 34. Captain Weddell, b.n. 16. Mr. Wise. 35. Hon. Henry Corry. 17. Mr. Baillie Eraser. 38. Mr, Baily. 18. Mr. Bankes. 37. Mr. Barrow. 19. Major the Hon. G. Keppel 38. Captain Marryat, e.n., c.b. (now Earl of Albemarle). To the first list were soon afterwards added the names of Sir John Franklin, Sir Edward Parry, Captain Beaufort, e.n., Captain Vidal, E.N., the Honourable Mountstuart Elphin stone, Mr. W. E. Hamilton, Captain Beechey, e.n., Sir George Staunton. Roderick Impey Murchison, proposed by Sir John Franklin and seconded by Major the Honourable George Keppel (Earl of Albemarle since 1852), was elected a Member of the Raleigh Club on February 1st, 1830. The first regular meeting of the Club took place at the Thatched House at 6 o'clock on the 7th of February, 1827, when Mr. Marsden took the chair. The great Orientalist, who died in 1836, was then aged seventy-three, and no doubt the oldest Member present. Sir Arthur Broke presented a haunch of reindeer venison from Spitzbergen, a jar of Swedish brandy, rye-cake (Flad Brod) baked near the North Cape, a Norway cheese (Qammel Ost), and preserved cloud-berries from Lap land, for the dinner. It was agreed that each Member should be invited "to present any scarce foreign game, fish, fruits, wines, &c., as a means of adding greatly to the interest of the dinners, not merely from the objects of luxury thus afforded, but also for the observations they will be the means of giving rise to." The evening passed with the greatest enjoyment, and it was agreed that a General Meeting of the Club should take place on the following Tuesday, February 13th, at the Thatched House, for the purpose of deciding upon the rules intended to be proposed. At this General Meeting Mr, Barrow was in the chair; and a set of rules was drawn up and confii-med. From that time the dinners of the Raleigh Travellers always took place at the Thatched House. At the next one, on c 18 Success ofthe Raleigh Club. February 19th, Captain Mangles presented some bread, made from wheat brought by him from Heshbon on the Dead Sea. Sir Arthur Broke contributed a brace of capercailzie (coque de hois) from Sweden. On March 5th, 1827, a ham from Mexico was presented for the dinner by Mr. Morier, and the health of that gentleman was accordingly drunk. At this time a rule was made that, as the object of the Club was that travellers may assemble in social converse, who have visited distant countries, particularly those that have been little explored, it should be required of Members who proposed and seconded a candidate to state his qualification in writing, such statement to be read from the chair when the candidate is proposed, and again when his ballot is about to take place. In the year 1828 the names, amongst others, of the Honourable Richard Bootle Wilbraham, Mr. Bartholomew Frere, Captain George Back, e.n., Mr. Nicholas Garry of the Hudson's Bay Company, and Captain the Honourable C. L. Irby, E.N., were added to the list of Members. In 1829 Lieutenant H. Lister Maw, e.n. — the first Englishman who ever went down the Amazon from Peru to the Atlantic — Sir William Ouseley, Colonel Belford Wilson — aide-de-camp to General Bolivar — Francis Baring, Esq., who had just returned from South America, Robert Brown the distinguished botanist, and Captain Blackwood, e.n., became Members of the Raleigh Club. Thus the most eminent Travellers in London were brought together, an interchange of ideas frequently took place, and the feeling that the creation of a more completely organised institution for the advancement of geography was necessary, gradually took a definite shape. The Raleigh Club had freshened up old memories, had kept alive an interest in geographical pursuits, and had prepared the way for more systematic work. It had "lubricated the wheels of science," an expression the origin of which was attributed, by Lord Ellesmere, to Lord Stowell. For this service the geographers of England are indebted to the happy inspiration of Sir Arthur de Capell Broke. After the formation of the Geographical Society, the Raleigh Club continued to flourish, becoming more and more closely connected with the Society, until 1854, when the affiliation became complete and, with new rules, the name of Raleigh was dropped, and it became the Geographical Club. The subsequent history of these dining Clubs thus became a part of the history of the Society. Objects of a Geographical Society. 1 9 CHAPTER V. FOUNDATION OP THE EOYAL GEOGEAPHIOAL SOCIETY. On Monday, the 24th of May, 1830, there was a numerously- attended General Meeting of the Raleigh Travellers' Club, with Mr. Barrow in the Chair. It was then submitted : — " That a Society was needed whose sole object should be the promotion and diffusion of that most important and entertaining branch of knowledge — geography; and that a useful Society might therefore be formed, imder the name of the Geographical Society of London : that the interest excited by this department of science is universally felt, that its advantages are of the first importance to mankind in general, and paramount to the welfare of a maritime nation like Great Britain, with its numerous and estensive foreign possessions ; that its decided utility in conferring just and distinct notions of the physical and political relations of our globe must be obvious to every one, and is the more enhanced by this species of knowledge being obtainable without much difficulty, while at the same time it affords a copious source of rational amusement ; and finally that, although there is a vast store of geo graphical information existing in Great Britain, yet it is so scattered and dis persed, either in large books that are not generally accessible, or in the bureaus of public departments, or in the possession of private individuals, as to be nearly unavailable to the public." These propositions were unanimously accepted as sound and true. It was then suggested that the objects of such a Society would be — • " 1. To collect, register and digest, and to print for the use of Members and the public at large, in a cheap form and at certain intervals, such new, inte resting, and useful facts and discoveries as the Society may have in its pos session, and may from time to time acquire. " 2. To accumulate gradually a library of the best books on geography — a complete collection of maps and charts from the earliest period of rude geo- gi-aphical delineations to the most improved of the present time ; as well as all such documents and materials as may convey the best information to persons intending to visit foreign countries, it being of the greatest utility to a traveller to be aware, previously to his setting out, of what has been already done, and what is still wanting, in the countries he may intend to visit. " 3. To procure specimens of such instruments as experience has shown t« be most useful and best adapted to the compendious stock of a traveller, by consulting which he may make himself familiar with their use. " 4. To prepare brief instructions for such as are setting out on their travels, pointing out tbe parts most desirable to be visited, the best and most prac ticable means of proceeding thither, the researches most essential to make, phenomena to be observed, the subjects of natural history most desirable to be procured, and to obtain all such infonnation as may tend to the extension of our geogi'aphical knowledge. And it is hoped that the Society may ulti mately be enabled from its funds to render pecuniary assistance to such 0 2 20 Mr. Barrow. — Mr. Robert Brown. travellers as may require it, in order to facilitate the attainment of some par ticular object of research. " 5. To correspond with similar Societies that may be established in dif ferent parts of the world ; with foreign individuals engaged in geographical pursuits, and with the most intelligent British residents in the various remote settlements of the Empire. "6. To open a communication with all those philosophical and literary Societies with which geography is connected ; for as all are fellow-labourers in the different departments ofthe same vineyard, their united efforts cannot fail mutually to assist each other." The meeting then proceeded to nominate a Provisional Committee, consisting of six Members of the Raleigh Club, namely Mr. Barrow, Mr. Robert Brown, Mr. Roderick I. Murchison, Mr. John Cam Hobhouse, Mr. Mountstuart El phinstone, and Mr. Bartie Frere ; to consider and propose resolutions to be submitted to another General Meeting. These six Founders of the Society were representative men, and a history of the Society's origin would be incomplete without a retrospective notice of their previous careers. John Barrow, who was born near TJlverstone in North Lancashire in June 1 764, evinced an ardent love of adventure and travel from his early youth. He quitted his employment as a clerk in an iron foundry to go for a voyage to Greenland in a whaler. Soon afterwards he received an appointment on the staff of Lord Macartney's Embassy, and went to China ; the results of his service on that occasion being a Life of Lord I\Iacartney, and a book of Travels in China and Cochin China. In 1797 he accompanied Lord Macartney to the Cape of Good Hope on his important mission to settle the government there, and Mr. Barrow remained as Auditor-General of Accounts. He returned to England in 1803, and published his ' Travels in Southern Africa.' The following year Lord Melville appointed him Secretary to the Admiralty. In this influential position he worked steadily and untiringly for the advancement of science, and especially for the spread of geographical knowledge. After the death of Sir Joseph Banks, it is to Mr. Barrow that all Government aid to geography is due, including the despatch of the Arctic Expeditions and of several exploring expeditions to Africa. In 1830 Mr. Barrow was certainly the warmest and most powerful friend to geographical science in this country. Mr. Robert Brown was born at Montrose in 1773, the son of the Episcopalian minister of that place. For a short time he was an Assistant Surgeon in an infantry regiment, but, through the kindness of Sir Joseph Banks, his prospects in life were changed, and in 1801 he was appointed naturalist to the scientific expedition which sailed in that year for Australia. Returning iu 1805, his collections and discoveries threw an Early Life of Roderick Murchison. 21 entirely new light on the geographical distribution of vegetable life. Afterwards, as Secretary and President, he was for many years the mainstay of the Linnean 'Society. Baron Humboldt bore witness to " the vast impulse which Robert Brown gave to the three great objects which- must for ever remain attached to his name — the minute development of the relations of organisa tion in natural families, the geography of plants, and the estimate of their numerical proportions." He was known among scientific men as " Princeps Botanicorum," but he was ever a sincere friend to geography. Robert Brown contributed the botanical appendix to several important works, such as Parry's 'Voyages,' Salt's 'Abyssinia,' and Clapperton's 'Journey.' He died in 1858, at which time he was President of the Linnean Society. Roderick Impey Murchison was the son of Dr. Kenneth Murchison of Tarradale in Ross-shire, by a daughter of Mac kenzie of Fairburn, and was born at Tarradale on the 19th of February, 1792. His mother's dearest friend was Miss Annie Robinson, daughter of the Provost of Dingwall in Ross-shire, the iuture wife of Mr. John Gladstone, and long before her marriage the mother of the Prime Minister often carried in her arms the ¦child who was hereafter to be our revered President. Roderick Murchison lost his father when he was a child, and his guardians were Colonel Alexander and his godfather Sir Elijah Impey, old Indian fiiends of Dr. Murchison. His mother married again, and he was sent to school at Durham when he vas seven ; but he always attributed the English accent, which he retained through life, to Sally the Dorsetshire lass, who taught him even before he was sent to school. From Durham he went to the military college at Great Marlow, and he was gazetted an ensign in the 36th regiment at the age of fifteen. His uncle General Mackenzie wrote of him as a charming boy, manly, sensible, generous, and warm-hearted. After a short service in Ireland, he sailed for Portugal in 1808, and was present at the battles of Rorija, Vimeira, and Coruiia, returning home after Sir John Moore's disaster. In 1814 he exchanged into the cavalry, joining the Inniskilling Dragoons, but was disappointed in his object, which was to be -sent to Belgium, where he would have taken part in the Waterloo campaign. His troop did not go, and the war came to an end. So young Murchison retired from the army, and in August 1815 he was married to Charlotte, the daughter of General Hugonin of Nursted House in Hamp shire. After passing some time in Italy, the newly-married couple settled at Barnard Castle in Durham, and Roderick Murchison became one of the greatest fox-hunters in the north of England. His devotion to hunting led to their moving to Melton Mowbray, but in 1824 he sold his hunters and passed 22 Sir John Hobhouse. — Mountstuart Elphinstone. the winter with his father-in-law at Nursted. It was at this time that he met Sir Humphrey Davy, when staying with his friend Mr. Morritt at Rokeby. The advice of this eminent savant, combined with the persuasions of his wife, finally changed Murchison's career, and he buckled to, with a will, at the study of geology. From that moment he devoted his life to science, first learning chemistry at the Royal Institution. In January 1825 he joined the Geological Society, and in 1826 became a Fellow of the Royal Society, continuing steadily at work both in the field and in the study. In 1828 he explored the volcanic region of Auvergne with his wife and Charles Lyell, continuing his geological tour into the Tyrol and Carinthia. He had accepted the appointment of Secretary to the Geological Societ}', and was fast rising into fame as a geologist when he joined this Committee of the Raleigh Club. John Cam Hobhouse, born in 1786, was educated at West minster School and at Cambridge, and in 1810 was the com panion of Lord Byron in his travels through Albania and Greece. He published his well-known 'Journey through Albania ' in 1813, and few works of travel have obtained a more lasting reputation. Succeeding to his father's baronetage in 1831, Sir John Hobhouse was the colleague of Sir Francis Burdett in the representation of Westminster from 1820 to 1833. He afterwards held the important posts of Secretary for Ireland, and President of the Board of Control, and he was created Lord Broughton in 1851. He died in his 83rd year on June 3rd, 1869. As Sir John Hobhouse he was a constant diner at the Raleigh Club, and took a keen interest in geo graphy. He was on the Council of the Geographical Society iu 1831, and again in 1857-58. The Hon. Mountstuart Elphinstone was born in 1779, and went to India at an early age, in the Company's Civil Service. After serving during many stirring events in the Dakhan, Lord Minto selected him to conduct the difficult mission to the Afghans, and at Peshawur he collected a mass of new geo graphical information which was embodied in his ' Account of the Kingdom of Cabul' (1815). In 1810 he became Resident at Poona, and in 1819 Avas appointed Governor of Bombay. He discharged the duties of this important post ^^ ith great abilitv during seven years, and the Elphinstone College is an enduring monument of his rule. After his return to England he devoted .several years to the preparation of his admirable ' History of ilogul Rule in India.' He was on our Council in 1831, Vice- President in 1838-39, again on the Council in 1841 ; but his latter years weio passed in literary retirement. He died on N.n-cmber 20th, 1859, in his 81st year. Bartie Frere. — Admiral Smyth. 23 Bartholomew Frere, brother of the Right Hon. Hookham Frere the intimate friend of Canning, was born in 1776, and educated at Harrow and Cambridge. He then entered the diplomatic service, and was for some time Charge d' Affaires at Constantinople. He was a well read geographer and a scholar, and these accomplishments, as Sir Roderick Murchison bore testimony, were united with the finest qualities of the heart, a playful wit, and the most engaging manners. He served on the Council of the Geographical Society for nearly twenty years, dying in 1852. Of these six Members, Mr. Barrow was the senior, and their meetings took place in his room at the Admiralty. They com bined great experience and knowledge of the world with pro found learning, and in Robert Brown and' Roderick Murchison they had colleagues whose practical experience in the working of the Linnean and Geological Societies was of great use. They met several times during the end of May and beginning of June 1830, settled all the preliminary business, and drew up the rules for the new Society. Meanwhile another Member of the Raleigh Club, Captain W. H. Smyth, e.n., had, early in 1830, not only sketched out a well-conceived scheme for a Geographical Society, but had enrolled many names ; and his zealous exertions, now heartily given to the Committee, materially furthered the successful progress of their work. These then were the seven Founders of the Royal Geo graphical Society, whose names should ever be had in remem brance by English geographers : namely — Sir John Barrow. The Hon. Mountstuart Sir Eoderick Murchison. Elphinstone. Mr. Eobert Brown. Mr. Bartholomew Prere. Lord Broughton. Admiral W. H. Smyth. Roderick Murchison went up the Rhine with his wife, and to Vienna in June 1830, and was absent until October ; and m the following winter he was elected President of the Geo logical Society. This is the reason that his name does not appear in the subsequent proceedings, nor on the list of the first Council of the Geographical Society. As soon as the Committee was ready to submit its Report, another meeting was held at the rooms of the Horticultural Society in Regent Street on July 16th, 1830, Avhen the following Resolutions were adopted, and the Geographical Society of London was constituted. " 1. That the Society be called the Geographical Society of London. " 2. That the number of Ordinary Members be not Innited, but that the 24 Rules. — TTie First Council. number of Honorary Foreign Members be limited as shall hereafter be determined. " 3. That the Council of the Society consist of a President, four Vice-Presi dents, a Treasurer, two Secretaries, and twenty-one other Members, to conduct the affairs of the Society. " 4. That the election of the said Council and OfBcers be annual. " 5. That the office of President be not held by the same individual for a longer period than two cousecutive years, but that he is eligible for re-election after the lapse of one year. " 6. That one of the four Vice-Presidents go out annually ; he being eligible, hoAvever, for re-election after the lapse of one year, but the Treasurer and Secretaries may be annually re-elected. " 7. That seven of the twenty-one other Members constituting the Council go out annually, at the period of the General Election of the officers of the Society. " 8. That the Admission Pee of Memliers be 31., and the Annual Subscrip tion 21., or both may be compounded for by one payment of 201.* " 9. That such part of the Punds of the Society as may not be required for current expenses be placed in the public securities, and vested iu the names of three Trustees, to be hereafter appointed by the President and Council. " 10. That these three Trustees be Supernumerary Members of the Council. " 11. That early in November next a General Meeting be held to decide on a Code of Regulations and Bye-laws for the management of the Society, which the President and Council will in the meantime prepare to be submitted to the said meeting. " 12. And lastly that the following noblemen and gentlemen compose the Council and Officers of the Society for this year (1830) : — President. The Eight Hon. Viscount Goderich, r.R.s. Vioe-Pbesidents. John Barrow, Esq., f.e.s. 1 G. Bellas Greenough, Esq., f.e.s. I Capt. Sir John Franklin, e.n., f,b.s. Lieut.-Col. Leake, f.b.s. Capt. Maconochie, e.n. Treasurer. John Biddulph, Esq. Secretaries. Eev. G. Eenouard {Foreign and Hon. Sec). Council. Viscount Althorp, m.p., f.r.s. Francis Baily, Esq., f.e.s. Capt. Beaufort, r.n., f.r.s. John Britton, Esq., f.s.a. W. Brockedon, Esq. Eobert Brown, Esq., f.b.s. Sir Arthur de C. Broke, f.r.s. Hon. Mountstuart Elphinstone. Capt. Sir Aug. Eraser, k.c.b., f.r.s. Capt. Basil Hall, r.n., f.r.s. W. R. Hamilton, Esq., f.r.s. E. W. Hay, Esq., f.r.s. J. Cam Hobhouse, Esq., f.b.s. Capt. Horsburgh, f.r.s. Colonel Jones, e.b. Capt. Mangles, r.n., f.s.s. Thomas Murdoch, Esq., f.e.s. Et. Hon. Sir George Murray, g.c.b.. F.R.S. Capt. Lord Prudhoe, b.n., f.r.s. Capt. Smyth, E.N., f.k.s. H. G. Ward, Esq." * The Admission Fee and Annual Subscription continue the same. But now (1881) the composition, on entrance, is 28^., or at any subsequent period 25i., if the Entrance Fee be already paid. I Speech of Mr. Barrow. 25 As soon as these Resolutions had been adopted, Mr. Barrow the Chairman, delivered an address explanatory of the general views of the Society. He concluded from the fact that 460 names had already been enrolled on the list of Members that a favourable opinion had been formed of the utility likely to result from the labours of the Society. He spoke in the name of the Foundation Committee, and said that the degree of utility which would be really effected must depend on the attention and assiduity which the President and Council might bestow on the Society's concerns, quite as much as on the stock of knowledge they might bring to the consideration of the several subjects that would come before them. He looked with confidence to aid and zealous co-operation from ofScers, both of the army and navy. He urged that on the exactitude of the minutest details of hydrography mainly depended the safety of navigation, and looked forward to the coihpletion of surveys and to extended observations on prevailing winds and currents. Every accession to hydrographical knowledge must be of great importance to navigation and therefore a fit object for promulgation by the Society. But he added that the Committee hoped that many valuable contributions on geo graphical subjects would be received from other individuals than those who are thus professionally qualified and invited to furnish them. Mr. Barrow went on to suggest the various branches of the subject which should occupy the attention of the traveller ; and concluded with the hope that the Society would shortly be in a position to form a valuable geographical library, and a useful collection of maps and charts. The list of 460 original Members contains 43 naval officers besides the King, 50 ofBcers in the army, and 10 clergymen. It includes most of the leading statesmen of both parties, Wellington and Peel, Aberdeen and Ellenborough, Melville, Goderich, Herries, Bexley, John Russell, Althorp, Huskisson, and a dozen other Members of Parliament. Among botanists, Robert BroAvn, Bentham, Hooker and Lindley ; among geolo gists, Buckland, Greenough, Sedgwick, De la Beche, Egerton, Lyell and Murchison enrolled themselves as original Members of the new Society; with Bailey, Whewell, Lubbock and Hallam, and the engineers Brunei and Rennie. With the great surveyors Colby and Everest, appear also the cartographers Arrowsmith and Walker, and the instrument-maker DoUond. With the Hydrographer Beaufort, the marine surveyors are repre sented by Beechey, Owen, King, Becher, Belcher, Blackwood, Sheringham, Denham, Washington, and Horsburgh, and soon afterwards FitzRoy, Graves, and Stokes. All the leading men 26 The First List of Fellows. of every profession who either saw the importance of advancing the cause of geography, or were actively engaged in its pur suit, had rallied at the call of the Foundation Committee of the Geographical Society ; and thus this new organisation, so urgently needed, and destined to work so much for good in the prosperous future that was in store for it, auspiciously commenced its career. LIST OF MEMBERS GEOGEAPHIOAL SOOIETY, AUGUST 4th, 1830. The Eight Hon. the Earl of Aber deen, K.T., F.E.S., P.S.A. Sir Thomas Dyke Acland, Bart., M.P., F.O.S. Lieut;-Gen. Sir Frederic Adam, g.o.b. John Adamson, Esq., f.S.a. William Ainsworih, Esq. James Alexander, Esq., m.p. Captain J. E. Alexander. J. M. Alsager, Esq. Viscount Althorp, m.p., f.r.s. 10 Sir Edmund Antrobus, Bart. Captain Archer. Eev. Dr. Arnold, f.r.s.. Master of Eugby School. Mr. Aaron Arrowsmith. Mr. J. Arrowsmith. William Astell, Esq., m.p.. Chair man e.i.c. John P. Atkins, Esq. Thomas Eose Auldjo, Esq. Adolph Bach, Esq. John Backhouse, Esq. 20 Alexander Baillie, Esq. George Baillie, Esq. Arthur Baily, Esq. Francis Baily, Esq., r.R.s. Sir P. F. Baker, Bart., f.r.s. Captain Bannister. Alex. Baring, Esq., m.p., f.h.s. Francis Baring, Esq. B. W. Barker, Esq. Rev. John Barlowe. 30 Thos. Barnes, Esq. John Barrow, Esq., f.r.s. Mr. B. B. Bate. Lieutenant-Colonel Batty, f.r.s. Captain H. W. Bayfield, R.N. Captain P. Beaufort, R.N., f.r.s. Henry de la Beche, Esq., f.r.s. Lieutenant A. B. Becher, r.n. The Eight Hon. Sir J. Beckett, Bart., M.P., F.R.S. His Grace the Duke of Bedford, f.s.a. 40 Grosvenor Charles Bedford, Esq. Henry Bedford, Esq. Capt. Frederick Beechey, R.N., f.r.s. Capt. Edward Belcher, R.N., r.G.s. Frederic Debell Bennett, Esq. John Joseph Bennett, Esq. George Bentliam, Esq., F.L.s. E. Bentley, Esq. Henry Berens, Esq., f.e.s. Joseph Berens, Esq. 50 Captain J. Betham, b.i.ji. The Eight Hon. Lord Bexley, f.b.s. John Biddulph, Esq., f.h.s. Jonathan Birch, Esq. Captain Price Blackwood, r.n. William Blake, Esq., f.b.s. Major Blanohard, r.e. John Bolton, Esq. John Bonham, Esq. Captain Bowles, r.n. 60 Lord Brabazon. Captain H. Eowland Brandreth, r.e. E. W. Brayley, Esq., f.s.a. * The names printed in italics are those of Fellows still alive at the fifty-first anni versary in 1881. The First List of Fellows. 27 Earl of Brecknock. Eev. Dr. Brereton, f.s.a. Sir Thomas M. Brisbane, k.c.b., f.b.s. John Britton, Esq., f.s.a. John Broadley, Esq., f.s.a. William Brockedon, Esq. William John Broderip, Esq., f.e.s. 70 Sir Arthur de Capell Broke Bart., F.E.S. James Browne, Esq., m.p. Eobert Brown, Esq. f.b.s. Thomas Brown, Esq. Wade Brown, Esq. M. I. Brunei, Esq., f.b.s. Major-Gen. Sir Alexander Bryce, c.b. J. S. Buckingham, Esq. Professor Buckland, f.b.s. J. William Buckle, Esq. 80 C. Bullen, Esq. Captain F. BuUock, b.n. Dr. J. Bunny. Eof. Chas. P. Burney, D.D., f.e.s. Decimus Burton, Esq., f.s.a. Marquis of Bute, f.b.s. Archdeacon Butler, f.b.s. Captain Theophilus Butler. B. Bond Cabbell, Esq. Earl of Caledon, K.P., f.g.s. 90 John Caley, Esq., f.b.s. John Carey, Esq. Nicholas Carlisle, Esq., f.e.s. Ealph Carr, Jun., Esq. W. Ogle Carr, Esq. John Bonham Carter, Esq., m.p. Samuel Cartwright, Esq., f.g.s. Viscount Castlereagh, m.p. Francis Chantrey, Esq., b.a., f.b.s. William Chaplin, Esq. 100 Aaron Chapman, Esq. Dean of Chichester. J. George Children, Esq., f.e.s. Francis Cholmeley, Esq., m.p., f.h.s. John Christie, Esq. Earl of Clare. Dr. Chas. M. Clarke. Thomas Clarke, Esq. William B. Clarke, Esq. \Villiam Stanley Clarke, Esq. 110 Sir George Clerk, Bart., f.e.s. Captain T. H. Shadwell Gierke. M. Waller Clifton, Esq., f.b.s. The Eight Hon. Sir George Cock- burn, G.C.B., F.B.S. Pepys Ccokerell, Esq. Eev. H. Coddington, f.b.s. H. Colburn, Esq. Lieut.-Colonel Colby, e.e., f.b.s. Viscount Gole, M.p., f.g.s. Captain J. N. Colquhoun, e.a. 120 Shelton Coulson, Esq. W. M. Coulthurst, Esq. Chas. T. Cox, Esq. Lt.-Col. the Hon. J. E. Cradock. W. P. Craufurd, Esq., f.g.s. William Crawfurd, Esq., f.h.s. J. Crawfurd, Esq., f.b.s. The Eight Hon. J. W. Groker, f.b.s. Mr. J. Cross. The Hon. Eobert Curzon, M.P. 130 Lieutenant-Colonel H. Custance. Eichard Hart Davis, Esq., m.p., f.b.s. Lieutenant E. K. DaAvson, e.e. Lieutenant H. M. Denham, b.n. Francis E. Dickinson, Esq. Colonel Sir Alexander Dickson, K.C.B., E.A., F.S.A. John Disney, Esq. George Dollond, Esq., f.e.s. Lieut.-General Sir Eufane Donkin, K.C.B., F.B.S. Captain J. G. Doran. 140 Maj.-Gen. Sir H. Douglas, Bart., F.B.S. W. E. Keith Douglas, Esq., m.p.,f.b.s. Lieutenant-Colonel Carlo Doyle. Captain Charles Drinkwater, e.n. Colonel Drummond, e.a. Edward Drummond, Esq. Lieutenant Thomas Drummond, e.e. Lord Ducie, f.b.s. Sir George Duckett, Bart., f.e.s. The Hon. Captain E. Dundas, e.n. 150 Major W. B. Dundas, b a. Lord Durham, f.g.s. Vioe-Admiral Sir P. C. H. Durham, A. Earle, Esq. H. Earle, Esq. Captain the Hon. W. Edwards. Sir P. de Malpas Grey Egerton, Bart., F.G.S. Lord Eliot, m.p. The Eight Honoprable Lord Ellen- borough, f.h.s. EdAvard Bllice, Esq., f.h.s. 160 Captain the Hon. George Elliot, e.n. The Hon. G. Agar Ellis, m.p., f.e.s. The Hon. Mountstuart Elphinstone. Charles Enderby, Esq. 28 The First List of Fellows. George Enderby, Esq. Captain George Everest, Surveyor- Gen. E.I.C, F.B.S. John Pairlie, Esq. Doctor Falconer. W. Falconer, Esq. Lieut.-Colonel Fanshawe, e.e. 170 Alexander Findlay, Esq. William Henry Pitton, Esq., m.d., F.B.S. Captain Adolphus Fitzclarence, e.n. Lieutenant-Colonel G. Fitzclarence. Edward Forster, Esq., f.e.s. Captain Sir J. Franklin, e.n., f.e.s. Captain Franklin, e.i.a. Colonel Sir Augustus Frazer, k.c.b., B.A., F.B.S. J. W. Freshfield, Esq., r.E.s. John Fuller, Esq., f.h.s. 180 John Gait, Esq., f.s.a. James Gardner, Esq. Nicholas Garry, Esq., Dep. Gov. Hudson's Bay Company, f.h.s. Henry Gawler, Esq. Davies Gilbert, Esq., m.p., p.e.s. Earl of Glasgow, f.b.s. Eight Hon. Visct. Goderich, f.b.s. Isaac Lyon Goldsmid, Esq., f.r.s. James Gooden, Esq., f.s.a. Adam Gordon, Esq. 190 Major H. W. Gordon, e.a. Sir I. Willoughby Gordon, Bart., G.C.B., F.H.S. J. E. Gowan, Esq., f.g.s. John Edward Gray, Esq., f.g.s. G. B. Greenough, Esq., f.e.s. Thomas Green, Esq., m.p. Col. Greenwell, a.d.c. to the King. Eev. Richard Greswell. John Griffin, Esq. John Guillemard, Esq., f.b.s. 2C0 Hudson Gurney, Esq., m.p., f.b.s., V.P.S.A. Captain Basil Hall, e.n., f.e.s. Lieutenant W. S. Hall. Henry Hallam, Esq., f.e.s. Terrick Hamilton, Esq. William Richard Hamilton, Esq., F.E.S. George Hammond, Esq. Lieutenant Harding, e.n. The Eight Honourable Sir Heni-y Hardinge, k.c.b. Right Honourable Earl of Hard- wicke, K.G., F.B.S. 210 Major-General Hardwicke, e.i.c, F.B.S. Captain T. G. Harriott. George Harrison, Esq., f.e.s. T. Charles Harrison, Esq., f.g.s. William Harrison, Esq., f.b.s. George Hathom, Esq. Eobert AVilliam Hay, Esq., f.b.s. George Heald, Esq. The Eight Hon. John Charles Her ries, M.P. Lord Marcus Hill. 220 H. W. Hobhouse, Esq. John Cam Hobhouse, Esq., m.E'., F.E.S. Thomas Hoblyn, Esq., f.e.s. James Hoffman, Esq. John Hogg, Esq. Robert Holford, Esq., f.e.s. Doctor Holland, f.e.s. Eichard HoUier, Esq. Professor Hooker, f.b.s. Captain Horsburgh, e.i.c, f.r.s. 230 Vice-Admiral the Honourable Sir Henry Hotham, k.c.b. Vice-Admiral Sir \\'m. Hotham, K.C.B. John Hudson, Esq. Eev. Dr. Hunt, f.s.a. The Eight Hon. William Huskis son, M.p. Sir R. H. Inglis, Bart., M.P., f.e.s. Captain the Honourable Charles Leonard Irby, e.n. Lieutenant Thomas J. Irvine, e.n. Eichard Jenkins, Esq. William Jerdan, Esq., f.b.s. 240 John Heueage Jesse, Esq. Charles Jones, Esq. Thomas Jones, Esq., f.h.s. Colonel Jones, e.e., a.d.c. to the King. R. W. Jones, Esq. William Jones, Esq., f.h.s. Captain Kater, v.p.e.s. Joseph Kay, Esq. Lieutenant Edward Kendall, b.n. Rev. J. Kenrick. 250 Major the Honourable George Kvp- pel, f.s.a. The First List of Fellows. 29 H. Bellenden Ker, Esq., f.r.s. H. T. Kilbee, Esq. Captain Philip Parker King, e.n., F.B.S. Chas. Knight, Esq. H. Gaily Knight, Esq., f.l.s. Aylmer Bourke Lambert, Esq., F.B.S. Edward Copleston, Lord Bishop of Llandaff, f.s.a. Lieutenant Larcom, e.b. William J. Law, Esq. 260 Colonel W. M. Leake, f.b.s. John Lee, Esq., ll.d., f.s.a. Stephen Lee, Esq. Thomas Legh, Esq., f.e.s. John Lindley, Esq., f.e.s. J. A. Lloyd, Esq. William Horton Lloyd, Esq. Edward Hawke Looker, Esq., f.r.s. Professor Long. John Wilson Lowry, Esq. 270 J. W. Lubbock, Esq., f.b.s. George Lyall, Esq. Charles Lyell, Esq., f.r.s. John M'Arthur, Esq. Major J. Macfarlane, e.i.c Alexander Mackenzie, Esq. Harry Mackenzie, Esq. The Right Hon. Sir James Mackin tosh, M.P., F.B.S. Edward Magrath, Esq. Captain Mangles, r.n., f.r.s. 280 Edward Marjoribanks, Esq. William Marsden, Esq., f.r.s. Alexander Marsden, Esq. J. Marshall, Esq., m.p. Eev. J. W. Martin. Joseph Martineau, Esq., f.h.s. G. P. Mathison, Esq. Doctor Maton, f.r.s. Acheson Maxwell, Esq. George Mayer, Esq. 290 The Eight Hon. Lord Viscount Mel ville, K.T., F.E.S. Viscount Milton, f.e.s. Dr. Charles Mitchell. Captain M'Konochie, r.n. Sir Charles Monck, IJart. Moses Montefiore, Esq. Aristides Franklin Mornay, Esq., F.L.s. James Moyes, Esq. Captain E. Z. Mudge, e.b. Captain William Mudge, r.n. 300 Eoderick Impey Murchison, Esq., F.R.S. Thomas Murdoch, Esq., f.r.s. Lieutenant Hastings Murphy, r.b. Lt.-Gen. the Eight Hon. Sir George Murray, g.c.b., f.r.s. John Murray, Esq. T. Laurie Murray, Esq. T. M. Musgrave, Esq. T. Myers, Esq., ll.d. Captain Lord Napier, r.n. Professor Napier. 310 Sir George Nayler, k.g.h., f.r.s. William Nicholson, Esq. George Nicholson, Esq. Alexander Nimmo, Esq. Lord Nugent, m.p., f.s.a. Nathaniel Ogle, Esq. George Ormerod, Esq., f.s.a. Thomas J. Ormerod, Esq. The Eight Hon. Sir Gore Ouseley, Bart., G.C.H., F.R.S. Doctor Outram, e.n. 320 Captain William Fitzwilliam Owen, E.N., F.H.S. P. Page, Esq., f.g.s. G. Palmer, Esq. Lieutenant-Colonel Parker, b.a. Captain Sir William Edward Parry, E.N., F.B.S. Francis Charles Parry, Esq., m.d., F.E.S. Lieut.-Colonel Pasley, e.g., f.b.s. J. Pattison, Esq. The Right Hon. Sir Robert Peel, M.P., F.E.S. J. H. Pelly, Governor Hudson's Bay Company, f.h.s. 330 C. R. Pemberton, Esq. Richard Penn, Esq., f.e.s. W. Hazledine Pepys, Esq., f.b.s. T. Erskine Perry, Esq., f.g.s. Louis Hayes Petit, Esq., f.b.s. Sir Thomas Phillips, Bart., f.b.s. Captain Charles Phillips, e.n., f.b.s. Frederick Pigou, Esq. John Plowes, Esq. Eev. C. Plumer, 340 Admiral Sir Charles Morice Pole, Bart., G.C.B., F.B.S. The Hon. W. Ponsonby, m.p. Charles Pope, Esq. Lord Porchester. Lieutenant Portlock, e.e., f.g.s. 30 Tlie First List of Fellows. Charles Potts, Esq. Benjamin Price, Esq. Captain W. Jones Prowse, e.n. Captain Lord Prudhoe, e.n., f.r.s. John Eadcliffe, Esq. 350 Crosier Eaine, Esq. C. Beading, Esq. George Eennie, Esq., f.b.s. John Rennie, Esq., f.b.s. Rev. George C. Renouard. Lieutenant Benwick, E.B. Dr. Richardson, b.n., f.b.s. Captain Robe, e.b. Lieutenant F. H. Robe. Lieutenant T. Congreve Eobe, e.a. 360 Lieutenant C. G. Eobinson, e.n. Rear-Admiral G. Tremayne Rodd, C.B. P. M. Eoget, Esq., M.D., Sec. e.b. George Rose, Esq. John Rouse, Esq. C. E. Rumbold, Esq. m.p., f.s.a. Lord John Russell, m.p. His Grace the Duke of Rutland. Joseph Sabine, Esq., f.e.s. The Right Hon. Lord St. Helens, G.C.H., f.s.a. 370 Marquis of Salisbury. Major H. Scott, e.a. Claude B. Scott, Esq. Professor Sedgewick, f.e.s., p.g.s. The Bari of Selkirk. Lord Selsey, f.e.s. Nassau William Senior, Esq. Lieutenant W. L. Sheringham, B.N. Captain W. H. Shirreff, e.n. Henry T. Short, Esq. 380 Lord Skelmersdale, f.h.s. Lieutenant M. A. Slater, b.n. Marquis of Sligo, f.h.s. John Smirnove, Esq., f.e.s. Lieut.-Colonel Sir Challes Smith, C.B., E.B. George Smith, Esq., f.l.s. James Smith, Esq. Joseph Smith, Esq., f.e.s. Peter Smith, Esq. William Smith, Esq., m.p., f.e.s. 390 Captain W. H. Smyth, b.n., f.b.s. Thomas Snodgrass, Esq., f.b.s. Captain Sotheby, e.n. William Sotheby, Esq., f.e.s. Sir James South, f.e.s., p.a.s. Alexander Young Speai-man, Esq. Ralph Spearman, Esq. The Right Hon. Earl Spencer, e.g., F.K.S. Captain the Hon. P. Spencer, c.b., e.n. A. Spottiswoode, Esq., m.p. 400 E. Spottiswoode, Esq. Eev. Edward , Stanley. Major-General the Hon. G. A. Chet- wynd Stapylton. Sir George Staunton, Bart., f.e.s. Daniel Stephenson, Esq. Earl Talbot, k.p., f.e.s. Lieutenant - General Sir Herbert Taylor, g.c.h. John Taylor, Esq. Richard Taylor, Esq., f.s.a. Colonel Thatcher, e.i.c 410 J. Deas Thomson, Esq., i'.e.s. Lord Chief-Justice Tindal. Charles Tindal, Esq. Colonel James Tod. Colonel Trench, m.p. W. C. Trevelyan, Esq., f.g.s. Sir Coutts Trotter, Bart. A. B. Valle, Esq. Comte Valsamachi. Colonel Sir C. Broke Vere, k.c.b. 420 Col. Sir H. C. Verney, Part., f.g.s. Lord Vernon, f.b.s. Captain Vetch, e.b., f.g.s. N. A. Vigors, Esq., f.e.s. Horace Waddington, Esq. James Walker, Esq. Mr. John Walker. Mr. John Walker, Jun. H. G. Ward, Esq. John Ward, Esq., m.p. 430 John Ward, Esq., f.h.s. William Ward, Esq., m.p. Lieutenant Washington, e.n. Sir FrederickB. Watson, k.o.h., f.k.s. Ralph Watson, Esq., f.s.a. J. Weale, Esq. Thomas Webb, Esq. His Grace the Duke of Wellington, K.G. Major Wells, e.b. John Weyland, Esq., f.r.s. 440 Eev. W. Whewell, f.e.s.. Prof. Min. Trin. Col. Camb. Frederick White, Esq. The Honourable Richard Bootle Wilbraham, m.p. The First List of Fellows. 31 William Williams, Esq., f.s.a. Eev. Dr. Williams, Master of Win chester College. Charles M. Willich, Esq. John Wilson, Esq., f.h.s. John Wilson, Esq. L. P. Wilson, Esq. Thomas Wilson, Esq. 450 Alderman Winchester, f.h.s. William Wingfield, Esq. Sir Alexander Wood. Captain W. Woodley, e.n. John Woolmore, Esq., d.m.t.h. John Wray, Esq. Sir Jeffry Wyatville, e.a., f.e.s. Mr. James Wyld. Major Wylde, e.a. 460 The Right Honourable Yorke, f.e.s. James Young, Esq. Charles Uh August, 1830. FELLOWS IN THE LIST OF 4th AUGUST, 1830, living ON THE 51sT ANNIVEESAEY, 1881. W. P. Ainsworth, Esq. The Earl of Albemarle (then Major Keppel). Lieut.-Gen. Sir James B. Alexander, cb. John PeUy Atkins, Esq. George Bentham, Esq. The Earl of Enniskillen (then Viscount Cole). Francis H. Dickinson, Esq. Admiral C. E. Drinkwater Bethune, c.b. (then Captain Drinkwater, e.n.). Eev. H. Greswell. Sir Moses Montefiore, Part. Sir T. Erskine Perry. General W. T. Eenwick, e.e. Sir Harry Verney, Part., m.p. James Wyld, Esq. 32 The Bombay Society. CHAPTER VI. PEESIDENTS AND SECEETAEIES OF THE EOYAL GEOGEAPHIOAL SOCIETY, 1830 TO 1850. The new Society commenced its operations under most favour able auspices. King William IV. not only became its Patron, but was also pleased to grant an annual donation of fifty guineas to constitute a premium for the encouragement and promotion of geographical science and discovery. His Majesty desired that the title should be the " Eoyal Geographical Society." The African Association was merged in the Geographical Society, and Mr. Bartie Frere, as its representative, became a Member of the Council. The Palestine Association, which had been formed early in the century, also resolved that, as the Geographical Society embraced, in its views, purposes similar to those for which the Palestine Association had been instituted. their funds, papers, and books should be made over to the Society, to be employed as the Council may think fit for the promotion of geographical discovery. In 1832 a Geographical Society was formed at Bombay, having in view the elucidation of the geography of Western India and the surrounding countries, and mainly supported by the distinguished surveyors of the Indian Navy. The Bombay Society, in a letter from the Secretary dated the 6th of June, 1832, desired to form a junction with that of London, and to be considered a branch of it, not only that it might ensure its own stability, but that it might acquire additional usefulness and efSciency from the patronage and counsels of the European institution. The Bombay branch expressed a wish to receive instructions from the London Society in refer- rence to the general plan of operations which it should adopt. This application met with a cordial response, and the two Societies continued to co-operate and to work together har moniously.* * The Bombay Society did very good geographical service in its day, and pub lished many valuable memoirs. Its Presidents were : — 1831-38. Captain Sir Charles Malcolm, e.n. 1838^9. Captain Daniel Ross, i.N., p.e.s. 1849-51. Mr. John B. Willoughby, c.s. 1851-52. Commodore Lushington, k.n. ±jora vroaerLcii ana rns (council. 66 The first President of the Eoyal Geographical Society was Viscount Goderich, then Secretary of State for the Colonies ; and the then Chancellor of the Exchequer, Lord Althorp, became one of the first Council ; while other Members of the Eeform Ministry joined the Society. It was a friendly neutral ground for both sides of the House, the Duke of Wellington, Sir Eobert Peel, and Lord Ellenborough enrolling their names as geo graphers at the same time. Frederick John Eobinson was the second son of Lord Grantham. He was Chancellor of the Exchequer in Lord Liverpool's Administration from 1823 to 1827, was created Viscount Goderich in 1827, and, after the death of Mr. Canning, he was Prime Minister from August 1827 to January 1828. In the Eeform Ministry Lord Goderich «as Secretary of State for the Colonies and, at the request of Sir John Barrow, he undertook the duties of first President of the Geographical Society from 1830 to 1833. A goodly company of zealous colleagues rallied round our first President. There were three of the original founders of the Ealeigh Club, Sir Arthur de Capell Broke, Colonel Leake, and Captain Mangles ; and four members of the Foundation Committee, Sir John Barrow, Sir John Hobhouse, Mr. Eobert Brown, and Mr. Mountstuart Elphinstone. Of statesmen there were Lord Althorp and Sir George Murray. Sailors mustered strong. The gallant Sir John Franklin was a Vice-President, and in the Council were Lord Prudhoe, Captain Beaufort, Captain Smyth, Captain Basil Hall — the charming writer — and Captain Mangles. Captain Francis Beaufort's name will ever be held in vene ration by geographers. It appears in the list of our first Council, and in nearly every subsequent list until his death. During his long and honourable career he zealously and staunchly upheld the interests of geography, and maintained the most cordial relations between the Society and the Hydro- graphic Department of the Admiralty. On the death of poor 1853-58. Commodore Sir H. Leake, k.c.b., e.n. 1 858-62. Commodore Wellesley, cb., e.n. 1862-65. Mr. W. E. Frere, c.s. 1865-66. Captain T. Black (P. & 0. Co.) 1866-67. Mr. Claude Erskine, c.s. 1867-69. Lieut.-General Sir E. Napier, k.c.b. 1869-73. Mr. Justice Gibbs. The Secretaries were Dr. Heddle, 1831-42; Dr. Buist, 1842-58; and Dr. Kennelly, 1858-73. The Society published 19 volumes of Transactions with maps, and in 1866 Dr. KenneUy completed an index of the first 17 volumes. But the abolition of the Indian Navy was a fatal blow to the Bombay Geographical Society. In January 1873 it came to an end. It was amalgamated with the Bombay Branch of the Asiatic Society, forming a Geographical Section of it, with a special Sub-Committee and Secretary. D 34 Lord Goderich and his Council. Dalrymple in 1808, he was succeeded as Hydrographer by Captain Hurd, who obtained sanction for employing Captain Beaufort to examine the coast of Karamania in the Levant, while Lieut. W. H. Smyth was employed with the Sicilian flotilla. Captain Hurd died in 1823. Sir Edward Parry was Hydrographer from 1825 to 182S, and in the latter year Captain Beaufort succeeded to a post which he held with great benefit to the service and to geography for twenty-six years. James Horsburgh sat with Beaufort at our first Council Board. Commencing his career as a cabin boy, Horsburgh rose to the command of an Indiaman, and after many years of indefatigable labour in collecting materials, he completed bis 'East India Directory,' which passed through many editions and, as newly edited by our Associate Captain Taylor, is still the recoiinised guide for the navigation of the eastern seas. Horsburgh's superintendence of the publication of charts at the India House commenced in 1810, and continued until his death in 1836. He was an ardent supporter of the Society, and was a benefactor to our library in its first commencement. Eennell, one of the greatest geographers of this century, died only a few months before our Society was inaugurated. Yet he was represented on the Council by his son-in-law. Admiral Sir J. Tremaine Eodd, O.B., who, with Lady Eodd, had assisted Major Eennell in the preparation of his current charts. Sir John Eodd was a benefactor to our library when in its infancy. He died in 1838. In 1844 Lady Eodd presented the Society with a medallion of her father Major Eennell. Among men of science and scholars. Lord Goderich was sup ported by Mr. Baily, Mr. Greenough, Mr. E. W. Hamilton, and Mr. George Long, to whom Eoderick Slurchison was added in 1833. Mr. Francis Baily was one of our first Trustees, and afterwards a Vice-President ; but he was better known as the mainspring of the Astronomical Society, and for his catalogues of stars and Life of Flam steed. He died in 1845. Greenough and Hamilton became Presidents, and George Long was after wards a Secretary of the Society. In topography the Council was represented by Mr. John Britton, and by Mr. Brockedon the artist and Alpine explorer. Such were the men who assisted the first President in the first dawn of our Society. Lord Goderich occupied the Chair from 1830 to 1833 ; when he was succeeded from 1833 to 1835 by Sir George Murray, the Duke's Quartermaster-General during the Peninsula war, and Secretary of State for the Colonies from 1828 to 1830. Sir George died at the age of seventy-four in 1846. Sir John Barrow himself, who had been created a Baronet in Sir John Barrow and the first Secretaries. 35 1835, was our third President, from 1835 to 1837. To this great man the Society mainly owes its existence, and its early prosperity. He looked upon it as likely to confer a lasting benefit on his country, and to be the efficient means ol amassing and disseminating valuable information. He himself was for many years the leading spirit, in this country, in the despatch of expeditions of discovery, and geographers will ever hold his name in reverence. His very numerous geographical articles in the 'Quarterly Eeview,' during a long series of years, had materially increased the interest taken in geo graphy; and thus the ' Quarterly Eeview ' maybe considered as an active agent in leading to the foundation of the Society. Those who have had the privilege of perusing the private cor respondence of naval men of that time, especially the letters of the gallant Fitzjames, know that the career of the Secretary of the Admiralty was marked by endless acts of thoughtful kindness, as well as by the industry and ability with which he served his country. After having been Secretary of the Admiralty for forty years, Sir John Barrow retired in 1845, and died full of years and honours in 1849. A portrait of Sir John Barrow hangs in the Council Eoom of the Society. It is a copy of the picture by Jackson, the original of which is in the collection of Mr. John Murray. The first Secretary of the Society, who organised the opening work and edited the early volumes of our Journal, was a sailor, Captain Alexander Maconochie, e.n., k.h. This officer entererl the navy in 1803, and after seeing active service on the coast of Spain and in the West Indies, became a Lieutenant in 1809. He was a prisoner from that year until 1814, having been obliged to surrender to the Dutch fleet in the Texel, and after the war he served under Sir Alexander Cochrane until he was promoted. At the foundation of the Society, Captain Maconochie became Secretary, an ofiice which he held until 1836. He had been among the foremost promoters of the Society. As Secretary he prepared all the business, had the immediate management of the finance under the Treasurer, superintended the publications, ensured accuracy by a rigid scrutiny, and abstracted the most valuable matter from numerous documents too voluminous to be published entire. For these services, and for his sound judgment, even temper, and untiring zeal, he received the hearty thanks of the Council on his retirement in 1836. He had accepted an appointment in Tasmania, was for some time Secretary to the Government of that colony, and afterwards Superintendent of the penal settlement at Norfolk Island. Captain Maconochie died in 1861. His colleague, as Honorary and Foreign Secretary, was the D 2 36 Captain Washington. — Mr. W. R. Hamilton. Eev. George Cecil Eenouard, who held the appointment for sixteen years, from 1830 to 1846. In early life he had been Chaplain to the Embassy at Constantinople, and afterwards to the Factory at Smyrna, and on returning to Cambridge in 1814 he was elected Professor of Arabic. His acquaintance with the geography and languages of the East made his services most valuable to this and other societies, and he gave his time and talents, in unstinting measure, to correct and improve our publications, and especially to promote a uniform system of orthography. Sir Eoderick Murchison said that " Mr. Ee- nouard's kindly manners and true modesty endeared him to every one on the Council with whom he acted, and when he spoke on any moot point, he was as logical in his deductions as he was accurate in his facts." As Eector of Swanscombe near Gravesend, he was an excellent parish priest, and he died there on February 15th, 1867, aged 87. As a successor to Captain Maconochie, our President Sir John Barrow secured for the Society the able and zealous ser vices of another naval officer. John Washington was born in 1800, and entering the navy in 1812, he saw much active service in the waters of the Chesapeake and on the American coasts. He was promoted when serving in the Forth on the Pacific Station, and got leave to come home from Valparaiso by crossing the Andes to Mendoza, and thence over the Pampas to Buenos Ayres. Afterwards, while serving in the Mediter ranean, Washington explored the interior of Morocco, fixing several positions astronomically. He became a Commander in 1833, and Secretary of the Geographical Society in 1836. In this position he infused vigour into our proceedings, and greatly improved our publications, labouring assiduously with the assistance of only a single clerk. It was Washington who introduced the practice of annually reviewing the progress of geography in the past year. He prepared two such addresses for 1837 and 1838, and it was this initiative which led to the delivery of annual addresses by the Presidents of the Society. Our fourth President occupied the chair, during his first term of office, from 1837 to 1839. Mr. William Eichard Hamilton was born in 1777, and was educated at Harrow and Cambridge, where he acquired thorough classical knowledge. In 1799 he entered the diplomatic service as Private Secretary to Lord Elgin when he went to Constantinople, and in 1801, on the evacuation by the French, he was sent to Egypt to negotiate the terms of peace. He then obtained the cession of several works of Egyptian art, including the famous trilingual stone of Eosetta. In 1802 Lord Elgin obtained the gift of the Par thenon marbles from the Porte. Mr. Hamilton was conveying Mr. Hamilton' s first Address. 37 them to England when the ship was wrecked off Cerigo, and these treasures were submerged, but thanks to the zeal and perseverance of our late President they were rescued from the deep, and have long been among the chief ornaments of the British Museum. In 180!-' Mr. Hamilton became Under-Secre tary of State for Foreign Affairs, a post which he occupied until 1822, when he was appointed Minister at Naples. In 1825 he retired from public life, and gave himself up to the pursuits of literature and science. He was an early member of the Ealeigh Club, was Vice-President of the Society in 1831, on the Council in 1836, and was elected President in 1838. In the first year of his Presidency he set the example of reading an Anniversary Address from the chair, which custom, never since departed from, has been one important means of ensuring the usefulness of our labours, and exciting a general interest in all geographical questions. Previously the Society had been furnished with annual addresses on the progress of geography by the Secre taries, but Mr. Hamilton assumed this duty himself, and his able and admirably conceived discourse of May 1838 is the Inaugural Presidential Address. After developing the links which connect geography with the other sciences, and with history and statistics, Mr. Hamilton thus proceeds : — " But the real geographer becomes at once an ardent traveller, indifferent whether he plunges into the burning heats of tropical deserts, plains, or swamps, launches his boat on the unknown stream, or endures the hardships of an Arctic climate, amidst perpetual snows and ice, or scales the almost inaccessible heights of Chimborazo or the Himalaya. Buoyed up in his greatest difficulties by- the consciousness that he is labouring for the good of his fellow-creatures, he feels delight in the reflection that he is upon ground untrodden by man, that every step he makes will serve to enlarge the sphere of human knowledge, and that he is laying up for himself a store of gratitude and fame." Lord Eipon, in a subsequent Address, said that these stirring words were followed up by such clear and precise analyses of all the prominent geographical researches of the year as to fix a high standard for the discourses of all future Presidents. When those researches had reference lo archaeology and numismatics, or to any point of ancient history, then it was that Mr. Hamilton shone out as the most powerful comparative geographer, and his hearers felt the true value of the application of his learning. With the aid of Captain Washington and Mr. Eenouard, our accomplished fourth President gave renewed vigour to the Society's operations. He was President for a second term, from 1841 to 1843, and Trustee from 1846 to 1857. He was also 38 Mr. Greenough. a very active Trustee of the British Museum, and managed the affairs of the Dilettanti Club until within a week of his death. Mr. Hamilton died at the great age of 82, in 1859. Mr. Hamilton was succeeded in the chair of our Society by one of its greatest benefactors, Mr. George Bellas Greenough, who was a Vice-President when the Society was founded, and President from 1839 to 1841. Born in 1778, Mr. Greenough was educated at Eton and Cambridge, and in 1798 went to Gottingen, where the eloquence of Blumenbach attracted him to the study of natural science ; and he afterwards acquired the elements of geology and mineralogy under Werner at Freiburg. From 1802 to 1807 he was actively connected with the Eoyal Institution, and in the latter year he founded the Geological Society and became its first President. His chief geological work was the map of England and Wales, and he also pub lished a ' Critical Examination of the first principles of Geology,' which deservedly attracted much attention at the time. In 1824 Mr. Greenough built a villa in the Eegent's Park, where he formed a fine library and a large collection of maps and charts. He was one of the leaders of the first British Associa tion Meeting at York in 1831, and in the same year was elected a Vice-President of our Society, an office which he held until he became President in 1839. His Anniversary Ad dresses were worthy to follow those of Mr. Hamilton, and they can have no higher praise. After resigning the chair, he was either a Vice-President or Member of the Council until his death in 18.54. By his will Mr. Greenough bequeathed his fine collection of geographical books, maps, and charts, to the Society of which he had been so active and useful a member from its foundation until his own death; and he added a sum of 500Z. to defray the expense of accommodating and arranging the collection. Lord Ellesmere, in his address, concluded his notice by saying that it should be the pride of geographers to record their admiration of the deep thinking philosopher and true geographer, George Bellas Greenough. His Lordship also suggested that a bust of Greenough should be placed near the collections with which he so munificently enriched the Society ; and this proposal was promptly adopted. The bust of Greenough, with that of Murchison, stands in the Society's map room. Mr. AV. E. Hamilton succeeded Mr. Greenough, and during this second term of his Presidentship the Society lost the services of its Secretary, Captain AA'ashington. That ac complished surveyor was needed afioat, and he resigned the Secretaryship in 1841. He was appointed to the Blacl Eagle, in which vessel he brought the King of Prussia to England, Colonel Jackson. 39 and soon afterwards was promoted to post rank. Up to 1847 he was surveying in the Blazer, and in 1855 he succeeded Sir Francis Beaufort as Hydrographer to the Admiralty ; maintain ing the same spirit of activity, action, and order in the survey ing service, by following in the footsteps of his revered predecessor. He lost no opportunity presented to him by his official position of rendering essential service to the Society, and of promoting every geographical expedition. He was especially energetic in connection with the search for Sir John Franklin's Expedition, and gave steady and cordial support to Lady Franklin through all her efforts to discover the fate of her husband and his gallant followers. Exhausted by over work in his office, the Hydrographer died in 1864 at Havre, while seeking rest by travelling abroad. Captain ^^"ashington was succeeded by Colonel Jackson, who was our Secretary from 1841 to 1847. Originally in the East India Company's service, this officer volunteered for the Eussian army in 1814, and rose in it to the rank of Colonel of the Staff Corps. When he retired, he received the appointment of Eus.sian Commissioner in London for the Department of Manufactures, and he combined with this duty the Secretaryship of our Society. As a geographer his labours were very useful. He published 'Aide Memoire du Voyageur' in 1834, which contains many hints and instructions for young travellers ; the useful manual, ' What to observe, or the Traveller's Ee- membrancer ;' and also a suggestive paper on ' Picturesque Descriptions.' As Secretary he edited the Journals with ability, and completed an index of the first ten volumes : and he wrote a glossary of geographical terms, a memoir on cartography, and the ' ililitary Topography of Europe,' edited from the French of Lavallee, which in his hands became almost a new work. He thus devoted many of the best years of his life to advancing our science, and, retiring from the Secretaryship iu 1847, he died on March 16th, 1853, in the sixty-third year of his age, Mr. Hamilton was succeeded in 1843 by Mr. Eoderick I. Jlurchison. It has already been seen that the name of pur great President did not appear in the list of our first Council, although he was an active Member of the Foundation Commit tee. When the Geographical Society was founded, Murchison was just commencing his memorable investigations connected with the Silurian formations. He began this work at Llandeilo in the spring of 1831, and in September he was at Bishop- thorpe, active in the foundation of the British Association at York. He continued to work at the geology of South AVales, with ardour and marvellous insight, during the succeeding years. In July 1835 he first proposed the name " Silurian " for 40 Roderick Murchisoji. — Lord Colchester. the formation, in 1836 he and Sedgwick identified the Devo nian rocks with the Old Eed Sandstone of Scotland, and in 1838 his great work ' The Silurian System ' was published. In 1839 Lady Murchison bought the house at 16, Belgrave Square, which was for so many years the centre of kindly hospitality for geographers, where young aspirants received help and en couragement, and the old were welcomed with generous appre ciation. From 1840 to 1843 Murchison was hard at work, with his colleagues De Verneuil and Von Keyserling, in Eastern Europe, investigating the geology of Eussia and the Ural Mountains, and he had only just returned from this important service, when he accepted the office of President of the Geographical Society for the first time. But, even in his busiest and most absorbing geological years, he had never been long absent from the work of our Society. He was on the Council in 1833, Vice-President in 1836, on the Council again in 1838, Vice-President in 1842, and was elected President in May 1843. His Vice-Presidents were his two predecessors, Mr. Hamilton and Mr. Greenough, with Lord Colchester and Sir John Eennie ; and among his Council were Sir John Barrow, Captain Beaufort the Hydrographer, Charles Enderby the great promoter of Antarctic Voyages, Bartie Frere, George Long, Sir Charles Malcolm, and Sir Woodbine Parish. His Secretaries were Colonel Jackson and Mr. Renouard. While still deeply immersed in the preparation of his work on Eussia, Murchison delivered his first Anniversary Address to our Society on May 27th, 1844. On that occasion Sir John Franklin and Sir George Back became Vice-Presidents, and Captains Smyth and Washington joined the Council ; while Sir Henry de la Beche, the Director of the Geological Survey, was welcomed by Murchison as a new Fellow of the Society. The most interesting feature of the new President's first address was the account he gave of the Ural Mountains and the gold pro duce of Siberia. In his second address he announced the de parture from England of our gallant Vice-President, Sir John Franklin, on the memorable expedition during which he died while "forging the last link of the North-West Passage." Murchison was knighted in 1846, the year after vacating the President's chair at the end of his first term. The next President was Lord Colchester, who was born in 1798, was educated at Westminster, and went to sea in 1811. He saw active service during the war, both in the Mediterranean and on the coast of North America, and in 1816 went to China in the Alceste with Lord Amherst's Mission. He accompanied the Ambassador in his journey tlirough China, and drew the sketches which illustrated the history of the embassy. As Mr. W. J. Hamilton. 41 Commander he had the Racehorse during the Greek war in the Levant, and was posted in 1826. He was in command of the Volage on both the east and west coasts of South America, bat retired from active service when she was paid-off. Joining our Society in 1836, he was on the Council in 1840, and President from 1845 to 1847. He continued as Vice-President, or as a Member of the Council, with scarcely any intermission, until 186IJ, the year before his death. During Lord Colchester's term of office it became necessary, owing to want of funds, to reduce the expenses. The Society's financial embarrassment at this period was caused by excessive expenditure on expeditions as compared with the funds at its command, and was increased by the serious commercial crisis of 1846. The Secretaries, Colonel Jackson and Sir. Eenouard, resigned, and it was resolved that there should be two honorary Secretaries, and an Assistant-Secretary on a reduced salary. This new system came into operation when Lord Colchester vacated the chair in 1847. At this time a scheme was sub mitted to the Council for giving more definite direction to its work. It was in the form of a privately printed pamphlet, " On the Organization of geographical labour," and it received the attention of a Special Committee. But the state of the Society's affairs was not then favourable to the proposal. in 1847 Mr. William J. Hamilton became President, Mr. George Long and Major Shadwell Gierke the Honorary Secre taries, and Dr. Humble the paid Assistant-Secretary. Mr. William John Hamilton, the son of the former President Mr. W. E. Hamilton, was born in London on July 5th, 1805. His education was commenced at Charter-house and completed at Gottingen, and in 1827 he entered the diplomatic service as Attache at lAIadrid. In 1835 Mr. Hamilton turned his attention to geology and obtained experience in field work with Sir Eoderick Murchison. Soon afterwards he undertook au expe dition, the main object of which was to investigate the compa rative geography of Asia Minor. His ' Eesearches in Asia Minor, Poutus, and Armenia,' were published in two volumes, in 1842. For his valuable labours he was honoured with the Founder's Medal of our Society in 1843. He was our President from 1847 to 1849, and was twice President of the Geological Society. He was also Conservative Member for Newport from 1841 to 1847, and Chairman of the Great Indian Peninsula Eailvvay Company. He was a most enlightened and zealous supporter of our Society, and continued on the Council until his death on June 27th, 1867. Mr. Hamilton was the father-in- law of one of our best and noblest naval Associates, the late Commodore Goodenough, whose father was also on our Council. 42 Mr. Long. — Major Shadwell Gierke. Of the two Secretaries elected in 1847, Mr. George Long was an original Member, and had constantly been a Member of Council or Vice-President. Born at Poulton, in Lancashire, in 1800, he was of Trinity College, Cambridge, and was a Wrangler in 1822. He was afterwards a Professor in the London tfni- versity, and took an active part in promoting the work of the Society for the diffusion of Useful Knowledge. He was one of the Editors ofthe ' Penny Cyclopaedia,' and the principal contri butor to the valuable geographical articles in that work. A profound classical scholar, Mr. Long was the translator of Marcus Aurelius and Epictetus, and he contributed a paper on the Eivers of Susiana to our 'Journal' in 1842. After retiring from the Secretaryship, he was on the Council until 1851 ; and he died at Portfield, near Chichester, on August 10th, 1879. Major Shadwell Gierke, the Foreign Secretary, was an officer of great talent. He entered the army iu 1804, and served with credit and gallantry in the Peninsular War, but he was wounded before Burgos, which resulted in the loss of a limb. He was actuated by a true zeal for geography, and an earnest desire to infuse a love for science into the services. With the latter object in view he ably conducted the ' United Service Journal,' and was one of the founders, with Admiral Smyth, of the United Service Museum. Major Shadwell Gierke was on our Council in 1845-46, Foreign Secretary in 1847-48, and was also Treasurer and Secretary of the Ealeigh Club. He died in 1849. Mr. Hamilton, with the aid of these two zealous and accom plished Secretaries, ably presided over our affairs. But cir cumstances were, at that time, against success, and the prospects of the Society were not encouraging. Mr. Hamilton himself took a broad and enlightened view of our work. He said in his last Address ; — •" that it is only by a complete union of scientific truth with popular interest that we can hope to see the science of geography take that hold of the public mind in this country, which shall ensure it the support necessary to secure its efficiency, and to maintain it in a healthful and powerful condition." It was by a steady adherence to the principle thus laid down by Mr. Hamilton, that the Society's progress was ensured, and that its subsequent prosperity became so great. The work of retrenchment, preparatory to very energetic measures to increase our numbers and efficiency, was commenced by the next Presi dent, Admiral Smyth, whose bold and yet prudent management formed the turning-point ofthe Society's history. Admiral Smyth. 43 CHAPTEE VIL PRESIDENTS and SECEETAEIES OF THE ROYAL GEOGRAPHICAL SOCIETY, 1851 TO 1881. Admieal W. H. Smyth, c.b., who was President from 1849 to 1851, was the restorer of the prosperity of the Society. He was descended from Captain John Smith, whose valour and genius were so instrumental in the colonisation of Virginia. His father, Mr. Joseph Smyth, had estates in New Jersey, which were confiscated when the American Eevolution suc ceeded, owing to his staunch loyalty to the old country. His only son, born on January 21st, 1788, entered the navy in 1805, and saw active war service in the China and Indian seas. In 1810 he was in command of a large gunboat in the defence of Cadiz, and was often engaged and under heavy fire from the French forts. As a reward for his excellent services at Cadiz, and for a valuable survey he had made of the Isla de Leon and adjacent coast, he was promoted to the rank of Lieutenant in 1813, and was sent to command a flotilla employed in the defence of Sicily. He executed some most valuable surveys, entirely through his own resources, for which he was made Commander in 1815. His 'Atlas of Sicily,' with a memoir, was published soon afterwards. From this time he was, for several years, actively engaged on surveys in the Mediterranean and Adriatic, first in the Aid, and from 1821 in the Adventure. His labours raised him to the first rank among maritime sur veyors, and Sir Francis Beaufort, the Hydrographer, wrote to him : " The more I see of your Mediterranean Surveys, the more I admire the extent of your labours, the perseverance of your researches, the acuteness of your details, and the taste with which you have executed the charts." Smyth was pro moted to post rank in 1824, and paid-off the Adventure in November of the same year. As an astronomer and meteoro logist he was an untiring observer to the close of his life. He erected an observatory at Bedford, and from 1828 to 1842 a meteorological register was kept there and at Cardiff, which was published monthly in the ' United Service Journal.' Admiral Smyth's equatorial refractor was one of the first constructed in this country, and with it he made a series of 44 Br. Norton Shaw. observations of the highest value. His astronomical instru ments were afterwards transferred to Dr. Lee's observatory at Hartwell, and in 1844 Admiral Smyth published his ' Cycle of Celestial Objects.' As an astronomer this distinguished officer stood in the first rank, and he was also an accomplished anti quary and numismatist. He translated and edited the 'His tory of the New World,' by Girolamo Benzoni, in 1857, for the Hakluyt Society. But it is for his great attainments as a geographer and hydrographer that our Society cherishes his memory. We have seen that he was one of our Founders. He was constantly on our Council from 1830, and Vice-President in 1845. He was President of the Society from 1849 to 1850, and Vice-President again from 1851 to 1855. In 1853 he became one of our Gold Medallists for his valuable and very popular work on the Mediterranean, as well as for his surveys. He died, at the age of 77, in September 1865, and his portrait hangs in the Society's Council Eoom. Admiral Smyth's eldest son, Mr. Warington Smyth, served on our Council from 1871 to 1874. The Honorary Secretaries, during Admiral Smyth's Presidency, were Mr. John Hogg and Mr. Trithen. Mr. Hogg of Norton House, near Stockton-upon-Tees, was a zealous antiquary and comparative geographer, who served on our Council for several years, and was one of the Secretaries from 1849 to 1851. He contributed several papers, chiefly on scriptural geography, and always continued to take an interest in our work until his death on September 16th, 1869. Mr. Trithen was an Oriental scholar, and, after serving for a short time as our Secretary, became Professor of Modern Languages at Oxford, where he died in 1855. But the official from whom Admiral Smyth received the most active assistance was Dr. Norton Sliaw, who was appointed Assistant-Secretary in 1849. His activity and zeal were chiefly exerted in procuring numerous additions to the list of Fellows. Norton Shaw was the son of an officer in the Danish service, and was born in one of the Danish West India Islands. He adopted the medical profession, and, before becoming our Assistant-Secretary, he had served as a surgeon under one of the great Companies of ocean steamers. Dr. Norton Shaw infused new life into the Society's proceedings, and through his energetic management the roll of our Fellows first assumed that progressive enlargement which continued long after his retirement. He was Assistant-Secretary for fourteen years, and soon after he resigned in 1863 Lord Stanley appointed him British Consul at Ste. Croix, where he died in 1868. With such efficient aid. Admiral Smyth applied himself vigorously and boldly to the work of restoring the Society's Colonel Yorke. — Dr. Hodgkin. 45 affairs to a prosperous condition. Arrears were called in, and expenditure was reduced until it did not exceed the actual income. Very successful efforts were then made to increase the sterling value of the work, and the interest of the evening meetings, and the result was a considerable rise in the opinion, both at home and abroad, of the merit of the Society, and a rapid and unchecked increase in its numbers. In 1851 Admiral Smyth was able to announce that the Society was fairly afloat again, and his two spirit-stirring Addresses contributed, in no small degree, to this end. But no higher tribute could be offered to the value of Admiral Smyth's services than was done in the generous acknowledgment of his successor. Sir Eoderick Murchison said : — " I found our geo graphical vessel had been so ably piloted through the shoals with which she had been surrounded, and that her crew was in so healthful and sound a condition, that it would be easy for me to steer her onwards with the same genial trade-wind in which her good commander had transferred her to me. The present flourishing condition of the Society is due to the skill and moral courage with which Admiral Smyth conducted your affairs, supported by an efficient Council, and by our zealous Assistant-Secretary Dr. Norton Shaw." Admiral Smyth was succeeded by Sir Eoderick Murchison, who had been knighted in 1846, and was President from 1851 to 1853. The Honorary Secretaries, during this period, were Colonel Philip Yorke and Dr. Hodgkin. Colonel Yorke, the son of the Hon. and Eev. Philip Yorke, Eector of Great Florkesley and Prebendary of Ely, was an officer in the Guards, and always took a warm interest in our work. He was on the Council from 1847 to 1849, Secretary in 1851, and Vice-President in 1853. Colonel Yorke died childless in 1874. Dr. Thomas Hodgkin, a Member of the Society of Friends, was born in 1798, and adopted the medical profession. He was Curator of the Museum at Guy's Hospital, and well known as a very active philanthropist. Dr. Hodgkin was one of our Honorary Secretaries from 1851 to 1862, and Foreign Secretary from 1862 to 1865. He accompanied Sir Moses Montefiore on a mission to Slorocco, for the purpose of obtain ing concessions in favour of the Jewish population, and he undertook two journeys to the Holy Land on philanthropic errands. Whilst on the second of these he was seized with the ill ness which terminated his useful life at Jaffa on April 5th, 1866. During his second term of office. Sir Eoderick was supported by a very strong geographical Council. His Vice-Presidents were the" Earl of EUesniere, Admiral Smyth, Sir Woodbine Parish, and Sir George Back. Among the most active sup porters of the Society was Sir Woodbine Parish, who served 46 The Hakluyt Society. almost continuously as Vice-President or Member of Council, from 1836 to 1853. He was for many years the regular referee on all subjects relating to South America. In the Council were four former Presidents besides Admiral Smyth ; there were the Hydrographer Sir Francis Beaufort, Captain FitzRoy, the sailor Duke of Northumberland (formerly Lord Prudhoe), Colonel Sykes, Sir Gardner Wilkinson, Mr. Murray of the Foreign Office, Mr. Eenouard and Mr. Hogg, the former Secretaries, Lieut. Eaper, e.n., the author of the standard work on naviga tion, and John Arrowsmith the cartographer.. Another great acquisition to the Council was Mr. A. G. Findlay. He served on it, almost continuously, from 1857 to 1874, and his assistance was highly valued by his colleagues, for his sound hydro- graphical knowledge. Hitherto one branch of geographical work, which had been considered essential in the days of Hakluyt and of Purchas, and is even more important now to the comparative geographer, had not been provided for. While current work was collected and published, no progress had been made in the efficient editing of earlier labours in the geographical field. But in 1847 the Hakluyt Society was formed for the purpose of printing rare and unpublished voyages and travels. This is a legitimate part of the work of geographers. For " the narratives of tra vellers and navigators make us acquainted with the earth, its inhabitants and productions ; they exhibit the growth of inter course among mankind, with its effects on civilization, and, while instructing, they at the same time awaken attention by recounting the toils and adventures of those who first explored unknown and distant regions." Sir Eoderick at once perceived the importance of these objects, he became President of the Hakluyt Society at its foundation, and continued to bold that office until his lamented death, looking upon the Hakluyt as an auxiliary to the Geographical Society. In 1847 and 1848 the Secretary was Mr. Desborough Cooley, but in 1849 he was succeeded by Mr. E. H. Major of the Map Department in the British Museum, and by 1850 the Society was in that flourishing state in which it has ever since continued, performing work which is a needful supplement to that of the Eoyal Geographical Society. Another important service to our science was done by Sir Eoderick at this time. The papers on geographical subjects sent to the British Association had, since its founda tion in 1831, been considered in the Geological Section. But in 1850 our President obtained a separate Geographical Section for us — Section E, and in 1851 the Geographical Section of the British Association assembled for the first time at Ipswich. The annual organization of this Section, after our Lord Ellesmere. 47 own Session has come to a close, and its supply with original papers or reviews of work done, has ever since been an interesting and useful branch of the business of our Society. Sir Eoderick Murchison's Anniversary Addresses, during his second term, were distinguished for those painstaking analyses of the work of travellers, and generous recognitions of their merits, which have invested the whole series of his geographical discourses with permanent value. He also commenced those brief but lucid essays on some special point which subsequently formed an admirable feature of his Addresses. In 1852 and 1853 he discoursed on the great features of the African Con tinent, and on the physical geography of the ocean. Sir Eoderick extended his private hospitality, in the most liberal manner, to all the members of the Society, and frequently afforded them the opportunity of meeting the most distin guished men of the day at his receptions in Belgrave Square. There can be no doubt that these soirees lent great support to the vigorous efforts of Dr. Norton Shaw in increasing the number of Fellows. This stimulating influence reached its highest point when the assemblies were held in the great art galleries of Lord Ellesmere and Lord Ashburton. The next President, who occupied the chair from 1853 to 1855, was, from his position and his love for geography, most admirably fitted for the post. Lord Francis Egerton was born on January 1st, 1800, and, as second son of the first Duke of Sutherland, became heir to the Duke of Bridgewater and was created Earl of Ellesmere in 1846. Educated at Eton and dis tinguished at Oxford, he soon took a high place in the House of Commons, and \\a.& Secretary for Ireland in the Duke of Wellington's administration (1828-30). But Lord Ellesmere, during the course of his useful and well-spent life, showed a greater love for literature and the arts than for politics. Between 1834 and 1854 he contributed fifteen articles to the ' Quarterly Eeview,' and about half related to geographical research. In these charming essays he has discussed the manners and usages of the Japanese as told by the old Dutch writers, the chivalrous expedition of Eajah Brooke, and the researches of our Arctic and Antarctic explorers. Master of several languages, Lord Ellesmere was a poet by nature, and was thus able to put before his countrymen the thoughts of Goethe and of Schiller. Above all he was full of sympathy for the efforts of others, and, on several occasions, sustained with his purse men of genius who were labouring under difficulties, and who but for his timely aid could never have produced works which have taken a high place in science and letters. In the first year of Lord EUesmere's Presidency, that dis- 48 Sir Walter Trevelyan. tinguished Surveyor, Captain Francis Price Blackwood was Honorary Secretary, with Dr. Hodgkin. In 1841 Captain Blackwood had been appointed to the Fly, to assign the true positions and exact limits to the Great Barrier Eeef, which stretches along the north-eastern shore of Australia. In the four years that he was thus employed, more than a thousand miles were surveyed and charted, and a beacon 70 feet in height was raised on Eaine's Islet as a guide for passing through the Barrier Eeef. In 1851 he went to Helsingborg, to observe the eclipse of the sun, and carefully examined the extraordinary projections of flame from the sun's limb. Captain Blackwood died in 1854, and was succeeded, as Honorary Secretary, by Sir Walter Trevelyan, one of our oldest and most zealous members, who had been on the Council since 1843. After passing through Harrow and Cambridge, Sir Walter studied at Edinburgh, and became an excellent botanist and sound geologist; and he was besides an accomplished antiquary. In 1821 he visited the Faroe Islands, and was the author of an excellent work, to which his name is not attached, entitled ' Greenland, Iceland, and the Faroe Islands.' Sir Walter Trevelyan was Honorary Secretary from 1854 to 1857, Vice-President in 1857, and one of our Trustees from 1860 until his death, which took place at Wallington, his seat in Northumberland, on March 23rd, 1879, when he was in his eighty-second year. Thus ably supported. Lord EUesmere's term of office saw the Society rapidly increasing in prosperity, and in 1854 it was moved to more spacious and convenient premises in Whitehall Place. Our noble President also obtained the annual Govern ment grant of 500Z. for the map room. He thus put the matter to the Chancellor of the Exchequer : — " The objects of our Society are of a nature which attracts to its operations men not only of first-rate, but of very varied eminence in all depart ments of science and of the public service. We can command for our Council and management the services not only of men devoted to our special scientific pursuit, but of others also who are familiar with the conduct of business in every shape. We can thus offer a guarantee for redeeming our obligation to the public. Trust us and you will have no reason to repent of your confidence." The propriety and usefulness of the grant was further guaranteed by the powerful support of Mr. Joseph Hume. The library and maps ^Yere classified and arranged in the new premises by Mr. Trelawney Saunders, who was then the Curator. He drew up an account of the method adopted, which is pre served in our archives. It was a source of great regret that, owing to the rule that a Admiral Beechey. 49 President can only hold office continuously for two years, the Fellows were obliged to lose the services of Lord Ellesmere. In resigning his oifice, he gracefully insisted upon the hospitable privilege of still receiving his colleagues at Bridgewater House. " There are some functions," he said, " whicli I should be reluctant altogether to resign ; and I have been better able than most men, from mere accidents of residence, to collect together, with the least inconvenience to the greatest number, the Members of the Society. If I am not wrong in supposing that such opportunities of occasional intercourse, to use an expression of Lord Stowell, ' lubricate the wheels of science,' I may hope to retain, as a simple Member of this Society, the honour, the privilege, and I must add the singular pleasure to myself, of promoting such intercourse as I have enjoyed as your President." Never has the Society had a warmer friend than Lord Ellesmere, or a President who was, from his varied accomplish ments and popularity, better fitted to preside over its interests. He died, at the age of fifty-seven, on February 18th, 1857. He was succeeded by Admiral Beechey, our Arctic President, the son of the eminent artist Sir William Beechey. Born in February 1796, young Beechey was in Commodore Schomberg's brilliant action off the Isle of France in 1811, and in the Vengeur at the attack on New Orleans. In 1818 he was Lieutenant of the Trent under Franklin, in the Spitzbergen Expedition, of which he published a charming account in after years. No narrative had been given to the public when the expedition returned, and Beechey, remembering old Hakluyt's imputation on some of our early writers who, he says, " should have used more care in preserving the memory of the worthy acts of our nation," made up for the omission in 1843. In 1819-20 Beechey was first Lieutenant of the Hecla in Parry's first voyage, when he wintered at Melville Island. In 1821 he was with Smyth in the Adventure, surveying the north coast of Africa, and he went overland eastward from Tripoli as far as Derna, in July 1822. During the three and a half succeeding years. Captain Beechey had command of the Blossom, engaged on a surveying and exploring voyage in the Pacific and up Behring Strait, where he extended the knowledge of the north coast of America to Cape Barrow. His ' Narrative of the Voyage of the Blossom,' was published in 1831. From 1837 to 1844 he was engaged on the survey of the coast of Ireland, and finally suc ceeded to the important post of Superintendent of the Marine Branch of the Board of Trade, lu 1854 he became a Eear- Admiral, and succeeded Lord Ellesmere as President of the Society in 1856. Suffering from ill-health, he still devoted his 50 The Geographical Club. energies to the advancement of geography, and was transacting the Society's business up to the last week of his life. He died on November 29th, 1856. Sir Roderick Murchison filled the post which was vacated by Admiral Beechey's death for one year, and was then elected President for the regular term of two years, from 1857 to 1859. At this time Mr. Francis Galton succeeded Sir Walter Trevelyan as Honorary Secretary. Mr. Galton, the youngest son of Mr. S. T. Galton of Duddeston near Birmingham, and grandson of Dr. Erasmus Darwin, was born in 1822, and graduated at Trinity College, Cambridge, in 1844. In 1850, at his own cos«t, Mr. Galton fitted out an expedition to explore the interior of Southern Africa, through the country of the Damaras, and the Ovampo. In a journey of upwards of 2000 miles he fixed several positions astronomically, and for this service he was honoured with the Founder's Medal in 1853. In 1860 Mr. Galton published ' The Art of Travel, or Shifts and Contrivances available in Wild Countries,' which went through several editions ; and he also edited a volume entitled ' Vacation Tourists ' in 1862 and some succeeding years. He first joined the Council in 1854, was Secretary from 1857 to 1863, Foreign Secretary from 1865 to 1866, and, though occupied with other scientific pursuits, has ever since worked actively for the Society either as a Member of the Council or Vice-President. During the whole period of the Society's existence, from 1830 to 1854, the old Raleigh Traveller's " Club continued to perform its useful and convivial share of geographical work. Sir Eoderick Murchison always strove to make the connection between the Club and the Society closer and more intimate. In 1834 the Ealeigh Club gave a great dinner to welcome back Sir John Eoss and his illustrious nephew from the Arctic Eegions, and in 1838 a similar reception was given to the oiScers of the Euphrates Expedition. Eeturning travellers ever received a hearty reception at the Ealeigh, and in June 1838 Sir Roderick carried a resolution that the dinners should always take place on the same days as the meetings of the Society. He also urged all its Members to enrol themselves as Fellows of the Society. At last it was thought desirable to make the connection still closer. On the 1st of May, 1854, at a special meeting of the Ealeigh Club, four resolutions were carried by Sir Eoderick: that the Ealeigh Club should be dissolved, in order that a new Club might be formed in closer connection with the Society; that the new Club should be called the Geogeaphical Club, composed of Members of the Ealeigh Club and Fellows of the Geographical Society; that the first dinner should be on June 12th, 1854, and that Sir Sir Roderick Murchison. 51 Eoderick Murchison should be President ; an office which i e held during the rest of his life. Ever since, the dinners of the Geographical Club, with the President in the chair, have taken place previous to the meetings of the Society, to which the Members have adjourned. Here geographers and explorers of all nations have been welcomed and entertained, and our beloved President, Sir Eoderick Murchison, presided at 206 out of the 223 Geographical Club dinners which took place between 1854 and 1870. The annually increasing number of Fellows attending the evening meetings led to the formation of a second dining Club connected with the Society, called the KosMOS Club. It was founded in 1858 by Dr. Norton Shaw, and con tinues to flourish under the auspices of its present Secretary Mr. Bates. In 1859 Earl de Grey and Eipon, the son of our first President, was elected to the same post, but he was obliged to vacate the chair on accepting ofiice in the following year, and was succeeded by Lord Ashburton, from 1860 to 1862. It was in 1859 that the Eoyal Geographical Society received a Charter of Incorporation, and became a body politic and cor porate, with perpetual succession, and a common seal. In this Charter the Council or governing body is declared to consist of a President, Vice-Presidents, a Treasurer, Trustees, Secre taries, and not more than twenty-one other Fellows ; and the Council is to have the sole management of the income and funds of the Society, and the appointment of officers and attendants. The Charter is dated February 8th, in the twenty-second year of Queen Victoria. In May 1862, on the retirement of Lord Ashburton, Sir Eoderick Murchison was elected President for the fourth time, and he continued to occupy the chair during the eight succeed ing years. Sir George Everest, the former Superintendent of the Great Trigonometrical Survey of India, Admiral CoUinson, the talented surveyor and Arctic Explorer, the veteran Sir George Back, John Crawfurd, the learned ethnologist and geographer. Sir Henry Eawlinson, and Viscount Strangford supported him as Vice-Presidents ; while he was aided on the Council by such surveyors as Sir Henry James and Sir Andrew Waugh, by such Arctic Explorers as M'Clintock and Sherard Osborn, by Galton, Baker and Grant among African travellers, and by our most eminent cartographers, Arrowsmith, Findlay, and John Walker. It was decided in 1862 that there should be two Honorary Secretaries, besides the Foreign Secretary ; and Mr. Francis Galton and Mr. William Spottiswoode (now President of the Eo'sal Society) were elected. In the following year Mr. Galton E 2 52 Sir Roderick Murchison. retired, and Mr. Spottiswoode and Mr. Clements Markham became the Honorary Secretaries. Mr. Clements Markham succeeded Mr. Major as Secretary of the Hakluyt Society in 1858, and has continued to hold that post also. In 1865 he was elected Treasurer of the Geographical Club. In 1864 and 1865 Mr. Clements Markham and Mr. Laurence Oliphant were the two Secretaries of the Geographical Society, and in 1866 Mr. Oliphant was replaced by Mi-. E. H. Major. After the retirement of Dr. Norton Shaw in 1863, Mr. Greenfield was Assistant-Secretary for one year, and in 1864 he was succeeded by Mr. Henry Walter Bates, the well-known author of that charming work, 'The Naturalist on the Eiver Amazons.' The Secretariat arrangements have since remained unchanged. Mr. Clements Markham and Mr. Major have, during all the succeed ing years, been the Honorary Secretaries, and Mr. Bates the Assistant-Secretary and Editor of the Society's publications. Sir Eoderick Murchison was created a K.C.B. in 1863, and a Baronet in 1866 ; and from other Sovereigns he also re ceived well-earned honours. During the long period that he presided over the Society^, Sir Roderick saw an extraordinary advance made in geographical discovery in all parts of the world, and his encouragement and active assistance were no slight elements ia the success which attended the efforts of many explorers. Ever steadfast in forwarding the searches for our Vice-President Sir John Franklin, and his brave comrades, Murchison stood by Lady Franklin when the Government abandoned her, and was her warmest friend and supporter when she resolved to despatch M'Clintock's expedition. As regards African explorers. Sir Roderick, as is well known, became the personal friend of Dr. Livingstone, and the energetic supporter of Burton, Speke, Grant and Baker. Livingstone spoke of him as " the best friend I ever had — true, warm, and abiding." Almost the last work of our beloved President was the earnest endeavour to obtain a resumption of Arctic dis covery, which was so warmly advocated by Sherard Osborn. He held that— " independent ofthe great geographical problem to be solved, the navy lacked something to occupy its energies in timeof peace ;" and he sighed for the good days of adventure, of Raleigh and Drake, Hudson and Baffin. The character of Murchison was admirably portrayed by his successor, who served for so many years on the same Council with him. "Industry and energy, a clear head, a strong will, and great tenacity of purpose were among his leading character istics ; while his warm feelings, his thorough honesty, his kind ness of manner, his entire absence of jealousy, his geniality, fine temper, tact and firmness, peculiarly fitted him to preside over Jolm Crawfurd. 53 public bodies, and to lead his followers to good and useful ends. Many a young traveller has been sustained under his hardships by Sir Eoderick's hopeful counsels. Sir Eoderick indeed never deserted a friend in need. At one time he might be seen urging the Government to send out expeditions to search for Franklin ; at another he would be energetically defending Governor Eyre, an old Medallist of the Society, from what he regarded as persecution. When Speke and Grant were supposed to be in diificulties in Africa, he was active in organising relief He was ever a steady supporter of Sir Samuel Baker ; and with Livingstone his name is entirely identified." One well-known face was missing from our meetings before we sustained the great loss of our revered President. Sir Roderick lived to record the merits of John Crawfurd, the great traveller and scholar. Born on the Island of Islay in 1783, Mr. Crawfurd was in his 8.5th year when he was unexpectedly carried off. In the East India Company's service, he was in the campaign with Lord Lake, but was soon afterwards transferred to Penang, where he commenced those studies of the Malay languages and people which enabled him eventually to compose his Malay grammar and dictionary. In 1811 he accompanied Lord Minto in his expedition to Java. Here he remained for nearly six years, amassing ethnological and geographical mate rials ; the results of his researches appearing in 1820, in his 'History of the Indian Archipelago.' In 1821 he was sent on a mission to Siam and Cochin China, and he acted as Governor of Singapore from 1823 to 1826. In tlie latter year he went to the capital of Burma on au important mission, and on his return to England he took a somewhat leading part in the advocacy of free trade. Afterwards he devoted his energies to the study of ethnology, and was the life and soul of the Ethnological Society for many years, writing no less than thirty-eight memoirs for its journal. He first came upon the Council of our Society in 1857, and continued to serve upon it, and to be a constant attendant of our meetings, until his death in 1867. He scarcely ever failed to take part in our discussions, and while stoutly maintaining his own views, he always showed forbearance and courtesy to others. Sir Eoderick deeply felt the loss of his dear old friend John Crawfurd. He was himself struck down with paralysis in the end of 1870, and he died full of years and honours on October 22nd, 1871. His remains were followed to tlie grave by his successor Sir Henry Eawlinson, by the Secretaries Mr. Clements Markham and 31r. 31ajor, by the Assistant-Secretary Mr. .Bates, and by Admiral Collinsou, Admiral Eichards, Colonel Grant, and Mr. John Murray. He bequeathed lOOOZ. to the Society 54 Sir Henry Rawlinson. he had served so well ; and his bust now stands in the Map Eoom. There is also a portrait of Sir Eoderick in the Society's Council Eoom. In each of his Anniversary Addresses Sir Eoderick Murchi son usually dwelt upon one special point relating to discovery or to a question of physical geography, which formed a com plete essay in itself. In 1853 his theme was physical geography; in 1857, earthquakes; in 1863, the sources of the Nile ; in 1864, the glaciers of the Himalayas and New Zealand compared with those of Europe, and on the power of glaciers in modifying the surface of the earth, and the agency of floating icebergs ; in 1865, on the importance of Arctic research ; in 1867, on the Aralo-Oaspian basin; in 1868, on the dependence of geography on geology ; in 1869, on a comparison between the former and present physical changes of the surface of the earth ; and, in 1871, on the connection of geographical with geological science. Sir Eoderick Murchison was succeeded as President of the Geographical Society and of the Club by Sir Henry Eawlinson, and as President of the Hakluyt Society by Sir David Dundas. Since 1871 the President of the Society for the time being has always been President of the Geographical Club. Henry Creswicke Eawlinson was born in 1810, and served in the Bombay army from 1827 until 1833. From the latter year until 1839 he was actively employed in Persia. During that period he explored, with great zeal, perseverance, and industry, the provinces of Luristan, Khuzistan, and Azerbaijan, and the mountain ranges which divide the basin of the Tigris from the elevated plains of Central Persia. He brought great learning and a vast extent of historical research to bear on his geographi cal enquiries, and identified rivers and towns by a comparison of their ancient and modern names. For these great services to geography Major Eawlinson received the Founder's Medal in 1839. In 1840 he was appointed Political Agent at Kandahar, and he held the southern capital of the Afghans in safety, throughout all the troubles that ensued, eventually returning to India by way of Kabul and the Kaibar Pass. In 1844 he became Political Agent in Turkish Arabia, and in 1851 Consul- General, resigning his appointment in 1855, when he returned home, and became a Director of the East India Company and K.C.B. He had first joined our Council in 1850, and was almost constantly Vice-President until Sir Roderick's death in 1871. During 1858-59 he was Envoy in Persia, and has since 1868 been a Member of the Council of India. Sir Henry Eawlinson was President from 1871 to 1873, again from 1874 to 1876, and has since been Vice-President. Sir Bartie Frere. 5.j Sir Henry Bartie Frere succeeded Sir Henry Eawlinson as President in 1873. He is a nephew of Mr. Bartie Frere, one of the Founders of our Society, and also of the Eight Hon. John Hookham Frere. Born in 1815, and entering the Indian Civil Service in 1833, he became Eesident in Sind in 1856, a K.C.B. in 1859, and was Governor of Bombay from 1862 to 1867. Always taking an instructed and warm interest in geographical pursuits Sir Bartie Frere has contributed papers to our Journal, and has done valuable service to the Society in many other ways. He had joined our Council soon after his return to this country, and in November 1872 a farewell dinner, with the President Sir Henry .Eawlinson in the chair, was given to him on his departure to Zanzibar on an important diplomatic mission. It was the largest gathering of the Geographical Club that had ever taken place up to that time. On that occasion our President said that Sir Bartie Frere's administration of Sind, during the Sepoy mutiny, evinced the very highest qualities of statesmanship, and that his great administrative success was achieved under every possible disadvantage and when, in other parts of India, disorder and rapine reigned supreme. It was under such circumstances that Sir Bartie succeeded in converting the lawless marauders of Sind into a peaceful and industrious peasantry. His subsequent govern ment of Bombay is still remembered in the island with feelings of the utmost gratitude, and no Indian statesman was ever more beloved by every class of the native population. On his return from Zanzibar Sir Bartie Frere was elected President of the Society, in May 1873. He was obliged to resign in the follow ing year in order to accompany the Prince of Wales to India, and soon after his return he went out as Governor of the Cape and High Commissioner in the end of 1875. While filling that responsible post, during a most anxious and difficult period, he never lost sight of the interests of our Society, and was ever ready to extend the most cordial assistance and encourage ment to explorers of all nations. Leaving the Cape, to the deep regret of the people he had so ably governed, he returned to England in the end of 1880 to be warmly welcomed by his numerous friends and well-wishers at home. His great services to the State had obtained for him the Grand Cross of the Bath, the Grand Commandery of the Star of India, a Baronetcy, and a seat in the Privy Council. Sir Eutherford Alcock, k.c.b., succeeded Sir Henry Eawdinson at the end of his second term of office in 1876. Sir Eutherford's knowledge of China and Japan, where he had served in various diplomatic posts from 1844 to 1871 when as Envoy Extra ordinary and Minister Plenipotentiary at Peking he finally 56 Recent Presidents. retired from active service, made him a great acquisition to our Council He held the office of President from 1876 to 1878, and has since actively aided in the Society's work as Vice- President and as Chairman of the African Exploration Fund Committee. The Earl of Dufferin was elected President in 1878, before he had returned from Canada, and the author of the charming " Letters from High Latitudes," the accomplished statesman and geographer, was very warmly welcomed when he first took the chair in the following November. But his acceptance of the appointment of Ambassador to Eussia obliged him to resign shortly afterwards, and he was succeeded in May 1879 by the Earl of Northbrook. It was a great advantage to the Society that, while we were receiving so much new geographical infor mation from the little-known countries beyond om- north-western frontier, the affairs of the Society should have been presided over by a statesman who had so recently been Viceroy of India. Eesigning, owing to his acceptance of the office of First Lord of the Admiralty, Lord Northbrook was succeeded as President, in May 1880, by Lord Aberdare. The Royal Aioard. 57 CHAPTEE VEIL expeditions PEOMOTED BY THE EOYAL GEOGEAPHIOAL SOCIETY AND GEANTS OF THE EOYAL A-WAEDS, 1830 TO 1855. The measures adopted by the Eoyal Geographical Society for promoting and encouraging discovery and research have been of four kinds. Awards have been presented to eminent ex plorers and geographers, in the form of gold medals, grants of money, gold watches, or instruments. Aid has been given to travellers. The Government has been urged, by the Council, to undertake important discoveries by the despatch of expe ditions ; and, on very rare occasions, the Society has itself undertaken the despatch and conduct of an expedition. The Eoyal Award of 50 guineas was, during the reign of King William, presented in money or as a single medal. Such recognitions have always been highly valued by discoverers and surveyors, and have formed a strong incentive to exertion. They were not wholly wanting in former days, and even, in the dawn of English geography, the Sovereign bestowed honorable decorations on those who nobly and successfully strove to increase our knowledge of the earth's surface by land and sea. Queen Elizabeth presented to Sir Humphrey Gilbert a jewel consisting of a small anchor of beaten gold with a large pearl on the peak, which he evermore wore on his breast. Sir Francis Drake received a medal suspended from his neck by a ribband. The Eoyal Society granted its Copley Medal to geographers on five occasions. Captain Cook received it in 1776, and a medal was also specially struck in his honour. The Copley Medal was granted to JMajor Eoy in 1785 for his mea surement of the Hounslow base, to Major Eennell in 1791, and to Captain Sabine and Lieut. Foster, e.n., in 1821 and 1827 for Arctic work. The Society, on its first establishment, and during its early days in King William's reign, found that explorers were actively at work in various parts of the world. The faithful Lander was completing the discoveries of Clapperton on the Niger, Enderby was despatching vessels to the Antarctic Eegions, Eoss was still absent in the far north, and Back was at work on his errand of rescue, Burnes was making his remarkable journey to Bokhara, 58 Expedition of Captain Alexander. Chesney was surveying on the Euphrates, and FitzEoy was exe cuting his valuable surveys along the coasts of South America. These were the first seven recipients, from our Society, of the award granted by King William for geographical discovery and research. In 1832 the sum of fifty guineas was conferred on Mr. Eichard Lander, in acknowledgment of his services in deter mining the course and termination of the Quorra or Niger. A portrait of this intrepid explorer, the faithftd companion of Clapperton, hangs in the Society's Council Eoom. The second Award was granted for Antarctic service. Mr. John Biscoe, E.N., left England in the brig Tula in 1830, despatched by Messrs. Enderby ; and he added one more to the many examples previously set by British seamen of patient and untiring perse verance amidst the most discouraging difficulties. He was the discoverer of Graham's Land and Enderby's Land. Mr. Biscoe died in 1848. Sir John Eoss received the third Award for his discovery of Boothia Felix and King William Land, and for his famous sojourn, during no less than four winters, in the Arctic Eegions. The remarkable and most important journey of Sir Alexander Burnes from Kabul to Bokhara and back through Persia, secured for that accomplished but unfortunate officer the fourth Award granted by the Society. His portrait hangs in the Society's Council Eoom. The fifth, in the form of a medal, was granted to Sir George Back for his memorable journey for the rescue of Eoss, and discovery of the Great Fish Eiver. Captain FitzEoy for his South American surveys and ex ploration of Patagonia, and Colonel Chesney for his Euphrates Expedition won, respectively, the sixth and seventh Awards. The Society, in its early years, did not confine its operations to the annual grant of the Royal Award. Expeditions were despatched, with its aid or under its auspices, to Africa, South America, Asia, and Australia; and active encouragement was extended to explorers. Captain Alexander of the 42nd High landers (the present General Sir James Alexander of Westerton, CO. Stirling) undertook an expedition north of the Orange Eiver. Leaving Cape Town in September 1836, he advanced, through the then unknown country of the Namaquas, as far north as Walfisch Bay, and gave an interesting account of that sterile region. The Council obtained Government aid for Captain Alexander, subscribed towards his expenses, and took a warm interest in his proceedings. He was knighted for his services in Africa; and afterwards commanded the 14th Eegiment at the siege of Sebastopol. The expedition of Schomburgk to Guiana was supported by our funds, and was still more closely connected with our Schomburgk and Ainsworth. 59 Society. Eobert Hermann Schomburgk was a Prussian scien- tifi(^ traveller who was first brought into notice by his careful examination of the West Indian Island of Anegada, and his delineation of the rocks and reefs which surround it. In 1834 his services were engaged by the Society, to discover the interior of British Guiana, and to connect the positions astronomically fixed iu that region, with those of Humboldt on the Upper Orinoco. It was intended that the work should occupy three years, and the Society undertook to contribute 900Z. towards the expenses. Iu pursuance of his instructions Schomburgk left Demerara in September 1835 and, ascending the Essequibo, reached the s.-flr. extremity of British Guiana. Thence he ascended the Eipanuny, and in 1836 he sent home most inte resting accounts of the physical aspects of the region, its vege tation and scenery. In 1837 he ascended the Berbice, and in the following year he reached the Caruma Mountains and the Rio Branco. Schomburgk was engaged on these arduous jour neys during five years, and worthily followed in the footsteps of the illustrious Humboldt, while making a portion of his great predecessor's work more complete. During his researches, he discovered and sent home the magnificent Victoria Begia, con structed an admirable map, and illustrated his discoveries by large and valuable collections. In 1840 he received the Gold Medal of the Society, and in 1843 he was knighted. Sir Eobert Schomburgk edited Sir Walter Ealeigh's ' Discovery of the Empire of Guiana ' in 1848, for the Hakluyt Society^ During the latter years of his life he was Consul-General in Siam, and very soon after his retirement, he died on March 11th, 1865. Another expedition was fostered by our Society, in conjunction with the Society for the promotion of Christian Knowledge. Its object was to make acquaintances with the Nestorian Christians, and the mountainous country they inhabit, and it was entrusted to Mr. Ainsworth, formerly naturalist to the Euphrates Expe dition, and Mr. Eassam of Mosul. Each Society granted a sum of 500Z. towards the expenses ; and joint instructions were care fully prepared. Leaving England in 1838, the travellers ex plored part of Asia Minor, and reached Mosul in 1839, proceeding thence into Kurdistan, and as far as Urumiyah. The expedition closed its labours in 1840, and although the work was not carried out to the extent anticipated, yet a great deal of geographical information was collected along the line of route. In 1837 the Council took an active part in promoting an ex[iedition for geographical discovery in Australia. A deputa tion, composed of the President, Mr. Murchison, and the Hydro grapher, waited upon the Secretary of State for the Colonies, pointing out the advantages likely to accrue from exploring 60 Sir George Back. Australia, and also recommending a nautical survey. The deputation was very favourably received, and a grant was obtained of lOOOZ. for the expenses of a land expedition under Lieuts. Grey, of the 83rd (now Sir George Grey, k.c.b.) and Lushington, to start from Swan Eiver. At the same time a survey of the coast was ordered in H.M.S. Beagle, commanded by Captain Wickhaip. Thus was Australian exploration com menced under the Society's auspices. The Council, from the first foundation of the Society, gave its attention to the important subject of Arctic discovery. Our first efforts were to throw more light on the geography of the northern shores of America. The highest Arctic authorities were invited to furnish the Council with their views on the subject, and valuable minutes were received from Sir John Barrow, Sir John Franklin, Sir John Eoss, Dr. Eichardson, and Captain Beaufort. A committee was then appointed to examine the various plans. The Hydrographer entreated the Council to take every means they possessed of persuading the Government to fit out an expedition, and accordingly a deputation consisting of Lord Eipon, Sir John Franklin, and Captain Back, laid the case before His Majesty's Government in 1836. The authorities were pleased to attend favourably to the representatives of the Council, and Captain Back was appointed to H.M.S. Terror, to proceed with her to the western shore of Sir Thomas Eoe's VA'elcome, to winter there, and thence to complete the explora tion of the American coast in the spring. It is well known that the object of the expedition was frus trated, owing to the impossibility of penetrating through the ice in Frozen Strait. But the failure by Sir George Back has proved better than many a success achieved by less gifted men. The exploration of the patches of coast connecting the discoveries of former explorers was work which could be done at a future time, and for which geographers could wait. But the narrative of the voyage of the Terror, of the hair-breadth escapes, the masterly conduct of the officers, and gallantry of the men, is a distinct gain to our country's literature. It is an Arctic classic — a treasure worth more than many leagues of new coast line. On the accession of Queen Victoria, Her Majesty was pleased to announce her gracious intention of continuing the grant of fifty guineas which was commenced by her uncle. It was then decided that iu future two gold medals should be annually awarded, each of the value of twenty-five guineas, to be called the Founder's and the Patron's Medal. At this time Mr. W. R. Hamilton, in his Anniversary Address, made some interesting remarks on the subject of our medals. He suggested that we The Royal Medals. ' 61 ought to expend the means at our disposal in having the por trait of the receiver engraved upon the die. " We should present him with one impression in silver, and strike off at least a hundred others in bronze for circulation among the various public museums at home and abroad, and for the supply of privaie collections. By such an arrangement the honour, name, and success of the receiver would not only be made known through out Europe, but would be perpetuated, together with the de lineation of his features, to the latest posterity." Mr. Hamilton referred, as an instance in point, to the bronze medal of Capt. Cook, which was struck, with his portrait, by the Eoyal Society, as a testimony of admiration for his great services to geography. Mr. Hamilton added, " But I fear this is a unique instance of the kind in this country." The President mentioned an addi tional argument in favour of his suggestion, namely the encou ragement it would give to a department of the fine arts which had long been neglected by our countrymen. It was eventually decided by the Council that two medals of equal vtdue and equal honour might annually be presented to the two gentlemen who might be judged to have rendered the most distinguished services to the cause of geography. The Founder's Medal bears the portrait of King William IV., and the Patron's Medal that of Her Majesty Queen Victoria. From the return of Schomburgk and Ainsworth until after the restoration of the Society's prosperity by Admiral Smyth, the Council was able to do little more than recognise the merits of travellers by granting the Royal Awards. £100 was granted to Dr. Beke in 1842, and in 1846 the Council obtained grants of small sums from the Government and the East India Com pany for Mr. Brockman, who was about to attempt a journey into the interior of Hadramaut. Otherwise it was only through the bestowal of our Gold Medals that the Society was able to encourage and promote geographical discovery during more than fifteen years. Still, even in our least prosperous period, we continued to encourage exploration, and to do good service by disseminating geographical knowledge through our publications. For work in Asia our Gold Medal was conferred on Sir Henry Rawlinson * iu 1840, and on Lieut. John Wood of the India Navy in 1841, for discovering the source of the Oxus. Lieut. Symonds, e.e., received it in 1843 for his survey in Palestine, and for ascer taining the difference of level between the Dead Sea and the Mediterranean ; our former President, Mr. W. J. Hamilton, in 1844, for his exploration of Asia Minor ; Mr. Layard, in 1849, " See p. 51. 62 Work in Africa and Australia. for his Nineveh excavations; and Baron von Hugel for his enterprising journey into Kashmir in the same year. In 1852 Captain Henry Strachey received the Gold Medal for his exten sive surveys in Western Tibet, and the sum of 25Z. was granted to Dr. Wallin of Helsingfors, for his remarkable journey across Arabia. On this, and some other occasions, the amount of the Eoyal Award was distributed in money, when, in the opinion of the Council, travellers had established for themselves strong claims to participate in the fund, although their services had not been of sufficient importance to justify the award of the medal, which is the highest honour at the disposal of the Society. In Africa the principal work of this period was performed in Abyssinia. Dr. Eiippell, of Frankfort, received the Gold Medal in 1839 for his labours in that country, during which he made a large natural history collection and presented it to the museum of his native country ; and in 1845 the same honour was conferred upon Dr. Beke for his important geographical researches in the Abyssinian kingdom of Shoa, and in the pro vince of Godjam, which he traversed in all directions, visiting the source of the Abai, Bruce's famous fountain of the Nile. Mr. Francis Galton earned the Gold Medal in 1853 for having, as already mentioned, fitted out an expedition to explore the interior of South Africa at his own cost, and for having success fully conducted it through the country of the Damaras and the Ovampo, a journey of upwards of 2000 miles. It was his merit also to have constantly and accurately observed for latitude and longitude. His companion, Mr. Anderssen, who afterwards con tinued the work of exploring as far as Lake N'gami, was presented with a portable box of surveying instruments, in 1855. The action taken by the Council, in encouraging the under takings of Lieuts. Grey and Lushington, was the stimulus to further important geographical labours in Australia. Mr. Edward John Eyre was the first Gold Medallist who received that honour for Australian discoveries. Son of the Eev. Anthony Eyre, the Vicar of Stillingfleet, near York, our Medal list was born in 1815, went out to Sydney in 1833, and bought a sheep farm on the Lower Murray. After several shorter ex peditions, Mr. Eyre undertook a journey in 1840 to ascertain whether there were fertile lands in the interior, beyond a salt marsh called Lake Torrens. He endured the most terrible pri vations, largely added to our geographical knowdedge, and well earned the Society's highest honour. From 1846 Mr. Eyre was employed by the Colonial Office as Lieut.-Governor in New Zealand under Sir George Grey until 1852, as Governor of St. Vincent and Antigua, and finally of Jamaica from 1862 to 1865. Strzelecki, Sturt and Leichhardt. 63 When Mr. Eyre was suffering persecution for his prompt sup pression of a negro revolt, he was generously befriended by our President Sir Eoderick Murchison, who knew that our gallant Medallist, who had for years been the humane friend of the aborigines of Australia, was not the man to err on the side of unnecessary severity. In 1845 Count Strzelecki received the Founder's Medal for his discovery of the extensive tract of New South Wales named Gipps's Land, and for his physical description of New South Wales, comprehending the fruits of five years of continual labour, during a tour of 70U0 miles on foot. Count Strzelecki, was afterwards a Member of our Council from 1855 to 1862. He was created a K.C.M.G., and died in December 1873. In 1846 two other Australian explorers received our Medals, Charles Sturt and Ludwig Leich hardt. Captain Sturt had explored the rivers Darling and Murray, and afterwards undertook a journey in 1844, with the object of traversing the whole extent of the continent from Adelaide to the Gulf of Carpentaria. He succeeded in pene trating to within 200 miles of the centre of the continent, when the illness of one of his party compelled him to retrace his steps. For these services to geography, for his energy and courage, combined with prudence and sound judgment, the Gold Medal was granted to Captain Sturt. This admirable traveller, the grandson of Mr. Humphrey Sturt of Critchill in Dorsetshire, was born in 1796 and, entering the army, accom panied the 39th to Sydney in 1827. His great services, though recognised by our Society, were entirely neglected by the Government for a quarter of a century. Justice, as is so often the case, came too late. In May 1869 he received notice that he was to be created a Knight Commander of St. Michael and St. George, but he died on June 16th before the tardily bestowed honour was gazetted. Dr. Leichhardt received our Gold Medal in 1847 for his journey of 1800 miles from Morton Bay to Port Essington, by which he opened to Australian settlers new and extensive fields of enterprise, and connected the remote settle ments of New South Wales with a secure port on the confines of the Indian Ocean. He afterwards perished while conducting another expedition over the waterless deserts of the interior in 1850. In 1851 the Council awarded 25Z. to Mr. Thomas Brunner, for a very enterprising journey among the Alps and along the western shore of the Middle Island of New Zealand, which, in those early days of colonization, was an undertaking of some risk and difficulty. Sir James Brooke, the Eajah of Sarawak and Governor of Labuan, worthily received our Gold Medal in 1848. The object to which he determined to devote his energies and means, from 64 Simpson and Rae. an early period of kis life, was the civilization of the Malay race. He sailed from England on his gallant and hazardous adventure in October 1838, in his yacht Boyalist, and on August 1st, 1839, dropped anchor off the coast of Borneo. Details of the skilful and gallant operations which led to the cession of Sarawak to Eajah Brooke are given in the interesting volumes of Admiral Sir H. Keppel, and Sir Eodney Mundy. Great advantages to geographical science, especially in the sur vey of coasts and rivers, resulted from the introduction of civilization and commerce amongst the Malays and Dyaks of Borneo, and he who originated and ably carried out these plans was well entitled to the Medal of our Society. The last year of his residence in Sarawak was 1857, and he died at his seat in the south of Devonshire, on June 11th, 1868. For his valuable services in Guiana it has already been recorded that Sir Eobert Schomburgk received the Medal in 1840, and in 1850 Colonel Fremont was awarded the same honour for his conduct of an exploring expedition to the Eocky Mountains and North California, from 1842 to 1846. After the return of Sir George Back in 1838, the attention of Arctic explorers was mainly turned to the completion of the delineation of the northern coast of America. In the summer of 1837 Mr. Thomas Simpson, accompanied by Mr. Dease, had already started from the Great Slave Lake, under instructions from the Hudson's Bay Company. By tracing the coast from Franklin's furthest to Cape Barrow they succeeded in connect ing the work of Franklin and Beechey ; and completed our knowledge from the Coppermine River to Behring Strait. In 1839 Simpson turned eastward from the Coppermine, passed Cape Turnagain of Franklin, and advanced as far as Castor and Pollux river, thus connecting the work of Back and Franklin. Simpson also discovered the south coast of King William Island and built a cairn at Cape Herschel. When, in 1848, this cairn was reached by a band of dying heroes from the north, the North-West Passage was discovered. For these ser vices Simpson received our Gold Medal in 1839. The work of delineating the Arctic shores of America was completed by Dr. John Eae, who was appointed to the com mand of an expedition by Sir George Simpson, the Governor of the Hudson's Bay Company, in 1846. Starting in boats from York Factory in Hudson's Bay, Dr. Eae wintered at Eepulse Bay, in a stone hut, w ithout fuel of any kind to give warmth ; he and his party maintaining themselves on deer, a large pro portion of which were shot by himself. During the spring of 1847 he explored on foot the shores of a great gulf, having 700 miles of coast line, connected the work of Parry with that of Ross's Antarctic Expedition. 65 Eoss, and proved that Boothia was part of the American Con tinent. In 1848 Eae accompanied Sir John Eichardson on an expe dition down the McKenzie Eiver, which examined the Arctic shores eastward to the Coppermine Eiver, in search of Sir John Franklin's party. In 1849 he continued the search in a boat via the Coppermine Eiver, but found the coast impenetrably blocked with ice. In 1850, at the request of Government, he undertook a further search for the missing explorers, and by a long sledge journey (the daily distance of which averaged more than twenty-four miles) in the spring of 1851, and a boat voyage the same summer, the south shores of WoUaston and Victoria Lands were closely examined, their continuity proved, and Victoria Strait seen, named, and ascended from the south, to a higher latitude than the position where Franklin's ships were abandoned in 1848. These discoveries earned for Dr. Eae the well-merited honour which was conferred on him in 1852 by the award of the Society's Founder's Gold Medal. In 1854, after passing a second winter at Eepulse Bay, he connected the work of Simpson and Eoss, west of Boothia, established the insularity of King William Land, and brought home the first information of the fate of the Franklin Expedi tion, for which he and his party of seven men received the Government reward of 10,000Z. The Gold Medal was bestowed on Professor Middendorff in 1846, for his remarkable travels in northern Siberia, and for having reached the great headland of Taimyr. He also threw light on the boreal range of vegetation, and on the ques tion of the frozen soil and sub-soil of Siberia. In 1858 Captain Inglefield, e.n., received our Gold Medal for his voyage in Baffin Bay. Although, in his first volume, Sir James Eoss quite correctly attributes the despatch of his memorable Antarctic Expedition to the action of the British Association in 1838, still the initia tion of the idea of such an expedition was due to the Secretary of our Society. An important suggestion for this Antarctic voyage was addressed by Captain Washington to the President and Council of the Eoyal Geographical Society, and although it was not printed by us, it was recorded in the Bulletin of the French Geographical Society, and is referred to by M. d'Avezac in his eloquent obituary sketch of Washington. Sir James C. Eoss had more experience of Arctic service than any other officer that ever lived. He endured nine Arctic winters, and passed sixteen navigable seasons in the Arctic regions. He was, without comparison, the fittest man for the command of the 66 FrankliiUs Expedition. expedition which first crossed the Antarctic Circle on January 1st, 1841. In one short month he made one of the greatest geographical discoveries of modern times, amid regions of per petual ice ; including a long range of high lands, named Vic toria, the great volcano, 12,400 feet above the sea, called Mount Erebus, and the marvellous range of ice cliffs. Eoss attained a latitude of 78° 11', thus approaching the South Pole more nearly, by hundreds of miles, than any of his prede cessors. For this great service to geography, the Founder's Medal was granted to Sir James Eoss in 1842. In 1848 the Founder's Medal was conferred on Captain Wilkes, of the United States Navy, for his services in command of the scientific exploring expedition, from 1838 to 1842. On the return of Sir James Eoss, attention was once more turned to Arctic discovery. The despatch of Sir John Frank lin's Expedition in 1845 was due to the representations of our Founder and former President, Sir John Barrow, who was then Secretary to the Admiralty. Sir John Franklin was at that time our Vice-President, and he had from the first been a fre quent diner at the Ealeigh Club, and a constant supporter of our interests. The Society therefore took a special interest in his expedition, the object of which was to add so largely to geographical knowledge. Never was an abler or a more gallant set of men assembled together under a more capable leader. The second in command was Captain Crozier, who had served with Parry and James Eoss in Arctic and Antarctic voyages ; while foremost among their subordinates was our brave and accomplished Associate, Captain Fitzjames. During the first year the Erebus and Terror performed one of the most remark able Arctic voyages on record, by sailing up Wellington Channel to 77" N., circumnavigating Cornwallis Island, and returning to winter at Beechey Isle. In the second year Sir John Franklin followed his instructions by pushing his way southwards towards the coast of America, knowing, from pre vious experience, that if he could once reach it, the passage along the navigable lane which exists there every summer, would be comparatively easy. If he had been aware of the in sularity of King William Land, and had hugged the Boothian coast, he would have succeeded. As it was his attempt was the best ever made; it was ably conceived and most gallantly carried out in accordance with existing knowledge. Franklin nobly died in the execution of his duty. His brave followers lived on, to perish it is true, in the same glorious cause, but not until some of them, by reaching Simpson's Cairn, at Point Herschel, had discovered the North-West Passage. While most frequently conferring its honours on explorers Raper. — Robinson. — Erman. — Ritter. 67 and discoverers, the Council of our Society did not overlook the less conspicuous, but not less useful labom-s of the scholar and the cartographer. The first recipient of the Gold Medal for literary work was Lieut. Henry Eaper, e.n. The son of Admiral Eaper, who was well known in his day as a great im prover of maritime signals ; this officer was born in 1799, and entered the navy at the age of twelve, on board his father's ship, the Mars. He was shipwrecked in the Strait of Gaspar in 1817, and suffered great hardships and privations on the rocky islet called Pulo Leaf, until he was rescued by a vessel from Batavia. Afterwards, at his father's express wish, young Raper joined the Adventure surveying ship in the Mediterranean, under Captain Smyth, where he had charge of the chrono meters. His last active service was in 1824, after which time he devoted himself to the cultivation of the scientific depart ments ofthe navy, and in 1840 he published his 'Practice of Navigation,' a book of sterling merit, for which he was awarded our Gold Medal in 1841. Lieut. Raper served for several years on our Council, and was also Secretary to the Astronomi cal Society. He died at Torquay in January 1859. In 1842 the Gold Medal was awarded to Dr. Edward Eobinson, the Professor of Biblical Literature at New York, for his biblical researches as connected with geography ; and in 1844 a similar honour was conferred on Professor Adolph Erman for his ser vices in physical geography, meteorology, and terrestrial magnetism. The great German geographer, Carl Eitter, re ceived the Patron's Medal in 1845. Eitter was the first who laid down and admirably carried out the principle that, in order to form clearer and more instructive ideas of geography, it was above all essential to study the configuration of the great masses of land. He was a perfect master of condensed descrip tion. His vast erudition and extreme accuracy enabled him to furnish, in his compendious works, as much knowledge as if his readers had laboured through all the original sources of his information. Humboldt truly pronounced Carl Eitter to have been the first geographer of the age. In these ways : at first, and so long as the funds admitted of it, by assisting expeditions with money grants, and afterwards by conferring rewards, the Society strenuously endeavoured to advance the cause of geography during the first quarter of a century of its existence. The Eoyal Awards became the goals which aroused the ambition of yotmg explorers, and urged them on to renewed efforts. The greatest honours that the Society could confer, they have always been very highly prized, and have been strong incentives to brave and even desperate enter prises in the cause of discovery. It was not, however, through F 2 68 Influence of the Society. these rewards alone that the Society made its influence felt for good. Of not less service were the publications which secured a permanent place of record for geographical achievements, and the library and map room through which the means of infor mation was secured for our countrymen. The Society formed that home for geography the want of which had been more and more sorely felt during the previous half century. It is interesting to note how influential the education acquired by travel and geographical research has been in training men who have afterwards become eminent in science. Among the great scientific worthies who have travelled or made exploring voyages in far distant regions, the names of Banks, Eobert Brown, Sabine, Hooker, Darwin, Huxley and Wallace may be mentioned, and these by no means exhaust the list. Indian Surveys. 69 CHAPTEE IX. EXPEDITIONS PEOMOTED BY THE EOYAL GEOGEAPHICAL SOCIETY AHD GEANTS OF THE EOYAL AWAEDS, 1855 TO 1880. When the prosperity of the Society rapidly began to increase under the fostering care of Admiral Smyth and Sir Eoderick Murchison, it was not long before active aid to labourers in the field began again to combine with rewards for work achieved, in the furtherance of the cause of geography. As the funds of the Society increased, the encouragement and power to assist explorers increased also, but such aid mainly took the direction of African discovery. In briefly recording the Society's work, it will be convenient to treat of each continent or great division of the globe separately, beginning with Asia, and then taking in order Africa, Australia, America, and finally the Arctic Eegions. So far as English labours are concerned, the most important Asiatic exploration has been undertaken from India, and generally under the orders of the Survey Department. It was therefore a well merited recognition of the value of the Indian Surveys when, in 1857, the Patron's Gold Medal was awarded to Sir Andrew Scott Waugh. The grant was made for his able extensions of the Great Trigonometrical Survey, and especially for his work in fixing 79 Himalayan peaks, one of which— Mount Everest (29,002 ft.) — is the loftiest mountain in the world. After his retirement in 1861 Sir Andrew Waugh was many years a Member of our Council, and a Vice-President, actively assisting us, almost until his lamented death in February 1878. In 1865 another eminent Indian Surveyor, Captain T. G. Montgomerie, received the same honour for his survey of Kashmir, and of the mighty mass of mountains up to the Tibetan frontier, from 1855 to 1865. Observations were taken from peaks over 20,000 feet above the sea, and the accuracy of this most difficult and laborious survey was s.pch that in a circuit of 890 miles, only a discrepancy of -^^ "bf a second in latitude and of ^'q in longitude was found. But the work for which Montgomerie is best known among geographers is that comprised in his system of employing carefully trained native observers to make discoveries in the unknown regions beyond 70 Nain Sing. — Hayward and Shaw. the northern frontiers of British India. Colonel Montgomerie died prematurely on the 31st of January, 1878, but both before and since his death the Society has recognised the useful labours of his trained subordinates. In 1875 a gold watch was presented to Mr. W. H. Johnson, of the Indian Survey Department, for his journey in 1865 across the Kuen-Lun Mountains to Ilchi in Khotan. Another gold watch had been granted, in 1866, to Mulla Abdul Medjid, for the service he had rendered to geographical science by his adventurous journey from Peshawur to Kokand, along the upper valley of the Oxus, and across the Pamir Steppes. In 1868 the Pundit Nain Sing, another of Montgomerie's trained explorers, received a gold watch for his route survey from Lake Mansarowar to Lhasa, the capital of Tibet ; and in 1877 he had conferred upon him the Society's Gold Medal for his important journey across the vast lacustrine plateau of Tibet, and thence by a new route into Assam. But our rewards for Trans-Himalayan exploration have not been confined to Government surveyors. In 1875 the eminent botanist, Dr. Thomas Thomson, the companion of Sir Joseph Hooker in the Eastern Himalayas, and the first who reached the Karakorum Pass in the west, received the Founder's Gold Medal for work done nearly thirty years before. Mr. Hayward and Mr. Shaw both received our Medals for their adventurous and interesting journeys into Eastern Turkistan. In the case of Mr. Hayward the Society granted the explorer a sum of 600Z., and received a report and map of his journey across the Kuen-Lun to Yarkand and Kashgar. In 1870 he was honoured with the Founder's Gold Medal, but his useful career was brought to an untimely end in the same year. Mr. Shaw was more fortunate. He visited Yarkand and Kashgar in 1869, and was again at Yarkand with the first Blission of Sir Douglas Forsyth, executing a valuable survey of the country between the high table lands at the head of the Karakash River and the valley of the Upper Shayok, and taking numerous accurate observations for latitude and longitude and variation of the compass. He well merited the Patron's Medal which was con ferred upon him in 1872. Mr. Shaw was afterwards Eesident at Leh, where he continued his geographical researches, and his lamented death in 1879 was a serious loss to our science. His ' Journey to Kashgar ' continues to be one of the most popular books in our library. Lastly, as concerns the Trans-Himalayan Eegion, a very eminent Surveyor received our Gold Medal in 1878. Captain Henry Trotter, e.e., of the Great Trigonometrical Survey, accompanied the mission of Sir Douglas Forsyth to Kashgar as Explorers in China. 71 geographer. He made a boat voyage on the Pangong Lake in October 1873, described the routes between Ladak and Turkis tan, and his excursions in the neighbourhood of Kashgar as far as the Artysh district ; and made an important journey over the Pamir Steppe into Wakhan, during March and April 1874. He visited the Victoria Lake, which is Wood's source of the Oxus, and succeeded in connecting the Indian Surveys with those of Eussia, at the same time throwing a flood of light on the geography of the Pamir and Eastern Turkistan. Four explorers in the Chinese Empire have earned the Eoyal Award. In 1862 Captain Thomas Blakiston received the Patron's Medal for his survey of the Yang-tsze-kiang for 900 miles beyond the farthest point previously reached by Englishmen. Mr. Ney Elias, in 1873, earned the Founder's Medal for his enterprise and ability in surveying the new course of the Yellow Eiver in 1868, and for his remarkable journey through Western Mongolia, by Uliassutai and Kobdo, during which he took a large series of observations for fixing positions and altitudes. In presenting the Medal to Mr. Ney Elias, Sir Henry Eawlinson recorded his opinion that the young explorer had performed one of the most extraordinary journeys of modern times. Baron F. von Eichthofen travelled in various parts of China from 1868 to 1872, mapping the country and making a systematic examination of the physical geography and geology of twelve of its provinces. Colonel Yule said of Baron von Eichthofen that in his person were combined the great traveller, the great physical geographer, and the accomplished writer, in a degree unknown since Humboldt's best days. For his great merits as a traveller Baron von Eichthofen was aw arded the Founder's Medal in 1878. In the following year the same Medal was given to Captain W. J. Gill, e.e., for his important geographical work in Western China and Tibet during 1877, and for his traverse survey and very complete maps of his route. Lieutenant Francis Garnier, of the French Navy, earned the Patron's Medal in 1870, for his exploring expedition from Cambodia to the Yang-tsze-kiang, during which he made valuable surveys, visited Talifu, and brought his party in safety to Hankow, travelling over 5400 miles. This distinguished young traveller was murdered by the Chinese rebels of Tonquin oa the 20th of December, 1873, when only in his 34th year. Two eminent Eussian explorers have received our Gold Medals for geographical work on the Asiatic continent. Admiral Alexis Boutakoff was the first to launch and navigate ships on the Sea of Aral, and he made a valuable survey of the chief mouths of the Oxus, for which he received the Founder's Medal in 1867. Colonel Prejevalsky, our other Eussian Medallist, 72 Livingstone. made successive expeditions, from 1870 to 1873, into Mongolia and to the high plateau of Northern Tibet, and in 1876 and 1877 he penetrated from Kulja to Lob Nor. For these great services to geography our Patron's Medal was conferred upon him in 1879. xlnother adventurous traveller in Central Asia, the Magyar, Dr. Arminius Vambery, was awarded the sum of 40Z. in 1865, for the self-reliance, courage, and perseverance with which he penetrated to Khiva and thence, through the deserts of the Oxus, to Bokhara and Samarkand, in the disguise of a Dervish. Lastly, Mr. W. Gifford Palgrave was, in 1863, granted a sum of 25?. for his very daring and remarkable journey in and across Arabia. As regards assistance given by the Society, the grant of 34Z. for instruments to the Eev. F. W. Holland, to aid him in his valuable Sinai exploration in 1868, and of 50Z. towards the survey of the Sinai Peninsula by Captains Wilson and Palmer, in 1869, must be mentioned. This by no means exhausts the list of travellers and surveyors on the Asiatic continent who have been helped on their way and cordially welcomed on their return by the Council of our Society. It is only the roll of the most deserving or the most fortunate, who have been carefully selected for special honour. Turning from Asia to the African Continent, the Society's great activity and liberal expenditure during the last quarter of a century have been two very important factors in the solu tion of geographical problems which have occupied the thoughts and defied the efforts of former generations for many centuries. It is over thirty years ago since, in 1850, Admiral Smyth pre sented a chronometer watch to " the Eev. David Livingstone of Kolobeng," for his successful exploration of South Africa ; and since then our Gold Medals have been presented to explorers of Africa no less than eleven times, a fact which indicates the constant efforts that have been made to increase cur knowledge of the vast unknown portions of that Contioent. The Society showed its high appreciation of the labours of the greatest of modern African travellers from the very first. David Livingstone was born at Blantyre in 1813, and after studying at Glasgow University, he went out to South Africa as a Missionary in 1840, settling at Kolobeng in the far interior in 1847. His first great journey, undertaken with the aid of General Sir Thomas Steele, Mr. M. C. Oswell, and Mr. Murray, was commenced in June 1849, with the object of discovering Lake N'gami, which he reached in August of the same year. Sir T. Steele sent the account of this journey to our Society, and it was at once resolved to recognise its im portance by the award of a chronometer watch to the intrepid explorer. In 1851 Livingstone, accompanied by his wife and Livingstone. — Barth. 7 3 Mr. Oswell, undertook another journey, and reached the Zam besi river. In 1852 he was in Cape Town, receiving instruc tion from Sir Thomas Maclear, the Astronomer Eoyal of the Colony. He then set out on his most famous expedition, reach ing liinjante, the capital of the Makololo in May 1853, and Sao Paulo de Loanda on May 21st, 1854. Eeturning to Lin- jante he visited the Victoria Falls of the Zambesi, and reached Quilimane, after having marched across the Continent of Africa, on May 26th, 1856. This famous journey, including great discoveries, secured for Livingstone our Founder's Medal in 1855, while it excited the interest of the whole civilized world. On reaching England he received a most enthusiastic welcome at our Meeting on December 15th, 1856, and during the next few months he was engaged on his narrative entitled ' Missionary Travels,' 45,000 copies of which were sold. The Government, struck by the importance of his discoveries, placed at Dr. Livingstone's dis posal those means and materials which formed the Zambesi Expedition. Sir Eoderick Murchison, the great traveller's steadfast and unfailing friend, organised what was called the Livingstone Festival, a farewell dinner, at which 350 guests assembled on February 13th, 1858. In March Livingstone started for the Zambesi, accompanied by his brother Charles Livingstone, by Dr. Kirk, Mr. Thornton as geologist, Captain Bedingfield, b.n., and Mr. Baines the zealous traveller and artist. Livingstone, during this expedition, traced the course of the river Shire, and in September 1860 he discovered the beautiful Lake Nyassa and the smaller Lake Shirwa. But except as regards the geographical discoveries, this expedition was not successful. In 1862 Livingstone's wife died of fever at Shupanga. The " Universities Mission," which had come out with high hopes owing to Livingstone's representations, lost its leader, Bishop Mackenzie, and the work was eventually aban doned. Dr. Livingstone returned to England in 1864. The years which include the discoveries of Livingstone saw much valuable work achieved in other parts of Africa. Dr. Henry Barth, a native of Hamburg, born in 1821, was an accomplished classical scholar as well as a great traveller. First associated with Eichardson, Overweg, and Vogel, and afterwards by himself, he made numerous excursions around lake Chad, discovered the great river Benue, and succeeded in completing a hazardous and adventurous journey to Tim buktu. For these services he received our Gold Medal in 1856, and in the following year he completed a work which Sir Eoderick Murchison pronounced to be the masterpiece of all his labours, entitled ' Travels in North and Central Africa,' in 74 Burton. five volumes. This work was published under the auspices and by the assistance of our Government, and Her Majesty conferred on him a Companionship of the Bath. Dr. Barth had under taken to edit Leo Africanus for the Hakluyt Society, thus filling up a serious desideratum in our geographical literature, but this was prevented by his untimely death at the early age of 44, in 1866. Corporal Church of the Sappers and Miners was granted a gold watch and chain by our Council in 1856, for his meritorious and intelligent services while employed upon the African expe dition under Dr. Vogel, and especially for his diligence in con ducting a long series of meteorological observations at Kuka. The exploration of the African equatorial lakes, commenced by that intrepid traveller and accomplished scholar. Captain E. F. Burton, forms an era in the history of discovery. The Council, in 1853, had secured the services of Captain Burton to explore the interior of Arabia, and assisted him with a grant of money. The result was his memorable journey from Yambu to Medina and Mecca. In the following year he attempted to explore Eastern Africa from Berbera to Zanzibar, with Lieu tenants Speke and Stroyan, and he himself succeeded in reach ing Harar, a place never before visited by Europeans. But further progress was prevented by an attack of the Somalis, in which Stroyan was killed, and both Burton and Speke were severely wounded. These preliminary services had shown Burton to be an able and resolute explorer as well as an accom plished orientalist. He was therefore selected to conduct an expedition from Zanzibar, under the Society's auspices, and with assistance both from the Foreign Office and the East India Company. A Treasury grant of lOOOZ. was also obtained. In June 1857 Captain Burton, accompanied by Captain Speke, started from Zanzibar and succeeded in reaching the great Lake Tanganyika, about 700 miles from the coast. Careful and complete itineraries, and astronomical observations by Captain Speke, were made in spite of severe hardships, privations, and sickness. On their return Speke made a journey northwards from Unyanyembe, and discovered the southern shore of a vast inland fresh- water lake, which was named Victoria Nyanza. Burton generously gave all the credit of the topographical work to his companion, he himself undertaking the history and ethnography, with accounts of the languages and peculiarities of the people. Captain Burton's exhaustive memoir of the Lake Eegions of Central Equatorial Africa, occupies the whole of the 29th volume of our ' Transactions.' It contains a complete description of the physical geography, the fauna and flora, the inhabitants and history of the countries along his line of route. Speke. — Baker. 75 He worthily earned our highest honour, which was conferred upon him in 1859. In 1860 another expedition was despatched under the Society's auspices, commanded by Captain Speke, to land at Zanzibar and explore the Victoria Nyanza, which was believed to be a main source of the Nile. A Treasury grant of 2500/. was obtained to aid in defraying the expenses. On this occasion Captain Speke was accompanied by Captain Grant. Leaving Zanzibar in October 1860, the travellers reached Unyanyembe in 1861, and during that and the following year they marched northward to the Victoria Nyanza, skirted its western shore, and reached the kingdom of Uganda. Following the Nile for 120 miles north of the lake, Speke and Grant were then obliged to leave the stream, but again struck it some 70 miles lower down, and at length reached Gondokoro on February 15th, 1863, where they were met and assisted by Samuel Baker. The travellers descended the Nile and received a very hearty welcome on their return to England. Speke had been granted the Gold Medal of our Society, and further honours were in store for him from his Sovereign, when a melancholy accident terminated his life in August 1864. His companion. Captain Grant, received our Gold Medal in 1864, and was created a Companion of the Bath, and the honour of knighthood was conferred on Sir Samuel Baker, who had so opportunely aided the explorers at Gondokoro. In 1864 Baron von der Decken, who had made two surveys of the lofty mountain of Kilimanjaro, received the Founder's Medal, and this gallant young explorer would have done further valuable service had not his career been cut short prematurely in 1866, when attempting to ascend the river Juba in a steamer. He had only reached his 33rd year. Before he succoured Speke and Grant, Sir Samuel Baker had made discoveries in the basin of the Atbara, and afterwards, advancing up the White Nile, he discovered the second great water-basin, to which he assigned the name of " Albert Nyanz^a." Sir Eoderick Murchison had presented our highest honour to him through his brother, in 1865 ; and on hearing of his great success, our President declared that nothing which had hap pened since the foundation of the Society had given him greater satisfaction than that this devoted and high-minded traveller should have thus proved himself to be truly worthy of the Medal. It was actually granted for the chivalrous spirit he displayed in rushing to the rescue of Speke and Grant. In 1871 Sir Samuel Baker, in the service of the Khedive of Egypt, again visited the scenes of his former discoveries, with the object of rooting out the slave-traders and kidnappers. In the 76 Livingstone's last Expedition. performance of this great service he explored the kingdom of Unyoro, and collected much valuable information respecting the equatorial lake region. His devoted wife accompanied him in all his journeys, and the hero and heroine of a noble and most arduous achievement received a cordial and heartfelt welcome on their return. A dinner was given in honour of Sir Samuel and Lady Baker by the Geographical Club on December 8th, 1873. The Society, ever anxious to encourage the efforts of indi vidual explorers, presented a sum of lOOZ. to M. Du Chaillu in 1866, for his efforts to penetrate into the interior from the We?t Coast of Africa, during which he made good astronomical obser vations, and also to reimburse him for the loss of his instruments. Assistance was also given to M. Gerhard Eohlfs of Bremen, in the shape of a grant of lOOZ. to enable him to continue his journeys which, during five years, commencing in 1861, he made in the northern part of the African Continent. His expedition in Morocco in 1863 and 1864, included the passage of the Atlas southward to the oasis of Tuat ; and afterwards he went from Tripoli to Kuka on the shores of lake Chad, and southwards by the Benue and Niger, and across the Yoriba country to Lagos, in the Gulf of Guinea. For these remarkable journeys M. Gerhard Eohlfs received the Patron's Medal in 1868. Dr. Livingstone returned from his Zambesi Expedition with feelings of disappointment. It was then that Sir Eoderick Murchison proposed to him the great work of defining the true watershed of Inner Southern Africa. He gladly undertook this hard achievement, the Society granting 500/. towards his expenses, and obtaining for him the title and position of a Consul, the Government adding another 500Z. Livingstone left England in August 1865, spent the following winter in Bombay and in Zanzibar, and finally advanced into the interior from the mouth of the Eovuma in April 1866. Travelling thence to Ujiji on lake Tanganyika, he discovered lake Bangweolo and the magnificent river Lualaba on his way. Afterwards he pene trated into the Manyuema country, enduring most terrible pri vations and, after having been lost to the outer world for years, he was at length found and succoured by Mr. Stanley at Ujiji. Mr. Stanley finally parted with Livingstone at Unyanyembe in March 1872, and in the following August the dauntless veteran resumed his explorations. He died near the shores of Lake Bangweolo on May 4th, 1873. His faithful servants, Chuma and Susi, conveyed their beloved master's body, with his journals and other property, during an eight months' march, to Zanzibar. The remains arrived in England on April 15th, Search for Livingstone. 77 1874, and were in the Society's Map Eoom until they were deposited in their last resting-place in the nave of Westminster Abbey. As an explorer, Livingstone trod some 29,000 miles of African soil, and laid open nearly one million square miles of new country. Sir Bartie Frere, who was our President when the great traveller died, thus concluded his sympathetic and careful sketch of Livingstone's career : — " As a whole, the work of his life will surely^ be held up in ages to come as one of singular nobleness of design, and of unflinching energy and self- sacrifice in execution. It will be long ere any one man will be able to open so large an extent of unknown land to civilized mankind. Yet longer, perhaps, ere we find a brighter example of a life of such continued and useful self-devotion to a noble cause." Livingstone's long absence caused great anxiety to his friends, and especially to the Council of our Society, which was un ceasing in its efforts for his succour, and liberal, beyond all pre cedent, in the expenditure of funds with that object — not only of money voted from the Society's own resources, but of still larger sums mainly subscribed by the Council and Fellows. These efforts for the relief of the great traveller form a very noble episode in the history of the Geographical Society. They were commenced, owing to a false report of Livingstone's death, with a searching boat expedition, under the command of Mr. Young, B.N., which our Council induced the Government to despatch in 1866, and to which we contributed 160Z. Mr. Young proceeded to the Zambesi, went up the Shire to lake Nyassa, navigated that inland sea, and satisfactorily disposed of the story, having performed the duty with skUl, promptitude, and success. In 1870, at the recommendation of our Council, the Government sent out lOOOZ. to Zanzibar to furnish Living stone with fresh supplies, to which a further sum was added by the great traveller's friend, Mr. James Young. Meanwhile Mr. Stanley, correspondent of the ' New York Herald,' left the coast for Ujiji in February 1871, and, as has already been recorded, he found Livingstone and brought him much needed succour. Eeturning to England in the summer of 1872, after performing this great service, Mr. Stanley was cordially received by our President and Council. He was entertained at a great dinner on October 21st, 1872, and the unprecedented step was taken of conferring upon him the Society's Gold Medal some months before the appointed time. Meanwhile the Council had started a Livingstone Search and Belief Fund, large sums were subscribed, and a well-equipped expedition was sent to Zanzibar, and was on the point of starting for the interior, when Mr. Stanley returned with the news of Livingstone's safety. 78 Cameron. — Grandy. — Schweinfurth. But when Stanley announced that the aged explorer had once more started alone for the unknown interior, it was strongly felt that succouring expeditions should be despatched both to the east and to the west coasts. Lieut. Grandy, e.n., was sent to the Congo to meet Livingstone if he should emerge on the west coast, and Mr. James Young generously defrayed the heavy expenses of this part of the scheme. The conduct of the east- coast expedition was entrusted to Lieut. V. L. Cameron, e.n. On November 11th, 1872, these two young officers were enter tained at dinner by the Geographical Club. Cameron's instruc tions were to deliver supplies to Dr. Livingstone wherever he might find him, and to place himself under the great traveller's orders. But after reaching Unyanyembe, the melancholy certainty of Livingstone's death necessarily altered Cameron's plans, and in October 1873 the faithful servants arrived there with the body and proceeded to the coast. Cameron resolved to achieve some geographical success. He pushed onwards, reached Ujiji in February 1874, explored the southern half of Lake Tanganyika in a boat, and solved the long doubtful problem of its outlet. He then advanced across the Manyuema country to the Lualaba or Congo, crossed that river, and reached the capital of Urua in October 1874. In the same month of the following year Cameron arrived at Benguela on the Atlantic, and was thus the first European traveller who had walked across tropical Africa from east to west. At a great meeting of the Society on April 11th, 1876, in St. James's Hall, Cameron gave an account of his memorable journey, and in May he was presented with our Founder's Medal. He was also promoted to the rank of Commander, and Her Majesty conferred upon him a Companionship of the Bath. The heavy expense of the expedition, upwards of 12,000?., fell mainly upon the Society, being only partly refunded by liberal private subscriptions, and by a grant of 3000?. from the Government. Lieut. Grandy was recalled on the news of Livingstone's death, but not before he had done some useful exploring work in the Congo country. While these resolute efforts were being made to increase our knowledge of tropical Africa, an accomplished German traveller had been engaged in exploring the south-western basin of the Nile. Dr. Schweinfurth, starting on his travels in 1868, succeeded in defining the limits of the basin of the Bahr Ghazal, crossed the water parting to the south, and reached the river Uelle, the course of which has not yet been explored. His work entitled 'The Heart of Africa,' is a most able description of the physical geography, ethnology, climate, botany, and resources of the Bahr Ghazal region. In recogni- Stanley. — St. Vincent Erskine. 79 tion of its merits Dr. Schweinfurth received our Founder's Medal in 1874. In 1874 Mr. Stanley undertook a second journey into the interior of Africa, to explore the equatorial lakes, and discover the course of the Congo. In March 1875 he reached the southern shore of the Victoria Nyanza, where he put a boat together, which he had conveyed from Zanzibar in pieces, and launched it on the lake. He circumnavigated the lake, visited the capital of Uganda, and returned to his camp after an absence of fifty-eight days. Having made some journeys in the direction of the Albert Nyanza, and in the kingdom of Eumanika, Stanley proceeded to Ujiji, and followed Cameron's route round the southern half of Lake Tanganyika. He then marched across Manyuema to Nyangwe and embarked on the Lualaba, which eventually proved to be identical with the Congo. Leaving Nyangwe on November 5th, 1876, Stanley and his party rapidly descended the river, encountering frequent opposition from hostile tribes, until the falls were reached, but it took the party five months to pass these cataracts. The distance from Nyangwe to the mouth of the Congo is calculated at 1800 miles, and Mr. Stanley was navigating the river from November 1876 to August 1877. Dangers in every form were met with intrepid resolution, while marvellous resource and ingenuity were exer cised in combating the great physical obstacles. Sir Eoderick Murchison, whose forecasts were seldom wrong, held the opinion that Livingstone's Lualaba was the Congo, and Stanley verified the fact. The Council of the Society, while encouraging and assisting exploration in tropical Africa, was not unmindful of the useful if less known labours of those who were zealously working further south, and also on the west coast. Mr. E. B. N. Walker received a sum of 143Z. in 1865, to aid him in his efforts to explore the Ogowe, lOOZ. was granted to Mr. St. Vincent Erskine in 1870 for exploring the Limpopo, Mr. Wakefield of Mombas was granted 35Z. in 1871, and in 1872 the services of Karl Mauch were recognised by the grant of 25?. Landing at Natal almost destitute, Herr Mauch gradually worked his way northward to the region lying between the lower courses of the Limpopo and the Zambesi, the region of the semi-fabulous Monomotapa of the early Portuguese. Here the enthusiastic explorer brought to light the abandoned gold-fields, and the ruins of an ancient city. He carried on his investigations year after year amid many privations, and also fixed the positions of several points, and the courses and width of rivers by exact observations. In 1873 a gold watch was granted to that well- known traveller and painter of African scenery, Thomas Baines. 80 Baines. — Munzinger. — Winwood Reade. Born in 1822, the son of a Master Mariner at King's Lynn, young Baines went out to the Cape in 1842, and remained there until 1854. He was next engaged as artist with Gregory's N.W. Australian Expedition, and afterwards with Livingstone on the Zambesi. In 1861-62 he made a journey from Walfisch Bay to Lake Ngami and the Victoria Falls, and from 1864 to 1868 he was again in England. His large series of admirable sketches in oils was divided between our Society and Kew Museum. His unselfishness and willingness to oblige were only equalled by his extraordinary industry. His time and abilities were at the service of all who needed them, with or without payment. In 1868 Mr. Baines returned to Africa to explore the gold-fields of Tati, which were discovered by Karl Mauch. The results of his exploration of this region were exceedingly valuable, but he gained nothing for himself, and died very poor at Durban on May 8th, 1875. That excellent man and most painstaking and accurate explorer, Werner Munzinger, contributed several valuable papers to our Journal, although he did not receive any special recog nition from the Society for his services. His career was pre maturely cut short. He rendered such essential service to the Abyssinian Expedition that a Companionship of the Bath was conferred upon him at its close, but his best geographical work was the toilsome and arduous journey through the desert Afar region, and the memoir and map which were its result. Munzinger was making his way to the kingdom of Shoa when he was murdered by a party of Gallas on November 14th, 1875. The name of W. Winwood Eeade must here find a place among African explorers. Born in 1838, the stories of Du Chaillu led him to make a voyage to the Gaboon to hunt gorillas, and on his return he published his ' Savage Africa.' Afterwards he led an expedition from Sierra Leone to the upper waters of the Niger in 1869 ; and his observations are recorded in his 'African Sketch Book.' This zealous explorer and brilliant writer was cut off prematm-ely, dvine: at the early age of 37, in 1875. _ ^ ^ ^ As regards the Niger region, a gold watch was presented to Bishop Crowther in 1880, in recognition of the service to geography which he has performed during his numerous voyages up the river. In consequence of the efforts made by His Majesty the King of the Belgians to promote African discovery, the Council of our Society resolved to raise an " African Exploration Fund," to be appropriated to the scientific examination of Africa. A Committee was appointed to carry the objects of the Fund into Keith Johnston. 81 effect, and the Council granted 500?. towards it, in March 1877. Seven routes were suggested for exploration : — 1st. From the gold-fields of South Africa, past the south end of Tanganyika, to Unyanyembe, 2nd. Along the east face of the coast range between the Zambesi and the Equator. 3rd. From the east coast to the north end of Nyassa. 4th. Between the north end of Nyassa and south end of Tanganyika. 5th. From the coast opposite Zanzibar to the south end of Lake Victoria ; thence to the north end of Tanganyika. 6th. From Mombasa, by Kilimanjaro, to s.E. shore of Lake Victoria. 7th. From Formosa Bay, along the valley of the Eiver Dana, by Mount Kenia, to n.e. shore of Lake Victoria. In 1878 the Committee selected the 3rd and 4th, from Dar es-Salaam, a few miles south of Zanzibar, to the northern end of Lake Nyassa, and thence to Tanganyika. The Council voted a further grant for the contemplated expedition, even tually raising their contribution to 2000?. Fellows and other well-wishers together subscribed 1989?. Young Mr. A. Keith Johnston, the only son of the eminent geographer of Edinburgh, was selected to command this expedition. Born in 1844, he had been carefully instructed in geography by his father, and afterwards completed his education in Germany^ For about eighteen months, in 1872-73, he was Assistant-Curator in our Map Eoom, and until 1875 he was learning active field work in the wilds of Paraguay. After his return he was engaged on literary geographical work until he left Eugland in November 1878. He was accompanied by Mr. Joseph Thomson, a young Scotch geologist, and at Zanzibar he secured the services of Livingstone's faithful servant Chuma. After a preliminary trip to the Usambara Mountains, the party landed at Dar-es-Salaam on May 19th, 1879. Ascending the course of the river Rufiji, Mr. Keith Johnston was attacked by fever, and he expired on the 23rd of June. " Thus," says his young companion, " was one of the most promising explorers who had ever set foot on African shores, numbered with the long list of geographical martyrs who have attempted to break through the barriers of disease and barbarism which make the interior of Africa almost impenetrable." Mr. Thomson, at the age of 22, now found himself alone in the wilds of Africa, charged with heavy responsibility, and at the head of work in which few have succeeded. The brave young fellow proved equal to the occasion. With his foot on the threshold of the unknown, he G 82 Joseph Thomson. — Serpa Pinto. resolved to go forward and do his best. " Though the mantle of Mr. Johnston's knowledge could not descend upon me," he said, " yet he left his enthusiasm for the work of research, and I resolved to carry out his design as far as lay in my power." On the 2nd of July Mr. Thomson resumed the journey, and after many long and perilous marches he reached the northern shore of Lake Nyassa. Thence he advanced northwards, and on November 2nd, 1879, he came in sight of Lake Tanganyika. His work, as traced out by the Society, was now finished ; but Mr. Thomson, on seeing the great expanse of waters, felt impelled to explore the Lukuga outlet discovered by Cameron. Encamping his men under command of Chuma, he started on his march northwards, along the western shore, with only thirty porters. Suffering from fever, the enthusiastic young explorer felt as if he had got a new lease of life when, on Christmas Day 1879, he beheld the noble river Lukuga bearing the drainage waters of the Tanganyika to the Congo and the Atlantic. For six days he advanced down the river's course, and reached a hill whence he could see the great plain of the Lualaba spread out below him. For a long time he was in constant danger from the fierce race of Waruas, but he eventually escaped and returned to his camp on April 4th. Mr. Thomson then made his way back to Zanzibar from the south end of Tanganyika, discovering a remarkable lake, which he named Lake Leopold, on his way. After resting for a few days at Unyanyembe, he finally reached the sea-shore at Bagamoyo. He thus concludes his modest and most interesting narrative : " I felt it to be my proudest boast that of the 150 men who left Dar-es-Salaam, only one did not survive to see the Indian Ocean again ; and it will ever be a pleasure to me to think that though often placed in critical positions, I never once required to fire a gun for either offensive or defensive purposes." This expedition was organized by, and directed from first to last, under instructions from a Committee of the Society's Council, the chairman of which was our former President, Sir Eutherford Alcock. It had a clearly defined aim, and it was conducted ably, economically, and with complete success, first by its lamented leader, and afterwards by a most competent successor, whose fortitude, energy, and sound judgment, com bined with intelligent and instructed observation, are rare com binations in any man, and most remarkable in one so young as Mr. Joseph Thomson. Finally, that gallant young Portuguese officer, Major Serpa Pinto, received our Gold Medal in 1881, for his discoveries and numerous astronomical observations, during the course of his march across Africa, from Benguela to Natal. Australian Explorers. 83 This long array of gallant and most brilliant achievements, with which our Society has been more or less closely connected, has wrought a marvellous change on the map of Africa. Yet this is only one great division of the world, and it will now be seen that our activity has not been confined to the African continent. The Society, since it initiated the expedition of Lieuts. Grey and Lushington, has taken a leading part in advocating and planning the exploration of Australia. A general plan for exploring North Australia was advocated by our Society, in consequence of a project for colonizing Carpentaria put forward in a book by Mr. Trelawney Saunders, and in accordance with the suggestions of our Associates Admiral Stokes and Captain Sturt. Her Majesty's Government decided upon adopting our proposal, and they selected an experienced surveyor, Mr. Augustus C. Gregory, to carry out this important project. Mr. Gregory had previously unravelled the condition of the in terior of Western Australia, and in 1848 he had proceeded from Perth and travelled over 1500 miles in search of good land. In 1856 his expedition went by sea from Sydney through Torres Strait, and landed on the Victoria Eiver, about eighty miles from its mouth. He was accompanied by his brother Mr. F. Gregory, the botanist Dr. Muller, the geologist Mr. Wilson, and Mr. Baines the artist traveller. Ascending the Victoria to its source, the explorers crossed the water-parting at a height of 1660 feet, and descended a stream flowing south, ending in a desiccated salt lake, which he called Sturt Creek. Eeturning to the Victoria, he next advanced thence to the Gulf of Car pentaria, and explored the region between the eastern side of that gulf and the then northernmost station of our settlers, ending his labours at Brisbane. He had marched over 6500 miles in a country previously unknown, and received our Founder's Medal in 1857. The Patron's Medal was adjudicated to another Australian explorer, Mr. M'Douall Stuart in 1861, for having advanced across the continent from the south to within 245 miles of the Gulf of Carpentaria. Attempts to cross the continent were continuous, and Mr. Eichard O'Hara Burke, with his companions Wills and Gray, at length traversed it from south and north. But they perished, and the Founder's Medal was awarded to the representative of O'Hara Burke in 1862. One man alone survived, Mr. John King, to whom a gold watch with a suitable inscription was presented. Meanwhile our Medallist, M'Douall Stuart, in 1861-62, successfully crossed the continent from Adelaide to Van Diemen Gulf, exploring the route along which the electric telegraph was subsequently laid. In 1863 our Gold Medal was presented to Mr. Frank Gregory G 2 84 North America. for his successful explorations in Western Australia, and gold watches, with honorary inscriptions, were adjudged to Mr. Wil liam Landsborough, Mr. John M'Kinlay, and Mr. Frederick Walker, for valuable additions to our knowledge ; the first for his journey from Carpentaria to Victoria, the second for ex ploring from Adelaide to Carpentaria, and the third for dis coveries between the Nogoa and the Gulf of Carpentaria. Landsborough and M'Kinlay were leaders of expeditions for the relief of O'Hara Burke. Our rewards for Australian work have since been bestowed upon gallant and resolute men who have traversed the trackless and arid wastes on the western side of the continent. In 1872 an overland telegraph line had been successfully laid across Australia from Port Augusta to Port Darwin. Central Mount Stuart is nearly on the centre of this line, and in April 1873 Colonel Egerton Warburton, of the good old Cheshire stock, started thence to reach the western settlements. After eight months' march, the latter portion of which was through an arid region where the party was supported by the meat of their slaughtered camels, and finally narrowly escaped death from starvation, the frontier settlements on the De Grey Eiver were reached in the end of December, nearly 1000 miles of entirely new country having been traversed. !For this service to geo graphy Colonel Warburton received our Medal in 1874. Mr. J. Forrest had the same distinction conferred upon him in 1876, for his route survey across the interior from Murchison Eiver to the line of the Overland Telegraph, when he marched, for the most part on foot, for 2000 miles, 600 of which was through a region covered with spinifex grass, and almost desti tute of water. Lastly, our Patron's Medal was presented to Mr. Ernest Giles, in 1880, for having led several exploring expedi tions between 1872 and 1876, the most important of which were from Beltana to Perth, and from Champion Bay to the Overland Line of Telegraph. If our honours have not so frequently been bestowed on travellers for work in North and South America, it is not for want either of important and interesting undiscovered regions to be explored, or of accomplished travellers to describe them. Since 1850 only two of our medals have been conferred for work in North America, and but one for South American ex ploration. In 1858 the Patron's Medal was adjudicated to Pro fessor Alexander Dallas Bache, who had been in charge of the Great Coast Survey of the United States since 1844. Sir Eoderick Murchison did no more than justice to this national undertaking, when he said that " whether we regard the science, skill, and zeal of tne operators, the perfection of their instru- South America. 85 ments, the able manner in which the Superintendent has enlisted all modern improvements into his service, the care taken to have the observations accurately registered, or the noble liberality of the Government, all unprejudiced persons must agree that the United States Coast Survey stands without a superior." Captain John Palliser received the Patron's Medal in 1859 for the successful results of the expedition under his command during 1857 and 1858, in exploring large tracts of British North America, and particularly for the determination of the existence of practicable passes across the Rocky Moun tains within British territory. Palliser's Expedition originated in the pressing recommendation of our Society. Since the days of Schomburgk, the Gold Medal has only been awarded to one traveller in South America. Mr. William Chandless received it in 1866, for his unaided exploration of the Eiver Purus, one of the great southern tributaries of the Amazon, for a distance of 1866 miles, and for laying down the course of this previously undefined stream by a continuous series of astronomical observations for latitude and longitude, and true compass bearings. The great danger encountered in travelling for months through a country of interminable forest, in which lurk hordes of savage Indians, was shown in the treacherous slaughter of Mr. Chandless's servant, and his boat's crew, in descending the river. The result of his enterprise was the discovery of a vast tract of interesting country previously unknown, and a profound modification of all our maps of the interior of tropical South America. Commander Musters, e.n., was, in 1872, awarded a gold watch, with a suitable inscription, for his adventurous journey in Patagonia through 960 miles of latitude, in 780 of which he travelled over a country previously quite unknown to Europeans. But this by no means exhausts the list of accomplished and deserving South American tra vellers, the successors of Humboldt, of Woodbine Parish, and of Schomburgk. The names of Pentland, Poeppig, Martins, Maw, and Smyth ; of Wallace, Spruce, and Bates ; of Tschudi, Wer- termann, and Eaimondi ; of Cox and Moreno, at once recur to the mind. South America is indeed the classic land of tra vellers ; the land to the descriptions of which the writer of travels and the porti ayer of scenery must go for his best models, the land which inspired our ablest geographical writers from the classic works of Humboldt to the charming narrative of Bates. No travellers have been more thoroughly fitted for their tasks by previous training, none have more resolutely faced dangers and privations, and some among them stand first as accurate scientific observers, while their works are the best models on which a book of travels can be written. Every 86 Searches for Franklin. geographical author should be a student of Humboldt, of Schomburgk, and of Bates. The searches for Sir John Franklin's expedition, in which the whole nation took so deep an interest, were specially advocated by our Society. The expedition had been sent out through the infiuence of our Founder and former President, and was com manded by one of our Vice-Presidents. It is our pride, too, to be able to reflect that Sir Eoderick Murchison stood by the noble-hearted widow of Franklin, supporting her efforts to the last when others, including the Government, fell away from her ; and that the attempts made by Sir Eoderick to obtain a renewal of the glorious work of Arctic discovery only ceased with his life. When Sir James Eoss returned, without tidings, in 1849, Captains CoUinson and M'Clure were despatched in the Enter prise and Investigator to search by way of Behring Strait, while Captain Austin's expedition sailed in April 1850 to follow the footsteps of Franklin up Baffin Bay and Barrow Strait. No expedition was ever more ably and successfully commanded than that of Captain Austin, and its proceedings form a turning- point in the history of Arctic exploration on several grounds. It was the first in which steam power was efficiently used in ice navigation, and the work of Cator and Sherard Osborn on board the Intrepid and Pioneer in Baffin Bay pioneered the way to a revolution in the methods of encountering and overcoming ice obstacles. Then it was Captain Austin who brought the care fully calculated system for winter quarters to the highest per fection, and no one has since improved upon his methods and arrangements. Lastly, it was Captain Austin who inaugurated the system of extended sledge parties, depots, and auxiliaries ; which was developed, in its details, by the genius of M'Clintock. Thus, in 1851, a most complete system of search was carried out, consisting of six extended parties to be away sixty days each, marching in different directions, and each supported by an auxiliary sledge to lay out a depot. Captain Austin returned in the autumn of 1851, and when another expedition sailed in the next year, it merely followed exactly the arrangements of its predecessor. Indeed its leading spirits were Austin's old officers — M'Clintock and Sherard Osborn, Mecham and Hamilton, MacDougall and May. Sir Henry Kellett, in the Resolute, wintered at Melville Island in 1852-53, and Lieut. Mecham fortunately discovered a record left by Captain M'Clure which announced the position of the Investigator in a harbour of Banks Land. Knowing the position. Captain Kellett sent Lieut. Pim to communicate early in the spring of 1853, and the gallant crew of the Investi- CoUinson and M^ Clare. 87 gator, just when the ship was about to be abandoned after three winters, were saved. By marching across to the Resolute and afterwards returning home by Baffin Bay, M'Clure, his officers, and crew traversed a North-West Passage. It was in 1853 and 1854 that the Arctic sledge travelling, developed and matured under Captain Austin, was still further extended. M'Clintock, in 1853, marched over 1328 miles, and was absent from the ship 105 days. Mecham was away 94 days and went over 1163 miles. Eichards and Osborn discovered the northern shores of the Parry Islands. But the. most brilliant feat in naval Arctic travelling was performed by our Associate Lieut. Mecham in 1854. He was travelling for 61 days, and marched over 1336 miles, at an average rate of 20 miles a day. Sir Eobert M'Clure, who received the honour of knighthood on his return, had our Patron's Medal adjudged to him in 1854, for his discovery of the North-West Passage, before it had been ascertained that Franklin's dying heroes were ahead of him in that great achievement. In presenting it, the Earl of Ellesmere said that when M'Clure sailed, the language in naval circles was — "that man will not return by the way he has gone, unless at least he should meet Franklin. He will return eastward or he will return no more." He died on October 17th, 1873, and was attended to his grave by the President and Secretary of our Society, and by many old Arctic officers. The author of the narrative of his voyage thus sums up his character : " M'Clure was stern, cool, and bold in all perils, severe as a disciplinarian, self-reliant, yet modest as became an officer. With a granite-like view of duty to his country and profession, he would in war have been a great leader ; and it was his good fortune, during a period of profound peace, to find a field for all those valuable qualities and to add fresh glory to a navy, the life-blood of which is honour and renown. The name of M'Clure will be for all time associated with the most remark able voyage of discovery of our generation." Captain Collinsou, in the Enterprise, while prosecuting the search for Franklin during three winters and five summers, also made a most re markable voyage. He penetrated further eastward from Beh ring Strait than any ship has ever done before or since, and his route, from Behring Strait, led him along that prescribed for Franklin, if successful in reaching the north coast of America. In 1858 he was awarded our Founder's MedaL Admiral Sir Eichard CoUinson has since worked hard for our Society as a most active Member of Council and Vice-President during eighteen years, from 1857 to 1875. In the latter year he was obliged to retire, owing to the pressure of his duties as Deputy- Master of the Trinity House. 88 Final Search for Franklin. The labours of the searching expeditions added largely to our knowledge of the Arctic Eegions. Not only was a vast extent of land and sea added to our maps, but light was thrown on the physical geography and hydrography of a considerable area previously unknown, as well as on questions relating to its geology and the distribution of animal and vegetable life. Above all a bright page was added to the history of naval prowess ; and it was no small advantage that the historian of the Arctic searches was a prominent and zealous actor in the work of exploration. Sherard Osborn's ' Stray Leaves from an Arctic Journal,' his ' Discovery of a North-West Passage by Captain M'Clure,' and his 'Career and Last Voyage of Sir John Franklin ' are classic works in the geographical litera ture of England. They will remain as the record of great events in naval chronicle, and will " awaken in the breasts of future Parrys, Franklins, or M'Clures that love for perilous adventure which must ever form the most valuable trait in the character of a great maritime people." The heart of our President, Sir Eoderick Murchison, was set upon never ceasing to search the Arctic Eegions until true tidings were obtained of the fate of Sir John Franklin and his gallant companions. He, therefore (news having arrived from Dr. Rae that an Eskimo statement pointed to King William Island, a place not hitherto searched, as the scene of the disaster, and that relics had been obtained which corroborated the story), very cordially joined with Lady Franklin in her efforts to induce the Government to send out a small expedition to search the unvisited shores of King William Island. A memorial was pre sented to the Prime Minister by Sir Eoderick, as President of the Society, dated June 5th, 1856, which was signed by Admirals Beaufort, Beechey, Austin, Collinsou, Smyth, and FitzEoy, by General Sabine, by the Earl of Ellesmere, and by many other eminent Arctic officers and geographers. The Government refused its request. Then it was that Lady Franklin resolved, with the aid of her steadfast friends, to despatch an expedition on her own responsibility. The cost was 10,412?. ; the subscriptions amounted to 2981?. Sir Eoderick Murchison gave 100?., Sir Thomas Acland, 100?. ; the mother of Lieut. Fairholme of the Erebus, 150?. ; the relations of Lieut. Hornby of the Terror, 150?. ; an old and dear friend ofthe gallant Fitzjames, 100?. ; Sir Francis Beaufort, 50?. ; the Hydrographer, 20?. ; Captain CoUinson, 20?. ; Sir James Eoss, 20?., and several other old Arctic officers, besides many Fellows of the Society were among the subscribers. Captain Allen Young gave 500?. besides his own valuable services. But the great bulk of the expense fell upon Lady Franklin. She was Sir Leopold M'Clintock. 89 so fortunate as to obtain the willing services of Captain M'Clintock, the most eminent among Arctic sledge travellers, to command her steamer, the Fox, and the expedition sailed on June 30th, 1857. In the first season the Fox was forced to winter in the pack of Baffin Bay and was exposed to extreme danger at the breaking up of the ice. But, undaunted by this disaster and resolved not to return home, M'Clintock again turned the Fox's head northwards, and was rewarded by reaching a point whence King William Island could be searched by sledg ing parties in the spring of 1859. M'Clintock marched entirely round the shores of King William Island and examined Montreal Island, at the mouth of the Great Fish Eiver, while Allen Young completed the discovery of the southern side of Prince of Wales Land. The result was that, by finding the famous document at Point Victory (signed by Captains Crozier and Fitzjames), the fate of Sir John Franklin and his heroic followers was ascertained, while the skeleton beyond or south of Simpson's cairn, on Cape Herschel, was a silent but certain proof that to them belongs the glory of having solved the question of the North-West Passage. When M'Clintock returned from this most successful expedition he received the honour of knighthood, while his time in the Fox was allowed to reckon as time served in one of Her Majesty's ships. The Council desired to commemorate, in an especial manner, the great services, to geography of our gallant Vice-President Sir John Franklin. They therefore awarded the Founder's Medal, in 1860, to his widow, in token of their admiration of her noble and self-sacrificing perseverance in sending out, at her own cost, several searching expeditions, until at length the fate of her husband was ascertained. It was adjudged to her not only as the merited recompense of her husband's dis coveries, but also as a testimony of the admiration entertained by British geographers for her who devoted twelve years of her life to this glorious object, in accomplishing which she sacrificed so large a portion of her worldly means. The Patron's Medal of 1860 was adjudged to Sir Leopold M'Clintock, for the consummate skill and unflinching fortitude with which he and his gallant companions not only enlarged our acquaintance with Arctic geography, but also brought to light the precious Eecord which revealed the history of the voyage and of the final abandonment of the Erebus and Terror. His interesting narrative of the voyage of the Fox, entitled ' Fate of Sir John Franklin,' passed through four editions. After the return of M'Clintock there was very lamentable neglect of Arctic work in this country during several years ; but the Council never ceased to take an interest in the efforts 90 Kane, Hayes, Nordenskjold, Payer, and Weyprecht. of other nations, and to show their appreciation of useful work well done, in a tangible form. In 1853 Dr. Kane, in the little brig Advance with a crew of seventeen men, led the first Ameri can expedition into Smith Sound, and the Founder's Medal was adjudged to him in 1856 for his discoveries and arduous labours during two winters in the ice. Dr. Kane's companion. Dr. Hayes, led another expedition to Smith Sound in 1860, and made a very gallant attempt to advance northwards along the western shore w ith a dog sledge. For this service to geography Dr. Hayes received the Patron's Medal in 1867. The admiring attention of our Council was also turned to the achievements of the Swedish explorers iu the Spitzbergen seas. Professor Nordenskjold received our Founder's Medal in 1869 for his valuable work in Spitzbergen, which was continued in subse quent years ; and when he succeeded in the glorious achieve ment of making the North-East Passage in 1879, the Medal was conferred upon the commander of his ship, the Vega, the gallant Captain Palander. The Norwegian, Captain Carlsen, had, in 1873, received a gold watch for circumnavigating Spitzbergen in 1863, and Novaya Zemlya in 1871. The discovery of Franz Josef Land by the Austro-Hungarian Expedition, under the command of Lieuts. Payer and Wey precht, and the admirably conducted sledging expeditions of Payer excited the admiration of English geographers. In 1875 the Founder's Medal was adjudged to Lieut. Weyprecht, and the Patron's Medal to M. Julius Payer. The latter officer came over to England, and was entertained at dinner by the Geographical Club, on November 10th, 1874, and also by the Trinity House. But in the meanwhile our Arctic Associates had, during ten years, been striving to obtain a renewal of Arctic exploration by the Government of this country. It was in 1865 that Captain Sherard Osborn resolved to bring this important subject before the Society. He fully recognised the fact that the great work could only be accomplished gradually, and that one expedition must follow another until all the knowledge attainable by human means, in this field of inquiry, had been secured. He also saw that a mere quest for the Pole was not an aim which would secure infiuential or intelligent support, but that the objects of Arctic exploration, in these days, must be to obtain valuable scientific results. Lastly he felt that the route for an expedition must be that which held out the best prospect of crossing the threshold of the unknown region and reaching new ground. He therefore wisely and correctly selected Smith Sound, at the head of Baffin Bay, as the direc tion that ought to be taken in the first instance. Sherard Osborn. 91 Sherard Osborn's memorable paper on the renewal of Arctic research, was read at the Meeting of the Eoyal Geographical Society on the 23rd of January, 1865, with Sir Eoderick Murchison in the chair. Seldom has so influential an assembly been brought together to support our Chair, men of the highest eminence in science being as numerous as Arctic and other naval officers. The address was eloquent and conclusive, and stirred up the feelings of those who heard it to such purpose that the subject was never again allowed to drop. Our President espoused the cause most warmly, secured the adhesion of other scientific societies, and headed a deputation of our Council to the Duke of Somerset, then First Lord of the Admiralty. But in March 1865 Sherard Osborn had accepted an appointment which obliged him to go to Bombay, and the movement, for a time, lost its chief support. In private correspondence Sir Eoderick deeply regretted Osborn's absence, speaking of him as " our right hand." Efforts were not, however, relaxed, and at last Osborn decided that the time had arrived for the formal renewal of his proposal. He read a second paper on the subject on April 22nd, 1872, and the Council appointed an Arctic Committee, with Admiral Sir George Back as its chairman, in that year. A second Committee, formed of Members appointed jointly by the Eoyal Society and by our Council, was formed in 1873 ; and the Eeports of these two Committees laid down the canons for Arctic exploration, enumerated its important objects in great detail, and adopted the views which Sherard Osborn had advocated since 1865. Our President Sir Henry Eawlin son, accompanied by Sir Joseph Hooker and Admiral Sherard Osborn, armed with these Eeports, had an interview with Mr. Disraeli on August 1st, 1874, and on the 17th of November the Prime Minister announced that the Society's petition had been successful. " Her Majesty's Government have had under consideration the representations of the Council of the Eoyal Geographical Society in favour of a renewed expedition under the conduct of Government, to explore the region of the North Pole, and having carefully weighed the reasons set forth in sup port of such an expedition, the scientific advantages to be derived from it, its chances of success as well as the importance of encouraging that spirit of maritime enterprise which has ever distinguished the English people, have determined to lose no time in organising a suitable expedition for the purpose in view." Accordingly the Alert and Discovery, Arctic exploring ships, were commissioned, under the command of Captain Nares, who had served under Kellett in 1852-54. But a very serious loss to our Society and to the navy, saddened the departure of the Arctic Expedition. On May 92 The Arctic Expedition of 1875-76. 6th, 1875, Admiral Sherard Osborn died very suddenly. His body was followed to the grave by the President and Secre tary of our Society, and by a large concourse of Arctic and other naval friends. Osborn became a Fellow in 1856, and was on our Council from 1867 until his death. He was also Vice-President of the Bombay Geographical Society from 1865 to 1867. He read various interesting papers at our meetings, constantly joined in our discussions, while his munificent present to our library will be noticed in another chapter. The Society never had a warmer or a more zealous friend. His cheery voice and hearty joyous smile, which won upon men's feelings as much as his close reasoning and well-marshalled facts affected their judgments, will long be remembered. The Arctic Expedition achieved all that our Council desired or expected in the face of greater dangers and obstacles than were ever anticipated. It succeeded in crossing the threshold of the unknown region, its ships attained a higher latitude than any other vessel has ever reached, they wintered further north than any human being has ever been known to have wintered before, and Captain Markham planted the Union Jack on the most northern point ever reached by man. Moreover the expedition explored that portion of the previously unknown Arctic region which could be reached from the direction of Smith Sound, with most valuable scientific results. On his return Sir George Nares and his officers were honoured with the warm approval of their Sovereign and of the Admiralty, and the leader was created a K.C.B. He and his officers had a magnificent reception at a special meeting of our Society, held at St. James's Hall, with the Prince of Wales in the chair, on December 12th, 1876. On the previous day they were enter tained at dinner by the Geographical Club, when the largest number of Members assembled that had ever been brought together since its foundation. Sir George Nares was adjudged the Gold Medal of our Society for his great services to Arctic geography, and Captain Markham received a gold watch, with a suitable inscription, for having advanced his country's iiag to the most northern point ever reached by man. The work of the expedition was done well, but geographers, who have studied the subject, are mindful that Arctic work cannot be completed by a single effort, and that the reasons for the continuance of northern exploration are as strong now as they ever were. The most gratifying recognition of the merits of our ex plorers was the dinner given to them by the old Arctic officers, to the number of twenty-eight, on December 6th, 1876. The Sir G. Back. — N.E. Passage. — 77*6 Dutch. — Leigh Smith. 93 veteran Sir George Back, who presided at this dinner, gave expression to the feelings of old Arctics in a heart-stirring speech that will not soon be forgotten by those who heard it ; and it was the last occasion on which the good old Admiral, the Father of Arctic explorers, spoke in public. Born in 1796, George Back achieved undying fame in the Arctic Eegions, first in the Spitzbergen Seas, next with Franklin on his two land journeys, then in his chivalrous attempt to succour the Bosses, when he discovered the Great Fish Eiver, and lastly in the memorable voyage of the Terror. He was an accomplished artist, as well as an accurate observer, and an undaunted explorer. He received our Gold Medal in 1835, and became a Fellow in 1836. From that time he was con stantly either a Member of Council or Vice-President, and was twice President of the Raleigh Club. He was a genial and most entertaining host, a steadfast and warm-hearted friend, and a hard-working Member of our Council. Sir George Back died, at a good old age, on June 23rd, 1878. He showed the regard he entertained for the Society and its objects, by his bequest of a legacy of 600?. and of the fine portrait of himself by Brockedon,* which now hangs in the Council Eoom of the Society. After the return of our Arctic Expedition, the glorious work was, it is to be hoped only for a time, abandoned to private efforts and to other countries. In 1878-79, Nordenskjold achieved the North-East Passage. The Dutch nation, inspired by the patriotic energy of Jansen and Koolemans Beynen, has sent the little schooner Willem Barents on three useful ex ploring voyages to the Arctic seas in 1878, 1879, and 1880. Captain Markham, in the little schooner Isbjorn, made a polar reconnaissance in 1879 ; and in 1880, Mr. Leigh Smith, in a steamer built specially for exploring, made important dis coveries along the south coast of Franz Josef Land. For this great service to geography he received the Patron's Gold Medal in 188L The Council, remaining true to the principles originally laid down, has not confined its honours to geographers only who have worked in the field. Scholars and cartographers, those who Lave discussed and utilized the work of tra vellers, have also had their labours and their merits duly recognized. The Society has adjudged the Eoyal Award to two of its Presidents. It is true that Admiral Smyth had fairly earned * Mr. Wm. Brockedon, f.b.s., -was on our Council in 1831, 1838, 1843, and 1844. He wag an artist, and also a great Alpine traveller ; author of ' The Passes of the Alps,' and Murray's ' Handbook of Switzerland.' He died in 1855. 94 Smyth, Murchison, Arrowsmith. the honour by his great geographical services in the field. But when, in 1854, he received the Founder's Medal, the Council and Fellows thought chiefiy of the pilot who steered the So ciety's ship through a stormy sea and brought her safely into port, of him who had given the Society, from its origin, the great benefit of his assistance and advice, and his vigorous superintendence while he occupied the presidential chair. The presentation of the Founder's Medal to Sir Eoderick Murchison, in 1871, was but a very slight acknowledgment of all that the Society owes to him who placed it amongst the fore most, the most active, the most popular, and the most widely known of our scientific bodies. The history of the award of a Gold Medal to Sir Eoderick was thus related by Sir Henry Eawlinson. " When ill-health forced him to retire, the Council had under consideration the presentation to him of some fitting testimonial. But while they were deliberating on the best means of carrying out this resolution, it was ascertained that Sir Eoderick, with a delicate and touching appreciation of the value of the Society's approbation, would prefer to any tes timonial, however costly and elaborate, the simple medal which he had himself so often presented to others as the reward of merit." Three eminent cartographers have been selected by the Council for the Eoyal Awards. Foremost was John Arrowsmith, an original Fellow of our Society, and a Member of the Council from 1851 to 1868. He was born at Winston, near Barnard Castle in Durham, on April 23rd, ] 790, and In 1810 he came to London to join his uncle Aaron Arrowsmith, who was then the leading cartographer In this country. For many years young John aided his uncle in the construction of his large collection of maps, and soon after his uncle's death he commenced his admirable ' London Atlas,' the first edition of which appeared in 1834. From that time he worked earnestly and ardently to the last, although from 1861 he ceased publishing on his own account. While engaged on his Atlas he laboured with the greatest industry, and lived in the most frugal manner. When that work had achieved success he still continued his pains taking career. He purchased his uncle's house, No. 10, Soho Square, from his cousin Samuel in 1839, and continued to live there until 1861. A great number of his maps Illustrate the papers in our Journals, and the perspicuity and fidelity with with which he laboured for many years in analysing and com paring the crude and hastily constructed sketch-maps which travellers brought home from distant lands, and the pains he took to delineate such fresh knowledge correctly, quite Irre spective of any pecuniary profit, renders his name justly famous Petermann. — Mrs. Somerville. — Colonel Yule. 95 among practical geographers. It will long be remembered, how, for so many years, he pointed out the places on the wall- diagrams as the authors read their papers at our Meetings, " describit radio," as Lord Ellesmere said. John Arrowsmith was adjudged the Patron's Medal In 1863, for the very important services he had rendered to geographical science. He died at his house in Hereford Square, on May 2nd, 1873, In his 84th year. In 1868 the Founder's Medal was awarded to Dr. Augustus Petermann for his services, as a writer and cartographer, in advancing geographical science, and for his well-known publica tion, the ' Geographische MIttheilungen,' commenced In 1856. Dr. Petermann was born at Bleicherode In Prussia in 1822, and first studied geography under Berghaus. In 1845 he came to Edinburgh to assist In the preparation of the English edition of the ' Physical Atlas ' of Berghaus, published by Keith John ston, and from 1847 to 1854 he was In London. Returning to Germany In 1855, he took the management of the geographical establishment of Justus Perthes at Gotha, Including the editor ship of the ' MIttheilungen.' From that time his life was one of ceaseless activity and usefulness in furthering the Interests of geography. He died at Gotha on September 23rd, 1878. To Mr. A. Keith Johnston of Edinburgh the Patron's Medal was adjudged In 1871. The two editions of his great 'Physical Atlas ' cost him ten years of the best period of his life ; the result was that the study of physical geography at once took its place among the necessary branches of a liberal education. In 1860 he published his ' Dictionary of Geography.' Mr. Keith Johnston only survived a month, after the presentation of the Medal. Mrs. Mary Somerville was, throughout a very long life, emi nently distinguished by her proficiency in those branches of science which form the basis of physical geography, and, in 1869, the Council unanimously agreed that she had well earned a claim to the Patron's Medal, which was accordingly adjudged to her. Her first work, ' The Connection of the Physical Sciences,' appeared in 1834, and her ' Physical Geography ' in 1848. It was Sir Bartie Frere who pointed out that, among the acts of Sir Roderick Murchison's Presidency, one of those of which he was most proud, was his having induced the Council to decree Gold Medals to two illustrious women : Mrs. Somer ville as the pre-eminent geographer and physicist, and Lady Franklin for her heroic exertions in determining the real fate of her husband. Colonel H. Yule, c.b., received the Founder's Medal In 1872 for the eminent services rendered by him to geography in the 96 Colonel Yule. — Mr. Bunbury. publication of his three great works, ' Narrative of a Mission to the Court of Ava In 1855,' 'Cathay and the Way Thither,' 1865, and his new edition of ' Marco Polo ' in 1871. ' Cathay and the Way Thithei- ' was one of the Hakluyt Society's series, and that the Geographical Society's Gold Medal should be adjudged to its editor, proves the close connection between the work and objects of the two Societies. Colonel Yule's exhaustive and masterly edition of ' Marco Polo ' Is a work, the publication of which forms an epoch in geographical literature, and It Is fitting that our Council should have conferred its highest honour on the first comparative geographer of this country. Since 1877, when he succeeded Sir David Dundas, Colonel Yule has been President of the Hakluyt Society. In 1880 the Council recorded their appreciation of the literary labours of Mr. E. H. Bunbury, in the production of his ' History of Ancient Geography,' a work of the highest value, combining accurate scholarship with large observation, and displaying a thorough acquaintance with modern geographical discovery, as well as with classical literature. A copy of the Council's Eesolution was presented to Mr. Bunbury, by the President, with the best thanks of the Council for the service he had rendered to geo graphical science and culture. This long roll of eminent explorers and geographers whom the Society has delighted to honour, this record of assistance given to expeditions in every part of the world, represents the main branch of the labours of an institution which has, during half a century, striven zealously and unceasingly to perform a duty which is of national importance. The Society's ' Journal.' 97 CHAPTEE X. PUBLICATIONS OF THE SOCIETY. LIBEAEY AND MAP EOOM. EDUCATIONAL MEASUEES. Next, in usefulness and Importance, to the operations of the Geographical Society in the field, are the measures for record ing the results of discoveries, for disseminating knowledge, for providing instruction and information, and for encouraging educational measures connected with the study of geography. In the first year of the Society's existence the form of our - JouENAL ' was decided upon by the Council, and the first volume was published in octavo, as at present, containing 264 pages, illustrated by eight maps. The first six volumes were edited by the first Secretary, Captain Maconochie, e.n., and in addition to the papers, contained analyses of recent publica tions, and miscellaneous geographical information. The two succeeding Secretaries, Captain Washington, e.n., and Colonel Jackson, continued the same plan of giving analyses of books, and In 1837 It was resolved that ail the maps should be engraved on copper. In order to supply the information as rapidly as possible, the ' Journal ' was published in two parts. In May and November, and for a short time, in 1839 and 1840, it came out in three parts. In February, May and November. A very useful addition was also made, in those years, In the shape of lists of geographical works and maps recently pub lished. But in 1842 the Issue of two parts during the year was reverted to, and in 1847 the analyses and miscellaneous Information were discontinued. Colonel Jackson completed an Index of the first ten volumes in 1844. Owing to the depressed state of the Society's affairs, the 'Journal' in 1848 only contained 144, and in 1849 only 200 pages ; but as our prosperity increased, so the size and import ance of the ' Journal ' continued to grow, and in 1862 it consisted of 31 geographical papers, Illustrated by 16 maps, and com prising 583 pages. The index of the second ten volumes of the ' Journal,' by Mr. G. S. Brent, was issued In 1853. From 1848 to 1855 the 'Journal,' Issued once a year, was the only publica tion, and It began to be felt that the information received by the Society ought to be utilised more expeditiously, and more frequently. Moreover the papers which did not obtain a H 98 ' Proceedings' place In the 'Journal,' as well as the discussions, were lost to the Fellows and to the public. It was at the suggestion of Mr. Francis Galton, then the Honorary Secretary, that the series of ' Peoceedings ' was com menced in 1855. to be published periodically, and to contain all papers read at the Meetings, together with the discussions, and additional geographical notices. These 'Proceedings' were Issued, in pamphlet form, at intervals of six weeks during the Session, and latterly six numbers formed a volume. The numbers did not appear at regular intervals, the first being published in about the middle of January and the last in September. There are twenty -two volumes of the ' Proceedings ' (Old Series), from November 1855 to December 1878, and the average size of the three last yearly volumes was 580 pages. This publication was capable of great improvement, and of being made the leading authority in the world on all sub jects relating to geography. In the year 1872, as the Council did not contemplate any change at the moment, one of the Honorary Secretaries, when an opportunity offered, undertook to edit a Geographical Periodical independent of the Society, to embody all the information which such publication ought to contain. The sections into which It was divided were original articles or papers, reviews of books, reviews of new maps and charts, geographical news in concise paragraphs, correspondence, obituary and other personal notices, and reports of proceedings of Geographical Societies at home and abroad. It was a monthly publication, each number being illustrated by one or two maps. ' The Geographical Magazine ' continued to have a steady constituency^ of 1000 to 1200 subscribers, and appeared regularly on the 1st of each month, under the editorship of Mr. Markham, from July 1872 to December 1878. But in the fulness of time the Council of the Eoyal Geographical Society felt the necessity for so enlarging and improving their 'Proceed ings ' as that they should cover the whole ground occupied by the Magazine. Thus the Magazine found its successor in a monthly periodical containing the same matter, and published by the Society. Its last number appeared in December 1878, and the first number of the New Series of the 'Proceedings' in January 1879. 'The Geographical Magazine' completed Its work and fulfilled its mission. Its labours were not iu vain, Its objects did not die with it, but were actively and ably pursued by Its successor. The ' Proceedings of the Eoyal Geographical Society ' (New Series) ' and Monthly Eecord of Geography ' have since been published on the first day of every month with perfect regularity, and very ably edited by the Society's Separate Volumes. 99 zealous and accomplished Assistant-Secretary, Mr. H. W. Bates. Each number contains the papers read at the Society's Meetings, with the discussions, occasionally also a memoir or communi cation which has not been read, announcements, geographical news in concise paragraphs, proceedings of Foreign Societies, notices of new geographical books and of maps, and obituaries ; and is Illustrated by two or more good maps. Meanwhile the ' Journal ' has continued to be Issued, and to contain the more Important papers Illustrated by maps, so that it forms an unbroken series of annual volumes from 1831 to 1881. The 'Journals' contain the whole series of Council Reports and Presidential Addresses. From 1854 they have been accom panied by a Eeport on the progress of Admiralty Surveys annually supplied by the Hydrographer. An Index to the third ten volumes (1850 to 1860) was prepared by our Gold Medallist, Colonel H. Yule, C.B., and issued In 1867, and a fourth index, now completed by Mr. Duffield Jones, brings that laborious work up to 1870. The Society has, In addition to its periodical publications, occasionally Issued separate volumes on special subjects. The first of these, printed at the Society's expense, appeared in 1837. It was a translation from the Danish of the ' Narrative of an Expedition to the East Coast of Greenland, by Captain Graah,' with an original chart. The translator, Mr. Gordon Macdougall, was accidentally drowned in 1835, but the work had the advantage of supervision by Sir James Eoss, who added some explanatory notes. The second volume separately issued was a ' Grammar of the Cree Language, with which is com bined an analysis of the Chippeway Dialect,' by Mr. Joseph Howse of Cirencester, published In 1844. But there was an interval of nearly thirty years before the Society undertook the issue of another separate Volume. ' The Lands of Cazembe,' published In 1873, contains Lacerda's Journey to Cazembe, translated and annotated by our Gold Medallist, Captain E. F. Burton ; the Journey of the Pombeiros across Africa ; and a resume of the journey of Monteiro and Gamltto, by Dr. Beke. The last separate volume that has thus been issued consists of a selection of papers on Arctic geographical and ethnological subjects, reprinted and presented to the Arctic Expedition of 1875 by the President, Council, and Fellows of the Eoyal Geographical Society. It proved useful on that occasion, and also In the Swedish Expedition of Professor Nordenskiold, which discovered the north-east passage. Great efforts have been made, from the foundation of the Society, to bring together a complete geographical library, and an equally extensive collection of maps. But for many years H 2 100 The Library. there were great diffi'culties owing to insufficient space, and for some time the want of funds offered another obstacle. The Council, and many of the Fellows, zealously exerted themselves, in days of adversity as in times of prosperity, and the means at the disposal of the Society were not unfrequently supplemented through the munificence of individual Fellows. The following account of the progress of the Library has been prepared by Mr. Edward Caldwell Eye, the Society's very able and efficient Librarian. " In the original prospectus of the Society, of the 24th of Blay, 1830, one of its primary objects Is stated to be 'to accumulate gradually a library of the best books on geography, a selection of the best voyages and travels ... as well as all such documents and materials as may convey the best Informa tion to persons Intending to visit foreign countries ' ; it being also proposed ' to open a communication with all those philo sophical and lltei'ary Societies with which geography is con nected.' The subsequent regulations contain a clause that ' The Society shall also commence the formation of a Library, ... to which all Members shall have access, and strangers by their orders, under such restrictions as may appear to the Council necessary.' " The first practical step towards this object is recorded in the Council Minutes of 1832, from which it appears that the Library then consisted of about 400 volumes, chiefly contributed by friends and Members of the Society, a list of whose names Is annexed to the Eeport. The names (81 in number) of these donors, the absolute founders of the present Library, are those of learned Associations, noblemen, men of science, and publishers, from whom it is invidious to make a selection, since nearly all are familiar as household words: Faraday, Humboldt, Hors burgh, Von Martins, Babbage, and the Court of Directors of the East India Company, amongst others, representing a past generation, and Mr. John Murray, so long associated with standard works of travel, still contributing. Small progress was made at first, the funds of the Society only permitting a trifling annual outlay on books ; and in 1834 the Library was considered to be the least satisfactory part of the Society's work, an appeal for help being made to the liberality of Members and friends. In 1836 and 1837, progress was far from satisfactory, many geographical works of the first importance being entirely wanting, and no suitable apartments found in which books could be placed for consultation. Many accessions are recorded in 1838, chiefiy owing to the liberality of Foreign Institutions (the Depot de la Marine, Paris, being the earliest to receive honourable acknowledgment), — the first fruits of The Library. 101 tlie wise extension beyond strictly geographical objects autho rised by the original prospectus. In 1839 and 1840 the increase was still higher, and foreign academies and official departments continued to assist. Suitable rooms at No. 3, Waterloo Place bslng then obtained, the Council in 1841 made a strenuous appeal to the Members for further aid, stating it to be their object ' that no work relating to geography, no map or chart extant, should be wanting to the Library.' This produced In the following year a special gift of 50?. from Mr. James Alex ander (who made two subsequent similar gifts), and some donations of books, especially one by Mr. (afterwards Sir Walter) Trevelyan, one of the original donors, and who not only sub sequently gave more books to the Library, but on his death bequeathed to the Society a?? his books that might be deemed of geographical importance. The Library was of very consider able extent and value In 1843, from more accessions ; and further steady but slight increase was made until 1848, when, in consequence of the pressing need of proper arrangement, a careful inspection was made by a Committee, who took measures for, preserving the books and obtaining the necessary accommo dation. A special subscription for defraying the cost of these works was set on foot, and by the next year had reached nearly 250?., whereof the greater part was expended. "In 1850, the Library contained over 4000 volumes (Sir Walter C. Trevelyan again, with Mr. C. Baring Young, having specially made liberal gifts) ; in 1852 the first Catalogue, prepared by the Secretary, Dr. Norton Shaw, was seen through the press by Mr. Greenough, who also recouped to the Society the honorarium awarded to Dr. Shaw. Eolations of exchange were in this last year established with many other Libraries and Public Institutions at home and abroad, and large and important accessions were recorded. h\ this year also was commenced the system of special grants by the Council for the Library use, as the balance of the subscribed fund above- mentioned was then exhausted. From this time, the importance of the Library was firmly established and recog-nised ; and in 1856, on the lamented death of Mr. G. B. Greenough, one of its earliest and most steadfast supporters, It received a large and important addition in the bequest of that gentleman's books and maps relating to geography, accompanied by a legacy of 500?. for the expense of accommodating the collection. Steady accumulations continued during succeeding years (1858 being marked by special improvement), and in 1865 the main Catalogue now In use was completed and Issued to the Fellows gratis. In 1871, the supplementary Catalogue, Including works acquired between 1885 and 1870, and the Classified Catalogue 102 The Library. of the whole (both prepared by Mr. Evans of the British Museum) were completed and published, the supplement being distributed gratis. The Classified Catalogue Is practically an amplification of a similar work prepared many years before for the Library by Mr. F. Galton. The large accumulations since 1870 have rendered it desirable that a second supplement, covering from that year to the end of 1880, should be prepared. This has been done by the present Librarian, and is now In the hands of the Printers. " On the removal in 1872 to the premises now occupied by the Society, the accommodation for books was increased about one-fourth, and this has in subsequent years been still further and largely added to by the erection of new presses In all avail able places, and by the appropriation of a special room apart from the Library for duplicates and works not frequently consulted. "The first Librarian of the Society was Mr. Charles Brad bury, appointed In December 1832, who also acted as draughts man. He resigned In November 1836, and was succeeded by Mr. E. W. Clifton, who was followed in December 1837 by Mr. Webb, e.n. In December 1841 Mr. J. Shilllnglaw became Librarian, resigning In November 1846. After him Mr. Cart- wright discharged the duties, as well as those of clerk ; and in 1854 so distinguished a geographer as Mr. Trelawny Saunders acted as temporary Librarian, practically re-organizing the library. That work being accomplished, Mr. Wheeler, the Chief Clerk, continued In charge of the books, until succeeded in both offices by Mr. E. Street In 1862. Lieut. A. J. Clark, a Fellow of the Society, acted on an emergency in 1864, until Mr. H. Purrler was appointed. In November 1866 Mr. J. H. Lamprey was made Librarian ; and on his retirement in March 1874, the present Librarian was appointed. The duties had by that time so much increased, that an assistant (Mr. Vin cent Hawkins) was engaged in the following October. " The work of the Library is superintended by a separate Committee, originally indicated in 1853. It meets practically every month during the Session, and has been very constantly and zealously presided over by Mr. Fergusson who, from 1863 to 1881, has given his time and valuable aid to the Society's work. The expenditure is now, on the average of the past six years, about 150?. per annum for books, and 90?. for binding. During that period, a further sum of 200?. has also been expended. This was the munificent present ofthe lamented Admiral Sherard Osborn during his life, ' in recognition of the valuable assistance afforded to him by the use of the Library.' " The Library now contains upwards of 20,000 books and pam phlets, for the most part either purely geographical or bearing The Library. 103 upon the sciences with which geography is connected, as desired by the original promoters of the Society. This large number of volumes, still steadily increasing, represents exchanges of publications and important donations, besides regular and occasional purchases. In addition to the gifts above alluded to, which form as it were a part of the history of the Library, having been made at critical periods of the existence of the Society, there are some which it is impossible here to pass over, though to give a proper recognition of obligations of this nature would require far more space than Is available. The Library is most especially indebted to the various Departments of Her Majesty's Government for invaluable and continued support, perhaps most of all to the Secretary of State for India and to the different branches of the Indian Administration, from whom have been received the co.-itly series of Gazetteers, the voluminous Eeports (frequently illustrated, and which under that modest name are often exhaustive scientific treatises), the lengthy accounts of Trigonometrical, Topographical, Marine, Geological, Statistical and Eevenue Surveys, the selections from Government papers, and the confidential and early details of explorations which enrich the presses devoted to Asia. It is to the attention to the Society's welfare In this respect by Mr. Markham, while he was in charge of the Geographical De partment at the India Office, from 1867 to 1877, that many of these acquisitions are due. To the Secretaries of State for Foreign Affairs and the Colonies (as also the separate Colonial administrations, notably those of Canada, Victoria and New Zealand), the Intelligence Department of the War Office and the Admiralty, we are also largely indebted. Nor are the Governments of foreign countries less generous In their aid. Of them, the United States authorities stand conspicuously in the front rank, their gifts being second only to those on Indian subjects above mentioned In mere extent, and perhaps even wider in scope. The many comprehensive publications of the various State Geographical and Geological Surveys under Hayden, Wheeler, Powell, King, and others, of the Engineer Department, and Naval Observatory, the Senate documents, and Coast Sur veys, are but the chief among the mass of works, bearing more or less on geography, which we continue to receive from Transatlantic official sources. And, as the outcome of a truly national Institution, the numerous Smithsonian publications can here be fitly acknowledged. " Of other foreign State benefactors, the Frenf'h Marine De partment and Minister of Public Instruction, tht; Prussian and Egyptian General Staffs, and various officials of the German, Eussian, Netherlands, Scandinavian, Austrian, Mexictin, Chilian, 104 The Library. and Peruvian Governments, deserve especial thanks for their donations. "To the Individual contributors above recorded must be added the names of John Crawfurd, who presented 'Purchas his Pilgrimes,' Lord Stanley, Sir Eoderick Murchison and Kenneth R. Murchison, Sir VV. Oodrington, Desborough Cooley, J. P. Gassiot and 0. H. Wallroth, as having either by costly gifts or continued support shown how much they cared for the Society's best Interests ; for Arctic works, the well-known names of Back, Barrow, and Hooper are to be in like way signalised ; and valuable presents by Commodore Jansen, Dr. Forchhammer, Dr. Zlegler, Count Wilczek, General Kaufmann, Professor Eaimondi, Capt. Vidal Gormaz, and the Archduke liudwig Salvator of Austria, sufficiently attest a world-wide interest in our welfare. This short list would be still more incomplete. If mention were not made of the continuous interest In the Library shown by our Secretary Mr. Markham, whose gifts of the great works of Gay and Castelnau, the earliest (1589) publication by Hakluyt, Van der Aa's collection of voyages, and all the early histories and memoirs of Viceroys referring to Peru, signalise themselves among minor donations too numerous to be given here. " The chief aim of the Library Committees has been to obtain books which are beyond the reach of most individual pur chasers ; and with this view they have secured such desiderata as the long and costly series of French Voyages, the 1599 edition of Hakluyt, Eden's Travels, the Journal of the Godef- froy Museum at Hamburg, &c. The collection is, however, least rich in old books of importance. "Eeceiving the publications of over thirty other Geographical Societies, subscribing for or being presented with every geo graphical periodical of any value, purchasing every Important work of travel or bearing on scientific geography as soon as possible, and with the series of all corresponding scientific bodies kept up to date, the Library may now perhaps fairly be considered as the best purely geographical one in existence. It is largely consulted by the Fellows, whose power of borrowing Is constantly exercised (though for the most part on works of transitory Interest), by the officers of public Departments, and by travellers, authors, teachers, students, missionaries, mer chants, publishers, and artists, who find in its stores material not elsewhere obtainable. In connection with the sciences allied to geography, it may be noted that the fact of some members of the Staff being Fellows of other Societies, has on several occasions enabled our own Fellows to obtalji ready access to authorities incidentally valuable, but not properly The Map Room. 105 within the scope of our Library. The aid which in earlier times it was enabled to afford to the State (e.g. during the Abyssinian War and San Juan Boundary dispute) is now of a less direct nature, as the Intelligence Department of the War Office has acquired so great an official standing and value. But that Department makes the most constant and the largest demands upon our resources. "From time to time the Library is consulted by foreign geographers, who on some occasions have for that purpose visited England ; and as the extent of Its possessions in the allied sciences is gradually getting better known, it is acquiring a reputation for referential purposes. " The Bibliography of the present issue of the Society's ' Proceedings,' tending as it does not only to add to a know ledge of geography (for there is no similar abstract in English of geographical works), but to increase the area of the Society's Infiuence, may also be properly mentioned here, as it Is founded on books that come under the Librarian's notice in his official capacity." The collection of maps and charts now contains 35,000 sheets, 500 atlases, numerous pictorial illustrations, 63 relief maps and models, and 240 large maps or diagrams suitable for the illustration of lectures. It has annually continued to in crease by donations and purchase, receiving a very large and important accession In 1855, from the munificent bequest of Mr. Greenough. All the principal maps published by Mr. Edward Stanford were presented by that gentleman; and in 1880 a complete collection of the maps published by the late M. P. H. Vandermaelen of Brussels, through his executors. Donations are received from the Admiralty, the War Department, and the Ord nance Survey Department, from the Secretary of State for India, and from various Foreign Governments, of the sheets of national surveys. The complete catalogue of maps and charts, including all the maps In the 'Journal,' was finished in 1880 and Is about to be published. The interest taken in the Society's labours led to the Map Room being raised to the position of a national institution. In 1854 Her Majesty's Ministers felt themselves justified in tendering a yearly grant of 500?. to the Society, in order that the collection of maps and charts might be rendered available for general reference. This proposition was gratefully accepted, and arrangements were promptly made in accordance with the Treasury Minute. Thus, through this grant, the Society's Map Room has become a valuable place of reference which is open to the public, and which has ever since been constantly utilised by the Intelligence Department of the War Office and by other Government Departments, as well as by numerous individual inquirers. It is a gratifying incident In con- 106 Instruments. — ' Hints to Travellers' nection with the grant that our Associate Mr. Joseph Hume, m.p., the rigid economist and jealous guardian of the public purse, raised his powerful voice in favour of a measure which he con sidered to be useful and desirable. From 1854 the Society's Map Room has been, as Sir Eoderick Murchison had long main tained It should be, the " Map Office of the Nation." The Society's collection of Instruments was formed both to enable travellers to become familiar with their use ; * and in order that the Council may be in a position to lend sets or single Instruments to explorers and travellers who may apply for such loans, and are found to be qualified to observe. The system of lending instruments has been very successful. Several travel lers are now annually enabled, in this way, to add considerably to the value of their reports, and the supply of instruments has become a regular and very useful branch of the Society's work. A complete set of Instruments, with other articles necessary for the equipment of an observer In the field, is placed under a glass case in the Map Room, as a guide to intending travellers, and to remind them of useful things which might otherwise be overlooked. With the instruments, the Council has always seen the Im portance of furnishing Instructions for their use, and suggestions to the explorer on all points relating to their work. The first book of the kind, was Colonel Jackson's ' What to observe, or the Traveller's Eemembrancer,' a fourth edition of which was Issued in 1861. Meanwhile the Council had appointed a Sub- Committee consisting of Captain FitzEoy, e.n., and Lieutenant H, Eaper, e.n., to report upon the best form in which informa tion could be furnished to inquirers. The result was the publi cation of a pamphlet entitled ' Hints to Teatellees,' containing the report of the Sub-Committee, and papers by Admiral Smyth, Admiral Beechey, Colonel Sykes, and Mr. Francis Galton. The report gives a list of necessary instruments, instructions for drawing maps and plans, and for observing for latitude and longitude. Admirals Smyth and Beechey furnish many valu able hints; Colonel Sykes's paper is on the use of thermometers to determine heights; and Mr. Galton discusses a traveller's outfit, and gives Instructions tor describing a new country. The second edition of Hints to Teavellees ' was revised by a Committee, consisting of Sir George Back, Admiral CoUinson, and Mr. Francis Galton, in 1864. Their information is prefaced by the remark that It is to be understood as addressed to a per son who, for the first time in his life, proposes to explore a wild country, and who asks what astronomical and other scientific outfit he ought to take with him, and on what observations he * See page 19. Scientific Lectures. 107 ought chiefly to rely. It, therefore, commences with a descrip tive list of needful instruments and other articles, which is followed by detailed instructions for observing for latitude and longitude, for rough triangulation, for ascertaining altitudes by boiling-point, for projecting routes, for constructing maps, with hints on photography by Professor Pole, and on collecting- objects In natural history by Mr. Bates. This edition was ex tensively circulated, and was followed by a third edition in 1871. The fourth edition of ' Hints to Teavellees ' appeared in a new form in 1878, under the sole editorship of Mr. Galton. Instead of being an ordinary 8yo. pamphlet. It is a little square volume of 104 pages, very compact, and easily fitting into a coat pocket. The principal additions are a " Memoir on Surveys " by Major Wilson, e.e., a paper on observations with theodolites or altazimuth instruments by Colonel J. T. Walker, e.e., and several useful tables. There was a rapid and extensive sale of the fourth edition, and a new and revised edition is now about to be prepared. In 1876 the Council had under Its consideration a series of proposals drawn up by several of Its Members, and concurred in by eminent men of science among the Council, which had for their object the adoption of measures with a view to giving greater encouragement to the study of the more strictly scientific side of geography, and ofthe causes which, by their combined action, have made the earth what we find It. The result of a careful consideration of these proposals was that the Council recorded its willingness to set aside an annual sum of 500?. for scientific purposes. It was decided that three lectures should be delivered at Evening Meetings during each Session, by the most eminent physicists wdiose services could be secured. These valuable lectures were continued during the three following years : — 1876-77. Major-Gen. Strachey, c.s.i. .. Introductory lecture on scientific Dr. Caepentee, c.b On the temperature of the deep sea bottom. A. E. Wallace, Esq Comparative antiquity of conti nents. 1877-78. Professor Duncan On the main land masses. Captain Evans, e.n., c.b. . . On the magnetism of the earth. W. J. Thistblton Dtee, B.sq. Plant distribution as a field for geographical research. 1878-79. Professor Geikib Geographical evolution. Professor Eolleston .. .. The modifications of the external aspects of organic nature pro duced by man's interference. Jomi Ball, Esq .. Qn the origin of the flora of the European Alps. 108 Instruction to Travellers. But it was found that the lectures were not suited to the large mixed audiences which assembled at the Geographical Society's Meetings. The object of the Council would, it became evident, be more satisfactorily attained by a system of instruc tion to those who were actually desirous of acquiring a know ledge of scientific geography with some practical object. A very large number of Englishmen visit countries which have never been geographically described or correctly mapped, and traverse routes along wlalch no observations have ever been taken. Many more annually pass and repass over tracts respecting whicli some previous contributions have been re corded, but which need additional and more correct observations before they can be adequately described and mapped. Every year these wanderers, in various professions and engaged upon divers avocations, spread themselves over every quarter of the globe ; yet, for want of necessary training, they travel and return without any or with few results that can be utilised for geo graphical purposes. In many Instances such travellers would gladly and even zealously add the work of observing and of collecting geographical information to the more direct objects of their journeys. It is probable that nearly all would do so if they were made sensible of the value of such work, and if the means of acquiring the necessary training were within their reach. These considera tions induced the Council of the Society to take steps for pro viding this preliminary training. It was believed that by undertaking to make proper arrangements for the pm-pose, the increase of valuable observations, for geographical purposes, in all parts of the world would be promoted. Mr. John Coles, late E.N., the Curator of the Society's Maps, was accordingly appointed to give Instruction in practical astronomy, route surveying, and mapping ; and steps were taken to make it generally known that such Instruction was provided by the Council. At the same time the construction of a small observatory on the roof of the Society's house was sanctioned, which was finished and in use by February 1880. Mr. Coles began to give instruction in October 1879, and he has since given 232 lessons to 24 students, down to the end of 1880._ The subjects taught embrace nearly all the problems in practical astronomy and surveying, the use of the transit- theodolite, ordinary 5-Inch theodolite, sextant and artificial horizon, hypsometrical apparatus, manner of plotting a traverse- survey by means of the prismatic compass, and map construction. The students have included civil engineers, naval and military officers, surgeons, magistrates, botanists, missionaries, and one bishop. School Prizes. 109 This measure has answered perfectly, and is likely to be still more successful in the future. Its scope might hereafter be extended, and It Is calculated directly to advance the interests and objects of the Society. For upon the careful and efficient training of explorers depends the value and accuracy of their work. A system had been Inaugurated, some years previously, for promoting the teaching of geography in our schools, and thus widely disseminating a taste for our pursuit, and sowing seeds, some of which might surely be expected to bear fruit In after years. In 1868 the Council resolved, at the suggestion of Mr. Francis Galton, to offer prizes for competition in the principal public schools, with the object of encouraging the study of geography. For some years previously an annual prize of 5?., termed the "Eoyal Geographical Society's Prize," had been granted by the Council, with beneficial results, to the Society of Arts, and awarded at their annual examination. It was now further resolved to offer two gold and two bronze medals, one of each to successful candidates in an annual examination on subjects of political and physical geography respectively, the first examination to take place in 1869, and to be repeated In each succeeding year. The decision of the Council to take this step was influenced by the Eeport of the Eoyal Commis sion on Public School Education in 1864, in which an opinion is expressed that greater attention should be paid to geography and history, than they now receive at schools. After the Council's action had received the test of ten years' experience, Jlr. Galton was able, in 1878, to announce the continued success of the Public Schools' competition. Most of the Schools which sent candidates for the first examinations continued to do so, showing that they had found by experience that the teaching of geography did not Interfere with other branches of stud)\ Out of the forty medals which had been given, twelve had been gained by Liverpool College, five by Eton, and four each by Rossall and Dulwlch. There could be no doubt that the effect of the medals had been to increase the standard of geographical teaching in many schools, and ample testimony has been borne, both by schoolmasters and by medallists, to the great service rendered to the cause of education by these prizes. A perusal of this chapter will have shown the nature of the measures adopted by the Society with the object of instructing and training explorers and geographers, and of utilising the results of their labours. We begin by striving to infuse a taste for geographical studies In our public schools. We next supply the means of efficient Instruction to all who are about to visit 110 Recapitulation. distant lands, and are willing to benefit by the facilities offered by the Society. Through our annually increasing library and map collection, the geographer is enabled to prosecute his studies with peculiar advantages ; and the results of the labours of explorers and of the researches of students receive wide pub licity through our 'Journals' and ' Proceedings,' and are thus fully utilised. Opening Prospects. Ill CHAPTEE XL PEOGEESS OF THE SOCIETY. Finance — Members — Meetings — House Accommodation. The power of forwarding the objects of the Society, of accumu lating geographical information and making It available, of furthering and assisting exploration and discovery, depends upon the support received by the Society from the public. It Is only on the condition that the Geographical Society's work Is felt and recognised to be work of national Importance, that it can be efficiently and continuously performed. The great object of the Founders of the Society, and of their Successors, has been, by activity and diligence, to establish the Society's reputation, and to prove the value of its labours. Through evil report and through good report, the work has been steadfastly pushed for ward during half a century ; and successive Members of the Council have given their time and abilities, In ungrudging measure, to the Society's business. It is this unostentatious work, this attention to the measures for increasing the number of Members, to financial details, and to administrative business, upon which the prosperity and well-being of the Society is founded. The Society commenced its operations with 460 Members in 1830, the admission fee being 3/., the annual subscription 2?., which might be compounded for by one payment of 20?.* In the first two years, from July 1830 to March 1832, the receipts amounted to 5239?., and it was the original plan of the Council to form a reserve fund by investing the sums received as com positions, and to meet current expenses with the amount repre sented by annual subscriptions. During the first ten years the receipts averaged 1500?. a year, and by 1840 a reserve fund of 4000?. had been invested. The number of Members increased to 700, but arrears of payment were very large. Through the kindness of Mr. Robert Brown, one of our seven Founders, the Society obtained shelter and a place of meeting, during those first ten years, at the rooms of the Horticultural Society in Regent Street, for which a house-rent of 110?. was paid. But, as the collection of books and maps increased, and the evening meetings became more popular and more numerously attended, * The composition is now 28Z. on entrance, or 25Z. at any subsequent period if the entrance fee be abready paid. 112 Early Sti-uggles. the want of better accommodation was more and more felt. The difficulty In obtaining suitable rooms was caused by want of sufficient funds, and also by the Society's large expenditure in furthering geographical exploration which, during the first ten years, was munificent, considering the means at Its disposal. At last, in 1839, the Society took a lease of a suite of rooms at No. 3, Waterloo Place, at a rent of 263?. a year, which it continued to occupy until 1854. There was an expenditure of 270?. in fitting up and furnishing these rooms. The evening meetings were still held in the public room of the Horticultural Society, in Eegent Street. The most depressed period of the Society's affairs was from 1845 to 1850, when the arrears increased to alarming propor tions, the deficits were chronic, and there was an annual neces sity for selling out and encroaching upon the reserve fund, to meet them. In 1848 there was a diminution in the number of Members. The Financial Committee reported that the Society was in a state of financial embarrassment, and a representation was made to the Prime Minister, asking for Government sup port on the ground of the national character of the Society's work. The receipts had fallen to 583?., while the expenditure was 755?. No help was granted. The Council had to face and overcome its difficulties without assistance, and it did so with most complete success. During Admiral Smyth's tenure of office the most strenuous and effectual efforts were made to give a healthy tone to the Society's finances, and to increase its resources. The number of Members began to increase, and fresh interest was given to the Society's meetings. In 1850 the sums invested had been reduced, by sales to meet annual deficits, to 1886?., while the subscriptions and entrance fees only amounted to 1036?. Con tinued efforts were made to Induce the Government to grant suitable apartments for the Society's use, but without result. But Admiral Smyth did not lose heart. " It is our part," he said, " to deserve success by eschewing despondency. I therefore call upon you all, and severally, to stand by your colours — " ' True as tbe dial to tbe sun Although it be not sbin'd upon.' " Meanwhile, through the kindness of the Principal and Council of King's College, Improved accommodation for the evening meetings was provided at Somerset House. The true foundation of the Society's success has been the close attention to its finances which has been given since 1850. In addition to the care bestowed upon them by the Treasurers, the Council has continuously had the great benefit of diligent Whitehall Place. — Burlington House. 113 assistance, in its financial affairs, from eminent merchants or actuaries of ability and long experience. From 1846 to 1863 Mr. Osborne Smith was constantly a Member of the Finance Committee, Mr. Brooking from 1855 to 1868, Mr. Charles White from 1869 to 1871, and Mr. S. W. Silver from 1871 to 1881. Sir George Balfour was also a most valuable Member of the Finance Committee from 1863 to 1868. From the time of Admiral Smyth the affairs of the Society continued to Improve without any check. In 1853 the Council, In order most efficiently to carry out the objects of the Society, was divided Into permanent working Committees under the following heads : — 1. Eegulations and Bye-laws. 2. Finance and House. 3. Library and Maps. 4. Publications. 5. Expeditions. In the following year the Society took the lease of 15, White hall Place, a commodious house with suitable Library and Map Eoom, at a rent of 500?. a year for 16 years. The work of removing the valuable collection of maps and charts, and properly arranging them in Whitehall Place, was ably per formed by Mr. Trelawney Saunders. The establishment of the Society In a house of Its own, added very materially to its use fulness, and to the convenience of the Fellows. At first the Library was fitted up for evening meetings, but it was very soon found that the accommodation was quite insufficient ; and in 1858 the use of the large room in the west wing of old Burling ton House was accorded by the Eoyal Society and the University of London. This long and handsome room, hung with portraits of the Presidents of the Eoyal Society, conspicuous among whom was Sir Joseph Banks, the Founder of the African Association and the great patron of geography, continued to be our place of meeting from 1858 to 1868. Here took place the crowded receptions of Livingstone and Speke, and here Sherard Osborn read his memorable paper on the renewal of Arctic research. The number of Fellows continued to Increase rapidly. In 1850 there were 700, in 1858 the number was over 1000, and by 1868 it had passed 2000. From that time the rate of increase was more marked, for the figure 3000 was reached by 1876, and In 1880 the number of Fellows was 3371. From 1830 to 1860 the elections took place by ballot among the general body of the Fellows at the evening meetings. But in 1861 the elections were entrusted to the Council. It had been found that very great inconvenience attended the method of I 114 Purchase of No. 1 Savile Row. ballot at the crowded evening meetings. It was Impracticable to carry round the boxes to obtain the vote of each Fellow, and very few took the trouble of voting as they entered the hall. Consequently It was unanimously agreed, at a General Meeting, that the elections should be entrusted to the Council, the names of Candidates proposed and of Fellows elected being regularly announced at each evening meeting. Besides the 3371 ordinary Fellows, there are nine Honorary Members, consisting of Crowned Heads or Imperial or Eoyal Personages who take an interest in geographical pursuits ; and 59 Honorary Correspond ing Members who are distinguished foreign geographers and travellers. By 1864 the finances of the Society may be considered to have been brought back to a satisfactory condition. The receipts were 5256?., and the expenditure only 3655?., leaving a large sum for investment. The funded capital of the Society was 10,500?. There was a considerable annual increase to the funded capital, which was accumulated with a view mainly to the pur chase of a freehold property, at the conclusion of the lease of 15 Whitehall Place. In 1870 the funded capital amounted to 19,250?. The freehold of the house at No. 1 Savile Eow was purchased In this year for 14,527?. A further expenditure of 3798?. was Incurred for alterations and building the Map Eoom, 1074?. for removal expenses, and 334?. for dilapidations on giving up the lease of 15 Whitehall Place. The extensive alterations were superintended by a Building Committee, con sisting of Mr. James Fergusson, and the Treasurer, Mr. Eeginald Cocks. The total sum sold out amounted to 18,250?. Thus the Society became possessed, for the first time, of suitable premises of its own, consisting of an Office, Council Eoom, large national Map Eoom, Library, rooms for the Assistant- Secretary and Office Keeper, Instrument Room, and rooms for draftsman, and for the binder and map-mounter. An Obser vatory has since been added, at the top of the house, for the convenience of students receiving instruction in practical astronomy. The value of the house and furniture, exclusive of library and map collections (insured for 10,000?.) is estimated at 20,000?. After the wing of old Burlington House was pulled down In 1869, the evening meetings of the Society took place for a time at the Eoyal Institution in Albemarle Street. But since 1870 they have been held, by permission of the Chancellor and Senate of the University of London, in their grand hall in Burlington Gardens. On great occasions, such as the reception of Lieut. Cameron, and of the officers and men of the Arctic Expedition Present Prosperity. 115 on their return In 1876, the accommodation In Burlington Gardens has been found to be Insufficient, and it has been necessary to hire a still more spacious place of reception, namely St. James's Hall. The great number of Fellows has ensured the financial prosperity ofthe Society. Since 1870 this prosperity has steadily increased. The receipts in 1880 amounted to 8600?., and the actual expenditure was 8490?. ; while the Society's funded capital had again risen to 18,500?. The expenditure on the house, including office expenses and salaries, was 1792?. ; on the Library, 467?.; on the Map Eoom, 1125?.; on the evening meetings, 157?. ; on lectures and instruction to travellers, 112?. ; on awards, 207?. ; and on the publications, 3197?. In most years the donations towards the expenses of travellers also forms a considerable Item In the accounts. Her Majesty the Queen is Patron of the Society, the Prince of Wales Vice-Patron, and the Duke of Edinburgh Honorary President. The Council consists of a President, six Vice-Pre sidents, a Treasurer, two Trustees, two Secretaries, a Foreign Secretary, and twenty-one Ordinary Members. Their meetings take place once every fortnight during the Session, from Novem^ ber to June, and they are also divided Into the following Com mittees for the transaction of the Society's business : — 1. Finance and House. 2. Library and Map. 3. Expeditions. 4. Hints to Travellers. 5. School Prizes. 6. Scientific Purposes. By this machinery, and by the work of the Society's able and zealous permanent staff, the objects and interests of geo graphical science are furthered and extended. Instruction is afforded to travellers and explorers, assistance and advice pro vided, the means of reference furnished by one of the largest collections of geographical books and maps in the world, which is constantly being Improved and added to, and information is regularly disseminated at the evening meetings and through the Society's publications. While this ordinary work Is thus pro vided for, the Council is always willing to consider any new proposal for increasing Its usefulness, and for still further widening the sphere of operations which are of such vital importance to a great maritime and commercial people. 116 Work to be done in the far North. CHAPTEE XII. COMPABATIVE VIEW OF GEOGEAPHICAL KNOWLEDGE IN 1830 AND 1880, WITH A NOTICE OF THE WOEK THAT STILL EEMAINS TO BB DONE. The progress that has been made in the science of geography since the Society was founded Is only partially shown by a comparison of an atlas of 1830 with the maps of the present day. For this progress Is not alone comprised in the discovery and delineation of unknown countries. Its range is far wider. There have also been great improvements in the methods of Investigation, in systematic arrangement of facts, in carto graphy, and in the construction and use of Instruments. At the same time the most striking advances have been made In the work of discovery, and In completing our general knowledge of the earth's surface, preliminary to more syste matic and detailed surveys. Yet, bearing In mind that the first discoveries are merely reconnaissances. It may sai'ely be said that, great as our progress has been during the last half century, it only represents a very small fraction of what remains to be done. Glancing first at the Arctic Eegions, which had attracted so much attention during the period from the peace in 1815 to the attempt of Parry to push northwards from Spitzbergen in 1827, iu 1830 only unconnected strips of coast line had been traced along the coast of Arctic America, and It was unknown whether there was a passage along that coast to Fury and Hecla Straits. Baffin's Bay had been re-discovered, and Parry had pushed westward along Barrow Strait to Melville Island, but nothing was known of the region between Barrow Strait and the con tinent. Knowledge respecting the eastern sides of Greenland and Spitzbergen, the coasts of Novaya Zemlya, and the sur rounding seas was vague and Inaccurate, and an enormous area was entirely unknown. Now the whole coast of Arctic America has been delineated, the remarkable archipelago to the north has been explored, and no less than seven north-west passages have been traced by our naval explorers.* The channels leading northwards from * 1. Along the west coast of Banks Island to Melville Sound. 2. Through Princess Eoyal Strait to Melville Sound. 3. Down McClintook Channel. Arctic and Antarctic l^horn. ii7 Smith Sound, the shores of the Palseocrystic Sea, considerable portions of the east coast of Greenland, and the south shore of Franz Joseph Land, have been discovered. Captain Markham has advanced the Union Jack to 83° 20' N., and Nordenskiold has achieved the north-east passage. Still much remains to be done in the Arctic Regions. The interior of Greenland presents a problem of the deepest In terest, while the discovery of its northern shore has been an object of honourable ambition for three centuries. The line of the Palseocrystic Sea has been traced from the North American coast along Banks and Prince Patrick Islands, Grinnell Land, and North Greenland ; while a stream of this tremendous ice fiows down Melville Sound to press upon the coast of King William Island, and fragments find their way down the east coast of Greenland. But the extent of this ancient ice is still unknown, and a complete discovery of the area It occupies, and the causes of its accumulation, will be a most important addition to geographical knowledge. The exploration of the northein side of Franz Joseph Land, of the lands north of Siberia, and the solution of numerous scientific questions within the undiscovered area, furnish work to occupy many successive expeditions in the future. Every new dis covery increases the Interest of those which are to follow. At first mere isolated geographical facts w ere ascertained ; but as discovery advances, and these facts become more numerous, they begin to explain each other. The whole physical economy ofthe Polar Eegion will thus gradually be brought to light, and generalisation will become possible. In the Aictic Eegions there is still an important and most difficult piece of work to be done ; and it is the duty of our Society to promote and further it by every means in its power. In the Antarctic Eegions there is another enormous field for discovery. When the Society was founded, our Antarctic know ledge was derived from the voyages of Cook and Bellingshausen, who ascertained that there was no land over a very extensive area in high latitudes, and from those of Bransfield, Powell, and Weddell. Our second royal award was granted to Captain Biscoe, who, in February 1831 and 1832, discovered Enderby and Graham Lands ; and in 1839 Balleny made known the Balleny Islands and Sabrlna Land. Dumont d'Urville dis covered Terre Adelie and Cotd Clarie, in 1841 Sir James Eoss established the existence of a great southern continent, and in 4. Down Peel Sound and Franklin Strait, and round the west side of King William Island. 5. Round the east side of King William Island. 6. Down Prince Eegent Inlet and through Bellot Strait. 7. Through Fury and Hecla Strait and Bellot Strait. 118 Work to be done in Africa. 1842 he penetrated to 78° 11' s., the furthest ever reached. Since that time nothing has been done in the Antarctic Eegions. South of 78° there is an area of millions of square miles which is absolutely unknown. Next to the regions of the Poles, the greatest undiscqvered area, when the Society was founded, was in the continent of Africa. In the 17th century, the wide African spaces had been well covered with names derived from Ptolemy, Leo Africanus, Edrisi, Pigafetta, and De Barros and other Portu guese sources. But the more critical school of geographers, which flourished in the end of the 17th and in the 18th centuries, rejected all names and details for which no sufficient authority could be given. Delisle (1698), who was followed by D'Anville, left the greater part of inner Africa a blank, retaining only the single great lake of Lopez and De Barros (Tanganyika). The maps of 1830 show a lofty chain, Ptolemy's "Mountains ofthe Moon," running across the continent, near the equator, and the Nile flowing northwards from them.* The coast kingdoms and colonies are Indicated, and the mouths and lower courses of some of the great rivers. A dotted line shows the conjectural position of a long lake named " Maravi," in 10° s. Fezzan also appears, and lake Chad, with the routes of Denham, Clapperton, and Lander. Otherwise interior Africa is a blank space ; a mysterious region, well fitted to excite the interest of geographers, and the adventurous ambition of explorers. Fifty years has seen a vast change in all this. The discoveries of Burton, Speke, and Baker, revolutionised the orography of equatorial Africa, and established the existence of great lakes — the reservoirs of the Nile and the Congo. Livingstone revealed to us the basin of the Zambesi, and by discovering Nyassa, cleared up the mystery of lake " Ma ravi." Stanley descended the Congo, and Cameron crossed Africa, from Zanzibar to Benguela. The course of the Niger was traced by many persevering efforts, as well as those of the Senegal, the Gambia, the Ogowe, the Limpopo, and the Orange river ; while intermediate regions have been brought within our knowledge through the labours of daunt less explorers of several nations — Portuguese on both coasts and across the continent, French In the north and west, Ger mans mainly from the west and east coasts, and in the Nile and Niger valleys, Englishmen In all parts; and single tra vellers of all four nations have left their marks In every direc tion. Africa has been a glorious field of generous rivalry among civilised Europeans. * But Ptolemy erroneously placed the Nile sources and tbe Mountains of the moon in about 12° e. Work to be done in Africa. 119 Yet much remains to be done. There is a wide field for discovery between Morocco and the Niger. The course of the Uelle, beyond the point reached by Schweinfurth, is entirely unknown, as well as the Immense region between the Uelle and the Congo. The country between lake Tanganyika and Albert Nyanza is undiscovered. South of Abyssinia, there Is a great mountainous region, drained by the Juba and the Godjeb or Sobat, of whicli we know next to nothing. D'Abbadie's journey to Enarea and Kaffa, and that of Father Massajah are the only ones on record in this direction. Here there is a region inhabited by a brave and industrious people, and re ported to be fertile and productive. Even now the coffee from these highlands finds its way through Abyssinia to Mas- sowah. Further south, the country east of the Victoria Nyanza, overlooked by the snowy peaks of Kenia and Kili manjaro, Is equally unknow'u; and still further south there are unexplored countries along the east coast to the Lim popo, in the interior, between the Congo and Zambesi, and along the course of the Cunene. Moreover, it must be remembered that the work of the first discoverers, though the most difficult and perilous, and therefore the most glorious, is of the character of a recon naissance. The whole must hereafter be systematically explored and surveyed before we can acquire accurate knowledge of the structure — the physical geography of inner Africa. This will be the work of many years, and will need the fostering support and help of our Society. Asia is the seat of the most ancient civilisations. Great trade routes have traversed it from end to end during many centuries. Important cities and countries were well known In history, while their actual positions are uncertain. The exclusiveness of the Chinese, and the barbaric fanaticism of Muhammadans, render vast regions, once civilised and the centres of commerce, as inaccessible as the wildest parts of Africa. Consequently there was, and still is, a wide field for exploration In the interior of the Asiatic continent ; and dis covery of a most Interesting kind. For no mere daring explorer Is fitted for Asiatic discovery. Classical and oriental learning, critical acumen, and historical knowledge are as necessary here as the ordinary qualifications of a trained traveller. Comparative geography, one of the highest branches of our science, by identifying sites, and demonstrating, from history, the changes which have taken place in the course of ages, has been au essential auxiliary to the student of the physical aspects of Asiatic regions. Thus the knowledge that has been acquired since 1830, on the continent of Asia, is not 120 Work to be done in Asia. only extensive, but also of the highest scientific and historical interest. It has not only made known to us the geography of new regions ; but has also thrown light upon the history of our race. The writings of Arrian and Ptolemy, of the Chinese Pilgrims and the Arab geographers are as necessary to the student of Asiatic geography as the reports of recent explorers ; for a mastery of comparative geography is essential for a due comprehension of the existing physical conditions of many parts of this continent. In 1830 the Indian atlas had already been commenced, and Per sian topography was based on the Itineraries of KInneir; while the Himalayan region had been explored by Moorcroft and Trebeck, Baillie Eraser, and Herbert and Webb. Bogle and Turner had penetrated into Tibet, China was known to us through the Jesuit survey published by Du Halde, and Arabia through the work of Burckhardt. But the great mountain system of Central Asia was not understood, and the fountains and courses of most of the great rivers were unknown. During the fifty years of our Society's existence, the trigono metrical survey of British India has been almost completed, the height of the loftiest mountains in the world were fixed between 1845 and 1850, our officers have mapped the whole of Persia and Afghanistan, surveyed Mesopotamia, and explored the Pamir Steppe. Japan, Borneo, Siam, the Malay Peninsula, and the greater part of China have been brought more com pletely to our knowledge. Eastern Turkestan has been visited, and trained native explorers have penetrated to the remotest fountains of the Oxus, and the wild plateaux of Tibet. Over the northern half of the Asiatic Continent the Eussians have displayed equal activity. They have traversed the wild steppes and deserts of what on old atlases was called Independent Tartary, have surveyed the courses of the Jaxartes, the Oxus, and the Amur, and have navigated the Caspian and the Sea of Aral. They have pushed their scientific investigations Into the Pamir and Eastern Turkestan, until at last the British and Eussian surveys have been connected. Still, many years must elapse before our knowledge of the geography of Asia will approach completeness. The sources and upper courses of the great rivers Yang-tsze, Cambodia, and Irawadi, and part of the course of the Brahmaputra, are unknown. Our acquaintance with the head waters of the Oxus Is still very far from being satisfactory, while the northern half of the Tibetan plateau, and much of the Kuen-Lun range are quite unknown. Coming nearer to our own dominions, Kafiri- stan is still a mystery^, and even the Zhob and other valleys within the Sulimani Eange have never been visited by Work to be done in America. 121 Europeans. There are also very extensive tracts in Arabia which no traveller has ever explored. The survey and geographical description of North America is progressing under the admirably organised Departments of the United States Government, while good work is also being pushed forward In the Dominion of Canada. An enormous ex tension of our knowledge has taken place since 1830, when California was only settled by scattered Misiones, and the country to the north of It was unexplored, except by a few trappers. Our Society has watched the progress of these mar vellous changes with the greatest interest, and has benefited by the fact that scientific research has gone hand in hand with the settlement of the country. It has conferred its highest honours on an eminent United States surveyor, and on two explorers of the Eocky Mountains ; but it has felt that the actual work In the field is already In good hands. This Is not the case, to anything like the same extent, In Central and South America, where much exploring work remains to be done. Commencing our review of South America from the south, there Is much that remains undiscovered In Patagonia and the extreme south of Chile, although valuable progress Is annually made by the Hydrographic Department of Chile, under the able and zealous lead of Captain Vidal Gormaz. As regards the interior of Patagonia, Captain Musters was the very first traveller who ever traversed that wild region from south to north, and this fact alone shows how much remains to be done there. Proceeding northwards, the labours of Mr. MInchin and others in the region through which the Bolivian-Brazilian frontier passes has quite recently Increased our geographical knowledge ; and our science Is no less Indebted to Colonel Church for his work in the basins of the Beni and Mamore. Still there Is a vast extent of interesting country which is practically unexplored in the provinces of Lipez, Chichas, and Carangas, and especially round the western side of lake Poopo. In many respects the Andean system is, to the physical geographer, the most interesting mountain mass in the world. Here the phenomena of earthquakes may be studied on the largest and most awful scale. Here are volcanic chains ex tending hundreds of miles, and fossiliferous Silurian rocks raised in the form of mountain peaks over 20,000 feet above the sea. Here, too, the meteorological and other physical phenomena of mountain chains are of peculiar interest. Yet the orography of western South America is very imperfectly understood, and this is particularly the case as regards the 122 Work to be done in America. peaks and ridges of south-western Bolivia. In the vast region of the Madeira basin, which has been the scene of Colonel Church's invaluable labour,?, there is a yet more extensive unknown area, over which historical tradition has thrown a halo of romance. The course of the Madre de Dios, which drains the eastern slopes of the Andes of Cuzco, and of the Caravayan rivers, with their rich auriferous deposits, areujiknown, and the work of discovery In this most interesting region remains to be completed. There is a wholly undescrlbed Andean country, comprised in the Peruvian provinces of Lucanas, Parinacochas, Cangallo, Aymaraes, and Cota.bambas, and in the coast valleys and deserts between Arequipa and Nasca. There is also much useful geographical work to be done in northern Peru and Ecuador, especially In the basins of the Pastasa, Morona, San tiago, Tigre, and Napo. The Putumayo was recently as cended in a steam launch by Mr. Simson ; but the basins, both of the Putumayo and the Japura, need further examina tion. There is an enormous tract in Colombia, bounded by the slopes of the Cordillera on the west, on the east by the Orinoco and Rio Negro, on the north by the river Meta, and on the south by the Uaupes and Japura, which is practically unknown. This region is also surrounded with a halo of romance, for here the old conquerors of the 16th century believed that the far-famed El Dorado dwelt in golden abund ance. Many parts of the Colombian Andes need exploration, as well as the whole region, from the EIo Branco to the Atlantic. Enough has been said to show that there still re mains a vast amount of exploration, and even of discovery to be achieved In South America, and that, so far as that continent Is concerned, geographers will have no need to sigh because there are no more worlds to conquer, for generations yet to come. In Australia and Xew Zealand, the whole interior of those countries has been discovered and explored since the Society was founded. The maps of 1830 show very little more than inaccurate coast lines. Now, the arid wastes of Australia have been traversed in various directions, and the whole con tinent has been crossed from sea to sea, with an amount of brave endurance and indomitable courage which have ex cited the admiration of geographers, and gained for the explorers themselves the highest honours that the Society can bestow. Little now remains to be done on the mainland of Australia ; but the interior of New Guinea has yet to be explored, as well as New Britain, the Solomon Group, and many islands to the north and north-east of New Guinea. Hydrography. 123 A large part of the world is still undiscovered, and it must be remembered that, even when the whole of this preliminary reconnoitring work is completed, the labours of the geo grapher are only commencing. It will then be necessary to push forward those more detailed surveys which are neces sary before the physical configuration and aspects of a region can be correctly understood and described. Our work, as geographers, is to measure all parts of earth and sea, to ascertain the relative positions of all places upon the surface of the globe, and to delineate the varied features of that surface. This great work has been proceeding from the first dawn of civilisation, and it will probably be centuries longer before it is completed. Nor are our labours confined to the land. Hydrography is an equally important branch of our work. Sir John Barrow, in his opening address in 1830, urged upon the Society that, on the exactitude of the minutest details of hydrography, mainly depended the safety of navigation, and he recommended its members to look forward to the completion of surveys, and to extended observations on prevailing winds and cur rents. "Every accession to hydrographical knowledge," he added, "must be of great importance to navigation and therefore a fit object for promulgation by the Society." Having the interests of hydrography at heart, and making it a part of its duties to advocate and watch over the execu tion of surveys, the Society was joined by all the eminent nautical surveyors. The hydrographer, Sir Francis Beaufort, was an active member of our Council for twenty-five years, making the work of his department known through the Society's publications, and sometimes inducing the Council to represent to the Government the urgency for undertaking some particular survey.* On four occasions the Society has conferred its highest honours upon naval surveyors, and the Society has been reminded of its duties relating to hydro graphy by successive Presidents, and by the reports -nhich accompany their Addresses, as well as of the importance of increasing the accuracy of the surveys. For instance. Admiral Beechey, in 1856, told us that "rapid reconnaissance of a coast might have been tolerated half a century ago, but that such a survey of any shore cannot now be accepted." * "A Deputation composed of tbe President, Captain Beaufort, and Mr. Murchison, waited upon Lord Glenelg, recommending a nautical survey to complete tlie parts of tbe north-west coasts of Australia left unfinished, and to examine more thoroughly Bass and Torres Straits. Tbe Deputation was most favourably received; a survey of the coasts was ordered, and H.M.S. Beagle, commanded by Captain Wickham, will sail early in June." — E. G. S. ' Journal,' vol. vii. p. 10 ; 1837. 124 Deep-bea isouriuiio^^c Great progress has been made in providing accurate charts for navigation during the last fifty years; but much remains to be done. Commander Hull, e.n., who was Superintendent of Charts at the Admiralty from 1873 to the end of 1879, read an admirable paper on this subject at the United Service Institution in 1874, entitled the "Unsurveyed World," in which he showed the coasts that have been surveyed, those that have been only partially surveyed, and those that have merely been explored. The first class of coasts still bears but a small proportion to the rest ; and, in furthering the advance of the good work by all legitimate means, whether by inviting dis cussion, publishing information, rewarding and encouraging zealous and meritorious surveyors, or making well-considered representations, the Society will perform in the future, as it has done In the past, a useful national service. Since the foundation of the Society a new branch of geo graphical investigation and study has come into existence, namely, the physical geography of the sea, which is an im portant extension of hydrography. Mathew Fontaine Maury, the Superintendent of the National Observatory at Washington, was the creator of this branch of our science. As Commodore Jansen truly said In his able memoir — " Maury threw a new light upon the ocean, and on Its profoundest abysses, that will never be extinguished ; and It was through Maury's Initiative that the naval profession now forms the most intelligent and active corps of co-operators in systematic research into the hidden chambers of the great deep. It was Maury who, by his wind and current charts, his trade-vvind, storm, and rain charts, and last, but not least, by his work on the Physical Geography of the Sea, gave the first great impulse to all subsequent researches." The progress of our knowledge of the bottom of the ocean has been nearly continuous since 1840, in which year Sir James Eoss, on board the Erebus, obtained a sounding in 2677 fathoms. In 1847, on January 12th, Captain Owen Stanley, in the Eattle- snahe, found bottom, near the equator, at a depth of 2600 fathoms. Then followed the work of officers of the United States; and in 1856 Derryman, with the Brooke machine, obtained twenty-four deep-sea soundings on a great circle from St. John's, Newfoundland, to Valentia. In 1857 Lieut. Dayman, in the Cyclops, obtained a complete series of deep-sea soundings across the Atlantic, showing the great fall of 7200 feet, and the " Telegraphic Plateau." In 1 858 Lieut. Dayman sounded from Newfoundland to Fayal, and from Fayal to the English Channel, and In 1859 across the Bay of Biscay, and along the coast of Portugal, to Malta. Then followed the work of Sir Work in the Future. 125 Leopold M'Clintock In 1860 in the Bulldog, of Captain Short- land in the Hydra In 1867, from Malta to Bombay, and of the Porcupine, Lightning, and Gannet. Finally, the important voyage of the Challenger under Captain Nares, from 1873 to 1875, In the Atlantic, Indian, and Pacific Oceans, added enor mously to our knowledge of the physical geography of the sea. The greatest depth was between St. Thomas and Bermuda, where a sounding of 3875 fathoms was obtained.* A line was taken across the Atlantic from Greenland to Ireland by the Valorous in 1875 ; and many deep sea soundings have been added by vessels employed by the Telegraph Maintenance Company. Our lamented associate, Admiral Sherard Osborn, who was the Managing Director of this Company, communi cated a most Interesting paper on the geography of the beds of the Atlantic and Indian Oceans and Mediterranean Sea In 1870. Osborn bore generous testimony to the great service performed by Maury, and said that the geographer must not be satisfied with observations on the surface of the ocean, but must endeavour to probe mysteries down to the solid crust on which the ocean rests. This then Is a branch of geogra phical enquiry. In which much remains to be learnt, and which has come Into existence since the Society was founded. This rapid glance at the unknown and unexplored parts of the earth, shows that many years must elapse before all has been discovered, and that there is abundant work before the Society, even of this preliminary kind. In his Anniversary Address of 1851, Admiral Smyth offered some remarks on the duties of the Society which are as applicable now as they were then. He said that "one by one the last remnants of the unknown would yield to the efforts of explorers ; but, had we even actually arrived at so desirable a consummation, would our labours then be terminated ? Would Geographical Socie ties cease to be requisite ? Certainly not. Our work might then be said to be only beginning. Till we actually know the whole extent and surface of the globe on which we move, its peculiarities as a whole, and the mutual relations of its several parts, it can never be thoroughly investigated or understood ; and much will long remain, as It now Is, only a source of wonder and confusion." When, In the far distant future, the whole surface of the earth has been surveyed and mapped, the study of physical geography may be recommenced on a sound basis, and generalisations will become more accurate, and will * Or 23,250 feet. This is 5752 feet less than tbe height of Mount Everest above tbe level of the sea. So that the perpendicular height of Mount Everest above the lowest depth of tbe ocean is S miles, or 52,252 feet. 126 Work in the Future. be founded on more correct and reliable data. Until then, investigations in all the branches into which the science of geography Is divided must be continued, with patience and industry, and with the best information that can be obtained. Geography is a progressive science. Every year, with its discoveries and novelties, also brings forth a large crop of corrections and of information which modifies preconceived theories and opinions. It is this freshness, this constant sup ply of new material, which constitutes one of the many charms of geographical research. The Geographical Society thus commences Its second half- century of work with a bright prospect of continued useful ness. It has an honourable record of past labours to look back upon. It has now reached a high position as regards popular support and financial prosperity. It goes forward in the full assurance, which is justified by its former history, that it will have a long career of activity and success ; and that its efforts to perform good work, and to encourage and assist the labours of others, will constitute a service of national value and Importance. APPENDIX. CONTENTS. I. Presidents of the Eoyal Geographioal Society Honorary Secretaries , , Foreign Secretaries , , , , Trustees , , , , Treasurers , , , , Paid Secretaries ,, ,, Assistant Secretaries , , LlBBARIANS , , , , Clerks in Charge of the Library Map Curators , , , , Map Draughtsmen , , , , Chief Clerks , , , , Clerks , , , , Office Keepers , , , , Map Mounter , , , , II. Members of Council from 1830 to 1880 III. Eeferences to Obituary Notices of distinguished Fellows ffl THE Presidential Addresses, and 'Proceedings' (New PAGE 129 129 130 130130131131 131 131131 132 132 132 132 132133 140 IV. List of Explorers and Geographers to whom the Eoyal Geographical Society has granted Honorary Awards: — Arctic . . 147 Antabcito . . 147 Ajbioa . . 147 Asia . . 148 Indian Archipelago . . 148 Australasia .. 148 North America . . 149 South America . . 149 Marine Surveyors . . 149 Eminent Geographers . . 149 128 Appendix. V. Grants made by the Eoyal Geographioal Society in aid op Travellers and Expeditions 150 VI. List of Papers in the ' Journals ' and ' Proceedings ' op the BoYAL Geogeaphical Society : — AbcticAntarctic EuropeAsia . . AfricaAmerica AustralasiaOceaniaIndian Ocean Miscellaneous Vll. List of Maps published in the 'Journals' and 'Proceedings' op the Eoyal Geographical Society: — 153 157 157 159175 187 194 199 200 202 1. The World . 206 2. Polar Eegions . . . 206 8. Europe . 208 4. Asia . 209 5. Africa . 217 6. America and West Indies . . . 223 7. Australasia . 227 8. Atlantic Ocean and Islands . 229 9. Pacific Ocean and Islands . . . 229 10. Indian Ocean Islands . 230 VIII. Alphabetical List of the Authors of Papers in the Eoyal Geogeaphical Society's ' Journals ' and ' Proceedings ' . . 231 IX. Presidents op the Geographical Section C, British Association 243 > , , > , , Section E, , , , , 244 Secretaries ,, ,, ,, ,, ,, 245 X. Presidents and Secretaries of the Hakluyt Society.. .. 246 XI. The Hakluyt Society, 1881 246 List of Presidents and Secretaries. 129 APPENDIX PEESIDENTS OF THE EOYAL GEOGEAPHICAL SOCIETY. (* Gold Medallists.) 1831-33. Viscount Goderich. 1833-35. General The Right Hon. Sir George Murray, g.c.b. 1835-37. Sir John Barrow, Part. 1837-39. Mr. W. R. Hamilton. 1839-41. Mr. G. B. Greenough. 1841-43. Mr. W. R. Hamilton. 1843-45. Mr. R. I. Murchison. 1845-47. Admiral Lord Colchester. 1847-49. *Mr. W. J. Hamilton. 1849-51. *Admiral W. H. t^myth, c.b. 1851-53. Sir Roderick Murchison. 1853-55. The Earl of Ellesmere, k.g. 1855-56. Admiral Beechey. 1856-59. Sir Roderick Murchison. 1859-60. Earl de Grey and Ripon. 1860-62. Lord Ashburton. 1862-71. *Sir Roderick Murchison, Bart., k.c.b. 1871-73. Major-General Sir Henry Rawliuson, k.c.b. 1873-74. The Right Hon. Sir H. Bartie Prere, Part., g.c.b., q.c.s.i. 1874-76. *Major-General Sir Henry Rawlinson, k.c.b. 1876-78. Sir Rutherford Alcock, k.c.b. 1878-79. Tbe Earl of Dufferin, k.p., k.c.b. 1879-80. Tbe Earl of Northbrook, g.c.s.i. 1880-81. Lord Aberdare. HONOEAEY SECEETAEIES. 1847-49. Mr. George Long, and Major Shadwell Gierke. 1850-51. Mr. John Hogg, f e.s., and Dr. Trithen. 1851-53. Colonel Philip Yorke, f.r.s., and Dr. T. Hodgkin. 1853-54. Capt. P. P. Blackwood, e.n., and „ „ 1854-57. Sir Walter Trevelyan, Bart., and „ „ 1857-62. *Mr. Francis Galton, f.e.s., and „ „ 1862-63. „ „ „ and Mr. W. Spottiswoode, f.r.s. 1863-64. Mr. Wm. Spottiswoode, f.e.s., and Mr. Clements R. Markham. 1864-66. Mr. Clements R. Markham, cb., f.r.s., and Mr. L. Oliphant. 1866-81. „ „ „ „ and Mr. R. H.Major.. K 130 Secretaries, Trustees, and Treasurers. ' ~J1 HONOEAEY FOEEIGN SECEETAEIES. 1830-46. Rev. J. 0. Renouard (1840, Editor of Journal to 1844). 1862-65. Dr. T. Hodgkin. 1865-66. *Mr. Francis Galton, f.e.s. 1866-71. Mr. Cyril Graham, o.m.g. 1871-75. Mr. John Ball, p.e.s. 1875-81. Lord Arthur Russell, m.p. (to 1881). TEUSTEES. 1830. Sir George Staunton, Part., and Sir George Duckett. 1886. „ " „ „ and Mr. F. Baily. 1845. „ „ „ and Mr. W. R. Hamilton. 1858. „ „ „ and Mr. R. Monckton Milnes. 1859. Mr. R. Monckton Milnes (cr. Lord Houghton, 1863) and Si i Walter Trevelyan, Part. 1878. Lord Hougbton and Sir John Lubbock, Part, (to 1881). TEEASUEEES. 1831. Mr. John Biddulph ; also Trustee in 1839. 1845. Mr. Robert Biddulph. 1864. Mr. Reginald Cocks (to 1881). Permanent Staff. 1^1 PEEMANENT STAFF. PAID SECEETAEIES, 1830-47, ASSISTANT-SEOEETAEIES, 1847-81. 1830 — July. Captain A. Maconochie, e.n., k.h. 1836 — May 23. Captain Washington, e.n. 1840— Nov. 9. Colonel Jackson (1844, Editor of ' Journal '). 1847— April 3. Dr. Humble. 1849— Jan. 22. Dr. Norton Shaw. 1863— July 13. Mr. Greenfield. 1864— April 25. Mr. H. W. Bates (to 1881). LIBEAEIANS. 1832— Dec. 15. Mr. Charles Bradbury. 1836— Nov. 14. Mr. R. W. Clifton. 1837— Dec. 11. Mr. Webb, e.n. 1841— Dec. 13. Mr. Shillinglaw. CLEEKS IN CHAEGE OF THE LIBEAEY. 1846— Nov. 23. Mr. Cartwright, to 1851. 1854 — Aug. 8. Mr. Trelawney Saunders (Temporary Librarian). 1854— Nov. 23. Mr. Wheeler. 1859— March 21. Mr. W. C. Street. 1863— Jan. 12. Mr. E. B. Tattershall. 1864— Nov. 14. Mr. A. J. Clark. LIBEAEIANS. 1864 — Nov. Mr. H. Purrier. 1866— Nov. 12. Mr. J. H. Lamprey. 1874— Feb. 18. Mr. B. C. Rye. (Assistant, Vincent Hawkins, Oct. 4, 1874.) MAP CUEATOES. 1854 — Jan. 22. Mr. Trelawney Saunders. 1857 — June 15. Staff-Commander C. George, b.n. 1877— June 18. Mr. J. Coles, e.n. Assistants .-—1857 — June 19. Mr. Oulet. 1872— April. Mr. A. Keith Johnston (to 1873). 1878— June. Mr. E. A. Reeves. K 2 132 Permanent Staff. MAP DEAUGHTSMEN. 1873— Nov. 12. Mr. W. J. Turner. 1881— April. Mr. Henry Scharbau. CHIEF CLEEKS. 1846— Nov. 23. Mr. Cartwright. 1854— Nov. 23. Mr. Wheeler. 1862— Nov. Mr. E. Street. 1863— April 13. Mr. H. W. Farley. 1875— Feb. 15. Mr. A. E. Ball. 1876— May 15. Mr. E. DufBeld Jones (to 1881). CLEEKS. 1854— Nov. 23. Mr. Price (to 1863). 1859— March 21. Mr. E. Street (to 1862). 1859— Oct. 24. Mr. Reginald Suggate (to 1881). 1863— Jan. 12. Mr. E. B. Tattershall (to 1864). 1866— Oct. 8. Mr. S. J. Evis (to 1881). OFFICE KEEPEES. 1846— Dec. 28. Serjeant Ligbtfoot. 1853— July 24 Robert Suggate. 1876— Dec. 4. S. J. Evis (to 1881). MAP MOUNTEE. 1857— Sept. R. Burnett (to 1881). Members of Council. 133 MEMBEES OF THE COUNCIL OF THE EOYAL GEOGEAPHICAL SOCIETY, 1830-1880. (P. President ; V.-P. Vice-President; C. Council ; Treas. Treasurer ; Sec. Secretary ; For. Sec. Foreign Secretary ; Trust. Trustee ; Presidents in Small Capitals ; * 6old Medallist.) Abbedaee, tbe Right Hon. Lord, P. 1880. Acland, Sir Thomas Dyke, Part., 0. 1840, 41, 42. Addington, The Right Hon. H. U., C. 1862, 63, 64, 67, 68, 69. Albemarle. (See Keppel.) Alcock, Sir Rutherford, k.c.b., C. 1872 ; V.-P. 1873, 74, 75 ; P. 1876, 78 ; V.-P. 1878, 79, 80. Althorp, The Right Hon. Lord, C. 1830. * Arrowsmith, John, C. 1851, 52, 53, 54, 55, 56, 57, 58, 59, 60, 61, 62, 65, 66, 67, 68. Ashburton, Lord, P. 1860, 61 ; V.-P. 1862, 63. Ayrton, Frederick, C. 1849, 50. Bach, A., C. 1832. *Pack, Admiral Sir George, C. 1838, 39, 40 ; V.-P. 1844, 45 ; C. 1846, 47 ; V.-P. 1848 ; C. 1849 ; V.-P. 1850, 51, 52 ; C. 1853 ; V.-P. 1854-58 ; C. 1859-64 ; V.-P. 1865-69 ; 0. 1870, 72, 73 ; V.-P. 1874, 75 ; 0. 1876. Packhouse, John, C, 1836, 37, 38, 40, 41. Baily, P., C. 1830, 31 ; Trustee, 1836-44. *Paker, Sir Samuel, C. 1866, 67, 68, 74. Balfour, Lieut.-Gen. Sir George, k.c.b., 0. 1863, 64, 65, 66, 67, 68. Pall, John ; For. Sec. 1871-74 ; C. 1875, 76, 77, 79, 80. Pandinel, James, C. 1844, 45, 46. Parkly, Sir Henry, g.c.m.g., k.c.b., V.-P. 1879, 80. Baeeow, Sir Jobn, Part., V.-P. 1830, 31 ; P. 1835, 36 ; V.-P. 1837, 38, 39, 40 ; C. 1841, 42, 43, 44 ; V. P. 1845-47. Beaufort, Admiral Sir Francis, k.c.b., C. 1830, 31, 36, 37, 38, 39, 40, 41. 42, 43, 44, 45, 46, 47, 48, 49, 50, 51, 52, 53, 54, 55. Peckford, Francis, C. 1841, 47, 49. Beechey, Rear-Admiral, C. 1854 ; P. 1855. Perens, Joseph, 0. 1840. Biddulph, John, Treas. 1830-44 ; Trustee, 1839. Biddulph, Robert, Treas. 1845-64. Plaauw, W. H., C. 1847. Blackwood, Captain Francis P., e.n., C. 1841, 47 ; Sec. 185S Borradaile. Abraham. C. 1836 Poioles, Admiral, C. 1836, 37, 38, 42, 43, 45, 46, 53, 54. 134 Members of Council. Prandreth, Major, e.b., C. 1847. Britton, J., 0. 1830, 31. Brockedon, William, C. 1830, 31, 36, 37, 38, 42, 43, 44. Brodie, Sir Benjamin, Bart., C. 1859, 60. Brodrick, The Hon. George, C. 1869, 70, 71, 72, 73, 74, 76, 77, 79. Brooke, Sir Arthur de Capell, Part., C. 1830, 31. Prooking, Thomas, 0. 1855, 56, 57, 58, 59, 60, 61, 62, 64, 65, 66, 67, 68. Proughton, Tbe Right Hon. Lord, C. 1830, 31, 39, 57, 58. Prown, Robert, 0. 1830, 31, 38. Puller, Captain Wentwortb, e.n.., C. 1839. Punbury, Edward H., C. 1846, 47. Purlington, Earl of, C. 1841 (now Duke of Devonshire). Puxton, Sir T. Powell, Part., C. 1871, 72, 73, 74, 75, 76, 77, 80. Calthorpe, The Hon. P. H. W., C. 1859, 60. Campbell, Sir George, k.o.s.i., C. 1870, 74, 75, 76. Cardwell, The Right Hon. Edward, C. 1856, 57. Carnarvon, Tbe 3rd Earl of, C. 1842, 43 (d. 1849). Chapman, Captain, E.A., C. 1841. Charters, Major, e.a., C. 1840. GJiaUerton, Sir William, Part., C. 1843, 46, 47. *Chesney, General Francis Rawdon, 0. 1839, 40, 41, 42. Churchill, Lord Alfred, C. 1861, 62, 63, 64. Gierke, Major Shadwell, C. 1845, 46 ; Sec. 1847. Cockburn, Admiral Tbe Right Hon. Sir George, g.c.b., C. 1837. Cocks, Reginald, Treas. 1864-81. Colchestee, Admiral Tbe Right Hon. Lord, C. 1839, 40 ; V.-P. 1841, 42, 43; 0. 1844; P. 1845, 47; V.-P. 1847, 48, 49; C. 1850, 51, 52; V.-P. 1853, 54 ; C. 1855, 56, 61, 62, 63, 64, 65, 66. *Collinson, Admiral Sir Richard, k.c.b., C. 1857 ; V.-P. 1858, 69, 60, 61, 62, 63, 64; C. 1865, 66, 68, 69, 70, 71, 72, 73; V.-P. 1874, 75. Colquhoun, Lieut.-Colonel, E.A., C. 1844, 45, 46, 47. Cottesloe, The Right Hon. Lord, C. 1863, 64, 65, 66, 67, 68, 69, 72, 74 ; V.-P. 1875, 76, 77, 79. Craufurd, W. P., C. 1832, 43, 44. Crawford, R. W., C. 1865, 66. Crawfurd, Jobn, C. 1857, 58, 59, 60, 61, 62, 63 ; V.-P. 1864, 65, 66 ; C. 1867. Curzon, The Hon. Robert, C. 1866. Cust, Robert, C. 1877, 78, 79, 80. Darwin, Charles, C. 1840. Db Obey and Ripon, The Earl of, P. 1859 ; V.-P. 1860 ; C. 1861 (now Marquis of Bipon). De la Beche, Sir Henry, C. 1844, 45, 51. De Mauley, Lord, C. 1851. Denison, Sir William, k.c.b., C. 1866. Denman, Captain The Hon. J., e.n., C. 1859. Derby, The Earl of, C. 1871 ; V.-P. 1872, 73. (See Stanley, Lord.) Devonshire, Tbe Duke of. (See Burlington, Earl of.) Dickson, Colonel Sir A., k.c.b., C. 1836, 37, 38, 39. Dodd, George, C. 1843, 44, 45, 46, 47, 48, 49. Donoughmore, The Earl of, C. 1864, 65. Douglas, General Sir Howard, C. 1845. Ducie, The Earl of, C. 1862, 73. Duckett, Sir George, Bari., Trust. 1832 to 1836. Duffeein, The Earl of, i;.p., k.c.b., C. 1858, 67 ; P. 1878. Members of Council. 1S5 Dundas, The Right Hon. Sir David, 1853, 54, 64, 65. Eastnor, Viscount, 0. 1846 (now Earl Somers). Ellesmeee, The Earl of, k.g.. C. 1851, 52 ; P. 1853-55 ; V.-P. 1855, 56. Elliot, Rear-Admiral Tbe Hon. George, C. 1837. Ellis, Sir Barrow, k.c.s.i., C. 1876, 77, 78, 79 ; V.-P. 1880. Elphinstone, The Hon. Mountstuart, 0. 1830, 31, 36, 37; V.-P. 1838-9, 40; C. 1841. Enderby, Charles, C. 1836, 37, 38, 42, 43, 44, 45, 47. Enniskillen, The Earl of, C. 1840. EHcourt, Thomas Gorviston Bucknell, C. 1843. Evans, Captain, e.n., c.b., 1874, 75, 76, 77, 78; V.-P. 1879, 80. Everest, Colonel Sir George, C. 1853, 55, 56 ; V.-P. 1857, 58, 59, 60, 61, 62, 63. Fanshawe, Colonel, V.-P. 1836, 37 ; C. 1838. Fellowes, Sir Charles, C. 1841, 42, 43, 44, 45, 49, 50, 51, 52 ; V.-P. 1853, 54 ; C. 1855, 56. Fergusson, James, C. 1863, 64, 65, 66, 67, 68, 69, 70, 71, 73, 74, 75, 76, 77 78 79 80 Findlay, A. G., C. 1857, 58, 59, 60, 61, 62, 63, 64, 67, 68, 69, 70, 71, 73, 74. *FitzRoy, Captain, e.n., C. 1837, 51, 52, 53, 56. Forsyth, Sir Douglas, k.c.s.i., c.b., C. 1877, 78, 79, 80. Fox, Lieut.-General, C. 1838, 39, 40, 41, 42, 43, 45, 46, 49, 50, 56, 57, 58, 60, 61, 64. * Franklin, Captain Sir John, K.N., V.-P. 1830, 44, 45. Eraser, Colonel Sir Augustus, k.c.b., C. 1830, 31. Eraser, J. Baillie, C. 1838, 39. Fremantle. (See Cottesloe.') Frere, Bartie, C. 1836, 37, 38, 39, 40, 41, 42, 43, 44, 45, 46, 47, 48, 49. Peeeb, The Right Hon. Sir H. Bartie, Bart., g.c.b., g.c.s.i., C. 1868, 69 ; V.-P. 1870, 71, 72, 74 ; P. 1873 ; C. 1875 ; V.-P. 1871-!. Freshfield, Douglas, C. 1879, 80. Galton, Captain Douglas, c.b., C. 1876. * Galton, Francis, C. 1854, 55, 56 ; Sec. 1857-63 ;.C. 1863, 64 ; For. S(c. 1865, 66 ; V.-P. 1866, 67, 68, 69, 70, 71, 72 ; C. 1873, 75, 76, 77 ; V.-P. 1879, 80. Gibbs, H. H., C. 1872. Goderich, Viscount, P. 1830, 31, 32, 33. As Earl of Ripon, C. 1836, 37. Godwin-Austen, Colonel, C. 1879, 80. Goldsmid, Major-General Sir Frederic, k.c.s.i., cb,, C. 1873, 74, 75, 76. Goodenough, Dr. (See Wells, Dean of.) Graham, Cyril, c.m.g., C. 1862, 63, 64, 65 ; For. Sec. 1866-71. *Grant, Lieut.-Colonel, o.B., c.s.i., C. 1869, 70, 71, 73, 73, 74, 75, 76, 77, 78, 79. Grant Duff, Tbe Right Hon. Mountstuart Elphinstone, C. 1869, 70, 74, 75. Green, Major-General Sir Henry, k.c.s.i., c.b., C. 1876, 77, 78, 79. Gkbbnough, George Bellas, V.-P. 1830, 31; C. 1836; V.-P. 1837, 38; P. 1839-41 ; V.-P. 1841, 42, 43 ; 0. 1844, 45, 46, 47, 49 ; C. 1850, 51, 52, 53, 64. Grey, R. W., C. 1852. Grey, Sir George, k.c.b., C. 1869. Holford, Rev. Thomas, C. 1842. Hall, Captain Basil, e.n., C. 1830, 31. Hall, Admiral W. H., k.c.b., C. 1860, 61, 62, 63, 64, 70, 71, 72, 74, 75, 76. Hallam, Henry, 0. 1836. Hamilton, William R., C. 1830 ; V.-P. 1831 ; C. 1836 ; P. 1837-39 ; V.-P. 1S39, 40; P. 1841-43 ; V.-P. 1843, 44; Trust. 1846-57. 136 Members of Council. ?Hamilton, William J., C. 1838, 39, 40, 41, 42, 45 ; V.-P. 1846 ; P. 1847, 49 ; V.-P. 1849, 50 ; C. 1851, 52, 53, 54, 55, 56, 58, 59, 60, 61, 63, 64, 65, 66. Harrowby, The Earl of, C. 1847, 56. Hay, The Right Hon. Admiral Sir John D., Part, c.b., C. 1865, 66. Hay, R. W., C. 1830, 31 ; V.-P. 1832 ; 0. 1836. Hay, Lord William, C. 1865 (now Marquis of Tweeddale). Hobhouse, John Cam., C. 1830-31. (See Proughton.) Hodgkin, Dr. Thomas, C. 1850 ; Sec. 1851-62 ; For. Sec. 1862-64 ; C. 1865. Hogg, John, Sec. 1849, 50 ; C. 1851. Holland, Sir Henry, Part., 0. 1853, 54. Hope, A. J. Beresford, C. 1860. Horsburgh, Captain, C. 1830. Houghton, Lord, C. 1854, 55, 56, 57 ; Trust. 1857-81. Hume, Joseph, C. 1854. Huxley, Professor, C. 1870. *Inglefield, Vice-Admiral Sir E. A., c.b., 1868, 69, 70. Jackson, Colonel, C. 1838, 39, 40 ; Sec. 1841, 47. James, Colonel Sir Henry, C. 1858, 59. Jervis, Colonel, C. 1837, 38. Jones, Colonel Sir G. T., Part, C. 1830, 31, 32. Jones, Captain Felix, i.N., 1865, 66, 67, 68, 69. Jones-Lloyd, Samuel (Lord Overstone), C. 1845. , Kennaway, Sir Jobn, Part., 1877. Keppel, Major tbe Hon. George, C. 1831, 1847 (now Earl of Albemarle). Kirk, Dr. John, c.m.g., C. 1865. I Laughton, J. K., e.n., C. 1880. Layard, Sir Austen H., g.c.b., C. 1860, 61. Lee, John, C. 1850, 51. Lee, Thomas, 1847, 49, 50. Jjeake, Colonel, V.-P. 1830, 31 ; C. 1836, 37, 38, 39, 40, 41, 42. Lefroy, General Sir Henry, k.c.m.g., c.b., C. 1855, 56, 57, 58, 61, 62, 79, 80. Lemon, Sir Charles, Part., C. 1844. Lloyd, Lieut.-Colonel J. A., C. 1851. Londesborough, Lord, C. 1851. Long, George, C. 1831, 36, 37, 38, 39 ; V.-P. 1840, 41, 42 ; C. 1843, 44, 45, 46 ; Sec. 1847 ; C. 1849, 50, 51. Long, Henry, C. 1843. Lome, Tbe Marquis of, C. 1874. Lubbock, Sir John, Part., Trust. 1878-81. * M'Clintock, Vioe-Admiral Sir F. Leopold, C. 1869, 70, 71, 77. Mackinnon, William, C. 1877. McNeill, The Right Hon. Sir John, g.c.b., C. 1840. Major, li. H., Sec. 1866-81. Malcolm, Admiral Sir Charles, C. 1840 ; V.-P. 1841, 42 ; C. 1843, 44, 45, 46, 47, 49 ; V.-P. 1850, 51. Manchester, Tbe Bishop cf, C. 1850. Manchester, The Duke of, C. 1875. Mangles, Captain, e.n., C. 1830. Markham, Clements Robert, c.b., C. 1862 ; Sec. 1863-81. Maxwell, Sir W. Stirling, Part, C. 1867. Meek, Sir James, C. 1839-40, 41, 42, 43, 44, 45, 46, 47, 49. Members of Council. 137 Merewether, Colonel Sir William L., k.c.s.i., c.b., C. 1879, 80. Merivale, Herman, C. 1850, 66, 67, 68. Milne, Admiral Sir Alexander, Part, g.c.b. ; V.-P. 1876, 77, 78, 79, 80. Milnes, R. Monckton. (See Houghton.) Monteith, General, C. 1831, 46. Morier, James, C. 1836, 37, 38, 39. *MuECHisoN, Sir Roderick Impey, Part., k.c.b., C. 1833 ; V.-P. 1836 ; C. 1837, 38, 39, 40, 41 ; V.-P. 1842 ; P. 1843, 45 ; V.-P. 1845, 46 ; C. 1847; V.-P. 1849, 50; P. 1851, 52 ; V.-P. 1853,54,55; P. 1856, 57, 58; V.-P. 1859, 60, 61; P. 1862-70; V.-P. 1871. Murchison, Kenneth, C. 1871, 72. Murdoch, Thomas, C. 1830, 31 ; V.-P. 1836 ; C. 1837. Mureay, General, The Right Hon. Sir George, g.c.b., C. 1830, 31 ; P. 1833, 35. Murray, James, C. 1849, 50, 51, 52. Murray, John, C. 1850, 72, 73, 74, 75, 77. Murray, Rear-Admiral The Hon. H. A., e.n., C. 1858, 59, 60, 61, 62, 63. *Nares, Captain Sir George, e.n., k.c.b., C. 1880. Nicholson, Sir Charles, Part, C. 1863, 64, 65, 66, 67, 68, 70, 71, 72, 73, 74, 75. Northbrook, The Earl of, g.c.s.i., P. 1879-80. Northumberland, The Duke of. (See Prudhoe.) Norwich, The Bishop of (Dr. Stanley), C. 1845. a Gorman, George, C. 1846, 47, 49, 50, 51, 52. Oliphant, Laurence, C. 1859, 60 ; Sec. 1864, 65 ; C. 1866, 67. Ommanney, Admiral Sir Erasmus, c.b., C. 1872, 73, 74, 75, 79, 80. Osborn, Rear-Admiral Sherard, c.b., C. 1867, 68, 69, 70, 71, 72, 73, 74, 75. Oswell, William Cotton, C. 1855. Overstone, Lord, 1855. (See Jones-Lloyd.) Owen, Captain W. F. W., b.n., C. 1832. Oxford, Bisbop of (Dr. Wilberforce), C. 1857, 58. Parish, Sir Woodbine, V.-P. 1836, 37; 0. 1839, 40, 42, 43, 49, 50; V.-P. 1851, 62 ; C. 1853. Parkyns, Mansfield, C. 1854. Pelly, J. H., C. 1847. Pelly, Colonel Sir Lewis, k.c.b., k.c.s.i., C. 1879, 80. Phayre, Lieut.-Gen. Sir Arthur, o.B., k.c.s.i., C. 1879. Pollington, Viscount, C. 1842 (now Earl of Mexborough). Pollock, General Sir George, g.c.b., C. 1854—56, 57. Portlock, Colonel, C. 1849, 53, 54, 55, 56, 59, 60 ; V.-P. 1861, 62. Prince Lee, Dr. (See Manchester, Bishop of.) Prudhoe, Captain Lord, e.n., C. 1830, 31, 36, 37, 39, 44, 46, 46, 60, 51, 52. (Afterwards Duke of Northumberland.) *Rae, John, C. 1862, 70, 71, 72. * Paper, Lieut. Henry, e.n., C. 1846, 49, 50, 51, 52, 53, 57. *Rawlinson, Major-General Sir Henry C. k.c.b., C. 1850, 51, 57, 58, 61, 62, 63 ; V.-P. 1864, 65, 66, 67 ; C. 1868 ; V.-P. 1869, 70 ; P. 1871, 72, 73 ; P. 74, 76 ; V.-P. 76, 77, 78, 79, 80. .Ttawson, Sir W. Rawson, k.c.m.g., c.b., C. 1841, 42, 76, 77, 78, 79. Reay, Lord, C. 1880. Rennie, George, C. 1836. Rennie, Sir John, C. 1840, 41, 42 ; V.-P. 1843, 44 ; C. 1847. Renouard, Rev. George Cecil, For. Sec. 1830-46; C. 1847, 49, 50, 51, 52. 138 Members of Council. Richards, Vioe-Admiral Sir George, c.b., C. 1867, 68, 69, 70 ; V.-P. 71, 72, 73 ; C. 1875, 76, 77. Richardson, Dr. Sir Jobn, E.N., C.B., C. 1832. Rigby, General, C. 1868, 69, 70, 71, 73, 74, 75, 76, 78, 79, 80. RiFON, The Earl of. (See Goderich.) EiPON, Tbe Marquis of. (See De Grey.) Rodd, Rear-Admiral Sir John Tremaine, c.b., C. 1837. Posse, Tbe Earl of, C. 1845. Russell, Lord Arthur, C. 1869, 70, 71, 72 ; For. Sec. 1876-81. Ryder, Admiral Alfred Phillipps, C. 1863, Sabine, General Sir Edward, k.c.b., C. 1852, 53, 57, 58, 59. St. Asaph, Bisbop of (Dr. Vowler Short), C. 1S51, fi2, 53. Seymour, Henry Danby, C. 1856, 57, 58, 59, 60, 64, 65, li, 75, 76, 77. She-field, Tbe Earl of, C. 1852, 53, 64, 55, 56, 57, 68, 59, 63, 64. Sheil, Sir Justin, k.cb., C. 1861. Short, Dr. Vowler. (See St. Asaph, Bishop of.) Silver, S. W., C. 1870-81. Smith, E. Osborne, C. 1846-63. *Smyth, Admiral W. H., c.b., C. 1830, 31, 44 ; V.-P. 1845, 46, 47 ; P. 1849, 51 ; V.-P. 1851, 52 ; C. 1853 ; V.-P. 1855. Smyth, Warington, C. 1871, 72, 73, 74. Somers, Earl, 0. 1865. (See Eastnor.) Spottiswoode, William, C. 1860, 61 ; -Sec. 1862, 63 ; C. 1864, 66, 66. Stanley, 0. 1864, 65. (See Derby, Earl of.) Stanley, Dr. (See Norwich, Bishop of.) Staunton, Sir George, Part., Trust. 1832-60. Staveley, Thomas, C. 1853, 54, 55, 56, 67, 58, 69. Steele, Colonel Thomas, c.b., C. 1868. Stephenson, B. C, C. 1871, 72. Stephenson, Robert, 0. 1868. Stokes, Admiral J. L., C. 1856, 67. Strachey, Lieut.-Gen. Richard, c.s.i., C. 1872, 73, 75, 76, 77, 78, 79, 80. Strangford, Viscount, C. 1860, 61, 62 ; V.-P. 1863, 64, 66 ; C. 1866, 67. Stratford de Pedeliffe, Viscount, k.g., C. 1870. Strzelecki, Count Sir Paul, k.c.m.g., cb., C. 1855, 56, 57, 58, 69, 61, 62. Sykes, Colonel, C. 1862, 55 ; V.-P. 1856, 57, 68, 59 ; C. 1860, 61. Temple, Sir Richard, Part., g.c.s.l, C. 1880. * Thomson, Dr. Tbomas, C. 1866, 67, 68, 69. Thuillier, Lieut.-Gen. Sir Henry, c.s.i., C. 1879, 80. Trevelyan, Sir Walter, Part, C. 1843, 52, 53 ; Sec. 1864, 55, 56 ; V.-P. 1857 ; Trust 1860-78. Trithen, Francis H., Sec. 1849, 50. Vaughan, Tbe Right Hon. Sir Charles, C. 1839. Verney, Sir Harry, Part., C. 1842, 57, 68, 69, 73, 74, 75, 76 ; V.-P. 1877, 78 ; 0. 1879, 80. Vetch, Captain, e.b., C. 1836. Walker, John, C. 1862, 63, 64. Ward, H. G., C. 1830. Ward, Jobn, C. 1832. Warre, J. A., C. 1859, 60. Washington, Rear-Admiral, Sec. 1836-41 ; C. 1841, 42, 43, 44, 47, 49. * Waugh, Lieut.-Gen. Sir Andrew Scott, C. 1861, 62, 63, 64, 65, 66 ¦ V.-P. 1867 08. 69. 70 ; C. 1871. Members of Council. 139 Wellington, The Duke of, k.g., C. 1869, 70. Wells, The Dean of (Dr. Goodenough), C. 1831. Wharncliffe, 3rd Lord, C. 1868. (See Wortley.) Wliewell, Dr.; C. 1853, 54. White, Charles, 1869, 70, 71. Wilberforce, Dr. (See Oxford, Bishop of.) WUkinson, Sir Gardner, C. 1841, 52, 63, 54, 56. Wilmot, Captain A. P. Eadley, e.n., C. 1867. Wilson, Lieut.-Colonel, o.B., C. 1872, 73, 74, 75. Wortley, Tbe Hon. J. Stuart (afterwards 2nd Lord Wbarncliffe), C. 1836, 37. Torke, Colonel Philip, C. 1847-49 ; Sec. 1861, 52 ; V.-P. 1853. * Yule, Colonel Henry, o.B., C. 1863, 76, 77. 140 Obituary Notices. OBITUAEY NOTICES OF DISTINGUISHED FELLOWS OF THE EOYAL GEOGEAPHICAL SOCIETY IN THE PEESIDENTIAL ADDRESSES AND PROCEEDINGS (New Series). *,* The first number refers to the Volume of tbe ' Journal,' tbe second number to the page. Abbott, K. B. xliv.-cxlvi. Aberdeen, Earl of. xxi.-cxii. AcosTA, Gen. Joaquim. xxiii.-lxvi. Adam, Sir Charles. ) ^.^ _j^^j^ Adam, Sir Frederick.) Adamson, J. xxvi.-clxxii. Addixgton, Right Hon. H. U. xL- cxxxvii. Albxandee, j. xix.-xli. Allbn, Capt. David, e.n. xii.- xxxvii. Allen, Capt. W., e.n. xxxiv.-cxxii. Anderson, R. xxvii.-cxiii. Anstbd, Professor. Proceed. (N.S.) ii. 382. Anstey, Chisbolm. xliv.-cl. Arrow, Sir Frederick, xlvi.-clii. Ashburton, Lord, xxxiv. -ox. Aeeowsmith, John, xliii.-olxi. Atkinson, T. W. xxxii.-cv. Ayrton, Fred, xliv.-cl. Back, Admiral Sir George. Proceed ings (N.S.) i. 70. Baikib, Dr. xxxv.-cxxiii. Baily, F. xv.-xlii. Baines, Thomas, xlvi.-cxli. Bakeb, Col. G. xxx.-c. Barclay, A. K. xl.-cxlv. Barclay, Charles, xxvi.-clxxiii. Barnard, Sir Andrew, xxv.-lxxx. Baeeett, Lucas, xxxiii.-cxxiii. Bareow, Sir John, Bart, xix.-xxxiv. Baeth, Dr. Henry, c.b. xxxvi.- cxxxiv. Basbvi, Captain, xlii.-clxiii. Bates, Joshua, xxxv.-cxxv. Beaedmoee, N. xliii.-clxix. Beaufort, Admiral Sir Francis, k.c.b. xxviii.-cxxiii. Bbautbmps-Bbaupeb. xxv.-xciii. Bbeoboft, Captain John, xxv.- Ixxxiv. Bbkb, Dr. xlv.-cxlvii. Belchbe, Admiral Sir E. xlvii.- cxxxvi. Bellot, Lieut. J. R. xxiv.-lxxxvi. Beebeuggbt, Adrien. xl.-cxlii. Bexley, Lord, xxi.-lvii. BiECH, J. W. W. xlvi.-cliii. Bird, W. Wilberforce. xxviii.- cxxxvi. Beiscoe, j., b.n. xix.-xl. Blackwood, Capt. Price. xxiv.- Ixxx. Blumenbach, Professor J. F. xl.- xlv. BoiLBAU, Sir John D., Part, xxxix.- cxlvi. BoLLABET, William, xlvii.-cxlviii. BoTFiELD, Beriah, m.p. xxxiv.- cxxvi. Bowles, Admiral Sir Wm., k.cb. xl.-oxl. Brand, George, xxxi.-cxy. Beandebth, Col. xviii.-xxxiii. Bbant, James, c.b. xxxii.-cvi. Beassey, Thomas, xli.-cliv. Bebadalbane, Marquis of. xxxiii.- cxxi. Obituary Notices. 141 Brett, J. W. xxxiv.-cxxvii. Brisbane, Sir J. Makdougall. xxx.- cii. Brockedon, W. xxxv.-lxxxiv. Brodie, Sir Benjamin, Bart, xxxiii.- cxx. Broke, Sir Arthur de Capell. xxix.- cxxviii. Beoke, Sir Philip, xxv.-lxxxv. Bkondstbd, Chevalier, xiii.-xliv. Brooke, Sir James, Bart., k.c.b. xxxix.-cxlii. Beooking, T. H. xxxix.-cxlvi. Beoughton, Lord, g.o.b. xL- cxxxix. Brown, John, xxxi.-cxvi. Beown, Robert, xxix.-cxv. Beunbl, Isambard K. xxx.-cvi. Buckingham, James Silk, xxvi.- clxxiii. Buckland, De.W., d.d. xxvii.-ciii. Buist, Dr. xxxi.-cxvii. Bullock, Admiral, xliv.-cl. BuEOHBLL, Wm. Jobn. xxxiii.- cxxiv. BuRGOYNE, Captain, r.n. xli.-cli. Burnes, Sir Alexander, xii.-xxxvi. Burnett, J. C. xxv.-lxxxv. BuENBY, Archdeacon, xxxv.-cxxvi. Butler, Rev. Pierce. xxxviii.- cxliv. Byeon, Hon. Frederick, xxxi.-cxviii. Cameron, Capt. Duncan, xli.-cliii. Campbell, Lieut.-Col. Neil, xxvii.- cviii. Carbuccia, General, xxv.-xciii. Carnaevon, Earl of. xx.-xxxvi. Care, Commander Washington. xxvi.-clxxiv. Caeeasco, Admiral Don Edouardo. xxxvi.-cxliii. Caetweight, Samuel, xxxv.-cxxvi. Chambers, Mr., of Adelaide, xxxiii.- cxxiv. Chapman, James, xlii.-clxxi. Chattbeton, Sir W. xxvi.-clxxiv. Chesney, Colonel, xlii.-clix. Christie, Henry, xxxv.-cxxviii. Cheistophee, Lieut., i.n. xix.-xli. Claeendon, Earl of. xli.-cxlvii. Claek, Sir James, xli.-cl. Claekb, Gen., of Missouri, xxii.- cviii. Clbek, Right Hon. Sir George. ixxviii.-cxlii. Clbekb, Major Shadwell. xix.- XXX vi. Clive, Hon. R. xxiv.-lxxxii. Colby, Major-General. xxiii.-lxviii. Colchestee, Admiral Lord, xxxviii.- cxlviii. Colquhoun, Col. J. Nisbet, xxiv.- lxxxii. Colquhoun, Chevalier James de. xxvi.-clxxiv. Colquhoun, Sir Robert, k.cb. xli.- cxlix. Constable, Captain (i.n.). Pro ceedings (N.S.) i. 457. CoNYBBAEB, Dean, xxviii.-cxlvii. Cope, Walter, xlii.-clxxi. Ceaoroft, Commodore. xxxvi.- cxlviii. Crawfurd, Jobn, f.r.s. xxxviii.- oxlviii. CuBiTT, Sir William, cb. xxxii.-cvi. CuBiTT, William, m.p. xxxiv.- cxxvi. CuNARD, Sir Edward, Bart, xxxix.- cxlvii. Cunningham, Allan, xl.-xliv. Cunningham, G. G. xxxi.-cxviii. Dalton, General. Proceedings (N.S.) iii. 109. Danibll, Rev. E. T. xiii.-xlii. Daniell, Dr. W. P. xxxvi.-cxlvii. Dartmouth, Earl of. xxv.-lxxxvi. Daussy, Pierre, xxxi.-cxix. D'Avezac, M. xlv.-cxxxiv. Davis, Capt. J. E., r.n. xlvii.-cxlvii. Db Angblis, Don Pedro, xxxi.-oxx. Db Blaquiere, Lord, xli.-cxlix. Db Compeignb, Marquis, xlvii.-cli. Db LA Beche, Sir Henry, xxv.-lxxxi. De La Maemoea, General, xxxiv.- cxviii. De la Roquette, M. xxxix.-cxU. Db Mauley, Lord, xxv.-xoii. Db Meyendorf, Baron G. xxxv.- cxx. Denison, Sir William, k.c.b. xli.-cl. De Ros, Rear-Admiral the Hon. xxxii.-cvii. Derby, Earl of. xxii.-lxvi. Dbeby, Earl of, k.g. xl.-cxliii. De Uecullu, Don Jose, xxvi.- clxxxvi. Dickinson, John, xxxix.-cxlvi. Dickson, Lieut.-General Sir Alex ander, xl.-xliv. 142 References to DiLKE, Sir C. Wentworth, Bart. xxxix.-oxlv. Dixon, Hepwortb. Proceed. (N.S.) ii. 1,3-'. Dodd, George, xxxv.-cxxviii. Dollond, George, xxiii.-lxxiii. Donaldson, Rev. J. W., D.D. xxxi.- cxx. Donaldson, Sir Stuart, xxxvii.- cxix. DONOUGHMOEE, Earl of. xxxvi.- cxlv. Drake, C. F. Tyrwhitt. xlv.-cxlvi. Deummond, Capt. Thomas, e.e. xl.-xliv. Dubois de Montpbeeux. xxi.-lxi. DucHETT, Sir George. xxviii.- cxxxiii. DuFOUR, Generab xlvi.-cxxxvii. Dukinfield, Rev. Sir Henry, Part. xxviii.-cxxxii. Dundas, The Rigbt Hon. Sir David. xlvii.-cliii. Dundas, Admiral tbe Hon. Sir R. S., K.CB. xxxii.-cvii. Dupbeey, Capt. Louis Isidore. xxxvi.-cxliii. Elgin and Kinoaedinb, Earl of. xxxiv.-cxx. Ellenborough, Earl of. xlii.-olxx. Ellesmeee, Earl of. xxvii.-xcvii. Ellesmere, Earl of. xxxiii.-cxxiii. Elliott, Charles, xxvii.-cxiv. Elphinstone, Hon. Mountstuart. xxx.-cvii. Blsey, j. R. xxviii.-cxxxvi. Elton, Captain J. E. xlviii.- cxxxiv. Endeeby, Charle.s. xlvii.-cliii. EsTcouET, T. Bucknall. xxiv.- l.xxxiii. EsToouET, Major-General J. B. xxvi.-clxxv. Everest, Sir George, xxxvii.-cxvi. Everett, Edward, xxxv.-oxx. Ewee, Walter, xxxiii.-cxxvi. Fairbaien, Sir Wm. xlv.-cliii. Paloonbh, Dr. Hugh, xxxv.-cxv. Fellows, Sir Charles, xxxi.-cxxii. Findlay, A. G. xlv.-cxxxii. Fitzjames, Captain, e.n. xxv.- lxxxvi. FitzRoy, Captain Robt., e.n., c.b. xxxv.-cxxviii. Fitzwilliam, Earl, xxviii.-oxxxiii. Forchhammer, John G. xxxvi.- cxxxvi. Forbes, Commander C. S., r.n. xlvii.-cliv. FoEBBS, Commander P. E., e. n. xxii.-lxvii. FoREBSTEE, Barou de. xxxi.-cxxiii. FoETEScuE, Earl, k.g. xxxii.-cviii. FowLBE, Rear - Admiral. xxxiv.- cxxii. Fox, General C. xliii.-clxlv. Feanklin, Admiral Sir Jobn. xxv.- lxxxvi. Feasee, James Baillie. xxvi.-clxxv. Pebrb, Bartbolomew. xxii.-lxv. Fbiedeeiohstal, E. R. xiii.-xliv. Febyoinbt, M. xiii.-xliv. Gabeibl, Edmund, xxxiii.-cxxxv. Gage, Admiral Sir W. Hall., g.o.b. xxxiv.-cxxi. Galitzin, Prince Emanuel, xxiv.- Ixxxiii. Gaenibe, Lieut. F. xliv.-cxxx. Gawlbe, Colonel George, k.h. xl.- cxlvii. GiFFOED, Earl of. xxxiii.-cxxii. GiSBOENE, Lionel, xxxi.-oxxiv. Goodenough, Dr. E. (Dean of Wells). xv.-xliii. Goodenough, Commodore, c.b., c.m.g. xlvi.-oxlv. Gordon, Rev. G. M. Proceedings (N.S.) ii. 706. Gould, Jobn. Proceedings (N.S.) iii. 181. GowEN, James Robert. xxxiii.- cxxiv. Grant, Captain Walter Colquhoun. xxxii.-cviii. Graves, Captain, e.n. xxvii.-cviii. Geay, Dr. xlv.-cli. Greenough, George Bellas, xxv.- Ixxxviii. Grey, Ralph William, xl.-cxliv. Grinnell, Cornelius, xl.-cxlvi. Geinnell, Henry, xlv.-oxxxvi. Geote, George, xlii.-olxix. Gueney, Hudson, xxxv.-cxxiv. Haddington, Earl of. xxix.-cxxix. Halfoed, Rev. T. xxvii.-cxi. Hall, Captain Basil, e.n. xv.-xlii. Hall, Admiral Sir W. H. Pro ceedings (N.S.) i. 214. Obituary Notices. 143 Hall, Dr. G. xxvi.-clxxvi. Hallam, Henry, xxix.-cxx. Hamel, Dr. xxxiii.-cxvi. Hamilton, William R. xxx.-cix. Hamilton, William J. xxxviii.- cxxxiv. Hammee-Puegstall, Baron, xxvii.- cxv. Hammond, W. xxvi.-olxxvii. Hanstebn, Professor, xliv.-cxxxiii. Haecouht, Rear Adml. Octavius Vernon, x.xxiv.-cxxii. Harris, Capt. Fortescue W. xxvi.- clxxvii. Havildar, tbe. Proceedings (N.S.) i. 600. Hawtrey, Rev. Dr. xxxii.-cviii. Hay, Robert Wm. xxxii.-cix. Hazelius, J. A. xlii.-clvi. Heddle, Dr. (Bombay G. S.) xii.- xxxix. Hbebbet, Admiral Sir Thomas, K.CB. xxxii.-cix. Hill, Samuel S. xl.-cxlv. Hodgkin, Dr. Thomas, xxxvi.-cxlvi. Hogg, John, xl.-cxliv. Holland, Sir Henry, xliv.-cxli. Holman, Lieut. J. Baptiste. xxviii.- cxxxiv. Holmes, Jobn. xxiv.-lxxxiii. Home, Capt. Sir J. Everard. xxiv.- Ixxxiv. Hookbe, Sir William J. xxxvi.- cxxviii. Hooper, Lieut. W. H. xxiv.-lxxxiv. Hopkins, D. Proceedings (N.S.) i. 726. HoENEE, P^re. Proceedings (N.S.) ii. 514. HoRSBUEGH, Captain, vii.-vi. Hotham, Admiral Sir W. xx.- xxxiv. Hume, Josepb, m.p. xxv.-xc. Hume, Hamilton, xliv.-cxlviii. Humboldt, Alexander von. xxix.-cii. Inghieami, Padre, xxii.-lxx. Inglis, Sir Robert H. xxv.-xoi. Ingeam, Herbert, m.p. xxxi.-cxxvi. Ieving, Dr. E. G. xxvi.-clxxvii. Jackson, Colonel, xxiii.-lxxi. Jameson, Professor, xxiv.-lxxxiv. Jamibson, Robert, xxxi.-cxxvi. Jbjebbhoy, Sir Jamsetjee. xlviii.- clvii. Jbnkyn, Rev. Dr. xxix.-cxxxiv. Jervis, Lieut. Col. T. B. xxvii.-cx. John of Austria, Arcbduke. xxix.- cxii. Johnston, Keith, xlii.-clxi. Johnston, A. Keith (Jun.). Pro ceedings (N.S.) i. 598. Johnston, Sir John, Part, xxxix.- cxlviii. Jomaed, M. xxxiii.-cxiv. Kane, Dr. Elisba Kent. xxvii.- cxvii. Kaye, Sir John, k.c.s.i. xlvii.- clv. Keatb, R. W. xliii.-clxix. Kellett, Admiral Sir Henry, k.c.b. xlv.-cxliv. Kenyon, Dr. xxvii.-oxvii. King, Rear-Admiral P. P. xxvi.- clxxviii. King, Rev. S. W. xxxix.-cxlvii. Klint, Swedish Admiral, xl.-xliv. Knight, H. Gaily, xvi.-xl. Kupffer, Professor, xxxvi.-cxliv. Laird, Macgregor. xxxi.-cxxvi. Lansdowne, Marquis cf. xxxiii.- cxvi. Laurence, Abbot, xxvi.-olxxx. Laurie, Jobn Mivfet. xxxviii.-cxliii. Laueib, Richard Holmes. xxix.- cxxxvi. Leake, Colonel W. Martin, xxx.- cxiii. Leaked, 'Dr. Proceedings (N.S.) i. 802. Lee, Dr. Jobn. xxxvi.-cxlv. Lbfeoy, Charles Edward, xxxii.- cxix. Lemon, Sir Charles, Part, xxxviii.- cxlvi. Lewis, Rigbt Hon. Sir George Corne- wall. xxxiii.-cxviii. Livingstone, Dr. xliv.-cxiii. Livingstone, Charles, xliv.-cxxviii. Lloyd, Lieut.-Col. J. A. xxv.-xci. Loch, Capt. Granville, e.n. xxiii.- Ixxiv. Loch, James, xxvi.-clxxx. Locke, Joseph, xxxi.-cxxviii. LoFTUs, W. Kennett. xxix.-oxxxvii. Logan, -Sir W. xlvi.-cli. Long, George. Proceedings (N.S.) i. 674. Longman, W. xlviii.-clvi. 144 References to LoED, Dr. xii.-xxxviii. Lucas, L. A. xlvii.-oxliv. Lyell, Sir Charles, Part, xlv.- cxxxvi. Lynch, Capt. H. B., e.n. xliii.- clxvii. McLbod, Sir Donald, xliii.-clxvi. Maclbod, General. Proceedings (N.S.) ii. 379. McClueb, Sir Robert, c.b. xliv.- cxxxix. Mackenzie, Right Hon. Holt, xlvi.- cliv. Maconochie, Capt., e.n. xxxi.- oxxix. Maoqueen, James, xl.-cxlvii. MaoWilliam, James Ormiston. xxxii.-cix. Maguieb, Corporal, xxviii.-cxlii. Majbndib, Asburst. xxxviii.-cxliii. Malcolm, Adm. Sir Charles, xxii.- Ixiv. Mandbville, John Henry, xxxi.- cxxx. Mangles, Capt., e.n. xxxviii.-cxliii. Maegaey, a. R. xlv.-cxl. Markham, John, xlii.-clxviii. Maesden, William, vii.-v. Maeshman, Mr. xlviii.-clx. Mauey, Capt. xliii.-clvii. Mawbey, General, xxi.-lviii. Maxwell, Sir W. Stirling, Part. xlviii.-olv. Mayers, W. S. F. xlviii.-oliv. Mecham, Commander, e.n. xxix.- cxxxiii. Meek, Sir James, xxvii.-cxi. Melville, Van Carnbee, Baron. xxx.-cxviii. Melville, Viscount, xxii.-lxvi. Meeewethee, Col. Sir William, K.C.S.I., cb. Proceedings (N.S.) ii. 704. Mbeivalb, Herman, xliv.-cxlix. Mbybe, Ceroid, xxix.-cxiv. Michelot, a. xxv.-xci v. Milton, Viscount, xlvii.-oxlii. Mitchell, Sir J. xxvi.-clxxx. Molesworth, Sir W. xxvi.-clxxxi. Montagu, Major H. Seymour, xxix.- cxxx. MONTEAGLE, Loi'd. XXXvi.-Cxlv. Montgomebie, Lieut.-Col. T. G. xlviii.-cxlv. MooESOM, Capt. W. xxx.-cxix. Moeibe, James, xix.-xxxviii. MoERisoN, M. C. xli.-clii. MoERiTT, Mr. xiv.-xlvii. Mullens, Rev. J. Proceedings (N.S.) i. 673. MuNziNGBE, Werner, xlvi.-oxxxi. MuEOHisoN, Sir Roderick, Part. K.CB. xlii.-cl. Murray, Rear- Adml. tbe Hon. H. A. xxxv.-cxxiv. MuEEAY, Hugb. xvi.-xl. MuEEAY, James, xlviii.-clix. MusTBES, Comm., e.n. Proceedings (N.S.) i. 397. Naedi, Monsignor. xlvii.-clii. Nbbld, Josepb. xxvi.-clxxxi. New, Rev. C. xlv.-cxxxvii. Newcastle, Duke of. xxxv.-oxviii. NOEDENSKIOLD, Nils. xxxvi.- cxxxviii. Noethampton, Marquis of. xxi.- lviii. NOETHUMBEDLAND, Duke of. XXXV.- cxii. Norwich, Bishop of. (See Stanley.) Nugent, Lord, xxi.-lviii. Oatbs, p. xlv.-clii. Obested. xxii.-lxix. Ogle, Sir Charles, -xxix.-oxxxii. O'GoEMAN. xxiv.-lxxxiv. OsBOEN, Admiral Sherard, c.b. xlv.- cxxi. Ouseley, Sir Gore, xv.-xliii. Ouselby, Sir William, xii.-xliv. OuTEAM, Sir Benj. xxvi.-clxxxi. Owen, Adml. Sir E. xx.-xxxiv. Paget, Arthur, xxxiv.-cxxvii. Palmbrston, Viscount, xxxvi.-cxix. Paekee, j. W. xxxi.-cxxx. Parry, Adm. Sir W. Edwd. xxvi.- clxxxii. Pasley, Gen. Sir Charles W., k.c.b. xxxi.-cxxx. Paulson, Oommr. xxix.-cxxxiv. Pbabody, George. xL-cxlix. Pechbll, Admiral, xx.-xxxv. Peel, Sir Robert, Part, xxi.-lvii. Peel, Capt. Sir William e.n., k.cb. xxix.-oxxxii. Pepys, W. H. xxvii.-cxiv. Pbery, Sir William, xlv.-oliv. Peteemann, Dr. Augustus. Pro ceedings (N.S.) i. 133. Obituary Notices. 145 Petbesen, Carl. Proceedings (N.S.) ii. 514. Phillimoee, Dr. J. xxvi.-clxxxv. Phillimoeb, Jobn George, xxxv.- cxxvi i. Phipson-Wybeants, Capt. Proceed ings (N.S.) iii. 238. Pollock, Sir George, g.c.b. xliii.- clxiii. Portlock, Major-Gen. J. E. xxxiv.- cxv. Power, Jobn. xlii.-clxxi. Peice, Rear-Admiral D. xxv.-xcii. Peichaed, Dr. xix.-xxxvi. Peinsep, James, xl.-xliv. Puller, C. G. xxxiv.-cxxvii. PusEY, Philip, xxvi.-clxxxv. Radstock, Admiral Lord, xxvii.- cxiii. ]!amsay. Sir James, xxix.-cxxxiv. Ranuzzi, Count, xlvi.-cxxxvi. Rapee, Lieut. Henry, xxix.-cxxvi. Raymond, Archdeacon, xxx.-cxix. Reid, Sir William, xxix.-cxxxi. Rendel, j. M. xxvii.-cxi. Rennie, George, xxvi.-cxlvi. Rennie, Sir John, xlv.-clii. Rbnouaed, Rev. G. C. xxxvii.- cxviii. Richardson, Sir Jobn, c.b. xxxvi.- c.xxxii. Eipon, Earl of. xxix.-oxxi. RiTTEE, Karl, xxx.-oxx. Robe, Lieut.-Colonel. xix.-xxxix. Rochet D'Heeicouet. xxv.-xciii. Roe, Captain, J. S., e.n. Proceed ings (N.S.) i. 277. Rogers, Professor Henry, xxxvii.- cxviii. Eoget, Peter Mark, f.e.s. xl.- cxlv. Ross, Admiral Sir Jobn, c.b. xxviii.- cxxx. Ross, Sir Patrick, xxi.-lviii. EosSE, Earl of. xxxviii.-oxxxvii. Rous, Admiral, xlviii.-clix. EoussiN, Admiral, xxv.-xciii. EuxTON, Lieut, xix.-xl. Sa DE Bandbiea, Marquis, xlvi.- cxxxiv. St. David's, Bisbop of. (See Teirl- WALL.) St. Leger, Anthony, xxxiii.-cxxvi. Santarem, Viscount, xxvi.-clxxxv. Schlagintweit, Adolf. xxix.- cxxxvii. Schomburgk, Sir Eobert. xxxv.- cxxi. ScHouw, Professor, xxii.-lxviii. ScoRESBY, Eev. Dr. xxviii.-cxxxviii. Sedgwick, Rev. A. xliii.-clx. Sbbmann, Berthold. xlii.-clxvii. Seymour, Henry Danby. xlviii.-ol. Shadwell, Sir Lancelot, xxi.-lix. Shaw, Robert B. Proceedings (N.S.) i. 523. Shaw, Dr. Norton, xxxix.-cxlvii. Shedden, R. xx.-xxxiv. Sheffield, The Earl of. xlvi.-cxlvi. > Sheil, Sir Justin, xli.-cli. Shuttleworth, Sir J. Kay. xlviii.- clviii. SiLLiMAN, Benjamin, xxxv.-cxxvi. Simpson, Sir George, xxxi.-cxxxi. Simpson, Dr. John, xxx.-oxxi. Slatbe, Commander, r.n. xii.- xxxviii. Smith, Sir Charles Felix, xxix.- cxxix. Smith, Abel.'^l :xxix.-cxxxv. Smith, E. Osborne. xxxiv.-cxxvL Smyth, Admiral, W.H., c.b. xxxvi.- cxxvi. Sm'STH, Admiral, W. xlviii.-cxlix. Sotheby, Samuel Leigh, xxxii.-cv. Speke, Captain Jobn Hanning. xxxv.-cix. Spencer, Earl, xxviii.-cxxxvi. Stanhope, Earl, xlvi.-oxlviii. Stanley, Lord, of Alderley. xxi.- lix. Stanley, Dr. (Bishop of Norwich). xx.-xxxv. Stanley, Captain Owen, e.n. xxi.- lix. Stirling, Admiral Sir James. xxxv.-cix. Stannus, Sir E. G. xxi.-lix. Staunton, Sir George, xxx.-cxxiv. Stephenson, Robert, xxx.-cxxi. Stokes, Cbarles. xxix.-lxxxiv. Strange, Colonel, xlvi.-cxlvi. Strangford, Viscount xxxix.- oxxxvi. Strickland, Hugb E. xxiv.-lxxxv. Strong, F. K. xlv.-cliv. Steuve, Professor, xxxv.-cxix. Stezblecki, Sir Paul, k.c.m.g., c.b. xliv.-oxxxiv. Stuet, Captam Charles, xl.-cxxxiii. 146 Obituary Notices. Sussex, H. E. H. tbe Duke of. xiii.- xlii. Swaet, Jacob, xxxvi.-cxlii. SwiNHOB, Robert, xlviii.-cliii. Sykes, Colonel, xliii.-clxvi. Symonds, Captain, W. 0. xii.- xxxvii. Tayloe, Richard, xxix-cxxxv. Tennant, James. Proceedings (N.S.) iii. 240. Thirlwall, Dr. (Bishop of St. David's), xlvi.-cxlvii. Thomson, Dr.Thomas. xl viii.-cxxxiv. Thornton, Richard, xxxiv.-cxxiii. Tindal, Commr. C. xxx.-cxxvi. Tonna, Lewis H. xxvii.-cxiv. TowsoN, J. T. Proceedings (N.S.) iii. 108. Trevelyan, Sir Walter, Part. Pro ceedings (N. S.) i. 236. Trithen, P. H. xxv.-xciii. Trotter, Rear-Admiral H. D. xxx.- cxxvi. Uzielli, Mattbew. xxxi.-cxxxii. Vattibe db Bouville. xxv.-xciv. Vaughan, Sir C. xx.-xxxiii. VisooNTi, Marquis, xlvi.-cxl. Vogel, Dr. xxviii.-cxli. Von Babe, xlvii.-cl. Von Buch, Leopold, xxiv.-lxiii. Von dee Decken, Baron, xxxvi.- VoN Haidingbb, Wilbelm. xli.- cxlviii. VoN Hugel, Baron, xli.-cxlix. Von Martius, Charles P. P. xxxix.-cxxxLx. Von Rbdbn, Baron, xxviii.-cxl. Von Sydow. xliv.-oxxxi. VuLLiAMY, B. L. xxiv.-lxxxv. Wahlbbeg, j. P. xxvii.-cxvi. Wahlenbbeg, Professor, xxi.-lxi. Walckenaae, Baron, xxii.-lxvii. Walker, James, f.k.s. xxxiii.- cxxxiii. Wallin, Dr. xxiv.-lxxxiv. Waebueton, Henry, xxix.-cxxiii. Waeeb, Jobn Ashley, xxxi.-oxxxiii. Washington, Rear-Admiral Jobn, o.B. xxxiv.-cxii. Waugh, Sir Andrew, xlviii.-cxliii. Weir, WiUiam. xxix.-cxxviii. Wbllsted, Lieut., i.n. xiii.-xliii. Westminster, Marquis of. xl.- cxliv. Wharncliffe, Lord, xxvi.-clxxxvii. Whbelweight, William. xliv.- cxlvii. Whewell, Dr. xxxvi.-cxxii. White, Cbarles. xliii.-clxviii. WiDDEiNGTON, Captain S. xxvi.- clxxxvii. WiELHOESKi, Count, xxvi.-clxxxviii. WiLBEEFOECE, Dr. (Bisbop of Win chester), xliv.-cxliii. Wilkinson, Sir Gardner, xlvi.-ol. Williams, Rev. D. xxx.-cxxvii. Williams, Dr. C. Proceedings (N.S.) i. 625. Willis, Capt. W. A., e.n. xxxiv.- cxxiii. Wilson, Sir Bedford P. xxix.- oxxx. WmCHESTEE. (See Dr.WlLBEEFOECE.) Wolfe, Commr. J. xx.-xxxvi. WoLPP, Dr. Joseph, xxxii.-cx. Wood, Major Herbert. Proceedings (N.S.) ii. 132. Wood, Commander James, xxx.- cxxvii. Wood, Captain Jobn, i.n. xlii.- cl vii. WYBEANTs(iSee Phipson-Wybeants). Wylie, j. W. S. xl.-cxlii. Yates, J. Brook, xxvi.-clxxxviii. Young, Thomas, xxxv.-cxxvii. Zahetmann, Admiral. xxiii.-Lxvi. ZlWOLKA, Pilot, xl.-xliv. Honorary Awards. 147 LIST OF EXPLOEEES AND GEOGEAPHEES to whom the EOYAL GEOGEAPHICAL SOCIETY HAS GRANTED HONOEAEY AWAEDS. AECTIC. 1834. Captain Sir John Ross, E.N., cb (Royal Award) 1836. Captain Sir George Back, E.N (Eoyal Award) 1839. Mr. George Simpson (Founder's Medal) 1846. Professor Middendorf (Founders Medal) 1862. Dr. Jobn Rae (Founder's Medal) 1853. Captain Inglefield, E.N., C.B (Patron's MedaV) 1854. Captain Sir Robert M'Clure, E.N., CB (Patron^ s Medal) 1856. Dr. Elisba Kent Kane (Founder's Medal) 1868. Captain CoUinson, E.N., C.B. (Founder's Medal) 1860. Lady Franklin (Founder's Medal) 1860. Captain Sir Leopold M'Clintock, E.N (Patron's Medal) 1867. Dr. Hayes (Patron's Medal) 1869. Professor Nordenskiold (Founder's Medal) 1873. Captain Carlsen (Gold Watch) 1875. Lieut. Weyprecht (Founder's Medal) 1875. Lieut. Julius Payer (Patron's Medal) 1877. Captain Sir George Nares, K.C.B (Founder's Medal) 1877. Captain A. H. Markbam, E.N (Gold Watch) 1880. Captain Palander (Founder's Medal) 188L Mr. B. Leigh Smith (Patron's Medal) ANTAECTIC. 1833. Mr. John Biscoe, K.N (Royal Award) 1842. Captain Sir James C. Ross, R.N (Founder's Medal) 1848. Captain Charles Wilkes, U.S.N (Patron's Medal) AFEICA. 1832. Mr. Eichard Lander (Royal Award) 1839. Dr. Edward Eiippell (Patron's Medal) 1846. Dr. Beke (Founder's Medal) 1853. Mr. Francis Galton (Founder's Medal) 1855. Eev. David Livingstone (Patron's Medal) 1855. Mr. Charles J. Anderssen (Instruments) L 2 148 Honorary Awards. 1856. Dr. Heinrich Barth, c.b (Patron's Medal) 1856. Corporal J. P. Church (Watch & Chain) 1869. Captain Eichard P. Burton (Founder's Medal) 1861. Captain John Hanning Speke (Founder's Medal) 1864. Captain J. A. Grant, CB (Patron's Medal) 1864. Baron C. von der Decken (Founder's Medal) 1866. Sir Samuel Baker (Patron's Medal) 1866. M. P. B. du Chaillu (100 Guineas) 1868. M. Gerhard Eohlfs (Patron's Medal) 1872. Herr Karl Maucb (Sum of &20) 1873. Mr. H. M. Stanley (Patron's Medal) 1873. Mr. 'Ibomas Baines (Gold Watch) 1874. Dr. Georg Scbweinfurtb (^Founder's Medal) 1876. Commander V. L. Cameron, e.n., c.b (Founder's MedaV) 1880. Bisbop Crowtber (Gold Watch) 1881. Major Serpa Pinto (Founder's Medal) ASIA. 1835. Sir Alexander Burnes (Royal Award) 1838. Colonel Chesney, E.E (Royal Award) 1840. Major-Gen. Sir Henry Eawlinson, K.CB (Pounder's Medal) 1841. Lieut. John Wood, i.n. (Patron's Medal) 1843. Lieut. J. F. A. Sjrmonds, E.B (Patron's Medal) 1844. Mr. W. J. Hamilton (Founder's Medal) 1849. Austen H. Layard (Founder's Medal) 1849. Baron Hiigel (Patron's Medal) 1851. Dr. George Wallin (26 Guineas) 1852. Captain Henry Strachey (Patron's Medal) 1857. Lieut.-General Sir Andrew Scott Waugh . . . . (Patron's Medal) 1862. Captain Thomas Blakiston (Patron's Medal) 1864. Mr. W. Gifford Palgrave (25 Guineas) 1865. Colonel T. G. Montgomerie, E. B (Founder's Medal) 1866. Dr. Arminius Vambery (40 Guineas) 1866. Dr. Thomas Thomson, M.D (Founder's Medxd^ 1866. Moola Abdul Medjid (GoldWatch) 1867. Admiral Alexis Boutakoff (Founder s Medal) 1870. Lieut. Francis Garnier, P.I.N (Patron's Medal) 1870. Mr. George W. Hayward (Founder's Medal) 1872. Mr. Eobert Berkeley Sbaw (Patron's Medal) 1873. Mr. Ney Elias (Founder's Medal) 1875. Mr. W. H. Johnson (GoldWatch) 1877. Tbe Pundit Nain Singh (Patron's Medal) 1878. Baron F. von Eichthofen (Founder's Medal) 1878. Captain Henry Trotter, E.E (Patron's Medal) 1878. Colonel N. Prejevalsky (Patron's Medal) 1879. Captain W. J. Gill, E.E (Founder's Medal) INDIAN AECHIPELAGO. 1848. Sir James Brooke, Eajah of Sarawak (Founder's Medal) AUSTEALASIA. 1843. Mr. Edward Jobn Byre (Founder's Medal) 1846. Sir Paul Strzelecki, K.C.M.G., o.B (Founder's Medal) 1847. Captain Cbarles Sturt (Founder's Medal) Honorary Awards. 149 1847. Dr. Ludwig Leiobbardt (Patron's Medal) 1851. Mr. Thomas Brunner (25 (Juineas) 1857. Mr. Augustus C. Gregory (Founder's Medal) 1861. Mr. John Macdouall Stuart (Patron's Medal) 1862. Mr. Eobert O'Hara Burke (Founder's Medal) 1862. Mr. John King (GoldWatch) 1863. Mr. Frank T. Gregory (Founder's Medal) 1863. Mr. William Landsborough (GoldWatch) 1863. Mr. Jobn M'Kinlay (GoldWatch) 1H63. Mr. Frederick Walker (GoldWatch) 1874. Colonel P. Egerton Warburton (Patron's Medal) 1876. Mr. -John Forrest (Patron's Medal) 1880. Mr. Ernest Giles (Patron's Medal) NOETH AMEEICA. 1850. General Jobn C. Fremont (Patron's Medal) 1858. Professor Alexander D. Bache (Patron's Medal) 1859. Captain John Palliser (Patron's Medal) SOUTH AMEEICA. 1840. Sir Robert Schomburgk (Patron's Medal) 1866. Mr. William Chandless (Patron' s Medal) 1872. Commander G. C. Musters, e.n (Gold Watch) MAEINE SUEVEYOES. 1837. Captain Robert FitzRoy, E.N., CB (Royal Award) 1854. Admiral W. H. Smyth, C.B (Founder's Medal) EMINENT GEOGEAPHEES. 1841. Lieut. Raper, e.n. (Founder's Medal) 1842. Rev. Dr. E. Robinson (Patron's Medal) 1844. Professor Adolph Erman (Patron's Medal) 1845. Herr Karl Eitter (Patrons Medal) 1863. Mr. John Arrowsmith (Patron's Medal) 1868. Dr. Augustus Petermann (Founder's Medal) 1869. Mrs. Mary Somerville (Patron's Medal) 1871. Mr. A. Keith Johnston, LL.D (Patron's Medal) 1871. Sir Roderick I. Murchison, Bart., k.c.b (Founder's Medal) 1872. Colonel Henry Yule, CB (Founder's Medal) 1880. Mr. E. H. Bunbury (Letter of Thanks) ANALYSIS. For Asia . . 28 English . . 72 „ Africa . . 22 Germans . 16 „ Arctic . . 20 Civilians . 51 Americans . 7 „ Australasia 16 Sailors . 23 Eussians . 3 Geographers . 11 Soldiers . 21 Swedes . 3 Antarctic . 3 Professors 5 French . . . 1 N. America 3 Doctors . 4 Portuguese 1 S. America 3 Clergymen 3 Norwegian . . 1 Marine Surveyors 2 Women . 2 Magyar . . 1 Indian Archipelag 3 1 Natives of India Negro . . . 2 1 Total . 109 150 Grants in Aid. THE SOCIETY'S GEANTS IN AID TEAVELLEES AND EXPEDITIONS. £ 8. d. 1832. Captain Back's Arctic Land Expedition 50 0 0 „ Instruments for travellers 11 14 0 1834. Delagoa Bay Expedition 170 16 4 „ Schomburgk's Guiana Expedition 60 0 0 1835. „ „ „ 176 0 0 1836. „ „ „ 490 0 0 „ Alexander's S. Africa Expedition 356 12 0 1837. Schomburgk's Guiana Expedition 156 4 0 1838. „ „ „ 5 5 0 „ Alexander's S. Africa Expedition 223 0 0 „ Ainsworth's Kurdbstan Expedition 298 0 0 1839. Schomburgk's Guiana Expedition 100 0 0 „ Ainsworth's Kurdistan Expedition 685 8 6 „ Wbite Nile Expedition 50 0 0 „ New Zealand Expedition 9 9 0 1840. Ainsworth's Km-distan Expedition 556 13 0 184L „ „ „ 313 12 9 „ Instruments for travellers 11 0 0 1842. Dr. Beke (Abyssinia) 100 0 0 „ Instruments for travellers 12 0 0 1843. Instruments for travellers 15 8 5 1844. Instruments for travellers 6 12 0 1861. Instruments for Consul Petherick. „ „ „ Dr. Rae. „ Consul Petherick for relief of Speke 100 0 0 (£1200 subscribed by Fellows.) 1863. Instruments for Dr. D. Walker (N. America). J, „ „ Captain Bedford Pim, e.n. „ „ „ M. Jules Gerard. 1864. Grant to M. Gerhard Rohlfs (N. Africa) 50 0 0 1865. Second Grant to „ „ „ 50 0 0 „ Grant to Mr. R. B. N. Walker (Ogow^) 100 0 0 „ Instruments for „ „ 43 0 0 „ Grant to Dr. Livingstone (Central Eq. Africa) .. .. 500 0 0 ,, „ Captain Wilson, e.e. (Dead Sea) 107 7 9 „ „ Captains Wilson and Palmer (Sinai). 1866. Leichhardt Search Expedition 200 0 0 1867. Instruments for Mr. Whymper (Greenland) 22 1 6 ,. „ „ Mr. Wbitely (S. America) 13 0 0 1868. Grant to Mr. Young, E.N. (Lake Nyassa) 160 0 0 „ Instruments for Rev. P. W. Holland (Sinai) 34 17 6 1869. „ „ Mr. Hayward (E. Turkistan) 14 8 6 „ Grant to „ „ 300 0 0 Grants in Aid. 151 £ s. d. 1870. Grant to Mr. St. Vincent Erskine (Limpopo) 100 0 0 „ Instruments for „ „ „ 18 0 0 „ Second Grant to Mr. Hayward (E. Turkistan) . . . . 300 0 0 „ Instruments for Sir iSamuel Baker 114 6 C „ Mr. Palmer 4 10 187L „ „ IVJf. R. B. Shaw (E. Turkistan) .. .. 23 4 0 „ „ Rev. T. Wakefield (Mombas) 35 5 0 „ „ „ C. Tyrwhitt Drake (Syria) 6 3 6 1872. „ „ Mr. St. Vincent Erskine (Limpopo) .. 18 2 0 „ Livingstone Search and Relief Fund 696 4 9 1873. Instruments, outfit, &c., Lieutenant V. L. Cameron, e.n. \ ,,1 ^1 i (416 0 0 „ „ „ Lieutenant Grandy, E.N 123 11 4 „ Outfit, Dr. Dillon, e.n 100 0 0 „ Meteorological Instruments, Consulate, Zanzibar .. .. 10 10 0 „ Livingstone Search and Relief Expedition 416 8 0 „ Instruments, Capt. A. H. Markbam, e.n. (Wbaling Cruise) 13 5 6 1874. „ Dr. Beke (Midian) 30 1 6 „ „ Mr. Ney Elias 8 10 0 „ „ Mr. Hegan (Bolivia) 21 17 6 „ Livingstone Search and Relief Fund 1778 16 5 1875. Cameron Expedition 500 0 0 „ Instruments, Colonel Gordon -Ioq k c „ „ Captain Allen Young 13 0 0 „ „ Arctic Expedition 10 0 0 1876. „ Mr. Watts (Iceland) 14 0 0 Captain Allen Young jg ^ « „ Mr. Cotterill (S. Africa) 24 0 0 Mr. J. A. Skertchly (W. Africa). „ „ Rev. Q. W. Thomson 5 0 0 „ „ Lieutenant Congreve (Paraguay) .. .. 15 0 0 „ Cameron Expedition Fund 1000 0 0 1877. Instruments, Rev. J\ W. Holland (Sinai) 27 0 0 „ African Exploration Fund 500 0 0 „ Instruments for Mr. Keith Johnston 170 0 0 „ „ „ Mr. Young, E.N 96 17 6 „ Cameron Expedition Fund * 1012 2 6 1878. African Exploration Fund 500 0 0 „ Instruments for Mr. Keith Johnston (E. Africa) .. .. 170 0 0 1879. „ „ Mr. Forbes (Celebes) 9 0 0 „ Mr. Simons (Sta. Martba) 15 0 0 „ Rev. T. J. Comber (Congo) 57 0 0 „ Rev. J. Mullens 10 0 0 „ Captain A. H. Markbam 5 18 0 1880. Africa,n Exploration Fund. Two Grants 1000 0 0 „ Instruments for Rev. W. P. Jobnston (E. Africa) .. .. 35 5 0 „ „ „ Mr. Delmar Morgan (Kuldja) .. .. 16 15 0 „ „ „ Dr. Aitchison (Afghanistan) 24 11 0 „ „ „ Mr. A. M'Call (Congo) 33 3 0 * Tbe total cost of tbe Cameron Expedition was 11,1012. 13j. 3d., of which 3000Z. was contributed by tbe Government. 152 Treasury Grants. £ «. d. 1880. Instruments for Captain Phipson-Wybrants 109 15 0 „ Dr. W. R. Peden (Shire) 30 13 0 1881. Palestine Exploration Fund 100 0 0 TEEASUEY GEANTS EECl]IYBD. 1836. For Guiana and South African Expeditions 1000 0 0 1856. For Captain Burton's Expedition 1000 0 0 1860. For Captain Speke's Expedition 2500 0 0 1873. For Dr. Livingstone's Funeral 500 19 1 1876. For Lieutenant Cameron's Expedition 3000 0 0 Arctic Papers. 153 LIST OF PAPEES IN THE 'JOUENALS' AND 'PEOCEEDINGS' OF THE EOYAL GEOGEAPHICAL SOCIETY. AECTIC. America, Noeth, Evidence for tbe discovery of, by the Scandinavians in the lOtb century, viii. 114. Arctic shores of. (See Simpson and Eae.) Andeeson, Mr. Journey to Montreal Island, xxvi. 18 ; xxvii. 321. Animal Life in tbe Arctic Eegions, by P. L. Simmonds. (Proceedings, Vol. i. 63.) (See Petermann.) " Arctic," whaler voyage of. C. E. Markbam. (Proceedings, Vol. xviii. 12.) Arctic Expeditions, Notes on tbe late, by S. Osborn. (Proceedings, Vol. i. 104.) Aeotic Expedition, On tbe progress of and voyage of the " Valorous." By C. R. Markham. (Proceedings, Vol. xx. 55.) of 1875-76. Results of. By C. R. Markham. (Proceedings, Vol. xxi. 536.) Arctic Expeditions of 1878, by C. R. Markbam. (Proceedings (N.S.) Vol. i. 16.) Aeotio Exploration by Sherard Osborn. xxxvi. 279. (Proceedings, Vol. ix. 42 ; Vol. xii. 92 ; Vol. xvi. 227.) (See Noeth Polae Exploeation.) Sir Eoderick Murchison's speech on. (Proceedings, Vol. ix. 87.) Austeo-Hungaeian Expedition of 1872-74. By Julius Payer, xiv. 1. (Proceedings, Vol. xix. 17.) Scientific work of the second, 1872-74. By Lieut. Weyprecht. xiv. 19. Back, Sir Geo. Search for Capt. Eoss. Account of bis land expedition. ii. 336 ; iii. 64 ; v. 405 ; vi. i. Voyage of the " Terror," vii. 457, 460. Babe, Professor. (See Sibbeia.) Baeent's Sba, Campaign of 1879, in. By Capt. A. H. Markbam. (Pro ceedings (N.S.) Vol. ii. 1. ) Bbheing Steait to Cambeidge Bay, the proceedings of H.M.S. " Enterprise " from. By Capt. R. CoUinson, e.n. xxv. 194. CiRCUMPOLAE Explorations. A. Petermann. (Proceedings, Vol. ix. 90.) CiBCUMPOLAR Regions. Recent elevations of land. By H. H. Howorth, xliii. 240. 154 Arctic Papers. CiRCUMPOLAE Sea, on tbe. By Capt. G. S. Nares. (Proceedings, Vol. xxi. 96.) (See Naees.) CoLLiNSON, Capt. Voyage of the " Enterprise." xxv. 194. CuREEKTS, On ocean. By Gen. Hauslab. xiv. 34. (See Greenland.) Dutch Navigatoes in Arctic Seas, by Commodore Jansen. (Proceedings, Vol. ix. 163.) Arctic Expedition. (Proceedings, (N.S.) i. 26.) Findlay, A. G. On route of Franklin, xxvi. 26. (Proceedings, Vol. i. 21.) Feanklin, Sie John. Sea of Spitzbergen, and Whale-fisheries in the Arctic Regions. By Aug. Petermann. xxiii. 129. ¦ Narrative of tbe expedition in search of. By Sir P. L. McClintock, e.n. xxxi. i. (Proceedings, Vol. iv. 2.) Arctic Explorations, with information respecting missing Party of. By Dr. John Rae. xxv. 246. Report of the expedition in search of, during 63-55 ; chart showing Arctic discoveries. By B. Kent Kane. xxvi. 1. On tbe probable course pursued by tbe expedition of. By A. G. Findlay. xxvi. 26. (Proceedings, Vol. i. 21.) (search for.) Letter from Jas. Anderson to Sir Geo. Simpson. xxvi. 18. Extracts from Jas. Anderson's Arctic Journal, xxvii. 321. Memorial for continuance of searcb for. (Proceedings, Vobi. 95.) Franz Josef Land. Discoveries by the Austro-Hungarian Expedition, xiv. 1 ; xiv. 19. (Proceedings, Vol. xix. 17.) Discoveries along coast of, by B. Leigb Smith. (Proceedings (N.S.) Vol. iii. 129.) Frobisher. On the voyages of, by Commander Becher, e.n. xii. 1. Fkobisher Strait. C. P. Hall. (Proceedings, Vol. vii. 99.) Frozen Soil op British N. America. Observations on the. Communicated by Dr. Richardson, ix. 117. Gbeman Aectic Expedition, Return of. Sir L. McClintock. (Proceedings, Vol. XV. 102.) Greenland, the site of the lost colony of, determined. By R. H. Major. xliii. 156. (Proceedings, Vol. xvii. 312.) On tbe large Continental Ice of, and origin of icebergs in the Arctic seas. By Dr. H. Rink, xxiii. 145. The Arctic Current round coast of. By Capt. E. Irminger. xxvi. 36. (Proceedings, Vol. i. 61.) On tbe supposed discovery by Dr. E. K. Kane of the North Coast of. By Henry Rink, xxviii. 272. (Proceedings, Vol. ii. 195.) Greenland Esquimaux, On the origin and migrations of tbe. I5y C. R. Mark bam. XXXV. 87. (Proceedings, Vol. ix. 88.) Greenland, Discharge of water from glaciers in. Dr. Rink. (Proceedings, Vol. vii. 76.) Greenland, Fiords and Glaoiees, On. By J. W. Tayler. xl. 228. (Pro ceedings, Vol. V. 90; Vol. xiv. 166.) Ground Ice. (See Siberia.) Hall, Captain. Arctic Expedition. (Proceedings, Vol. xv. 382.) (See Fro bisher St. " POLAEIS.") Arctic Papers. 155 Hobsbuegh, Cape, Land in vicinity of, by E. P. Philpots. (Proceedings, Vol. xiii. 372.) Inglefeld, Capt. Voyage of tbe " Isabel." xxiii. 136. Irminger, Admiral. (See Greenland.) (See Icelandic Currents (Europe). Kane, Dr., Expedition of. (See Feanklin, search for.) xxvi. 1. Kennedy, Mr. Voyage of the " Prince Albert." xxiii. 122. King William Land. Expedition of Lieut. P. Sobwatka. By 0. E. Markbam. (Proceedings (N.S.) Vol. ii. 667.) Labrador, Visit to N.E. coast of, during 1867, by H.M.S. " Gannet," Comm.W. Chimmo. xxxviii. 268. (Proceedings, Vol. xii. 196.) Peninsula, Exploration up the Moisie Eiver, to the edge of the Table land of the. By H. Y. Hind, xxxiv. 82. • ¦ Portion of coast of, by Capt. R. V. Hamilton, e.n. (Proceedings, Vol. ix. 131.) Light experienced in northern latitudes during theabsenceof tbe sun. Remarks on. By Capt. S. Osborn. xxviii. 371. McClintock, Sir Leopold. Expedition in search of Franklin, xxxi. 1. (Pro ceedings, Vol. iv. 2.) McCluee, Sir Robert. Discovery of N.W. passage, xxiv. 240. Mackenzie Rivee district, by R. Macfarlane. (Proceedings, Vol. ix. 125.) Montebal Island. (See Anderson, M'Clintock.) Nares, Capt. G. S., On the circumpolar sea. (Proceedings, VoL xxi. 96.) Neva, congelation of tbe, at St. Petersburg, and temperature of its waters wben covered with ice. By Gol. J. R. Jackson, v. i. Nordenskiold, Professor. Voyage of 1868 to Spitzbergen. xxxix. 131. North Polar Expedition of 1868, Account of tbe Swedish. By A. E. Nordenskiold (commanding), xxxix. 131. North Polar Exploration. By A. Petermann. (Proceedings, Vol. ix. 90, 114.) Best route for, by C. E. Markham. (Proceedings, Vol. ix. 138.) Letter on, by Lady Franklin. (Proceedings, Vol. ix. 148.) (See Arctic Exploration.) North Polar Region, On tbe exploration of tbe. By Capt. S. Osbom, r.n. xxxvi. 279. North Pole, On tbe climate of the, and on circumpolar exploration. By W. E. Hickson. xxxv. 129. (Proceedings, VoL ix. 137.) ¦ ¦ By Hopkins. (Proceedings, Vol. iv. 100.) Table of voyages towards tbe. Compiled by C. R. Markbam. xxxvi. 295. On best route for reaching. (See Wrangbll.) On route to. By Admiral Richards. (Proceedings, Vol. xix. 208. North- West Passage, and further survey of Northern Coast of America, communications on a, vi. 34. Discovery of the. By Comm. R. M'Clure, e.n. xxiv. 240. Northern Circumpolar Regions, Recent elevations of the earth's surface in the. By H. H. Howorth, xliii. 240. 156 Arctic Papers. Noethumbeeland Inlet, Journal of a whaling voyage. By Mr. Wareham, xii. 21. NovAiA Zbmlia, On the recent Eussian Expeditions to. By Professor K. B. von Baer, viii. 411. (See Baebnts Sba.) OsBOEN, Admiral S., On Arctic exploration, xxxvi. 279. (See Arctic Ex ploeation, Light, North Polae Region.) Open Water in the Polar Basin, by R. V. Hamilton. (Proceedings, Vol. xiii. 234.) Petbemann, Dr., On distribution of animal life in the Arctic Regions, xxii. 118. (See Feanklin.) On the proposed Polar Expedition. (Proceedings, Vol. ix. 90, 114.) Polae Basin, Remarks on open sea in. By Eobert White. (Proceedings, Vol. i. 27.) " PoLAEis," Discoveries of. By 0. R. Markham. (Proceedings, Vol. xviii. 12.) Pole. (See Noeth Pole.) Eae, Dr., Information of missing expedition, xxv. 246. Victoria Land, xxii. 82. WoUaston Land, xxii. 73. EiNK, Dr. (See Gebenland.) Eoss, Capt., Search for. (See Back.) Ross, expedition to ascertain fate of, ii. 336. (See Back.) Schwatha, Lieut. (See King William Island.) / SiBBEiA, On the frozen ground in. By Prof. K. E. von Baer, viii. 210. SiBBEiAN Rivers, Ground ice in the. By Colonel Jackson, vi. 416. Sledge Tea yelling. On. By Capt. A. H. Markbam. (Proceedings, Vol. xxi. 110). By Sir L. M'Clintock. (Proceedings, Vol. xix. 464.) Simpson and Dease, Account of recent Arctic Discoveries, viii. 213 ; ix. 325 ; X. 268. Smith Sound, Discoveries of the " Polaris." By C. E. Markham. (Pro ceedings, Vol. xviii. 12.) Expedition of Dr. Kane. xxvi. 1. Southampton Island, On the N.E. shore of. By Capt. Back, e.n., vii. 460. (See"TEEEOE.") Spitzbeegen, On discoveries East of. By C. E. Markham, xliii. 83. (Pro ceedings, Vol. xvii. 97.) (See Noedenskiold.) Stephenson, Capt. H. F. On tbe winter quarters of tbe Discovery. (Pro ceedings, Vol. xxi. 106.) Swedish, N. Polar Expedition, by Nordenskiold and von Otter. (Proceedings, Vol. xiii. 161.) " Teeeor," H.M.S., Account of the late voyage of, vii. 457, 460. Theemometeical Obsbevations, made at Sir Edw. Parry's several wintering places. By Dr. Richardson, ix. 331. Unknown Lands within the Arctic Circle. Probable existence of. By Capt. S. Osborn. (Proceedings, Vol. xyi. 227.) Papers on Europe. 157 Victoria Land. (See Eae, Dr.) Wollaston Land. (See Eae, Dr.) Wrangbll, Admiral von. On reaching the Pole, xviii. 19-24. Zbni, Voyages of. By Capt. Zahrtmann, v. 102. Frislanda is Iceland and not the Pjeroes. By Admiral Irminger. xlix. 398. is not Iceland, but tbe Pajroes ; an answer to Admiral Irminger. By E. H. Major, xlix. 412. ANTAECTIC. Antarctic Discovery, On, and its connection with the Transit of Venus in 1882. ByJ. E.Davis, xxxix. 91. (Proceedings, Vol. xiii. 114.) Antarctic Ocean, Eecent discoveries in the. By John Biscoe, r.n. iii. 106; Discoveries in tbe, by Balleny, in February 1839. ix. 517. Deception Island, Account of, from private journal of Lieut. Kendal, r.n. i. 62. Iceberg. Note on a rock seen on an, in 61° S., by C. Darwin, ix. 628. Mokbll's Antaectio Voyage. Eemarks on, by Capt. E. V. Hamilton, e.n. (Proceedings, Vol. xiv. 145.) SABELfTA Land. C. Enderby. (Proceedings, Vol. ii. 171.) Southern Circumpolar Eegion, Eecent changes in tbe. By H. H. Howorth. xliv. 252. EUEOPE. Aitkins Eook. On tbe Vigia so called. By Captain Vidal, r.n. i. 51. Albania. Geographical Account of, from MS. of Count Karaczay. xii. 45 Alps. Notes on the passage of Hannibal. By Professor Paul Chaix. xxv. 182. European. On the origin of the flora of. By John Ball. (Proceedings, (N.S.) Vol. i. 564. Arta. Observations on the Gulf of, made in 1830. By Lieut. J. Wolfe, e.n. iii. 77. Arve. Hydrography of tbe valley of. By Professor Paul Chaix. xxvii. 224. Athos, Mount, and its Monasteries, witb notes of route from Constantinople to Salonica, in June 1836. By Lieut. Webber Smith, vii. 61. .. Eemarks on tbe Isthmus of. By Lieut. Spratt, r.n. xvii. 145. Azores. (See under Oceania.) Azov, On tbe Sea of, the Putrid Sea, and adjacent coasts of. By Capt. Sherard Osborn. xxvii. 133. (Proceedings, Vol. i. 305.) 158 Papers on Europe. Balkan, or Mount Hsemus. Notes on a journey in 1847. By Lieut.-General A. Jochmus. xxiv. 36. Baltic, On tbe level of tbe. vi. 440. Black Sea, memoir of the voyage of H.M.S. "Blonde." By tbe Eev. Edmund Goodenough, D.D., F.E.S. i. 101. and Caspian. Differenceoflevelby Baron von Humboldt, viii. 135. and Caspian. Expedition to determine difference of level, vi. 426. (See Caspian.) Caucasus, On the, by Capt. Duncan Cameron., (Proceedings, Vol. vi. 5.) ¦ Journey in. D. W. Freshfield. (Proceedings, Vol. xiii. 66.) Columbeetes (volcanic rooks), near coast of Valencia, in Spain, by Capt. Smyth, E.N. i. 58. Commentaeibs on ancient military operations in Greece, by Jochmus. xxvii. 1. (See Maeathon.) Ceetb. Extract of a letter from Capt. Spratt, e.n. xxiv. 238. Cypeus. Journey through, by J. Thomson. (Proceedings (N. S.) Vol. i. 97.) ¦ Eough Notes on Prehistoric, by Sir Henry Eawlinson. (Proceedings (N. S.) Vol. i. 106.) Danube. Route between Kustenj6, by the Kara-su and Teni-Keui vaUeys, by Capt. Spratt. xxvi. 203. Dniepee, On the lower course of tbe. By Prof. H. Maiden, xv. 351. Don, On the valley of tbe. By C. B. Markbam. (Proceedings (N.S.) Vol. i. 675.) EpiEus, remarkable localities on the coast of. By Mr. Jas. H. Skene, xviii. 139. Description of the ruins of tbe Acropolis of Cassope. By Lieut.-Colonel CoUinson, e.b. xxxii. 68. On the Physical Geography and natural resources of. By Major R. Stuart, xxxix. 276. Bene (Lough) Account of. v. 392. Gipsies in Moldavia, by Samuel Gardner ; and speech by Sir H. Rawlinson. (Proceedings, Vol. i. 37.) Geeecb. Memoir on the Northern frontier. By Lieut.-Col. Baker, vii. 81. Eastern, geographical positions of the principal points of. By M. Peytier. viii. 423. Iceland, Dr. Rae's Eeport on. (Proceedings, Vol. v. 80.) Journey across the Vatna JbkuU. By W. L. Watts, xlvi. 1. (Pro ceedings, Vol. XX. 21.) Icelandic Cueeents. By Admiral Irminger. (Proceedings, Vol. v. 225.) Ladoga Lake, Survey of. A. Andreyeff. (Proceedings, Vol. xiii. 375.) LissA and Pelagosa, A visit to. By R. P. Burton, xlix. 151. Marathon, Notes on battle of, and of Sellasia and Thermus. By General Jochmus. (Proceedings, Vol. i. 481.) Papers on Asia. 159 Mediteeeanean Sea, Geography of the bed of. By Sherard Osborn. xii. 46. (Proceedings, Vol. xv. 28.) Mild, On tbe volcanic group of. By Lieut. Leycester, e.n., f.e.q.s. xxii. 201. Neva, Congelation of. By Colonel Jackson, v. 1. NoEWAY and Lapland, Voyage on the Coasts of. By Lieut. G. T. Temple, E.N. (Proceedings (N. S.) Vol. ii. 273.) Rhone and Geneva, Geographical and Statistical notes on the. By Prof. Chaix. xiv. 322. Santoein or Theea, Account of tbe volcanic group of. By Lieut. B. M. Leycester, e.n. xx. 1. Volcanic Eruptions. Dr. Schmidt. (Proceedings, Vol. x. 118.) Visit of Capt. Lindesay Brine to. (Proceedings, Vol. x. 317.) Sellasia, Battle of. (See Marathon.) Serpent Island (Black Sea), Remarks on. By Capt. T. Spratt, r.n., CB. xxvii. 220. Skyhos, On the Isle of. By Capt. T. Graves, e.n. xix. 152. Spain, Heights of various points in. By Don F. Bouzi. ii. 269. Switzerland, Summary of the last Census of. By Prof. Paul Chaix. xxiv 313. Theemus, Battle of. (See Marathon.) Turkey, Eueopean, Mt. Caucasus, and Asia Minoe, Astronomical posi tions in, fixed by P. G. W. Struve. viii. 406. Wick, Observations on the water of. By Jobn Cleghorn. xxvii. 230. ASIA. Abila District, near Mount Lebanon. By Jobn Hogg. xx. 38. Aden, Report on the Country, around. By Capt. G. J. Stevens, xliii. 296. Afghanistan, Comparative Geography of, and extract of a letter from Major Rawlinson. xii. 112. See Bamian, Kuream, Kandahae, Kabul, Helmund. Afghan Gbogeaphy. By C. R. Markbam. (Proceedings, Vol. xx. 241.) Campaign, Geographical results of. By Capt. T. H. Holdich. (Pro ceedings (N.S.) Vol. iii. 65.) Frontier. On Mountain Passes. By C. R. Markham. (Proceedings (N.S.) VoL i. 38.) Ala-tu Mountains. By Atkinson. (Proceedings, Vol. iii. 127.) Alai. See PamIe. Al Hadhe, Ruins of By Baron Von Hammer, xii. 261. Amu-Daeia, or Oxus, Tbe Delta and Mouths of the. By Adm. Boutakoff, of Eussian Navy, xxxvii. 152. . Notes on the Lower, and Lake Aral. By Major H. Wood. xiv. 367. See Oxus. Amu Deeya (Oxus), Journey to the sources of ; with observations on R. Indus. By Lieut. Wood, i.n. x. 530. 160 Asiatic Papers. Amur, Notes on the River and its surroundings. By MM. Pesoburof, Permikin, &c. xxviii. 376. (Proceedings, Vol. ii. 153 ; Vol. iii. 92.) Anatolia, N.E., Tour in. By W. G, Palgrave. (Proceedings, xvi. 223.) Andaman Islands, Narrative of an expedition to tbe, in 1857. By P. J. Mouat, M.D., F.E.G.s. xxxii. 109. (Proceedings, Vol. vi. 41.) Angora, Journey from (by Kaisariyah), to Bir or Birehjik. By W. Ainsworth. X. 275. Anti-Libanus, Notes of a Reconnaissance of the. By R. F. Burton, xiii. 408. Antioch, on tbe Bay of, and tbe Ruins of Seleucia Pieria. By Lieut.-Col. Chesney, r.a. viiL 228. Arabia, Observations on the Coast of, between Ras Mohammed and Jiddah. By Lieut. R. Wellsted, i.n. vi. 51. Remarks on manners of tbe inhabitants of Southern Arabia, and on ancient and modern geography of that part, and on desert route from Kosir to Keneb. By Jas. Bird, Esq. iv. 192. Observations made in Central, Eastern, and Southern, during a journey in 1862 and 1863. By W. G. Palgrave. xxxiv. 111. South Coast of. Journey from Tower of Ba'-l-haff to Ruins of Nakab el Hajar. By Lieut. Wellsted, e.i.c.s. vii. 20. Visit to Jebel Shammar, New routes through Northern and Central. By W. S. Blunt. (Proceedings (N.S.) Vol. ii. 81.) Memoir from the entrance of the Red Sea to Misenat, in 50° 43' 25" e. By Capt. Haines, i.n. ix. 125 ; xv. 104. Proceedings of brig " Palinurus " whilst examining Coast between Ras Morbat and Eas Soger, &c. By Commander J. P. Saunders, xvi. 169. Notes taken on a journey through a part of Northern Arabia. By Dr. Geo. A. Wallin. xx. 293. Interior of, by W. Gifford Palgrave. (Proceedings, Vol. viii. 63.) Visit to Wahabee capital. By Col. Pelly. xxxv. 169. (Proceedings, Vol. ix. 293.) Account of a journey into interior of South. By W. Munzinger and Capt. Miles. xU. 210. (Proceedings, Vol. xv. 319.) Southern, Geography of. By Baron von Maltzan. (Proceedings, Vol. xvi. 115.) Aracan, Extracts from a Journal up tbe Koladyne Eiver. By Capt. S. E. Tickell, Bengal Native Infantry, xxiv. 86. Hill trip on borders of, by Lieut. Lewin. (Proceedings, Vol. xi. 52.) Aral, Survey of the Sea of. By Commander Alexis Butakoff, Imperial Eussian Navy, xxiii. 93. Aeaeat, Ascent cf Mount, in 1856. By Major E. Stuart. (Proceedings, Vol. xxi. 77.) Armenia and Asia Minor, Journey through a part of, in 1836. By Jas. Brant, Consul at Erz-Rum. vi. 187. Notes of a tour, in 1851. By K. B. Abbott, xii. 207. Kuedistan, and Uppbe Mesopotamia, Journal of a tour in, with Notes of Researches in tbe Deyrsim Dagb, in 1866. By J. G. Taylor. xxxviii. 2yl. and Mount Aeaeat. By James Bryce. (Proceedings, Vol. xxii. 169.) Aeeaoan, General remarks on Coast. Transmitted by Capt. Laws, e.n. i. 175. Ashtaroth, On the Site of. By Capt. Newbold, h.e.i.m.s. xvi. 331. Asiatic Papers. 161 Asia, On the Ethnography of High Asia. By Jas. Cowles Prichard, m.d., F.R.S. ix. 192. Asia Minor, Extracts from Notes made on a journey in 1836. By W. J. Hamilton, Esq. vii. 34. Notes of a journey in 1837. By W. J. Hamilton, Esq. viii. 137. ¦ Narrative of a survey of South Coast, and of a tour into Lycia- By R. Hoskyn. xii. 143. Eemarks on Mr. Hoskyn's paper. By Col. W. Martin Leake. xii. 162. — Proposed communication between Lake of Sabanja and Gulf of Nioomedia. By General Jochmus. (Proceedings, Vol. i. 301.) Azbrbijan and the shores of the Caspian, Journal of a tour through. By Col. Monteith, e.i.c.s. iii. 1. Azov, Sea of. On geography of. By Capt. Sherard Osborn. (Proceedings, Vol. i. 305.) Badakshan. By Sir H. Eawlinson. (Proceedings, Vol. xvii. 108.) Baghdad, Notes on two journeys from, to the Euins of Al-Hadhr, in Meso potamia, in 1836 and 1837. By Jobn Eoss. ix. 443. Journal of a steam voyage to tbe North of, in 1846. By Lieut. Felix * Jones, xviii. 1. Journey from, to Busrah. By Wm. K. Loftus. (Proceedings, Vol. i. 45.) to Busrah, Notes of journey, with descriptions of Chaldaean remains. By W. Kennett Loftus, Esq. xxvi. 131. Bakhtiyari Mountains, Ancient sites among tbe, with remarks on the rivers of Susiana and tbe site of Susa. By Professor Long. xii. 102. Extracts from a journal kept travelling through tbe country of tbe Mamaseni and Khogilu. By Baron C. A. de Bode. xiii. 75. Bangkok, Siam, Boat excursion from, to the Pechaburri, on Western Shore of Gulf of Siam. By Sir Eobert Schomburgk. xxxi. 302. See Siam. Bamian, On mountain passes leading to valley of. By Lieut.-Gen. Kaye, cb. (Proceedings (N.S.) VoL i. 244.) Bashan, Explorations in the Desert east of tbe Hauran, and in tbe ancient land of. By Cyril Graham, f.e.g.s., &c. xxviii. 226. Batum, Notes on an excursion from, to Artvin. By M. P. Guarraoino XV. 296. Beloochistan, On tbe subterranean supply of water in, and the hill districts of Western Sind. By J. W. Barns, xxxvii. 338. (See Persia.) Beloes, Tbe, and their country. By M. Veniukof. xxxvi. 265. Bhawtjlpoeb State, Notes on Physical Geography of. By J. W. Barns xiii. 390. BoEE, or Eushing Tide in the Gulf of Cambay, On the. By Lieut. Ethersey, i.n. viiL 196. Brahmaputra, or Tsanpu, Course of. By J. J. Cooper, (Proceedings, VoL xiii. 392.) Bunder Maeayah, On tbe neighbourhood of. By Capt. S. B. Miles, xiii. 61. Burma and its Tributary States, On the Geography of. By Capt. H. Yule. xxvii. 54. (Proceedings, Vol. i. 269.) Burma. Communication between China and. By Capt. Sprye. (Proceedings, VoL V. 45.) * In the headings of tbe paper the name is erroneously given J. T. Jones. M 162 Asiatic Papers. Burma. British and Western China, Trade routes between. By J. Coryton. xiv. 229. (Proceedings, Vol. xix. 264.) BusHiE to Shieaz, Notes on the routes from, &c. By Lieut.-Gen. Wm. Mon teith. xxvii. 108. BusHiEB and Tbheban, On the elevation of the country between. By Major St. John, xxxviii. 411. BtJSSOEA to Aleppo, Diary of a journey with Sir Eyre Coote. xxx. 198. BuiSTAR Dependency in British India, On tbe Mardian Hills and tbe Lower Indravati m. By Capt. Holdich. (Proceedings (N.S.) Vol. i. 372.) Cabul. (See Kabul.) Cambay, Tides in the Gulf of. By Capt. J. B. Jervis. viii. 202. Cambodia, Notes on the Antiquities, Natural History, &c., of. By Jas. CampbeU, Surgeon, e.n. xxx. 182. A visit to the ruined cities and buildings of. By Dr. A. Bastian. xxxv. 74. (Proceedings, Vol. ix. 85.) Travels in. By D. 0. King. (Proceedings, VoL iii. 365.) The Lao country, &c., Notes on. By M. Henri Mouhot. xxxii. 142. (Proceedings, VoL vi. 80.) Southern Laos and. By H. G. Kennedy xxxvii. 298. Candahae. (See Kandahar.) Canton to Hankow, Sketch of the journey. By Albert S. Bickmore, m.a. xxxviii. 60. Boat journey to west of. By Lieut. Oliver. (Proceedings, Vol. vi. 85.) Cashmere. (See Kashmir.) Caspian and Black Sbas, Eemarks on Country between the. By Prof. Hermann Abich. xxi. 1. (See Black Sea.) Cathay, Notes on. By Col. Yule. (Proceedings, Vol. x. 270.) Caucasus, Journey in tbe, and ascent of Kasbek and Elbruz. By Douglas W. Freshfield. xxxix. 50. Central Asia, Note to Arrowsmith's Map of. xiv. 420. ¦ The watershed of. By Col. Gordon, xlvi. 381. ¦ ¦ In 1872. By Mr. E. B. Shaw. (Proceedings, Vol. xvi. 396.) Ceylon, Papers concerning communication with India. Minute on the subject. By Governor of Madras, iv. 1. Chaab Arabs, Notes on. By Sir H. Eawhnson. xxvii. 185. (Proceedings, VoL i. 361.) China, On Chinese and European Maps of. By Wm. Huttmann. xiv. 117. ¦ On tbe frontiers of, toward Birmah. By Dr. Gutzlaff. xix. 85. Eeport on Eussian caravan trade with. By H. Parkes, Esq. xxiv. 306. S.W. Exploration to, by way of the Irawadi and Bhamo. By Major Sladen. xii. 257. (Proceedmgs, Vol. xv. 343.) A journey outside the Great Wall of By S. W. Bushell. xUv. 78. (Proceedings, Vol. xviii. 149.) Journey from Hankow to Ta-li-Pu. By A. E. Margary. xlvi. 172. Visit to the Valley of tbe Shueli, in Western Yunnan. By Nev Elias. xlvi. 198. Col. Sosnoffsky's expedition to, in 1874-75. xlvii. 150. Western, Travels in and on Eastern borders of Tibet. By Capt. Gill. xlviii. 57. (Proeoadings, VoL xxii. 265.) Asiatic Papers. 168 China, South-Western, Approximate determination of positions in. By G. 0. Baber. xlix. 421. Memoir on East Coast of. Canton, &c. By Sir John Davis. (Proceed ings, Vol. i. 330.) Interior of. By A. S. Bickmore. (Proceedings, Vol. xii. 51.) Journey from Hankow to Talifu. By Mr. Margary. (Proceedings, VoL XX. 184.) Journey from Ningpo to Shanghai. By C. J. Gardner. (Proceedings, VoL xiii. 170.) Journey through Shantung. By J. Markham. (Proceedings, Vol. xiv. 137.) Travels in Western, and Eastern Tibet. By J. J. Cooper. (Proceedings Vol. xiv. 336.) March across, from Chin Kiang to Bhamo. By J. McCarthy. (Pro ceedmgs (N.S.) Vol. i. 489.) Journeys in the interior of. By G. J. Morrison. (Proceedings (NiS.) Vol. ii. 145.) Chinese geographical names. On the transliteration of. By P. P. Smith. (Proceedings, Vol. xxi. 580.) Taetaey, Notes on. By Capt. S. Osborn. (Proceedings, Vol. xi. 162.) Chiteal, Munful Mir Munshi on (Proceedings, Vol. xiii. 130) Havildar's journey through, xiii. 180. (Proceedings, Vol. xvi. 263.) Chusan, witb a survey map of the Island. By Sir J. F. Davis, xxiii. 242. Cilioian and Syeian Gates, Notes on the comparative geography of. By W. Ainsworth. viii. 185. Cochin. On its natural advantages as a place of trade. By F. C Brown iii. 268. Cochin -Chinese Empiee, Geography of tbe. By Dr. Gutzlaff. xix. 86. Constantinople to Mosul, Notes taken on the journey in 1839^0. By W. Ainsworth. x. 489. CoOEG, Effects of Forest Destruction in. By Geo. Bidie, m. b., &c. xxxix. 77. (Proceedings, Vol. xiii. 74.) CoEBA, On the. By Capt. Allen Young. (Proceedings, Vol. ix. 296.) CossYAHS, Account of the, and of their convalescent Depot. By Lieut. Murphy, e.b. ii. 93. Curia Muria Isles, near the South-Eastern Coast of Arabia, Account of the. By late Dr. Hulton, ln. xi. 156. By Dr. Buist. (Proceedings, Vol. iv. 50.) Cutch, Eunn of. By Sir H. Bartie Frere. xl. 181. (Proceedings, Vol. xiv. 120.) Daghestan, in the Caucasus. By Baron de Bode. (Proceedings, Vol. iv. 91.) Damascus, Hauran, and the Lebanon Mountains. Memoir on Rev. J. L. Porter's map of. xxvi. 43. • The volcanic region East of, Notes on the exploration of. By Capt. R. P. Burton, xhi. 49. (Proceedings, Vol. xvi. 104.) Dead Sea, An account of the levelling from tbe Mediterranean to the. By Col. Sir H. James, xxxvi. 201. and Jordan Valley, On the depression of the. By Dr. Edward Eobinson. xvhi. 77. Explanation of sudden and violent drainage on sides of tbe basin of the. By Captain W. Allen, r.n. xxiii. 163. M 2 164 Asiatic Papers. Dead Sea, and part of Syela, On the. vii. 456. Exploration hy Henry Poole. (Proceedings, Vol. i. 221.) Demavend, Mount near Tehran, An account of the ascent of, in 1837. By W. T. Thomson, viii. 109. Ascent by T. Thomson and Lord S. Kerr. (Proceedings, Vol. iii. 2.) Ascent by Watson. (Proceedings, Vol. vi. 103.) DiARBBKE, Description of. By E. J. Garden, xxxvii. 182. (Proceedings, VoL xi. 159.) Eonte from Brzeroum to. By J. G. Taylor. (Proceedings, Vol. xii. 302.) Djungaria and the Celestial Mountains. By M. P. P. Semenof. xxxv. 213. Eastern Turkistan. Account of an exploring expedition from Port Vernoye to West Shore of Issik-Kul Lake. By P. Semenoff. Translated by E. Delmar Morgan, xxxix. 311. EcBATANA Atropatenian, Memoii on the site of. By Major Eawhnson. X. 65. Bl Balad, the Euins of. By H. J. Carter, xvi. 187. Brzee^im, Earthquake of. June 1869. By Robert A. 0. DalyeU. xxxiii. 234. Erz-Rum to Trebizond, Notes on a journey in October, 1838. By Henry Suter. X. 434. Notes on a journey from, to Aleppo in June, 1838. By Viscount PolUngfeon. X. 446. EuL.a;us of the Greek Historians, On tbe determination of the Eiver. By Wm. Kennett Loftus. xxvii. 120. (Proceedings, Vol. i. 219.) See SusA. Eupheates, Eeport on the navigation of the. By Col. Chesney, e.a. iv. 374. Expedition, Statement of labours and proceedings of, under Col. Chesney. vii. 411. EvEEEST, Mount. Papers relating to. (Proceedings, Vol. i. 345 ; Vol. ii. 102.) Faizabad, A Havildar's journey through Chitral to, in 1870. By Major T. G. Montgomerie. xiii. 180. (Proceedings, Vol. xvi. 263.) Peeghana. (See Pamie.) Formosa, Observations on coal in the n.e. of the Island. By Lieut. Gordon, E.N. xix. 22. Notes on tbe Island of. By E. Swinhoe. xxxiv. 6. (Proceedings, Vol. viii. 23.) Southern, Notes of a journey in. By J. Thomson, xliii. 97. (Pro ceedings, Vol. xvii. 144.) Journey through. By H. J. Allen. (Proceedings, Vol. xxi. 268.) ¦ Trip into interior of. By T. L. BuUock. (Proceedings, Vol. xxi. 266.) By A. Corner. (Proceedings, Vol. xix. 615.) — Rivers in Northern. By G. H. Kopsch. (Proceedings, Vol. xiv. 79.) Ganges and Hoogly, Communication between the. By J. H. Johnson E.N. ii. 316. Garo Hills, On the. By Godwin-Austen, xliii. 1. (Proceedings, Vol. xvii. 36.) Ghats of India, On tbe effects of tbe destruction of forests in tbe, on the Water Supply. By C. E. Markham. xxxvi. 180. (Proceedings, Vol. x. 266.) Asiatic Papers. 165 Ghilan, Province of, in Persia, Mr. Abbott on. (Proceedings, Vol. iii. 390.) Gilgit and Yassin, Letters from Mr. Haywood on exploration of. xii. 1. and Chiteal, Munful Mfr Munshi on. (Proceedings, Vol. xiii. 130.) Gobi, Buried Cities in the Desert of. By Sir D. Forsyth, xlvii. 1. (Pro ceedings, Vol. xxi. 27.) Geeat Tibet, Travels in, and trade between, and BengaL By C. R. Mark ham. xiv. 299. (Proceedings, Vol. xix. 327.) Exploration of the Namcho. By Col. T. G. Montgomerie. xiv. 316. Memorandum on tbe results of the exploration. By Col. T. G. Mont gomerie. xiv. 325. Hadeamaut, Excursion in. By A. Baron von Wrede. xiv. 107. Hankow. (See China.) Haran, in Padan Aram, Notes on an excursion to, and thence to Shechem. By C. T. Beke. xxxii. 76. (Proceedings, Vol. vi. 195.) Hauran, On. By C. Graham. (Proceedings, Vol. ii. 173.) On. By F. A. Eaton. (Proceedings, Vol. viii. 29.) Helmund, The basin of. By C. E. Markham. (Proceedings (N.S.) i. 191.) Heraclea, from Constantinople by, to Angora, Notes of a journey, in 1838. By Wm. Ainsworth, JEsq. ix. 216. , Hermon, The, and the physical features of Syria and Northern Palestine. By John Wortabet, m.d. xxxii. 100. Himalayan Valleys. Kulu, Lahul, and Spiti. By A. P. P. Harcourt. xii. 245. (Proceedings, Vol. xv. 336.) Himalaya, Papers relating to the. (Proceedings, Vol. i. 345.) HiMMA-LEH Mountains, Journey through tbe, to the sources of the Jumna, and thence to confines of Chinese Tartary, in 1827. By Capt. C. Johnson. iv. 41. and Valley of Cashmir, Notice of a visit to, in 1835. By Baron Charles Hiigel. vi. 343. HiMYARiTio Alphabet, The, and inscriptions, xi. 118. HoNQ-KoNG, Note on the Island of. By A. E. Johnston, Esq. xiv. 112. Ili, Valley of tbe. By Ashton Dilke. (Proceedings, Vol. xviii. 246.) (See KuLDJA.) Ilchi. (See Khotan.) Iliyats, or wandering tribes of Persia, some account of. By Jas. Morier, Esq. vii. 230. India and China, On Communication between, by the Burbampooter and Yang-tsze. By Gen. Sir Arthur Cotton, e.b. xxxvii. 231. By Dr. McCosh. (Proceedings, Vol. v. 47.) India, Descriptive papers of tbe countries on the North West frontier of. By Lieut. Burnes. iv. 88. On the maritime communications of, as carried on by natives. By Lieut. Burnes. vi. 23. Observations on tbe ancient intercourse with, suggested by remarks of Lieut. Burnes. By Lieut. Dickinson, vi. 113. On the progress and present state of survey in. By Capt. Thos. Best Jervis. vii. 127. Eoutes in the Nizam's territory ; from tbe journals of Capt. J. E. Wilson, xiii. 118. 166 Asiatic Papers. India, Overland telegraph route to. By Sir H. Eawlinson. (Proceedings, Vol. v. 219.) Destruction of forests, and effect on water supply. By C. E. Markham. xxxvi. 180. (Proceedings, Vol. x. 266.) Effects of forest destruction in Coorg. By Dr. Bidie. xxxix. 77. (Proceedings, Vol. xiii. 74.) Geography and climate as regards site for a capital. Sir G. CampbeU. (Proceedings, Vol. xi. 54.) Eiver communication between China and. Sir A. Cotton, xxxvii. 231. (Proceedings, Vol. xi. 255.) On the Highland Region adjacent to the Trans-Indus frontier of. By Major James Walker, xxxii. 303. Indian Sueveys for tbe year 1878-9. (Proceedings (N.S.) vol. ii. 422.) Seapoets. Duncan Macpherson. (Proceedings, Vol. vii. 95.) Indeavati RrvBE. (See Bustae.) Indus Rivee, Notes on the lower portion of the. By Col. W. Tremenheere. xxxvii. 68. (Proceedings, Vol, xi. 22.) Substance of a geographical memoir on the. By Lieut. A Burnes. iii. 113. Memoir to accompany the survey of the Delta of tbe, in 1837. By Lieut. T. G. Carless, i. n. viii. 328. ' On the construction of the map of the. By Lieut. A. Burnes. iii. 287. Ieawady, The, and its sources. By Dr. J. Anderson, xl. 286. (Proceedings, Vol. xiv. 346. T. T. Cooper on. (Proceedings, Vol. xiii. 392.) IssYK-KUL Expedition, Brief sketch of results of the. By Capt. A. Golubef. xxxi. 366. ¦ , Notes on the Lake of, and the Eiver Kosbkar. By W. Veniukof. xxxii. 560. Expedition to. By P. Semenoff. xxxix. 311. Japan, Narrative of a journey in tbe interior of; ascent of Fusiyama, and visit to sulphur-baths at Atami in 1860. By Su' Rutherford Alcock, CB., F.E.G.s. xxxi. 321. Journey in Island of Yezo in 1873 ; and on Progress of geography in Japan. By R. G. Watson, xliv. 132. (Proceedings, Vol. xviii. 226.) Narrative of a journey through the interior of, from Nagazaki to Yeddo in 1861. By Sir R. Alcock. xxxii. 280. (Proceedings, Vol. vi. 196.) Report on the sUk districts of. By Mr. P. 0. Adams, xl. 339. Island of Tsusima near. L. Oliphant. (Proceedings, Vol. vii. 61.) Extract of a letter from Commander Mathison of H.M.S. Mariner in 1849. XX. 136. A tour through parts of the Provinces of Echigo, Echiu, Kaga, and Noto. By J. Troup. 1871. xiii. 425. Journey from Ki6to to Yeddo. By C. W. Lawrence, xliii. 54. (Pro ceedings, Vol. xvii. 80.) Ascent of Fuji-Yama. By. J. H. Gubbins. (Proceedings, Vol. xviL 78.) Ascent of Fuji-Yama in tbe snow. By A. J. Jeffreys. (Proceedings, VoL xix. 169. Ascent of Fusi-Yama. By Sir R. Alcock. (Proceedings, Vol. v. 132.) Island of Yesso. Pemberton Hodgson. (Proceedings, Vol. v. 113.) Asiatic Papers. 167 Jaxabtes or Sye Daeia, The, from Russian sources. By Robert Michell. xxxviii. 429. Jbeusalem, by Hebron, the Dead Sea, &c., to 'Akabab, Note of journey from, and back by Petra, in 1888. By Count de Berton. ix. 277. Terra Santa, Mount Sinai, and Egypt, Account of a pilgrimage to. By Bernard de Breitenbach, Dean of Mentz. ix. 311. via. Mount Sinai, narrative of a journey from Cairo to. By the late Dr. Geo. A. Wallin. xxv. 260. JoEDAN, On the fall of the, &c. By Mr. Augustus Petermann. xviii. 89. Expedition to the, and the Dead Sea. By Lieut. Molyneux, e.n. xviii. 104. Kabul to Kashgae. Major Montgomerie's account of the Mirza's journey xU. 132. Rivee. On the Upper Basin of the. By 0. E. Markham. (Proceedings (N.S.) Vol. i. 110.) ^-^ Eoute through. By G. J. Vigne. ix. 512. Kach'hi Gandava, Eoutes through, and account of tribes, xiv. 193. Kaisariyah, Notes of a journey from, to Bir, in 1839. By W. Ainsworth, Esq. X. 311. Kalgan, Trip to. By E. Swinhoe. (Proceedings, Vol. xiv. 83.) Kamschatka, Note on a new map of. Letter from Prof. Adolph Erman. ix. 508. Kandahar, The highway from the Indus to. By Sir R. Temple. (Pro ceedings (N.S.) Vol. ii. 529.) Notes on the country between, and Girishk. By Capt. R. Beavan. (Proceedings (N.S.) Vol. ii. 548.) and India, Routes between. By Gen. Sir M. Biddulph. (Proceedings (N.S.) VoL ii. 212.) Karakorum Pass, successful journey to the. By Tbomas Thomson, m.d. xix. 29. Kabategin, Principality of. By Gen. Abramof. xii. 338. Kaeen-ni, A tour to, to open a trading-road to the Shan traders. By Edward O'Riley, Esq. xxxii. 164. (Proceedings, Vol. vi. 83.) Kaeun and Dizful Rivbes and the Ab-i-gargar Canal to Shuster. By Lieut. W. B. Selby, i.n. xiv. 219. Kashgae, Geographical results of Mission to, under Sir T. D. Forsyth. By Capt. H. Trotter, xlviii. 173. (Proceedings, Vol. xxii. 287.) Remarks on Sir D. Forsyth's mission to. By Sir H. Rawhnson. (Pro ceedings, Vol. xviii. 414.) Journey of Mr. Hayward to. (Proceedings, Vol. xiv. 40.) Report on the Mirza's journey from Kabul to. (Proceedings, Vol. xv. 181.) A Prince of, on the geography of Turkistan. R. B. Shaw. (Proceed ings, Vol. XX. 482.) Kashmik, Notes on the vallay of. By Capt. H. H. Godwin- Austen, xxxi. 30. Route through. By G. J. Vigne. ix. 512. Natural productions and agriculture of. From MS. of Wm. Moorcroft. iL 253. On the survey and physical configuration of tbe Valley of. By Wm. Purdon. xxxi. 14. (Proceedings, Vol. iv. 30.) (See Cabhmie.) 168 Asiatic Papers. Khiva. By Sir H. Rawlinson. (Proceedings, VoL xvii. 162.) Khorasan, Northern, notes on a portion of. By Jas. BailUe Eraser, viii. 308. Routes in, during 1831 and 1832. By Sarg. Gibbons, xi. 136. Route from Turbat Haideri to the river Heri-Rud on the borders of Sistan. Extracted from Dr. Forbes' JournaL xiv. 146. Diary of a tour in, and notes on tbe Eastern Alburz tract. By Capt. Napier, xlvi. 62. Notes on tbe Yomut Tribe. By Kazi Syud Ahmad, xlvi. 142. Tables of routes in tbe Eastern Alburz tract, xlvi. 146. Khotan, Report on journey to Ilchi, capital of. By W. H. Johnson. xxxvii. 1. (Proceedings, Vol. xi, 6.) Journey to, of the Brothers Schlagintweit. (Proceedings, Vol. i. 273.) Khuzistan, Description of tbe province of By A. H. Layard, Esq. xvi. 1. Kiachta, Eoute from Tientsin to. By W. A. Whyte. (Proceedings, xiv. 243). KiEMAN, Jbbal, and Khoeasan, Routes in, during 1831 and 1832. By Sarg. Gibbons, xi. 136. Kokand, A journey to, in 1873. By E. Schuyler. (Proceedings, VoL xviii. 408.) KOEEA. (See COREA.) Kraw, Isthmus of. Route across. By Capts. Eraser and Furlong. (Pro ceedings, Vol. vii. 58.) Kos and Symi, Notice of the Gulfs of. By Lieuts. Graves and Brook, r.n. viii. 428. in Anatoha, Notice of the gulfs of. By Lieut. Saumarez Brock, E.N. is. 507. Kuldja. By Major P. C. H. Clarke. (Proceedings (N.S.) Vol. ii. 489.) By Ashton Dilke. (Proceedings, Vol. xviii. 246.) By Dehnar Morgan. (Proceedings (N.S.) Vol. iii. 150.) Kumaon and Garhwal, in tbe Himalaya Mountains, On tbe physical geography of, and of the adjoining parts of Tibet. By Capt. Strachey. xxi. 57. Kumaon, Altitude of places in. By Capt. W. S. Webb. iv. 376. Kuedistan, Notes of a journey through, in 1838. By Jas. Brant, x. 341. Travels in, with notices of Eastern and Western Tigris and ancient ruins. By J. G. Taylor, xxxv. 21. (See Armenia.) Visit to the Chaldeans of Central, and ascent of Peak of Rowandiz. By Wm. Ainsworth. xi. 21. KuBiA MuEiA Isles. (See Curia Muria.) Kuream Valley, Survey operations in. By Capt. Gerald Martin. (Pro ceedings (N.S.) Vol. i. 617.) " Kuweik Rivee," The, an aqueduct. By D. J. Macgowan. xxxii. 74. Ladakh, Notes on the Pangong Lake district of, made during survey in 1863. By Godwin Austen, xxxvii. 343. Lakeeadbevh Aeceipelago, Extract from Lieut. Wood's private journal of the. vi. 29. Laos, On the Country of the free. By Dr. Gutzlaff. xix. 33. Southern, and Cambodia. By H. D. Kennedy, xxxvii. 298. Leh to Yarkand and Kashgar, Journey from, and exploration of the sources of the Yarkand. By G. W. Hayward. xl. 33. Asiatic Papers. 169 Lhasa, Nepal to. Route surveys. By Col. Montgomerie. (Proceedings, VoL xii. 146.) Lingah, Kishm, and Bunder Abbass, Visit to. By Lieut.-Col. Lewis Pelly. xxxiv. 251. Lob Nor, On position of. R. B. Shaw. (Proceedings, VoL xvi. 242.) Lushai Expedition. (Proceedings, Vol. xvii. 42.) Lycus, in Kurdistan, Sources and course of. By J. B. Taylor. (Proceedings, Vol. xi. 97.) Maghian, Notes on M. Fedchenko's Map of. By R. Michell. xUii. 263. Mahanuddy, On the basin of the river. A geographical abstract of a report by Mr. R. Temple, xxxv. 70. (Proceedings, Vol. ix. 81.) Malay States, Geography of Perak and Salangore. By W. B. D'Almeida. xlvi. 357. Maldiva Islands, Some geographical remarks on, and the navigable channels between the Atolls. By J. Horsburgh. ii. 72. On tbe. By Capt. Owen, e.n. ii. 81. Mardian Hills. (See Bustar.) Manchuria, Notes on. By Rev. A. WiUianlson, b.a. xxxix. 1. (Pro ceedings, Vol. xiii. 26.) Palladius's Journey through. (Proceedings, Vol. xvi. 204.) Notes on the Russian harbours on the coast of. By Rev. W. V. Lloyd, R.N. xxxvii. 212. (Proceedings, Vol. xi. 263.) An expedition through, from Pekin to Blagovestcbensk. By Palladius. xiii. 142. Mangi, Notes on Southern. By Geo. PhUUps. xliv. 97. (Proceedings, Vol. xviii. 168.) Mazandbran, Memoranda to accompany part of a sketch of, &c., in April, 1836. By Major B. D'Arcy Todd. viii. 101. Medina and Mecca, Journey from Cairo via Suez, &c., to, in 1845. By Dr. G. A. Wallin. xxiv. 115. Journey to, with route from Yambu. By Lieut. Burton. xxiv. 208. Journey from, to Mecca, down the Darb-el-sbarki, or Bastei-n Road, in Sept. 1853. By Lieut. Burton, xxv. 121. Mekean, Mission into, for political and survey purposes, in Dec. 1861. By Major Goldsmid. xxxiii. 181. (Proceedings, Vol. vii. 91.) Coast, Journey from Gwadur to Karachi. By Capt. S. B.' Miles. xliv. 163. Route from Jask to Bampur. By B. A. Floyer. xlvii. 188. Journey through. By Major E. C. Ross. (Proceedings, Vol. xvi. 139 and 219.) Meev, The road to. By Sir H. Rawlinson. (Proceedings (N.S.) Vol. i. 161.) Mesopotamia, On part of, contained between Sheriat-el-Beytha, on tbe Tigris, and Tel Ibrahim. By Lieut. Bewsher. xxxvii. 160. (Proceedings, Vol. xi. 155.) Notes of an excursion to Kalab Sherkat, the Ur of the Persians, and to tbe Euins of Al Hadhr. By Wm. Ainsworth. xi. 1. A journey from Baghdad to the ruins of Opis and the Median wall. By John Eoss, m.d. xi. 121. 170 Asiatic Papers. MiDiAN, Memoir explaining the new map of, made by the Egyptian Staff- officers. By E. P. Burton, xlix. 1. MiNicoY, Account of Island of. By Capt. J. Basevi. xiii. 368. MrtfOA AND Nis^A, Remarks on the supposed situation of. By Mr. T. Spratt, E.N. viii. 205. MoHAMEAH, and the vicinity, Notes on the ancient geography of. By Col. Sir H. Rawlinson. xxvii. 185. (Proceedings, Vol. i. 351.) MoKHA to Sana, Narrative of journey from, in July and August 1836. By Mr. Chas. Cruttenden, i.n. viii. 267. Mongolia, Westeen, A journey through. By Ney Elias. xUii. 108. (Pro ceedings, Vol. xvii. 184.) Route by, from Peking to St. Petersburg. By C. M. Grant, xxxiii. 167. (Proceedings, Vol. vii. 27.) Noeth- Western, Pdvtsofs Expedition in. By E. D. Morgan. (Pro ceedings (N.S.) Vol. i. 701.) Mosul, Notes taken on a journey to, from Constantinople, in 1839 and 1840. By Ainsworth. x. 489. Moukden, Manohueia, Narrative of journey from Tientsin to, in July 1861. By A. Miohie, Esq. xxxiii. 153. (Proceedings, Vol. vii. 25.) Mustakh Range, On tbe glaciers of the. By Capt. Godwin- Austen, f.e.g.s. xxxiv. 19. (Proceedings, Vol. viii. 34.) Nagasaki to Yeddo. Journey of Sir R. Alcock. (Proceedings, VoL vi. 196, 200.) Nepal to Lhasa, thence to the source of the Brahmaputra. Report of a route-survey made by the Pundit. By Capt. G. T. Montgomerie, e.b. xxxviii. 129. Nepaul, On the Northern frontier of, from a member of tbe Nepaulese Embassy in London, xx. 262. Nob-Zaisan, The (Lake), and its vicinity. By GenL Abramof. xxxv. 58. Oman, Narrative of a journey into the interior of, in 1835. By Lieut. Well sted, E.I.C.S. vii. 102. Oebnbueqh, orographical survey of the country, from the Eussian MSS. of M. J. Khanikoff. xiii. 278. Obontes, Eiver (in Syria), Notes made on a journey to the somrces of tbe. By W. Burckhardt Barker, Esq. vii. 95. Oxus, Lower, The old channels of. By B. D. Morgan, xlviii. 301. Oxus, Papers connected with tbe Upper. By Colonel H. Yule. xiii. 438. Monograph on. By Sir Henry Eawlinson. xiii. 482. Mouths of. By AdmL Boutakoff. (Proceedings, Vol. xi. 113.) (See Amu Darya.) Palestine, &c.. Extracts from a journey of travels in, in 1838, undertaken for tbe illustration of Biblical Geography. By Eev. E. Eobinson ix 295. Notes on its physical geography, extracted from the letters of Col. von Wildenbruch. xx. 227. Note on. By Mr. A. Petermann. xx. 232. ¦ OutUnes of a journey in, in 1852. By Dr. E. Eobmson, E. Smith, &c. xxiv. 1. Asiatic Papers. 171 Palestine. Eeport of a journey in. By Mr. Henry Poole, xxvi. 56. Eecent surveys. By Major Wilson. (Proceedings, xvii. 326.) Pamir, The, and the sources of the Amu-Daria. By M. Veniukof. xxxvi. 248. Eussian expedition to tbe Alai and. By E. Michell. xlvii. 17. (Proceedings, Vol. xxi. 122.) M. Severtsof s journey in Ferghana and the. (Proceedings (N.S.) Vol. ii. 499.) Pamir Eegion. By Sir Henry Eawlinson. (Proceedings, Vol. x. 134.) Pangong Lake. By Capt. Godwin- Austen. (Proceedings, Vol. xi. 32.) Patkoi Eange, Notes of a trip across. By H. L. Jenkins, xii. 342. Pbohbli Gulf, and the Peiho. By Sherard Osborn. (Proceedings, Vol. iii. 56.) Peking, journey from, to St. Petersburg, across tbe Desert of Gobi. By C. M. Grant, xxxiii. 167. (Proceedings, Vol. vii. 27.) — — Notes of a journey in the N.W. neighbourhood of. By Jones Lamprey, Esq., M.B., 67th Eegt., p.e.g.s. xxxvii. 239. (Proceedings, Vol. xi. 269.) Notes on, and its neighbourhood. By W. Lockhart, Esq. xxxvi. 128. (Proceedings, Vol. x. 154.) Pebsia, Khoeassan and Afghanistan, Notes in. By Capt. Claude Clerk, P.E.G.S. xxxi. 37. Notes. Shahriid to Astrabad. (Proceedings, Vol. xvii. 193.) Notes on Eastern and Western Beluchistan. By Col. F. J. Golds mid, C.B., F.E.G.s. xxxvii. 269. (Proceedings, xvii. 86.) Geographical notes taken during a journey in, in 1849 and 1850. By Keith E. Abbott, h.b.m. xxv. 1. Southern, Observations on geography of. By Sir Henry Eawlinson. (Proceedings, Vol. i. 280.) Persian Gulf. Notes made on a survey along the eastern shores, in 1828. By Lieut. Kempthorne, e.i.c. Marine, v. 263. Concerning the pearl fisheries in the. By Col. D. Wilson, iii. 283. As an area of trade. By Col. L. Pelly. (Proceedings, Vol. vhi. 18.) Descriptive sketch of tbe Islands and Coasts at the entrance. By Lieut. Whitelock, i.n. viii. 170. Persian Teavel, Notes on recent. By Major-Gen. F. Goldsmid. xliv. 183. Peeso-Kblat frontier. Survey of. By Major B. Lovett. (Proceedings, Vol. xvi. 219.) Pbtbb-Bottb Mt. (Mauritius), account of the ascent of, Sept. 7th, 1832. By Lieut. Taylor, e.a. iii. 99. Petea, Extract from Baron Keller's Itinerary of his tour to, describing an overland route from Mount Sinai to Akabab. xii. 75. Pishin Valley. By Gen. Sir M. A. Biddulph. (Proceedings (N.S.) Vol. ii. 212.) Punjab, Kabul, Kashmie and Little Thibet, Eoute through, in 1834-38. By G. T. Vigne. ix. 512. Eageby Hills, Madbas, Account of the. By Col. Monteith. v. 404. Eed Sea, On tbe physical geography of the. By Dr. Buist, of Bombay, f.e.g.s. xxiv. 1^27. 172 Asiatic Papers. Euad, On the Island of. North Syria. By Capt. W. Allen, r.n., p.e.g.s. xxiii. 154. RuNN OP Cutch, Notes on the, and neighbouring region. By Sir Bartie Prere, k.cb. xl. 181. (Proceedings, Vol. xiv. 120.) Saghalin, On the Island of. By Col. Veniukof. xiii. 373. Samaekand. Notes on ruins of. By Fedchenko. (Proceedings, Vol. xv. 392.) Sedasheghue and seaports of India. By Duncan Macpherson. (Proceedings, Vol. vii. 95.) Seleucia, in Piebia, tbe ancient harbour of. By Capt. W. Allen, b.n., F.R.S., P.E.G.S. xxiii. 157. Semipalatinsk. By N. Abramof, member of the Imperial Eussian Geogra phical Society, xxxii. 565. Shan States, Journey to. By C. O'Reily. xxxii. 164. (Proceedings, Vol. vi. 83.) Shantung, Notes on a journey through. By J. Markham, H.M. Consul at Chefoo. xl. 207. (Proceedings, Vol. xiv. 137.) Shieaz to Bam, Surveys on the road from. By Major B. Lovett. xiii. 202. (Proceedings, Vol. xvi. 261.) Shieaz to Fezza and Daebab, thence westward to Kazerun, Notes taken on a journey from, in I860. By Consul Keith E. Abbott, xxvii. 149. Siam, Extracts from the ' Journal of a Residence in, and voyage along coast of China to Mantchou, 1832.' By Rev. Chas. Gutzlaff. iii. 291. Trade of. Journey from Bangkok to Pecha-buri. By Sir R. Schom burgk. (Proceedings, VoL iv. 211.) Through, to Moulmein. By Sir E. Schomburgk. (Proceedings, VoL v. 118.) See Bangkok. Geographical notes on, with new map of tbe lower part of the Menam Eiver. By Harry Parkes, Esq., p.e.g.s. xxvi. 71. Geographical Notes on. By H. Parkes. (Proceedings, Vol. i. 13.) and Cambodia, travels in. By D. 0. King, Esq. xxx. 177. (Pro ceedings, Vol. iii. 365.) Sibbeia, Northern, narrative of M. Middendorfs journey in. Communicated by Admiral von Krusenstern. xiv. 247. Sinai, Notes on tbe map of tbe Peninsula of. By Eev. P. W. Holland. xxxix. 342. (Proceedings, Vol. x. 158 ; xii. 190.) On the Peninsula of. By Rev. P. W. HoUand. xxxviii. 237. (Pro ceedings, xiii. 204.) and Palestine, Recent surveys in. By Major C. W. Wilson, xliii. 206. Sind. By Capt. A. Burnes, b.lcs. vii. 11. SiNGAPUR, Journal of an excursion from, to Malacca and Pinang. By J. E. Lagan, xvi. 304. SiNJAR Hills, a visit to tbe, in 1838, with some account of the sect of Yezidis, &c. By F. Forbes, Esq., m.a. ix. 409. Sistan, Journey from Bandar Abbas to Mash-had, viS. By P. J. Goldsmid. xbii. 65. (Proceedings, Vol. xviL 86.) Visit to tbe Kub-i-Khwajah. By Major B. Lovett, xliv. 145. Notes on. By Sir H. Eawlinson. xliii. 272. (Proceedings, Vol. xvii. 92.) SocOTRA, Memoir on the island of. By Lieut. J. E. Wellsted, e.i.c Marine. V. 129. Asiatic Papers. 173 Southern Laps and Cambodia, Notes of an expedition to, in 1866. By H. G. Kennedy, xxxvii. 298. Susa, On tbe site of. By George Long. iii. 257. See EuL.a;us Eiver. Symi, Sketch of the island and gulf of, on tbe S.W. coast of Anatolia, in 1837. By Jas. Brooke, viii. 129. Syria, On parts of, and Dead Sea. vii. 456. Tabbiz, Itinerary from, to Tebran,in 1837. By Major E. D'Arcy Todd. viii. 29. Notes of a journey from, through Kurdistan, to Suleimaniyeh in 1836. By Lieut.-Col. J. Shiel. viii. 64. Notes of a journey from, through Persian Kurdistan to tbe ruins of Takhti-Soleiman, thence to Gi'lan in 1838 ; with memoir on site of Atropatenian Bcbatana. By H. C. Rawlinson. x. 1. Tadum, Journey from Kumaon to, and back along the Kali Gandak to British Territory. By Major T. G. Montgomerie. xiv. 350. Tal — Cho'tia'li Field Force, Account of the country traversed by the second column of the. By Lieut. R. 0. Temple, xlix. 190. Talifu. See China. Tanghi Daeia, a branch of the Jaxartes. On the desiccation of. By M. Khanikoff. xiv. 333. Tavium, Observations on the position of. By W. J. Hamilton, Esq. vii. 74. Tehama, Notes on a collection of plants from the. By John Lindley, f.b.s. V. 296. Tehean to Alamut and Khueebm-Abad, Itinerary from, in May 1837. By Lieut.-Col. Justin Shiel. viii. 430. THfioHlis, Mount (of Xenophon), Identification of the. By M. P. Rorit. xl. 463. Thibet. See Tibet. Tian-Shan Celestial Range, A journey to tbe western portion of the, from western Umits of the Trans-Hi Region to Tashkend. By N. Severtsof. xL 343. First ascent of the, and visit to upper course of the Jaxartes or Syr- Daria, in 1867. By P. P. Semenof. xxxi. 356. Tibet and Sbfan. By Dr. Chas. Gutzlaff. xx. 191. Physical Geography of Western. By Capt. Henry Strachey, Bengal Army, xxiii. 1. Journey to Shigatze. By T. G. Montgomerie. xiv. 330. A fourth Excursion to tbe passes into Tibet by the Donkiah Lab. By Dr. J. D. Hooker, xx. 49. ¦ Visit to Daba in. By Capt. Bennet. (Proceedings, Vol. x. 165.) Geeat, Travels in, and trade with Bengal. By C. R. Markham. xiv. 299. (Proceedings, Vol. xix. 327.) . Account of the Pundit's journey in. By Capt. H. Trotter. xlviL 86. Western. Exploration by Parties of the Indian Survey. (Proceedings (N.S.) Vol. i. 444.) The Pundit's journey from Leh to Lhdsa and return to India via Assam. By Capt. H. Trotter, (froceedings, Vol. xxi. 326.) Attempt of Native Envoy to reach Missionaries in. By Capt. Gregory. (Proceedings, Vol. xiv. 214.) See Geeat Tibet. T. T. Cooper on. (Proceedings, Vol. xiii. 392.) 174 Asiatic Papers. Tigris, Note accompanying a survey of the, between Ctesiphon and Mosul. By Lieut. H. Blosse Lynch, i.n. ix. 441. Note on a part of the, between Baghdad and Samarrah. By Lieut. H. B. Lynch, i.n. ix. 471. Sources of. By J. G. Taylor. (Proceedings, Vol. ix. 36.) Trans-Himalayan Explorations, Eeport of tbe, during 1867. By Capt. T. G. Montgomerie, e.e. xxxix. 146. (Proceedings, Vol. xiii. 183; xiv. 207.) Teans-Indus Feontiee of British India, Notes on the highland region adjacent to the. By Major James Walker, xxxii. 303. Trans-Indus Teeritoeies, etc Notes on the Flora of the country passed through by Brigadier-Gen. Chamberlain's force in 1860. By Dr. J. L. Stuart, xxxii. 316. Teans-Naeyn Countey, Expedition to, in 1867. By Baron P. R. Osten- Sacken. xl. 260. (Proceedings, Vol. xiv. 221.) Teavancobe, On the inland navigation of ; an account of the AUpee Mud- bank and tbe Wurkallay Barrier. By 0. R. Markham, f.s.a. xxxvi. 195. (Proceedings, Vol. xi. 78.) Troy, Observations on the Topography of. By Dr. P. W. Forchhammer. xii. 28. TsAi-SAN Lake. By General Abramof. (Proceedings, Vol. ix. 40.) TsusiMA, Japan, A visit to tbe Island of. By Laurence OUpbant, f.e.g.s. xxxiii. 178. TuECOMAN frontier of Persia. Capt. tbe Hon. G. Napier's Journey. (Pro ceedings, Vol. XX. 166.) TuEKisTAN. Progress of Russian exploration. By E. D. Morgan. (Pro ceedings, Vol. xiv. 229.) Astronomical Points fixed by Struve in, from 1865 to 1868. xxxix. 338. ¦ Eastben, a Prince of Kashgar on the geography of. By R. B. Shaw. xlvi. 277. (Proceedings, Vol. xx. 482 ; xvii. 195.) Account of an Expedition to west shore of Issikul Lake. By P. Semenoff. xxxix. 311. Trade between, and India. By Sir Henry Rawlinson. (Proceedings, xiii. 10.) Transit of tea from N.W. India to. (Proceedings, Vol. xiii. 198.) TuBKOMANiA, Col. Stebnitzky's Report on his joui-ney, in 1872, in Central and Southern, xliv. 217. Tyee, Extract from a notice on the site of Ancient. By Count de Berton. ix. 286. Ural Mountains, Observations on the, to accompany a new map of the southern portion of that chain. By Sir E. I. Murchison. xiii. 269. Extract from tbe reports of M. Hoffman, Chief of an expedition to the North Ural. xix. 31. UxiAN City, besieged by Alexander the Great; on its probable site. By tbe Baron C. A. de Bode. xiii. 108. Wadi-bl- Ababa, On the Watershed of. By Capt. W. Allen, e.n. xxiii. 166. Wakhan. By Sir H. Eawlinson. (Proceedings, Vol. xvu. 108.) Yang-tsze-Kiang, Notes on the, &c. By Dr. Alfred Barton, f.e.g.s. xxxii. 26. Asiatic Papers. 175 Yang-tsze-Kiang, Notes on the, from Han-kow to Pingshau. By Lieut.-Col. H. A. SareL xxxii. 1. (Proceedings, Vol. vi. 2.) Special mission up the. By E. Swinhoe. xl. 268. (Proceedings, Vol. xiv. 235.) On the. By the Eight Hon. Lord Colchester and Capt. CoUinson, b.n. xvu. 130. On tbe inundations of the. By B. L. Oxenham. xiv. 170. (Pro ceedings, Vol. xix. 244. Yangtsze-kiang, tbe, and the Hwang-Ho or Yellow River. By Wm. Lockhart. xxviii. 288. (Proceedings, Vol. ii. 201.) or Takiang, from Wusung to Hankow, Notes of a voyage up. By Laurence Oliphant, Esq. f.e.g.s. With Chart of tbe river by Capt. Sherard Osborn, e.n. xxx. 75. (Proceedings, Vol. iii. 162.) Yangtsb-kbang, Ascent of the. By WiUiam Blackney, e.n. xxx. 93. Yaekand, On the geographical position of, and otber places in Central Asia. By Capt. T. G. Montgomerie, e.b. xxxvi. 157. Visit to, and Kashgar. By R. B. Shaw. (Proceedings, Vol. xiv. 124.) — — ¦ Mr. Shaw's observation for longitude. (Proceedings, Vol. xv. 180.) Ibrahim Khan. Route from Kashmir to. (Proceedings, Vol. xv. 387.) Results of observations taken during expedition to. By Mr. Sbaw. xU. 373. (Proceedings, Vol. x. 162.) Route of Mahomed Amir from Jelalabad to. (Proceedings, Vol. xiii. 122.) Journey of Mr. Hayward to Kashgar and. (Proceedings, Vol. xiv. 41.) Yellow Rivee, Notes of a journey to the new course of the, in 1868. By Ney Elias, Esq., f.e.g.s. xl. 1. (Proceedings, Vol. xiv. 20.) Yemen, Notes of a journey in. By C. MiUingen. xliv. 118. (Proceedings, Vol. xviii. 194.) Yenisei, Visit to the Valley of. By H. Seebohm. xlviii. 1. (Proceedings, xxii. 101.) Yesso, Japan, The western shores of Volcano Bay. By Comm. Forbes, e.n. xxxvi. 173. (Proceedings, Vol. x. 169.) A journey in. By Capt. T. Blakiston. xiii. 77. (Proceedings, VoL xvi. 188.) Notes on East, Nortb-Bast, and West Coasts of. By Comm. St. John. xiii. 343. Yunnan, W. Visit of Ney BUas to valley of Shueli in. (Proceedings, Vol. XX. 234.) T. T. Cooper on. (Proceedings, Vol. xv. 163.) Zaeafshan Valley, Topographical sketch of the. By Mr. A. Fedchenko. xl. 448. Zayton, Notes on the identity of. By Rev. C. Douglas, xliv. 112. ZoHAB, at the foot of Zagros, Notes on a march from, to Khuzistan (Susiana), thence to Kirmanshah. By Major Rawlinson. is. 26. AFEICA. Abbeokuta. By Capt. E. P. Burton. (Proceedings, Vol. vi. 49, 64.) Abyssinia, Eoutes in, and the neighbouring countries. By Dr. Beke. x. 580. 176 African Peepers. Abyssinia. On a map of the Eoute from Tajurrah to Ankober. By Dr. Beke. xiii. 182. Prom Metemma to Damot, along the Western shores of the Tana Sea. By H. Blanc, m.d., f.e.o.s.b. xxxix. 36. (Proceedings, Vol. xiii. 39. Danakil Tribes, Notes on the. xii. 268. Journey to, in 1862. By S. W. Baker, xxxiii. 237. The Portuguese expeditions to, in the 15th, 16tb, and 17th centuries. By C. E. Markham, Secretary, e.g.s. xxxviii. 1. (Proceedings, Vol. xii. 11.) Memorandum on. Communicated from the Foreign Office, xxv. 215. Communications respecting tbe geography of Southern. By Dr. C. Tilstone Beke. xii. 84. Eeport on the route from Tajurra to Ankobar. By Asst. Surgeon Kirk, xiL 221. ¦ On the route from Ankobar to Dima. By Dr. Beke. xii. 245. On the countries South of. By Dr. Beke. xiii. 264. Continuation of routes in. By Dr. Beke. xiv. 1. Note by Dr. Beke on Mr. Ayrton's Paper, xx. 289. Nile Tributaries in. By S. Baker. (Proceedings, Vol. x. 279.) Abyssinian Expedition, Geographical results of the. By C. E. Markham. xxxviu. 12. (Proceedings, Vol. xii. 113. 298.) Narrative of captivity in, and journey from Metemma to Damot. By Dr. Blanc. (Proceedings, Vol. xiii. 39.) Afae Countey, Narrative of a journey through the. By W. Munzinger. xxxix. 188. (Proceedings, Vol. xiii. 219.) (See Danakil.) Afeioa, Physical Geography of Inner. By Sir Roderick Murchison. (Pro ceedings, viii. 151.) Letter from John Duncan to the Librarian of tbe Society, xv. 346. Notes on African Geography. By Macqueen. xv. 371. Notes taken during travels in. By Baron J. W. von Miiller, xx. 275. Notes on the present state of tbe geography of some parts cf. By Jas. M'Queen, Esq. xx. 235. Major Serpa Pinto's march across. (Proceedings (N.S.) Vol. i. 481.) Akbm, On tbe district of. By Capt. J. S. Hay. xlvi. 299. (Proceedings, Vol. XX. 475.) Albebt Nyanza, Account of the discovery of tbe second great lake of tbe Nile. By S. W. Baker, xxxvi. 1. (Proceedings, Vol. x. 6.) Journey towards. By Lieut. Chippendale. (Proceedings, Vol. xx. 67.) On the circumnavigation of. By R. Gessi. (Proceedings, Vol. xxi. 50 ; Vol. xx. 470.) Alexander, Capt., Latest intelligence from. vii. 439. Ankobee, Extracts of a journal kept at, from 7th June to 2nd Oct. 1839. By Eev. J. L. Krapf. x. 469. Aeguin, Account of the Island off the West Coast of Africa. By Capt. Grover, p.e.s. xvi. 162. Ascension, Communications on the Island of. By Capt. Brandreth, e.e., and Mrs. Col. Power, v. 243. Atbaba and its tributaries. By S. Baker. (Proceedings, Vol. vii. 21.) Atlas Mountains, Ascent of. By Sir J. Hooker. (Proceedings, Vol. xv 212.) African Papers. Vll Bamangwato Country. By Capt. E. E. Patterson. (Proceedings (N.S.) Vol. i. 240.) Batonga Country, Elephant Mountains in. E. F. Burton. (Proceedings, Vol. vii. 104.) Benguela to Ibo and Mozambique, journeys of Silva Porto witb tbe Arabs from, through Africa, from 1852 to 1864. By Jas. Macqueen. xxx. 136. (Proceedings, Vol. i. 75.) Bahe el Ghazal. Mme. Tinne. (Proceedings, VoL viii. 12.) Benin and the Upper Course of tbe Quorra or Niger. By Capt. Becroft. xi. 184. Benzeeta, Lakes of, in tbe Regency of Tunis. By Lieut. Spratt. e.n. xvi. 251. Bbebnice, Notice on the ruins of. By Lieut. Wellsted, i.n. vi. 96. BiDA, in Nup^, to Kano, in Haussa, Notes of a journey from, in 1862. By Dr. Baikie, e.n. xxxvii. 92. BiNUE Rivee, Ascent of, in 1879, with remarks on the systems of the Shary and BiNUB. By E. Hutchinson. (Proceedings (N.S.) Vol. ii. 289.) Bulama Island, west coast of Africa. Visit of Governor O'Conor to. (Pro ceedings, Vol. i. 42.) Bushman Land. By Dr. Moffatt. (Proceedings, Vol. ii. 77.) Cairo to I'fat, Abstract of journal kept by Rev. Messrs. Isenberg and Krapf on the journey in 1839. Communicated by Church Missionary Society, x. 455. Cameron, Commander, r.n. Journey to Ujiji. (Proceedings, Vol. xix. 136.) Surveyof Tanganyika. (Proceedings, Vol. xix. 246.) Journey across Africa. Letter from. (Proceedings, VoL xx. 118, 304.) Cambroons, Excursion up the river of, to the Bay of Amboises. By Capt. Allen, R.N. xiii. 1. Mount, Excursion Inland from. By Rev. T. J. Comber. (Pro ceedings (N.S.) Vol. i. 225.) Burton's ascent of. (Proceedings, Vol. vi. 238.) Canary Islands, Survey of some of the, and of part of W. Coast of Africa in 1835. By Lieut. Ariett, r.n. vi. 285. Ethnographical remarks on tbe original language of their inhabi tants. By Don. J. J. da Costa de Macedo. xi. 171. Cape Colony, On tbe roads and Kloofs in the. By Major Michell, r.e. vi. 168. On steam communication with Australia and the Cape. By Capt. J. L. Stokes, E.N. xxvi. 183. (Proceedings, Vol. i. 79.) Discovery of diamonds. Professor Tennant. (Proceedings. Vol. xii. 322. Cape Coast, Note of a journey from, to Whyddah on W. coast of Africa. By Mr. John Duncan, xvi. 143. Cape Palmas, and the Mena or Kroomen. Communicated by Dr. Francis Bacon, xii. 196. Caeavan Journey from E. to W. coast of Africa. Notice of communication by Vice-Consul Brand, through the Foreign Office, with Remarks by W. D. Cooley. xxiv. 266. Centbal Afeica, Geographical notes of the Khedive's expedition to. By- Lieut. Julian A. Baker, e.n. xliv. 37. (Proceedings, Vol. xviii. 50, 131.) N 178 African Papers. Central Africa, Discoveries by H. M. Stanley. Speech by the Prince of Wales. (Proceedings, Vol. xxii. 165.) Central South Afeioa, Journey through, from the Diamond fields to the Upper Zambesi. By Dr. E. Holub. (Proceedings (N.S.) VoL ii. 166.) Notes on the Chobe River. By Dr. Bradsbaw. (Proceedings (N.S.) Vol. iii. p. 208.) Central Africa. Eeport of explorers under Dr. A. Smith, vi. 394. . Failure in exploring interior of, from original documents in tbe office of the E.G.S. ii. 305. Central African, New route and new mode of travelling into. By J. Mullens. (Pircceedings, Vol. xxi. 233.) Central Afeican Expedition of Livingstone. (Proceedings, VoL iv. 19.) Centbal Africa, Mission to. Progress of tbe Misson, consisting of Messrs. Eichardson, Barth, and Overweg. xxi. 130. ¦ ¦ Noeth. By Dr. Barth. (Proceedings, VoL ii. 217.) Letters from Vogel's expedition, xxiv. 276. (Proceedings, VoLiL30.) Letter from Dr. Barth to Dr. Beke, from Timbuctoo. xxiv. 283. Letters from Vogel. xxv. 237. Notes on geography of. By James Macqueen. (Proceedings, Vol. i. 12 ; Vol. iii. 362.) Expeditions by tbe Furanys. xxiii. 120. Letters from Ladislaus Magyar, xxiv. 271. Notes on geography of. By Macqueen. xxvi. 109. (Proceedings, Vol. iii. 208.) ¦ Historical Description. By Barth. xxx. 112. Chad Lake, Journey to, and vicinity. By Dr. Nachtigal. xlvi. 396. Chore Rivee. By Dr. Bradsbaw. (Proceedings (N.S.) Vol. iii. 208.) CiNNAMOMiFBRA (Eegio) of the Ancicnts. By D. Cooley. xix. 166. CoLESBERG to Steinkopf, Joumey in 1854-56. By R. Moffatt. xxviii. 153. Congo, Dr. Behm, on Livingstone's exploration of the Upper. (Proceedings, Vol. xvii. 21.) Ascent by Comm. Hunt, e.n. (Proceedings, Vol. ii. 374.) On. By Capt. Bedingfield. (Proceedings, Vol. iv. 66.) Proceedings of Lieut. Grandy. (Proceedings, Vol. xix. 78.) Account of recent journeys in the interior of. By Rev. T. J. Comber. (Proceedings (N.S.)Vol. iii. 20.) Note on Lieut. Grandy's map of his journey from Ambriz to San Salvador and tbe. By W. J. Turner, xlvi. 428. Journey through to Makuta. By Rev. T. J. Comber. (Proceedings, VoL i. 225, N.S.) Geographical sketch of basin of, and Nile. By H. M. Stanley. (Proceed ings, Vol. xxii. 382.) CuNENE Rivee, Green, Hahn, and Rath. (Proceedings, Vol. ii. 350.) Damaea Land, Notes to accompany Andersen's map of. By Thos. Baines. xxxvi. 247. Damaeas of South Afeica, Capt. Alexander's intended visit to the. vi. 443. Dae es Salaam, Routes from, towards Lake Nyassa. By Keith Johnston. (Proceedings (N.S.) Vol. i. 417.) African Papers. 179 Dae es Salaam, Country between, and Kilwa. , By Capt. Elton. (Proceed ings, Vol. xix. 110.) DanAkil Tbibes, Notes on. xii. 268. Davidson, Mr., Letter from, dated Wednoon. vi. 429. Notices of. vii. 144. Delagoa Bay, On the civilisation of the Tribes inhabiting the Highlands near. By W. D. Cooley. Ui. 310. Journey from Natal to, thence to gold-fields near Leydenberg. By Percy Hope. xUv. 203. East Afeica, exploration in. By Count C. von Krockow. xxxvi. 198. • On tbe coast country of. South of Zanzibar. By Capt. Elton. xUv. 227. Routes of native caravans from coast to interior. By J. Wake field, xl. 303, Extract from a journal by Lieut. Christopher, on tbe coast of. xiv. 76. On. By Lieut. Barker, xviii. 130. On. By Lieut. Cruttenden, (i.n.). xviii. 136. Expedition of Burton and Speke. (Proceedings, Vol. ui. 348.) Expedition of Speke and Grant. (Proceedings, Vol. v. 11-127 ; VoL vi. 17 ; Vol. vii. 20.) Special reception of Speke and Grant. (Pro ceedings, Vol. vii. 213-217.) • English captives in. By General Rigby. (Proceedings, Vol. x. 113.) Notes on Wakefield's map of. By Keith Johnston. (Proceedings, Vol. xvi. 125.) Native routes in. By Keith Johnston. (Proceedings (N.S.) Vol. i. 417.) Remarks on coast of. By Sir Bartie Frere. (Proceedings, Vol. xvn. 343.) East African Expedition, Discoveries of, under Capt. Speke. xxxiii. 334. (Proceedings, Vol. ii. 52.) ¦ ¦ ¦ A coasting voyage from Mombasa to tbe Pangani River ; visit to Sultan Kimwere. By Capt. Burton and J. H. Speke. xxviii. 188. The lake regions of Central equatorial Africa, witb notices of lunar mountains, and sources of " White Nile." By Capt. Burton, xxtx. Of tbe R.G.S. Notes on the route taken. By J. Thomson. (Pro ceedings (N.S.) VoL u. 102.) Progress of, Thomson's Eeport on journey from Lake Nyassa to Lake Tanganyika. (Proceedings (N.S.) Vol. ii. 209.) Progress of the Society's; journey along Western side cf Lake Tanganyika. By J. Thomson. (Proceedings (N.S.) VoL n. 306.) Journey of the Society's. By J. Thomson. (Proceedings (N.S.) Vol. ii. 721.) Egypt, Some account of the Natron Lakes of. From Sir Gardner Wilkinson. xiii. 113. Equatorial Afeica, Lake region of. By Col. Grant, xiii. 243. Khedive's Expedition to Lake Districts of. By Col. C. E. Gordon. (Proceedings, Vol. xxi. 56.) Geographical and scientific results of the. (Proceedings, Vol. xxi. 63.) N 2 180 African Papers. Equatoeial Africa, East, Snowy Mountains of. By Baron von Decken. (Proceedings, Vol. viii. 5.) Equatoeial Western Afeica. By Du ChaiUu. (Proceedings, Vol. v. 108.) Febnando Noeonha, a visit to. By A. Rattray, xiii. 431. Gambia and Carsamanza Ritees, Supposed junction, on W. Coast of Africa. By E. W. Hay. iii. 72. Mohammed Sisei, a Mandingo of Nyani-Maru on the. By Capt. Washington, -yiii. 448. EivBB, Abridged account of an expedition of about 200 miles up the. By Governor Ingram, xvii. 150. Gaza Land, Two journeys in. By St. Vincent Erskine. xlviii. 25. (Pro ceedings, Vol. xxii. 127.) (See Mozambique.) Ghadamas, Joumey from Tripoli to. By Vice-Consul C. H. Dickson, xxii. 131. Account of. By Dickson, xxx. 255. Ghat, Eoute from to Tawat, through the middle of the " Sahara.'' Com municated by Mr. Richardson, xvi. 268. Gold Region. (See Limpopo.) GoEDON, Colonel. Expedition. On tbe progress of. By Sir H. EawUnson. (Proceedmgs, Vol. xx. 50 ; VoL xxi. 56 ; Vol. xxi. 63.) xlvi. 381. Haeae, a trip to. By Lieut. Burton, xxv. 136. Its probable position, with information relative to tribes in its vicinity. By Lieut. Barker, i.n. xii. 238. Ijebu Countey, Journey to Od^ in. By Capt. Bedingfield. (Proceedings, Vol. vii. 105.) Ivory Teadb. By Dr. Vogel. (Proceedings, Vol. i. 215.) Jamooe Ri-stbe, On its mouths. By Rev. Jobn Clark, xvi. 255. Jimma Countey (s.w. of Berbera), Account of the. Communicated by Sir J. Gardner Wilkinson, xxv. 206. Juba River, Death of Baron Von der Decken on the. ("Proceedings, Vol. x. 109.) ^ Kilimakjabo and tbe White Nile. By Macqueen. xxx. 128. Mountain. Thornton. (Proceedings, VoL vi. 47. ; Vol. ix. 16.) Ascent of, by Revs. New and Bushell. (Proceedings, Vol. xvi. 167.) KiNGANi Eiver, Bast Africa. By P. Holmwood. xlvii. 253. KoBDOPAN. Notes of a journey to. By Holroyd. ix. 163. and Dabfur, Astronomical observations in. By Major H. G. Prout. xlix. 392. ^ ¦¦ KosTANTiNAH, Heights obtained during tbe Campaign of September, 1837. viii. 226. ^ Kroomen. (See Cape Palmas.) Kubbababish A5ABS, On the, between Dongola and Kordofan. By M. Par kyns XX. 254. KwoEA and Chadda, Expl jring trip up tbe rivers. By Dr. Baikie. xxv. 108. African Papers. 181 Limpopo, The, its origin, course, and tributaries. By Thos. Baines. xxiv. 288, Exploration to the mouth of. By St.Vincent W. Erskine. xxxix. 233, (Proceedings, Vol. xiii. 320.) Exploration of. By Capt. P. Elton. xUi. 1. (Proceedings, Vol. xvi. 89.) and Zambesi, Account of gold-bearing region between. By Baines. xii, 100. (Proceedings, Vol. xv. 147.) Livingstone, Festival. (Proceedings, Vol. ii. 116.) • ¦ Progress of. (Proceedings, Vol. xii. 175. ; Vol. xv. 115 — 335.) Letters respecting. (Proceedings, Vol. xiv. 8 to 16.) Search Expedition, Eeport of the. By Young, xxxviii. 111. Dr., Eeports on death of. (Proceedings, Vol. xviii. 221.) Letters from. (Proceedings, Vol. xviu. 265.) Government aid to. (Proceedings, Vol. xiv. 334.) Proposed search expedition. (Proceedings, Vol. xvi. 124.) C. R. Markham on a search and relief expedition for. (Proceedings, VoL xvi. 158.) Search Expedition. (Proceedings, Vol. xvi. 102, 145, 184, 203, 225, 241.) (See South Africa, Ngami, Nyassa, Zambesi.) LupiJi, River Delta. Examination by Dr. Kirk. (Proceedings, xviii. 74.) Madagascae. (See Indian Ocean.) Mandingo. (See Gambia.) Marooco Geographical notice of tbe Empire of. By Lieut. Washington. i. 123. ' Vocabulary of the names of places in. By Count Graberg. vii. 243. (See Atlas.) Masasi. (See Rovuma.) Massombdes to Caemdo, Journey of Joao, in 1841. By Macqueen. xxx. 161. Matabeli Land, Notes on. By Capt. E. E. Patterson. (Proceedings (N.S.) Vol. i. 509.) Mayotta and the Comoro Islands. By T. S. Leigh, xix. 7. Mohammedu-Sisei, a Mandingo of Nyani-Maru on the Gambia. By Capt. Washington, b.n. viii. 448. Mombas and neighbouring coast. By Lieut. Emery, b.n. iii. 280. Mombasa, Journey from the Pangani to. By Chas. New. xiv. 414. (Pro ceedings, Vol. xix. 317.) Moselekatse, King of the Matebele, a visit to. By Eev. E. Moffatt. xxvi. 84. Mozambique, Third and fourth journeys in Gaza or Southern. By St. Vin cent Erskine. xlviii. 25. (Proceedings, xxii. 127.) Namaquas, Great, Boschmans, and HUl Damaras. Expedition through. By Capt. Alexander, viii. 1. By Moffat. (Proceedings, Vol. ii. 77-158.) Natal, Tbe physical geography, and climate of. By R. J. Mann, xxxvii. 48. (Proceedings, Vol. xi. 18.) . , Cotton plantations in. Letter from Capt. Stokes, r.n. xix. 33. Ngami, Second visit to Lake. By Rev. D. Livingstone, xxi. 18. 182 African Papers. Nigeb, Expedition to detei-mine the course and termination of, from Yaaori to the Sea. By E. and J. Lauder, i. 179. Delta, Notes accompanying a Chart of a portion of tbe. By R. D. Boler. xlvi. 411. Voyage up, from Lagos to Bida. By Rev. J. Milum. (Proceedings, (N.S.) Vol. iii. 26. Notes on. P. V. Robins. (Proceedings, Vol. x. 116.) Notes on the Eiver, by Bishop Crowther. (Proceedings, Vol. xxi. 481.) Expedition. By Dr. Baikie. (Proceedings, VoL ii. 83 ; vi. 22 ; vii. 66 ; xi. 49.) Nile, White. On sources of. By A. W. Twyford. (Proceedings, Vol. i. 503.) Land journey westward, by J. Petherick. xxxv. 289. Notes to accompany a survey ofthe, from Lardo to Nyamyungo. By Col. Gordon, xlvi. 431. Notes to accompany a Survey of, from Khartum to Eigaf. By Lieut. C. Watson, xlvi. 412. Petherick on tbe. (Proceedings, Vol. iv. 39.) Petherick on Sources. (Proceedings, Vol. iv. 223.) Petherick (Proceedings, VoL v. 27, 40, 41; vi. 18; vii. 20; viii. 122, 146.) , Lieut. Watson's astronomical observations at positions on the Nile. xlvi. 417. ¦ Peney, expedition from Gondokoro. (Proceedings, VoL vi. 18.) Letter on exploration of Sir Samuel Baker. (Proceedings, VoL XV. 92.) Report on tbe calculations of heights from Watson's observations on the. By R. Strachan. xlvi. 421. Meteorological Observations taken on the White Nile, between Khartum and Rigaf. By Lieut. Watson, xlvi. 424. Above Gondokoro. By J. Kemp. (Proceedings, Vol. xix. 324.) Nile, Livingstone's last journey to, and tbe probable ultimate sources of tbe. By Findlay. xxxvii. 193. (Proceedings, Vol. xi. 232.) Upper Basin of, by inspection and information. By Capt. Speke. xxxiii. 322. On the, and on tbe present and former levels of Egypt. By Sir J. G. Wilkinson, ix. 431. and its Tributaries. By C. Beke. xvii. 1. Comments on M. d'Abbadie's discovery of the sources of the White Nile. By P. Ayrton. xviii. 48. Observations on, between Dufli and Magungo. By Col. Gordon. (Pro ceedings, Vol. xxi. 48.) Notes on the Victoria NUe, between Magungo and Poweira. By Col. Gordon. (Proceedings, Vol. xxi. 49.) Geographical notes on. By Prof. Paul Chaix. xix. 143. H. M. Stanley's Geographical sketch of basin of, and that of Congo. (Proceedings, Vol. xxii. 382.) North Africa, routes in. By John Bekr es Seddik. vi. 100. NuSez Rivee, Eeport on its trade and resom-ces. By Lieut. Comm. Lysaght. xix. 29. Nyam Nyam Country. By Dr. Junker. (Proceedings (N.S.) Vol. iii. 301.) African Papers. 183 Nyassa, Livingstone's expedition to Lake, in 1861-63. xxxiii. 250. Pro ceedings, iv. 87 ; vii. 18. Explorations to W. of Lake in 1863. By Livingstone, xxxiv. 246. Lake Mission. By E. D. Young. (Proceedings, Vol. xx. 451.) second circumnavigation of. By Dr. Jas. Stewart. (Proceedings, (N.S.) Vol. i. 289.) Eeport of expedition of Mr. Young. (Proceedings, Vol. xiL 79.) Journey along part of W. side of. By Dr. Laws. (Proceedings (N.S.) Vol. i. 305.) Eoutes towards, by Keith Jobnston. (Proceedings (N. S.) Vol. i. 417.) On tbe, and journey to Zanzibar. By H. B. Cotterill. (Proceedings,' Vol. xxii. 233.) Observations on W. side of, and on tbe country between, and Tangan yika. By G. James Stewart. (Proceedings (N.S.) Vol. ii. 428.) - — - On a recent sojourn at Lake. By E. D. Young. (Proceedings, Vol. xxi. 226.) Lake, and the water route to tbe lake region of Africa. By J. Stewart, c.e. (Proceedings (N.S.) iii. 257.) N'yassi, or the Great lake of S. Africa, its geography investigated. By Cooley. XV. 185. Further explanations in geography of. By Cooley. xvi. 138. Old Calabae, Ascent of, in 1836. By Oldfield. vii. 195. Is it a branch of the river Quorra ? By Capt. Allen, e.n. vii. 198. Old Calabar Eivbb, Explorations of, in 1841 and 1842. By Capt. Becroft and King. xiv. 260. By Capt. J. B. Walker. (Proceedings, Vol. xvi. 1 35.) Ooowfi Eiver, Joumey of E. B. Walker up. (Proceedings, Vol. xvii. 354.) Obange, or 'Gaeiep Rivee, South Africa, Water Supply in tbe Basin of the. By Jas. Pox Wilson, xxxv. 106. (Proceedings, Vol. ix. 106.) Oeange Rivee, Joumey from Little Namaqua-Land eastward, in Aug., 1856. By Robert Moffatt. xxviii. 174. . ¦ Free State, and country of Transvaal Boers ; a trading trip into. By John Sanderson, xxx. 233. Palmas. (See Cape Palmas.) Petheeick. (See Nile.) Pigafetta's Map of. By R. H. Major. (Proceedings, Vol. xi. 246.) Peinoe's Island and Anno Bom, In tbe Bight of Biafra ; memoir descriptive of. By Capt. Boteler, e.n. ii. 274. QuANZA, On tbe Eiver. By Carl Alexanderson. xlvi. 428. Quilimane River, Note on. By Capt. Hyde Parker. (Proceedings, Vol. i. 312.) QuoEEA, is it the same river as tbe Niger of the Ancients ? By W. Martin Leake, ii. 1. Letter from J. Becroft. vi. 424. (See Niger.) (See Kwoea.) Ebd Sea, Notes on Bruce's Chart of Coasts of. By Lieut. J. E. WeUsted. v. 286. . Notes on names of places on shores of. By A. Thompson D'Abbadie. ix. 317. . . Physical geography of. (See under Asia.) xxiv. 227. 184 African Papers. Regio Cennamomifeea of the Ancients. By D. Cooley. xix. 166. Eovuma and Masasi, District. By Eev. C. Maples. (Proceedings (N.S.) Vol. ii. 337.) Eovuma Eiver East Africa, Notes of expeditions up the. By John Kirk. xxxv. 164. (Proceedings, Vol. ix. 284.) Dr. Livingstone on the. (Proceedings, Vol. vi. 20.) D. J. May, e.n., on the. (Proceedings, Vol. vi. 36.) Eufiji Rivee, Survey of lower course of. By Capt. G. L. Sulivan, e.n. xiv. 364. Sahara, Letter from Davidson, dated at Wednoon, near. vi. 429. Sennae, Lord Prudhoe's journey from Cairo to, in 1829 ; describing the Penin sula of Sennar. v. 38. SiEEEA Leone, Mr. W. 0. Thomson's journey from, to Timbo, capital of Futah JaUo, in W. Africa, xvi. 106. Somali Coast, Memoir on the Bdoor Tribes. By Lieut. C. J. Cruttenden, i.n. xix. 49. ¦ ¦ Country. By Capt. Miles. (Proceedings, VoL xvi. 149.) Land, Visit. By Dr. Kirk. (Proceedings, Vol. xvii. 340.) Soudan, Expedition from Suakin to the. By P. Parry, xliv. 152. South Africa, Notes on. By H. Gassiott. xxu. 136. Expeditions into interior of iv. 362. Expedition to interior of (S.W. Africa). By Francis Galton. xxii. 140. ¦ ¦ Explorations in. By Messrs. Livingstone & OsweU. xxii. 163. ¦ Extracts of letters from Eev. D. Livingstone, dated from Kolobeng. xx. 138. Extract of a letter from W. C. OsweU, regarding the interior lake of. XX. 143. Explorations into interior of. By Dr. David Livingstone. Letter from Maclear on Livingstone's observations, xxiv. 291. Explorations in ; route from Walfisch Bay to Lake Ngami, and ascent of the Tioge River. By Chas. J. Anderssen. xxv. 79. (Pro ceedings, Vol. iv. 63.) Notes on. By Chapman. (Proceedings, Vol. v. 16.) Explorations into interior of. By Rev. D. Livingstone. Journey to Loanda. xxv. 218. The general features of the Interior, between Barkly and Gubulu- wayo. By Alex. Bailie, xlviii. 287. Gold country of. By J. R. Wilkinson. (Proceedings, Vol. xiii. 134.) Explorations into interior of. By Dr. David Livingstone. Astro nomical observations, xxvi. 78. On temperate. By Sir Bartie Frere. (Proceedings (N.S.) Vol. iii. 1.) — — Sand-bars at mouths of rivers of. By Dr. Mann. (Proceedings, Vol. xvi. 138.) South Central Africa, Explorations into interior of. By Dr. David Livingstone — The Zambesi, xxvii. 349. Journal. By P. C. Selous. (Proceedings (N.S.) Vol. ni. 169.) Speke, Capt. (See East Africa.) African Papers. 185 Suez Canal and its pilotage. By Capt. G. S. Nares. (Proceedings, Vol. xiv. 75.) Opening of. By Lord Houghton. (Proceedings, Vol. xiv. 88.) Report of Capt. Richards and CoL Clarke. (Proceedings, Vol. xiv. 259.) Tanganyika, On Lake, Ptolemy's Western-Lake Reservoir of " Nile." By Richard P. Burton, xxix. 231. xxxv. 1. (Proceedings, Vol. iii. Ill ; Vol. ix. 6.) On tbe Southern half of. By Lieut. Cameron, xiv. 184. Lieut. Cameron's Diary, xiv. 197. Timbuktu, Trade route from Gambia to. By H. Cooper. (Proceedings, XX. 78.) Transvaal, Geographical and economic features of. By P. B. Fynney. xlviii. 16. (Proceedings, Vol. xxii. 114.) Notes on physical and geological features of, to accompany his new map of. By F. Jeppe. xlvii. 217. From the gold region in, to Delagoa Bay. By Capt. C. Warren. xlviii. 283. (See Orange Free State.) Teipoli, An account of. By Col. G. H. Warrington, xiv. 104. Uganda. See Victobia. Ukeeewe Lake, On. By Capt. R. P. Burton. (Proceedings, Vol. xvi. 129.) Umzila's, South East Africa, joumey to in 1871-72. By Mr. St. Vincent Erskine. xiv. 45. (Proceedings, Vol. xix. 110.) Unyamwezi, Description of. By P. Broyon Mirambo. (Proceedings, Vol. xxii. 28.) Upper Egypt, Notes on part of Eastern Desert of. By J. Wilkinson, ii. 28. UsAMBAEA Countey in Bast Africa. By Rev. J. P. Farler. (Proceedings (N.S.) VoL i. 81.) Notes of a trip from Zanzibar to. By Keith Jobnston. (Pro ceedings (N.S.) Vol. i. 545.) Notes on geology of. By J. Thomson. (Proceedings (N.S.) Vol. i. 558.) Journey to Magila on borders of. By A. BellviUe. (Proceedings, Vol. XX. 74.) Vei Language, Discovery of a nati-ve written character at Bohmar, on W. coast of Africa, with vocabulary of the Vatice or Vei Tongue. By Lieut. F. E. Forbes, xx. 89. Notes on tbe language and alphabet. By E. Norris. xx. 101. Victobia Nyanza, Note on height of. By Staff Com. George. (Proceed ings, Vol. XX. 169.) Joumey to, and back via the Nile. By R. W. Felkin. (Pro ceedings (N.S.) Vol. n. 357.) On H. M. Stanley's exploration of. By Col. J. Grant, xlvi. 10. (Proceedings, Vol. xx. 34.) Victobia and Uganda Lake. By Rev. C. T. Wilson. (Proceedings (N.S.) Vol. ii. 353.) Victobia Nyanza Expedition, Progress of tbe, of the Church Missionary Society. By B. Hutchinson. (Proceedings, Vol. xxi. 498.) Vogel, Dr., fate of. (Proceedings, Vol. ii. 79.) See Centbal Africa (North). 186 African Papers. VoLTA River, Doblen. (Proceedings, Vol. vi. 49.) Notes on. By Capt. Croft. (Proceedings, Vol. xviii. 183.) — Country between, and Niger. By Sir John Glover. (Proceedings, Vol. xviii. 286. Wady Halfeh, On tbe country between, and Gebel-Berkel, in Ethiopia, with remarks on the level of the Nile. By Sir G. Wilkinson, xx. 154. Wami Rivee, Boat journey by Clement HUL (Proceedings, Vol. xviL 337.) Wassaw, Visit to tbe gold fields of. By J. A. Skertchly. xlviii. 274. Wednoon, Letter of Mr. Davidson from. vi. 429. West Afeica, On a map showing the possibiUty of the rivers Yeu and Chadda being the outlet of Lake Chad. By Capt. Allen, viii. 289. On the coast of, surveyed by H.M.S. " ^tna" in 1830-32. By Capt. Belcher, b.n. ii. 278. . British Settlements. By O'Connor. (Proceedings, Vol. vi. 15.) . Mr. Winwood Reade in. (Proceedings, VoL vu. 106.) Second journey into. By M. P. B. du ChaUlu. xxxvi. 64. (Proceedings, Vol. x. 71 ; Vol. v. 108.) Oil rivers. By W. N. Thomas. (Proceedings, Vol. xviL 148.) Westeen Equatorial Africa, An exploration of the Elephant Mountains in. By R. P. Burton, xxxiii. 241. White Nile. (See Nile.) Whyddah, A journey from, to Adofoodiah. By J. Duncan, xvi. 154. YoRUBA AND NupE COUNTRIES, Joumey in, in 1868. By Daniel J. May.. xxx. 212. Zambesi, On the Gradient of tbe, on the level of Lake Nyassa, on the Murchi son Eapids, and on Lake Shirwa. By Jobn Kirk. xxxv. 167. — — ' Delta, On fossil bones from tbe alluvial strata of the. By Jobn Kirk. xxxiv. I99. (Proceedings, Vol. viii. 151.) ¦ ¦ AND Shire Rivbes, Extracts from despatches of Dr. D. Livingstone, 1858-61. xxxi. 256. — . — Notes on the. By the late Richard Thornton, xxxiv. 196. ¦ An expedition up the, to Senna, by three officers of H.M.S. " Leven," when surveying E. coast of Africa in 1823. ii. 136. A visit to the River. By T. S. Leigh, xix. i. Note on, by Capt. Hyde Parker. (Proceedings, Vol. i. 312.) McLeod on. (Proceedings, Vol. ii. 363.) Journey of Galvao da Silva to Manica Gold fields, in 1788, with description of country south of the Lower. By Macqueen. xxx. 155. Expedition. (Proceedings, Vol. iii. 99.) Dr. Livingstone on. (Proceedings, Vol. v. 128.) Mackenzie. Missionary Expedition. (Proceedings, Vol. v. 131.) Zanzibar, On the possessions of the Imaum of Muskat, on climate and pro ductions of, and on the prospects of African discovery from Mombas. By Col. Sykes. xxiii. 101. Remarks by Sir Bartie Frere. (Proceedings, Vol. xvii. 343.) Zulu and Amatonga Countries, Notes to accompany maps of, and of the country between Alivval and Natal. By John Sanderson, xxxii. 335. American Papers. 187 Zulu Land. Books, Memoirs, and Map of. (Proceedings (N.S.) Vol. i. 201 and 205.) ¦ • Notes on physical geography of, by Rev. G. Blencowe. (Pro ceedings (N.S.) Vol. i. 324.) AMEEICA. Aconcagua, Mt. in Chili, Notice of. By Capt. R. FitzRoy, e.n. vii. 143. Amazons Rivee, On tbe southern affluents of tbe, on tbe rivers which flow from the Cordilleras of Peru into the Maranon or Amazons. Report of river Beni and surroundings, by Thadeus Haenke. v. 90. AND Negeo Rivbes, Account of the, from recent observations. By Lieut. Smyth, e.n. vi. 11. Notes on the rivers Maue-assii, Abacaxis, and Canumd,. By W. Chandless. xl. 419. Eiver, Table of distances on. By L. Nash. (Proceedings, Vol. xxi. 596.) Geographical positions on the. (Proceedings, Vol. xvi. 271.) America, Telegraphic communication with. Shaffner. (Proceedings, Vol. iv. 101.) (North), Evidence for the discovery of, by the Scandinavians in 10th centm-y. viii. 114. America, Central, On. By Col. Don Juan Galindo. vi. 119. ¦ Sketch of tbe eastern coast of. By Capt. Bird Allen, r.n. xi. 76. Considerations on the great Isthmus of. By Capt. E. FitzRoy, R.N. XX. 161. Note upon the language of. By R. G. Latham, xx. 189. • South, Tierra del Fuego, and the Strait of Magelhaens, On the geo graphy of. By Capt. Philip Parker King. i. 155. • North, Remarks on the freezing of streams in. By A. C. Anderson. XV. 367. Remarks on the physical geography of. By C. S. Rafinesque. xi. 165. • ¦ Palliser's expedition. (Proceedings, Vol. ii. 38-146 ; Vol. iv. 228.) (See Rocky Mountains.) Observations on the indigenous tribes of the N.W. coast. By Jobn Scouler. xi. 215. Barometric and thermometric measurements of heights in. By Capt. J. H. Lefroy. xvi. 263. South, and Oceania, Notes on. By Gen. W. Miller, xii. 137. American Antiquities, On the Museum for, in Copenhagen. By Prof. C. Rafn. xiv. 316. Andes, Southern, of Chili, Expedition across the, to open a new line from tbe Pacific to the Atlantic Ocean. By Don GuUiermo Cox, of Chili. xxxiv. 206. ¦ Proposed railway route across the, from Caldera, in Chili, to Rosario, on the Parana. Report of E. A. Flint's survey. By W. Wheelwright, xxxi. 155 . (Proceedings, Vol. iv. 45.) On a projected railway route over the, from tbe Argentine RepubUc. By R. Crawford, xliii. 46. (Proceedings, Vol. xvii. 57.) 188 American Papers. Andes, Bolivian, On the general outline and physical conformation of the ; on the line of perpetual snow between 16° and 20° S. Lat. By J. B. Pent- land. V. 70. • ¦ A journey across the, between Cochabamba and Chimor^. By J. A. Lloyd. Eemarks on communication between Bolivia and the Atlantic, via, tbe Amazon, xxiv. 259. Anegada, Eemarks on. By E. H. Schomburgk. ii. 152. Apubimac and Mantaro, Confluence of. By Don Antonio Eaimondi. xxxviii. 413. (Proceedmgs, Vol. xiii. 112.) Aquiey, Notes on the Eiver. By W. Chandless. xxxvi. 119. (Proceedings, Vol. xi. 100.) Aeizona, Notes on. By C. D. Postans. (Proceedings, Vol. xix. 302.) Ataoama, Journey into the Desert of. By Dr. E. Philippi. xxv. 158. The Desert of. By J. Harding, xlvii. 250. Ateato, Prom the Bay of, to tbe Bay of Cupica on tbe Pacific, in 1827. By Comm. Chas. Friend, e.n. xxiii. 191. Through the Valley of, to tbe Pacific, in search of a route for a ship canal. Under F. M. Kelley. xxvi. 174. (Proceedings, Vol. i. 63.) Bayanos Eivbb on the Isthmus of Panama. By Laurence Oliphant. xxxv. 142. (Proceedings, Vol. ix. 276.) Belize to Guatemala, A joumey from, and return by the river Polocbic in 1834. By E. Legh Page. vin. 317. Belize Eivbb, Physical Geography of. By A. S. Cockburn. (Proceedings, Vol. xii. 72.) Bebbicb, in British Guayana, Diary of an ascent of the, in 1836-37. By Eobert H. Schomburgk. vn. 302. Bolivia, Notes on, to accompany original maps. By G. C. Musters, xlvii. 201. (Proceedings, Vol. xxii. 40.) Boundary of ChiU and. (Proceedings (N.S.) Vol. i. 785.) Bogota, Journey from Chimborazo to. By R. Cross. (Proceedings, VoL ix. 277.) Boundary (North America), from tbe Lake of the Woods to the Eocky Mountains. By Capt. S. Anderson, xlvi. 228. (Proceedings, Vol. xx. 274.) Beazil, Journey from Eiver St. Francisco to the Eiver Tocantins and to city of Maranhao. By J. W. Wells, xlvi. 308. . • Letter on the Abroblos Bank off coast of. By Capt. FitzEoy. u. 315. Tbe valley of tbe Tibagy. By T. P. Bigg-Wither, xlvi. 263. (Pro ceedings, Vol. XX. 455.) Beitish Columbia, Exploration in Jarvis Inlet and Desolation Sound. By W. Downie. xxxi. 249. Journey into the interior of. By Mathew B. Begbie. xxxi. 237. (Proceedings, Vol. iv. 33.) On the geography and mountain passes of, in connection with an overland route. By A. Waddington. xxxviii. 118. (Proceedings, xii. 121.) Remarks on the geography and natural capabilities of, and its gold fields. By Lieut. H. S. Palmer, e.e. xxxiv. 171. (Proceedings, Vol. iv. 33 ; Vol. vUi. 87.) A journey through tbe districts bordering on the Thompson, Eraser, and Harrison Eivers. By Lieut. E. C. Mayne, e.n. xxxi. 297. (Proceedings, Vol. iv. 33.). American Papers. 189 Beitish Columbia. Eeport on the Harrison and Lilloet route. By Lieut. H. S. Palmer, e.e. xxxi. 224. W. Kelly on. (Proceedings, Vol. vi. 107.) ¦ ¦ ¦ Sketch of the country between Jervis Inlet and Fort Pemberton ; with a map. By Lieut. E. 0. Mayne. xxxi. 297. ' Benches " or valley terraces in. By Chief Justice Begbie. (Pro ceedings, Vol. XV. 133.) British North American Exploeing Expedition, Progress of the, under Capt. J. PaUiser. xxx. 267. (See Eocky Mountains.) Oalifobnia, Notes on Upper. By Dr. Thos. Coulter, v. 59. The Modoc Regions. By Wm. Simpson. (Proceedings, Vol. xix. 292.) Caravaya, The Province of. By C. R. Markham. xxxi. 190. Rivers df San Gavan and Ayapata in. Raimondi. (Proceedings, Vol. xi. 102.) Caribs, Notice of. By Don Juan Galindo. in. 290. Cabmen, On the town of, and the Rio Negro. By Murrell R. Robinson. xiv. 130. Centbal Ameeioa, New transit across. By Bedford Pim. (Proceedings, Vol. vL 75, 112.) Exploration in. By J. CoUinson. (Proceedings, Vol. xii. 25.) On tbe ruined cities of. By Capt. Lindesay Brine, e.n. xiii. 364. (Proceedings, Vol. xvn. 67.) On Lake Yojoa. By Mr. Squier. (Proceedings, Vol. iii. 106.) Chili. (See Andes.) Chile, Observations on tbe Coal Formation in. By W. BoUaert. xxv. 172. Boundary of Bolivia and. (Proceedings (N.S.) Vol. i. 786.) Chiloe, Account of Island and Province of. By Capt. Blankley, b.n. iv. 344. Cocos, Isle. Note on. By Admiral Sir George Seymour, xix. 20. CoLOEADO, On tbe basin of tbe, and the great basin of N. America. By W. A, Bell, xxxix. 95. (Procceedings, Vol. xiii. 140.) Columbia. Notes on tbe topography of tbe Sierra Nevada of Santa Marta. By P. A. A. Simons. (Proceedmgs (N.S.) Vol. i. 689.) Rivee, Notes on the geography of. By the late Dr. Gairdner, m.d. xi. 260. Communication between the populations of Europe and Asia, Plan for a Direct. By Asa Whitney, xxi. 86. with the East, via British N. America. By Capt. Synge, e.e. xxii. 174. in Southern Peru. By C. R. Markham. xliv. 127. (Proceedings, Vol. xviii. 212.) Coeentyn, Diary of an ascent of the. By E. H. Schomburgk. vii. 285. CoEDOVA to Mbndoza, Notes on the route from, in 1837. By Capt. Gosselman. ix. 407. CosiQuiNA, Volcano of (1835). v. 387. CupiCA, Isthmus of. By Admiral lUingworth. (Proceedings, Vol. i. 86.) Cu-YUNY EiVEB, Expedition up, in 1837. By Wm. Hilhouse. -vii. 446. Cuzco, Journeys to the northward and eastward of, and among the Chunchos Indians, in July 1835. By Gen. Miller, vi. 174. On the site of. By J. Pentland. viii. 427. 190 American Papers. Daeien Indians. (See Tule.) Exploration of. By H. C. Caldwell. (Proceedings, Vol i. 484.) Scientific explorations in the, in 1861 and 1865. By M. Lucien de Puydt. xxxviii. 69. (Proceedings, Vol. xii. 63.) Eeport of party sent to cross the Isthmus of, under Comm. J. 0. Prevost. xxiv. 249. Summary of the survey of the. By L. Gisborne. xxvU. 191. (Pro ceedings, Vol. i. 88.) of Central America, further considerations on the great. By Capt. R. FitzRoy. xxiii. 171. Dominica, Island of. Recent volcanic eruption at the Grand Souffriere. (Pro ceedings (N.S.) VoL ii. 363.) Dominican Republic, On the peninsula and Bay of Samana in the. By Sir R. Schomburgk. xxiii. 264. BcuADOE, Explorations in, in 1866 and 1857. By Geo. Jas. Pritchett. xxx. 64. (Proceedings, Vol. iii. 93.) EsMEEALDA, Jouruey from, to San Carlos and Moura, thence to Demerara, in 1839. By R. H. Schomburgk. x. 248. Essequibo and Massaeoony Eivebs, Expeditions up the, in 1830-1831. By Capt. J. B. Alexander, ii. 66. Falkland Island, East, Account of. By Sir Woodbine Parish. ilL 94. Peozen Soil of British N. America, Observations on the. By Sir J. Richardson, ix. 117. Galapagos Islands, A visit to, in 1880. By Capt. A. H. Markham. (Pro ceedings (N.S.) Vol. u. 742.) Notes on Capt. Markham's paper. (Proceedings (N.S.) Vol. ii. 755.) By Sir G. Seymour, xix. 20. GoBGON Bay, in Central America. By Capt. Bedford Pim, r.n. (Proceedings, Vol. vi. 112.) Granada, Lake of, on tbe Isthmus between it and the Pacific Ocean. By J. BaUy. xiv. 127. Guatemala, on the latitude and longitude of important places in the RepubUc of. By A. Van de Gebuchte. xxviii. 359. (See Usamasinta River.) Guiana, British, Memoir on the Warow-Land of. By Wm. HUhouse. iv, 321. Expedition into interior of, in 1835-1836. By R. H. Schom burgk. vi. 224. The third expedition into interior of, to the sources of the Esse quibo, &c. By R. H. Schomburgk. x. 159. A journey in the interior of. By E. F. im Thurn. (Proceedings (N.S.) Vol. iL 465.) Expedition to the Barima and Guiana Rivers. By R. H. Schomburgk. xii. 169. Excursion up the Barima and Cuyuni Eivers in 1841. By R. H. Schomburgk. xii. 178. Visit to the sources of the Takutu in 1842. By Sir Robert Schomburgk. xiii. 18. American Papers. 191 Guiana, Beitish. An expedition from Pirara to the Upper Corentyn, thence to Demerara. By Sir E. H. Schomburgk. xv. 1. Eeport on the Kaieteur waterfall. By Charles B. Brown, xii. 77. (Proceedings, VoL xv. 122.) HisPANioLA. By Major R. Stuart, xlviii. 234. Honduras, Central Ameeican, Account of Lake of Yojoa or Taulebe in. By E. G. Squier. xxx. 68. Hudson's Bay. Proposed communication with Vancouver's Island. By J. Banister. (Proceedings, Vol. i. 263.) Juan' Fbbnandez, Expeditions by order of the King of Spain 1749-76 ; estabUshment of a colony on tbe Island of. By Sir Woodbine Parish. iv. 182. JuEUA, Notes of joumey up the river. By W. Chandless. xxxix. 296. Labradob Peninsula, Exploration up the Moisie River to tbe edge of the table-land of the. By H. Youle Hind, xxxiv. 82. (Proceedings, VoL viU. 50.) Llanganati, On the mountains of. By Eichard Spruce, xxxi. 163. Magellan, Steaits of. Reports from Capt. T. Henderson and Comm. S. Paynter, on Coal Formations in the. xx. 151. • ¦ ¦ Visit to Skyring Water. By Dr. Coppinger. (Proceedings (N.S.) Vol. ii. 652.) Mantabo and Apubimac, The confluence of the rivers, in the Huanta Mountains. By Prof. Antonio Raimondi. xxxviii. 413. (Proceedings, Vol. xui. 112.) Massaeoony, Voyage up the, in 1831. By Wm. Hilhouse. iv. 25. Mexico, Journey from, to Mazatlan, with description of remarkable ruins. By Chevalier J. Ldwenstem. xi. 100. Gulf of. On ; notes on Tampico and vicinity, and on navigation of the Tabasco. By Peter Masters, xv. 236. Journey to. By C. H. Sevin. xxx. 1. Excursion to an ancient volcano in. By Henry de Saussure. xxx. 53. (See New Spain.) Minas Geraes, Geographioal notes on the province of. By H. Gerber. xliv. 262. MoDOC Eegion. By W. Simpson. (Proceedings, Vol. xix. 292.) Mosquito Territory, Eemarks on, with map. By C. N. Bell, xxxii. 242. Indians, Joumey among. By G. H. Wickham. (Proceedings, Vol. xiii. 58.) Negro Eiver, A voyage of exploration up the. By W. Parish, vi. 136. Newfoundland, Physical geography of. By Julian Moreton. xxxiv. 263. Geography and resources of. By A. Murray, xlvii. 267. Journey across the island of. By Geo. Robinson, xlvii. 278. New Mexico, On Lieut. Wheeler's explorations in. By T. W. Goad. (Pro ceedings, Vol. xxii. 272.) New Spain, On tbe monuments and reUques of the ancient inhabitants cf. By Capt. Vetch, e.e., f.e.s. vii. 1. 192 American Papers. Nicaragua, Notes on Lake of, and the Province of Chontales. By Chevalier Emanuel Priedrichsthal. xi. 97. Gerald Raoul Perry on. (Proceedings, Vol. vi. 74.) Survey for a canal from Lake of, to the Port of Salinas or Bolanos. By Magister Andreas Oersted, xxi. 96. Communication between Atlantic and Pacific Oceans by way of Lake. By Capt. PhiUips, r.n. iii. 275. 'Transit route across. By Capt. Bedford Pim, e.n. (Proceedings, VoL vi. 75, 112.) North Ameeican Bound aey, from Lake ofthe Woods to the Eocky Mountains. By Capt. Anderson, xlvi. 228. (Proceedings, Vol. xx. 274.) Norton Sound, A journey from, to Port Youkon. By F. W. Whymper. xxxviu. 219. (Proceedings, Vol. xii. 186.) Old Providence, On the Island of. By 0. P. Collet, e.n. vn. 203. (Proceedings, Vol. xxi. 148.) Obegon, The exploration of, in 1878, by tbe Wheeler Survey. Bv J. W. Goad. (Proceedings (N.S.) Vol. i. 694.) Ascent of Mount Hood. By Eev. H. K. Hines. (Proceedings, Vol. xi. 80.) Journey across Cascade Mountains into E. Oregon. By E. Brown. (Pro ceedings, Vol. xi. 84.) Oeinoco. Proposed expedition by Admiral Sir Charles ElUot. (Proceedings, VoL L 251.) Panama, Notes on Isthmus of. Communicated by .J. A. Lloyd, i. 69. On tbe territory of Burioa, in the Province of Chiriqui, Isthmus of. By. J. H. Smith, xxiv. 256. Pabana, Eeport on the BraziUan Province of the. By H. P. Vereker. xxxn. 137. (Proceedings, Vol. vi. 74.) Paeaguay, Geography and resources of. By Leone Levi. (Proceedings, Vol. xviu. 117.) Notes on physical geography of. By Keith Johnston. (Proceedings, Vol. XX. 494.) Patagonia, Explanatory notes on maps of. By H. L. Jones, xxxi. 204. A year in. By Commander Musters, e.n. xii. 59. (Proceedings, Vol. XV. 41.) Peel Eiver, Account of. By A. K. Isbister. xv. 332. Pbbu, Geography of Southern. By Wm. BoUaert. xxi. 99. (Proceedings, Vol. xu. 126.) . Railroad and steam communication in Southern. By C. E. Markham. xliv. 127. (Proceedings, Vol. xviii. 212.) Outlines of tbe Geography of. By Don Valentine Ledesma. xxvi. 210. On the Province of Tarapaca, in South. By Don M. B. de la Fuente. xxvi. 229. On Loreto in N. Peru. By Antonio Eaimondi. (Proceedings, Vol. vUi. 58.) . On the Eivers San Gavan and Ayapata, in the Province of Carabaya. By Professor Antonio Eaimondi. (See Caeavaya.) xxxvii. 116. . Geographical Position of tribes which formed the Empire of the Yncas of. By C. E. Markham. xii. 281. (Proceedings, Vol. xv. 367.) American Papers. 193 Peru, Yncas of. Note on Map of Empire of. By T. Saunders. xUL 513. Purus, Ascent of the river. By W. Chandless. xxxvi. 86. (Proceedings, Vol. X. 103.) On the supposed sources of the. By C. E. Markbam. xxv. 151. (Proceedings, Vol. v. 224.) Queen Charlotte Islands. By Torrens. (Proceedings, Vol. iv. 226.) By R. Brown. (Proceedings, Vol. xiiL 381.) Quito, Journey from, to Cayambe. By Dr. Wm. Jameson, 1859. xxxi. 184. To the River Napo, Excursion from, Jan. — May, 1857. By Dr. Wm. Jameson, xxviii. 337. Railroads. (See Communications.) Red River and Saskatchewan. By Dr. John Eae. (Proceedings, Vol. vii. 102.) Eio Negeo, On the. By A. E. WaUace. xxiii. 212. RiojA, On the Province of, in South America ; to accompany a map. By J. O. French, ix. 381. Rocky Mountains. By Palliser and Hector, xxx. 267. (Proceedings, Vol. iii. 122 ; Vol. iv. 73.) By Lord Milton and Dr. Cheadle. (Proceedings, VoL ix. 17.) RuPBET Land. By Capt. Synge. (Proceedings, Vol. vii. 71.) Salado Valley', Journey through and across the Argentine Provinces. By T. J. Hutchinson, xxxiv. 226. San Salvadoe, Description of the State of. Communicated by Jobn Power. xxviii. 349. San Joaquim, Poet, Journey from, to Roraima, thence to Esmeralda, in 1838-1839. By R. H. Schomburgk. x. 191. Santa Cbuz River, An attempt to ascend. By Capt. R. FitzRoy, e.n. vn. 114. Skyeing Watee. (See Magellan Steait.) South Ameeica, On tbe Geographical position of W. coast of. By Carlos Moesta. xxviii. 333. On the still unexplored parts of. By 0. R. Markham. (Proceedings, VoL xxiL 40.) Tapajos, Notes on tbe rivers Arinos, Juruena, and. By W. Chandless. xxxii. 268. Tbhuantepec, On the Isthmus of. By Herr M. G. Hermesdorf. xxxii. 536. Tempebatuee of the air, the best points in British N. America for observing tbe. By Dr. Richardson, ix. 121. Texas and New Mexico, Journey through, in 1841 and 1842. By Thomas Falconer, xiii. 199. Notes on coast of Texas, taken in 1842. By Wm. BoUaert. xiii. 226. ¦ On Geography of Texas. By Wm. BoUaert. xx. 113. Tule Indians on Darien coast. Vocabulary. By Dr. Cullen. xxi. 241. O 194 Australian Papers. UcAVALi, Peruvian exploration of tbe. By J. E. Tucker. (Proceedings, Vol. xiii. 133.) Uruguay, On the gold-fields of. By H. Bankart. xxxix. 339. Central, A journey to. By Dr. D. Ohristison. (Proceedings (N.S.) Vol. ii. 663.) Usamasinta River, Description of. By Don Juan Galindo, iii 59. Valparaiso and Callao, on the longitude of. ix. 602. Vancouver Island, Eoute in exploring a road from Albemie Canal to Nanaimo in 1861, with a Track chart. By Commander Richard C. Mayne, r.n. xxxiL 529. Report of an expedition along East coast of. By Governor Jas. Douglas, xxiv. 246. Notes on physical geography of. By C. Forbes, xxxiv. 154. ¦ Description of. By its first Colonist, W. Colquhoun Grant, xxvii. 268. (Proceedings, Vol. i. 487.) By Mayne. (Proceedings, Vol. vi. 107.) By Dr. Forbes, e.n. (Proceedings, Vol. viii. 83.) ¦ Remarks on, concerning Town sites and Native Population, By W. C. Grant, xxxi. 208. ¦ To Hudson's Bay. Proposed communication. By J. Banister. (Proceedings, Vol. i. 263.) Vera Paz, Account of the Province of. By Padre P. A. de Escobar, xi. 89. ViEGiNiA, Account of the Mound at Grove Creek Flats, in. By Schoolcraft. xii. 259. West India Islands, Remarks on the Heavy Swell, on tbe set and velocity of the tides. By R. H. Schomburgk. v. 23. YuLB Indians. (See Tule.) AUSTEALASIA. Alps, Austrahan. By Muller. (Proceedings, Vol. i. 3.) AusTBALiA, Recent Information from. (1832.) ii. 318. Latest accounts from. (1835.) vi. 433. Account of tbe recent exploration to tbe interior of. By Major J. L. Mitchell, vii. 271. ¦ Considerations on the political Geography and geographical Nomen clature of. By Capt. Vetch, e.b. viii. 157. Exploring excursions in. By H. S. Russell, xv. 305. On the Languages of. xv. 365. ¦ Considerations against the existence of a Great Sea in its Interior. By B. J. Byre. xvi. 200. On Steam communication with. By Capt. J. L. Stokes, e.n. xxvi. 183. (Proceedings, Vol. i. 79.) An Exploration into its interior in 1844-45. By Capt. 0. Sturt. xvii. 85. Australian Papers. 195 AUSTBALIA, Diary of John M'Douall Stuart's explorations from Adelaide across the Continent of, 1861-62. xxxiii. 276. (Proceedings, VoL v. 104; vi. 8. AusTBALlAN ExPLOEATiON, Joumal of ; sccoud preparatory journey to the vicinity of Lake Torrens. By John M'Douall Stuart, xxxi. 66. By Walker, Landsborough, M'Kinlay. (Proceedings, Vol. vii. 3, 6, 6, 40, 82, 84.) ¦ Journal of; third preparatory journey to vicinity of Lake Torrens. By Jobn M'Douall Stuart, xxxi. S3. ¦ Journal of; last expedition into the Interior. By John M'Douall Stuart, xxxi. 100. (Proceedings, Vol. vii. 82.) Discovery. Progress of. By Sir 0. Nicholson. (Proceedings, Vol. xiv. 190.) BuBDEKiN river in Queensland. Lower Course of. By G. E. Dalrymple. (Proceedings, VcL vii. 2.) Burke's Expedition, Sir H. Barkly on. (Proceedings, Vol. vi. 53.) BuiiKE and Wills, Messrs., Reports of the expeditions to reUeve or ascertain fate of. xxxiii. 5. By Lieut. Chimmo. (Proceedings, Vol. i. 255.) Cabpentabia, Exploring expedition from Victoria to Gulf of, under Robert O'Hara Burke, xxxn. 430. Centbal Austealia. Scientific exploration. By Dr. Neumeyer. (Pro ceedings, Vol. xii. 286.) Expedition to determine source of River Barcoo. By E. B. Kennedy, xxii. 228. Chatham Islands, An account of. Communicated by Dr. E. Dieffenbach, m.d. xi. 195. Letter from E. Dieffenbach, describing Te Wanga Lake. xii. 142. Cooper's Creek, Explorations N.W. of. By J. Ross. (Proceedings, Vol. XV. 96.) Cloudy Bay and Harbour, Notes on. By Capt. W. C. Symonds. viii. 416 Darling River, A notice of its lower course. By Mr. John E. Byre XV. 327. Darling and Baewan, Voyage up the. By W. R. Randell. xxxi. 145. (Proceedings, Vol. iv. 94.) Daewin, Poet. On survey of neighbonrhood. By Sir C. Nicholson. (Proceedings, Vol. xiv. 190.) Denison, Poet, Overland route from, to Rockingham Bay. By A. J. Scott. (Proceedings, Vol. viii. 110.) Depuch Island, Notes on. By Capt. Wickham. xii. 79. Essington, Port of. On the recent establishment at, on the N.E. coast of Australia. By Capt. Sir J. Gordon Bremer, b.n. ix. 499. (See Mel ville Island and Moebton Bay.) Overland journey from Sydney to. xiu. 339. Plindbes Range, Report on the Country to the Eastward of, Sjath Australia. By Capt. C. B. Prome, e.e. xiv. 283. o 2 196 Aitstralian Papers. Gipps' Land, Mr. Orr's Report to Govemor Latrobe of an expedition to. xi. 192. Geeat Baerier Reef, Survey within. (Proceedings, Vol. viii. 114.) Grey and Stanley Eange, Cadell on. (Proceedings, Vol. vi. 66.) Hume Rivee, On the course of, from the HUly Districts to junction of the Morumbidgee. By Capt. C. Sturt. xiv. 141. King Geoegb's Sound, Descriptions of the Natives of. By Scott Nind. i. 21. Leichhaedt, Expedition in searcb of tbe remains of Dr., and party. By John Forrest, xl. 231. (Proceedings, Vol. xv. 190.) By Gregory. (Proceedings, Vol. iii. 18.) By Clarke. (Proceedings, Vol. iii. 87.) Search Expedition. (Proceedings, Vol. x. 58.) Liveepool Plains and Mobeton Bay, On the country between. Letters from Comm. H. G. Hamilton, b.n. xiii. 245. Loed Howie Island, Visit to. By Dr. Corrie. (Proceedings, Vol. xxii. 136.) r Melville Island and Poet Essington, Geographical Memoir of, on Cobourg Peninsula ; on settlements on N. coast of New HoUand. By Major Campbell, 57th Foot. iv. 129. MoBETON Bay to Poet Essington, Account of Ludwig Leichbardt's expedi tion from. xvi. 212. Murchison Range, Jobn M'DouaU Stuart's explorations to the North of, in 1860-61. xxxii. 340. Murray River, On the navigation of the. By Capt. Thos. Cadell. xxv. 177. (Proceedings, Vol. vi. 56.) New Guinea. (See under Oceania.) New South Wales, The Progress of interior discovery in. By Allan Cunningham, ii. 99. New Zealand, Notices of, from original Documents in tbe Colonial Office. iL 133. Recent surveys in tbe middle Island of. By Capt. J. L. Stokes, R.N. xxi. 25. On the physique of the inhabitants. By Dr. A. S. Thomson. xxiii. 87. On Otago in. By J. T. Thomson. (Proceedings, Vol. n. 354.) Thos. Brunner's exploration of interior of Middle Island, xx. 344. ¦ Progress of di.scovery in Middle Island of. xiii. 344. West coast of Middle Island. By Dr. Hector. (Proceedings, Vol. viii. 47.) A reconnaissance survey of the southern districts of Otaco. By J. T. Thomson. xxviU. 298. ¦ Altitude sections of routes between East and West coasts of Canterbury. By Julius Haast. xxxvii. 328. ¦ ¦ Expedition to W. coast of Otago. By Jas. Hector, xxxiv. 96. (Proceedings, Vol. ix. 32,) — < Two expeditions to W. coast of Middle Island, in 1859. By John Rochfort. xxxii. 292. Australian Papers. 197 New Zealand, West coast of Middle Island. By A. Walker. (Proceedings, Vol. ix. 33.) ¦ Notes on mountains and glaciers of Canterbury. By Dr. J. Haast. xxxiv. 87. (Proceedings, Vol. viii. 56.) Notes to the topographical map of tbe Southern Alps, in Canterbury. By J. Haast. xl. 433.) Reconnaissance survey of tbe Lake-districts of Otago and Southland. By Jas. McKerrow. xxxiv. 56. (Proceedings, Vol. vni. 47.) North Australian Exploring Expedition, Journal of the, under A. C. Gregory, xxviii. 1. (Proceedings, Vol. v. 2.) ¦ Progress of. By A. C. Gregory. (Proceedings, Vol. i. 183 and 225, 324, 4900 Mr. Baines on. (Proceedings, Vol. ii. 3.) North Australia, New Country of. By J. M. Stuart. (Proceedings, Vol. ix. 21.) On tbe Aboriginal tribes of its northern coast. By G. W. Earl. xvL 239. Boat voyage along its north and west coasts. By J. P. Stow (Proceedings, Vol. x. 34.) • Notes on, and the neighbouring seas. By G. W. Earl. xii. 139. Nobth-Bast Australia, New harbours in. By Sinclair. (Proceedings, Vol. iv. 79 ; v. 4.) On the Settlement in Buckingham Bay, and advance of colonization over. By J. B. Dalrymple. xxxv. 191. Noeth- West Austealia, Notes on the physical geography of. By J. £. Wilson, xxviii. 137. Noeth- West Coast of Austealia, Expedition to the. By P. T. Gregory. xxxii. 372. (Proceedings, Vol. vi. 54.) North-Western Australia, Explorations in. By Jas. Martin, xxxv. 237. (Proceedings, Vol. x. 86.) Expedition from Government Camp, Camden Harbour, to the Southward of the Glenelg Eiver in. By R. J. ShoU. xxxvi. 203. The recent expedition to N.W. coast of, under Grey and Lushington. viii. 454. Survey of N.W. coast, in H.M.S. Beagle in 1838. By Capt. Wickham. viii. 460. On structure of. By W. H. Filton. (Proceedings, Vol. i. 601. Phillip, Port, South Australia, On the country round, vi. 419. Port Denison to Cape York, An overland expedition from ; under P. and A. Jardine. By Richardson, xxxvi. 19. Queensland, Exploration of the lower course of tbe Burdekin in, and its identification witb the Wickham. By G. E. Dalrymple. xxxiii. 3. (Proceedings, Vol. vi. 13.) By Frank Gregory. (Proceedings, Vol. v. 121.) Rockingham Bay, New Settlement in. By G. E. Dalrymple. (Proceedings, ^ Vol. X. 33.) Somerset, Cape York, Australia, Description of neighbourhood of. By J. Jardine. xxxvi. 76. 198 Australian Papers. Somerset and the Cape York Peninsula, Australia, Notes on physical geography, climate, and capabilities of. By Dr. A. Rattray, xxxviii. 370. South Australia, Expeditions of Discovery in. By B. J. Eyre, xiii 161. . Progress of discovery in. xiii. 341. . . Governor G. Grey's exploratory journey along its S.E. sea-board. By Thos. Burr. xv. 160. Expedition by Macdouall Stuart. (Proceedings, Vol. iv. 77.) Maodonnel. (Proceedings, Vol. iv. 93.) . M.arine suv\'ey of the Northern Territory of By F. Howard. xxxvi. 227. By Freeling, Hach, &c. (Proceedings, Vol. ii. 185.) South-Western Australia, Account of an expedition to explore. By Alex. Forrest, xiii. 388. Swan River, State of the Colony of, Jan. 1, 1830. By John Barrow, i. 1. General view of the Botany of tbe vicinity of. By R. Brown, i. 17. Van Diemen's Land, Remarks on a short vocabulary of the Natives of; and also of the Monero Downs in Australia. By Dr. John Lhotsky. ix. 157. Victoria River, Expedition of Mr. Edmund Kennedy to ascertain course of. xix. 193. Western Australia, Expedition under J. S. Roe to the South-Eastward of Perth in, during 1848 and 1849. xxii. 1. ¦ Tbe settler's expedition to the Northward from Perth, under A. C. Gregory, xxii. 57. ¦ Governor J. Fitzgerald's expedition to the Murchison River, xxii. 7L ¦ On. By Amos Scott, xxv. 176. Report of an expedition to explore the interior of. By Eobert Austin, xxvi. 235. Geology of. By Hargreaves. (Proceedings, Vol. viii. 32.) Explorations. By H. M. Lefroy. (Proceedings, VoL vin. 45.) Journey. By Brothers Dempster. (Proceedings, Vol. vi. 11.) ¦ Interior of. By Sir C. Nicholson. (Proceedings, VoL xiv. 190.) Researches in. xiii. 189. ¦ Expedition in. By Messrs. Gregory, in 1846. xviii. 26. ¦ By (;4regory. (Proceedings, Vol. iii. 34.) , Eeport of Lieut. Helpman, r.n., on coral discovered on tbe Irwin Eiver. xviii. 38. , Note to correct inaccuracies in these papers. By J. Arrowsmith. xviii. 74. ¦ Journey across. By Col. Egerton Warburton. (Proceedings, Vol. V. 124 ; xix. 41.) Journal of expedition. By John Forrest. xU. 361. xiv. 249. (Proceedings, Vol. xix. 310-481.) Expeditions. By Giles, Boss, Forrest, and Gosse. xlvi. 328. (Proceedings, VoL xix. 51.) Y(U!K, Cape, Jardine (.)verland E.xjiedition to. By Mr. Eichardson. (Pro ceedings, Vol. X. 32.) District ol. By J. Jardine. (Proceedings, Vol. x. 85.) Pouiusula. By Dr. Rattray. (Proceedings, Vol. xii. 313.) Papers relating to Oceania. 199 OCEANIA. AaoEEs, Description of tbe Island of St. Mary. By Carew Hunt. xv. 258. Description of St. Michael. By C. Hunt. xv. 268. The Pormigas Bank near Santa Maria. By Capt. A. Vidal, r.n. xix. 160. BoNiN Islands, Notes on the. By Capt. Michael Quin, r.n. xxvi. 232. Easter Island or Rapa Nui, A visit to, in 1868. By J. L. Palmer, e.n. xl,167. Fiji Islands, Remarks on a Government mission to the. By B. Seemann. xxxii. 51. (Proceedings, Vol. vi. 96.) -~ — •" — The. By M. Bensusan. xxxii. 42. (Proceedings, Vol. vi. 97.) " The exploration of the Rewa River and its tributaries in Na Viti Levu. By J. D. Macdonald. xxvii. 232. Feiendly Islands, and Tongatabu, Sketch of the. By 0. W. Brierly. xxn. 97. Hawah, Sandwich Islands, On tbe volcanic Mts. of. ( [By J. G. Sawkins. xxv. 191. Hebrides, New, and Santa Cruz Groups. By Lieut. A. H. Markham. xUL 213. (Proceedings, Vol. xvi. 388.) Navigator Islands, by Dr. Forbes. (Proceedings, Vol. xxi. 140.) New Britain and New Ireland, Notes on. By Rev. G. Brown, xlvii. 137. . Observations on, and neighbouring leUnds, durmg six years' exploration. By W. Powell. (Proceedings (N.S.) Vol. iii. 84.) New Guinea, Natural History of tbe Louisiade Islands and, by J. MacGill' vray. xxi. 13. ' Contributions to the knowledge of. By Dr. Solomon Mullei xxviii. 264. Notes of a voyage to. By A. R. Wallace, xxx. 172. and its Islands, On tbe trade of tbe Eastern Archipelago with. By A. B. Wallace, xxxii. 127. (Proceedings, Vol. in. 358.) -- — • New strait at S.W. extremity of. vi. 439. . On. By Miiller. (Proceedings, Vol. U. 181.) Recent discoveries at the. Eastern end of. By Capt. J. Moresby xliv. 1. (Proceedings, Vol. xviu. 22 ; xix. 225.) Three visits to. By W. Wyatt Gill. xliv. 15. (Proceedings Vol. xviu. 31.) and Western Islands of the Pacific, Notes on. By B. Redlich. xliv. 30. . Eastern, Discoveries in, by Capt. Moresby and officers of H.M.S. " BasiUsk." By Capt. J. Moresby, r.n. xiv. 153. Description of Country and Natives of Port Moresby and vicinity By 0. C. Stone, xlvi. 34. (Proceedings, VoL xx. 266, 330.) On the trade of. By A. R. Wallace. (Proceedings, Vol. vi. 43.) — — . Discovery of Buxter River in. By 0. Stone. (Proceedings, Vol. XX. 92. 200 Papers relating to Oceania New Guinea, Voyage of the " Eliangowan " to China Strait in. By Rev. S, Macfarlane. (Proceedings, Vol. x.xi. 350.) . Fly River. By D'Albertis. (Proceedings, Vol. xx. 343 ; (N.S.) i.4.) Fly River. By Rev. S. Macfarlane. (Proceedings, Vol. xx. 253.) . Travels of Mikluko Maklay in. (Proceedings, Vol. xix. 517.) New Hebrides and Santa Cruz Groups. By Comm. A. H. Markbam. xUi. 213. (Proceedmgs, Vol. xvi. 388.) Ne-w Ireland, Journey along Coast. By Rev. G. Bro-wii. (Proceedings (N.S.) VoL ili. 213.) Pacific Ocean, Notes on the Cocos, and two of the Galapagos Group. By Rear-Admiral Sir G. Seymour, xix. 20. Extracts from a private journal kept on board H.M.S. " Seringa patam, ' (1830). By Capt. W. Waldegrave, r.n. iii. 168. New Mand in tbe. vi. 441. — — Newly discovered Islands in. vii. 464. Pitcairn Islanders, Recent accounts of the. By Capt. W. Waldegrave, B.N. in. 156. Removal of. (Proceedings, Vol. i. 60.) Rapa. Description of the island of. By Capt. Vine Hall. (Proceedings, Vol. xiii. 83.) Saddle Island, Volcano of, extract from log of H.C. steam vessel " Victoria," xvi. 338. Sandwich Islands, On tbe geography and recent volcanic eruption of the. By Rev. Thos. Staley. xxxviii. 361. (Proceedings, Vol. xii. 306.) ¦ Letter dated Oahu, from Mr. Douglas to Capt. Sabine, iv. 333. (See H.-.WAII.) Santa Cruz Group, Commander A. H. Markbam on. xUi. 213. (Proceed ings, Vol. xvi. 388.) Sketch of the surveying voyage of H.M. ships " Adventure '' and " Beagle,'' 1825-36. By Capts. P. P. King, P. Stokes, and E. FitzEoy, b.n. vi. 311. South Sea Islands, Proceedings at the. By Capt. J. E. Erskine, e.n. xxi. 222. INDIAN OCEAN. Aeru Islands. By A. R. Wallace. (Proceedings, Vol. ii. 163.) Asiatic Archipelago, Proposed exploring expedition to the. By Jas. Brooke. viii. 443. Bay of Bengal, surface currents of, during tbe Soutb-West Monsoon. By J. A. Heathcote. xxxii. 234. (Proceedings, Vol. vi. 101, 114.) BoENBO, Observations on N.W. coast. By Spencer St. John, xxxii. 217. (Proceedings, Vol. vi. 83.) Sketch of the geography of. By John Crawfurd. xxiii. 69. New Maharajahate of Sabak in. By P. L. Sclater. (Proceedings (N.S.) VoL i. 121.) On rivers ilukah and (\yah in. By Lieut. De Crcspigny. (Proceedings, VoL i. 205 ; ii. 042; xvii. 133.) and the Indian Ocean. 201 Borneo, On Northern. By Lieut. De Crespigny. (Proceedings, Vol. xvi. 171.) Journey up the Sadong Eiver. By A. R. Wallace. (Proceedings, Vol. i. 193.) Cayagan Sulu, near Borneo, Account of. By Capt. Chimmo. (Pro ceedings, Vol. XV. 384.) Sarawak and Northern Borneo. By W. M. Crocker. (Proceedings (N.S.) VoL iu. 193.) Ceylon, Positions in. x. 579. Cocos or Keeling Islands, Account of. Transmitted by Sir E. W. C. E. Owen. i. 66. Notes on. By H. 0. Forbes. (Proceedings (N.S.) Vol. i. 777.) Comoro Islands. By Capt. A. De Horsey, r.n. xxxiv. 258. By T. S. Leigh, xix. 7. Eastern Aeceipelago, Notes of a cruise in, in 1841. By Capt. 0. Stanley, B.N. xii. 262. Indian Arohipelago, Voyages of steamer " Egeron " in, including discovery of Strait Egeron. xlviii. 294. On the physical structure and arrangement of the Islands of the. By G. W. Bari. xv. 368. Indian Ocean, Geography of the bed of. By S. Osborn. xii. 46. (Proceed ings, Vol. XV. 28.) On the course of tbe hurricane on the Malabar Coast in April, 1847, and on the position of the " Cleopatra " at the time. By Capt. T. G. Carless. xix. 76. Kalatoa and Pulowbh Isles. By J. Cameron. (Proceedings, Vol. ix. 30.) Kisser, one of the Serawatti Group, Account of a visit to. By G. W. Earl. Vol. xi. 108. Madagascar. Accoimt of the Ovahs ; sketch of their country, dress, &c. By Capt. Lewis, r.e. v. 230. A memoir on. By Lloyd, xx. 53. Abstract of MSS. books, &o., respecting, during the possession of Mauritius by the French. By W. J. Hamilton, xx. 76. A boat voyage along tbe coast lakes of East. By Capt. Brooke. xxxvi. 52. (Proceedings, Vol. x. 54.) A visit to the N.E. province of. By Eev. H. Maundrell. xxxvii. 108. Ankova and the Eoyal Cities. By Eev. W. EUis. (Proceedings, Vol. X. 65.) Notes on W. coast of. By Capt. Wilson, r.n. xxxvi. 244. By Lieut. Oliver. (Proceedings, Vol. vii. 68.) Explorations in North of. By Dr. Gunst. (Proceedings, Vol. ix. 289.) On the central provinces of. By J. Mullens, xiv. 128. (Proceedings, Vol. xxi. 155.) Visit to Vohimarina. By Bishop of Mauritius. (Proceedings, Vol. xi. 50.) Eecent journeys in. By Eev. J. Mullens, xlvn. 47. (Proceedings, Vol. xix. 182.) Journey from Antananarivo to Mojunga. By J. H. Maynard. (Pro ceedings, Vol. XX. 110.) 202 Miscellaneous Papers. Madagascae. History of geographical knowledge of. By Rev. James Sibrfe. (Proceedings (N.S.) Vol. i. 646.) Malay Abchipblago. On the Physical Geography of the. By A. R. Wallace, xxxiii. 217. (Proceedings, Vol. vii. 206.) Maldives, Commodore Moresby's Report on the Northern Atolls of tbe. V. 398. Rodriguez, Island of. Remarks on tbe country, products, &o. By B. Higgin. xix. 17. Serawatti Group. (See Kisser.) Seychelles. On tbe Island of Mahi. By Lieut.-Col. Lewis Pelly. xxxv. 231. Sumatra, Dutch expedition to Central. By Professor Veth. (Proceedings (N.S.) Vol. i. 759.) MISCELLANEOUS. Aneroid Barometer, Remarks on. By CoL P. Yorke. xxi. 35. for tbe purposes of surveying in India. By Dr. Geo. Buist. xxi. 42. Antiquity of Continents, Lecture on comparative, as indicated by distribu tion of animals. By A. Wallace. (Proceedings, Vol. xxi. 505.) Arid Countries, On certain, and causes of their dryness. By Thos. Hopkins. xxvi. 158. (Proceedings, VoL i. 58.) Bxploratiou of. By P. Galton. (Proceedings, Vol. ii. 60.) Atlantic Ocean, Geography of the bed of. By S. Osborn. xii. 46. (Pro ceedings, Vol. XV. 28.) — Sea bed of. Proposed survey. By Dr. Wallich, (Proceedings, viL 53.) Aurora Boeealis. By J. W. Tayler. (Proceedings, Vol. iiL 117.) BiFUECATE Stream, Notice of, at Glen Lednoch Head, Perthshire. By T. P. White. (Proceedings, Vol. xiii. 352.) Bread Plants, Tbe geography of. By Ph. Dr. Michelsen. xxxii. 565. " Bulldog," H.M.S., Surveys of. By Sir Leopold M'Clintock. (Proceedincs, Vol. V. 62.) Canons and Fjoeds, Remarks on formation of. By E. Brown, xii. 348. Columbus, Landfall of. By E. H. Major. xU. 193. (Proceedings, Vol. xv. 210.) - — By Capt. Becher, e.n. xxvi. 189. (Proceedings, Vol. i. 94.) Cueeents (Oceanic). On their connection with proposed Central American Canal. By A. G. Findlay. xxiii. 217. (Oceanic) on N.E. coast of S. America. By J. A. Mann. (Proceed ings, Vol. vii. 50.) Gibraltar. By Dr. Carpenter. (Proceedings, Vol. xv. 54.) (See Iemixgbb, under Arctic and Ocean Circulation, Gulf Stream.) Cyclones, On the formation of, and tracks they pursue. By Capt. A. Parish. xxvL 154. (Proceedings, Vol. i. 36.) Oy clonic Hurricanes, Chronological Table of 400, iu West Indies and North Atlantic. By Andres Pooy. xxv. 291. Miscellaneous Papers. 203 Distances, Vertical, Different standards for expressing. By Miss Colthurst. xix. 192. Earthquake Wave at Samoa. By Rev. D. Turner. (Proceedings, Vol. xiii. 57.) Education, Place of geography in. By Rev. E. Hale. (Proceedings, Vol. xvi. 450.) Electric Circuits. By Shaffner. (Proceedings, Vol. v. 94.) Evolution, Geographical. By Prolessor Geikie. (Proceedings (N.S.) Vol. i. 422.) Fjords, Canons, Benches, Prairies, and intermittent rivers, on the formation of. By R. Brown, xxxix. 121. (Pi oceedings, VoL xiu. 144.) See Canons. ' Fox,' Surveys of. By Capt. Allen Young. (Proceedings, Vol. v. 70.) Geography, Sketch of progress of, from 1836-37, and of the labours of the Royal Geographioal Society. By Capt. J. Washington, r.n. vii. 172. Sketch of progress of, and of the labours of the Royal Geographical Society in 1837-38. By Captain J. Washington, r.n. viii. 235, Geographical Societies, Regulations respecting, in British Colonies and Dependencies, iii. 324. Discovery, Notes indicative of tbe progress of. xiii. 194. Globe, Old, at I'rankfort, date 1520, Memorandum on. By H. Blanohard. xviiL 46. Voyage round tbe. By P. D. Bennett. 1833-36. vii. 211. Ground Ice in the Siberian Rivers. By Col. Jackson, vi. 416. Gulp Stream soundings and temperatures. By Comm. Chimmo. (Pro ceedings, Vol. xiii. 92.) ¦ On the. By Mr. A. G. Findlay. (Proceedings, Vol. xin. 102.) Evidence of, in North Atlantic. By Admiral Irminger. (Proceedings, Vol. xiii. 226.) Dr. Carpenter on. (Proceedings, Vol. xv. 54.) Heights, Determination of, from atmospheric pressure. By A. Buchan. (Proceedings, Vol. xiii. 360.) Hints to Travellers. By Admirals Smyth, Beechey, and Col. Sykes. xxiv. 328. Second edition, xxxiv. 272. Third edition. (Proceedings, VoL xvi, 5.), Hurricanes. (See Cyclonic.) Ice. (See Ground Ice.) Iceberg, Note on a rock seen on an, in 61° s. lat. By C. Darwin, ix. 528. Lakes, On the seiches of. By Col. Jackson, iii. 271. Longitude, On instruments for observing. By travellers on land. xxx. 315. . By Moon's greatest altitude. By W. Spottiswoode. (Proceedings, Voh V. 234.) JIagxbtic Intensity ok the Earth, vuii 367. 204 Miscellaneous Papers. Magnetic variations at Aden. Notice. By Capt. Haines, xxiv. 225. Magnetism of the Earth. Lecture. By Capt. Evans. (Proceedings, Vol. xxiL 188.) Mainland masses, Lecture on. By Prof. Duncan. (Proceedings, Vol. xxiL 68.) Maps. Description of Sir Henry James' projection, xxx. 106. (See Pro jections.) Meteoeological Observations, Instructions for making and registering, at various stations in Southern Africa, as also at sea. v. 367. and other observations made on voyage to Algoa Bay in 1853. By Dr. Sutherland, xxv. 256. Journal kept at Alexandria, Notes on. By Hugh Thurburn. xxii. 128. Mountain Ranges, Typical. By Wm. Spottiswoode. xxxi. 149. (Proceed ings, Vol. iv. 97.) Names of Places in geography. By Lieut.-Col. Ross King. (Proceedings, Vol. xix. 134.) Nomenclature, geographical. Hints on. By Col. Jackson, iv. 72. Oceanic Circulation. By Dr. Carpenter. (Proceedings, VoL xv. 54.) ¦ ¦ ¦ Letter from Sir J. Herschel. (Proceedings, Vol. xv. 211.) Further inquiries on. By Dr. Carpenter. (Proceedings, Vol. xviu. 301. Oceans, Geography of the beds of. By Sherard Osbom. xii. 46. (See Seas ; Salt ; Temperature.) Organic Nature, Lecture on the modifications of tbe external aspects of, produced by man's interference. By Prof. RoUeston. xlix. 320. Orography, Additions to. By Prof. Chaix. x. 575. Picturesque Desceiption in books of travel. By Col. Jackson, v. 381. Places -with Two Names, List of. By B. Norris. xxiv. 318. Plant Distribution as a field for geographical research. By Thiselton Dyer. (Proceedings, Vol. xxii. 412.) Peojection of the Sphere, On a new. By Sir J. Herschel. xxx. 100. (Proceedings, Vol. iii. 174.) Description of Sir H. James's, xxx. 106. Reconnaissance of a new country. By Capt. Warren. (Proceedings, Vol. xix. 155.) Salt, On the distribution of, in the ocean. By J. Y. Buchanan, xlvii. 72. (Proceedings, Vol. xxi. 255.) Sea, Physical geography of. By Maury. (Proceedings, Vol. v. 22.) Seas passed between England and India, On specific gravity, tem]ierature, and currents of. By H. Toynbee. xxxv. 147. (Proceedings, Vol. ix. 281.) Scientific Geography, Introductory lecture on. By Lieut.-Gen. Strachey. (Proceedings, Vol. xxi. 179.) ¦ On tbe scope of By Gon. Strachey. (Proceedings, Vol. xvi. 443.) Stade as a linear Measure, Col. Lcakc on. ix. 1. Miscellaneous Papers. 205 Stereoscopic Maps taken from models of mountainous countries. By F. Galton. xxxv. 99. (Proceedings, Vol. ix. 104.) Sun Signals. By Francis Gallon. (Proceedings, Vol. iv. 14.) Temperature of deep-sea bottom. Lecture by Dr. Carpenter. (Proceedings, VoL xxi. 289.) Surface, of North Atlantic, Admiral Irminger on. xl. 441. Mild, of British Isles in winter, on causes of. By T. Hopkins. xxviL 206. Ocean. Summary of observations recently made. By Dr. Carpenter. (Proceedings, Vol. xix. 493.) Surface of North Atlantic. By N. Whitley. (Proceedings, Vol. xiii. 229.) Thermometer, Use of, to determine heights, CoL Sykes on. viii. 435. Trade Winds. By T. Hopkins. (Proceedings, Vol. ii. 357.) TussAC Grass, Sir W. Hooker on. xii. 265. Vespucci, Amerigo Varnbagen on the voyages of. (Proceedings, Vol. ni. 389.) ( 206 ) LIST OF MAPS AND OTHER ILLUSTRATIONS contained in the 'JOUENAL' AND 'PEOCEEDINGS' OF THE EOYAL GEOGEAPHICAL SOCIETY. I.— THE WOELD. Geographical Areangement and Nomenclature, Illustrations to CoL Jackson's Paper on. (Journal, Vol. iv.) Land-Masses. — 5 Diagrams to illustrate the paper by Prof. P. Martin Duncan, " On the Formation of the Main Land-Masses." (Proceedings, Vol. xxii.) Oceanic Circulation. — Further inquiries on. Diagrams to illustrate Dr. Carpenter's Paper on. (Proceedings, Vol. xviii.) Oceanic Currents. — Map to illustrate Pindlay's Paper on. (Journal, Vul. xxiii.) Projection. — Col. James's Projection. (Journal, Vol. xxx.) New Projection of the Sphere. Herschel. (Journal, Vol. xxx.) Saltness of the Ocean. — Chart showing the Distribution of. (Journal, Vol. xlvii.) Vertical Distances. — Table to illustrate Miss Coulthurst's Comparative View of the various Standards used to express Vertical Distances. (Journal, Vol. xix.) WoBLD. — 1. Lines of B(|ual Magnetic Variation or Declination (Isogenic Lines) 1878. 2. Terrestrial Magnetic Meridians, and Curves or Equal Dip, or Inclination (Isoclinal Lines) 1878. (With the Magnetic Pole in each Hemisphere.) 3. The Earth's Magnetism. To accompany the Paper by Capt. P. J. Evans, Hydrographer of tbe, Admiralty. (Proceedings, Vol. xxii.) II.— POLAE EEGIONS. Arctic Coasts. — Examined by Dr. J. Eae. (Journal, Vol. xxii.) Arctic Discovbeies. — Map of. (Journal, VoL viii.) Aectic Explorations. — Map to illustrate Dr. Rink's Paper on Dr. Kane's Arctic Explorations. — (Journal, Vol. xxviii.) Arctic Land Expedition. — Map showing the Route of the recent Arctic Land Expedition. (Journal, Vol. v.) Arctic Land Expedition. — Map of the Route of the. (dournal, Vol. vi.) Arctic Maps. 207 Arctic Regions. — Map of the range of Temperature in the. 2 Maps. (Journal, Vol. ix.) .— 3iap to illustrate Inglefield's Route in the. (Journal, Vol. xxiii.) • ¦ Chart illustrating the remarks of Mr. Findlay, on the probable course pursued by Sir John Franklin's expedition, and of Capt. Irminger, on tbe Arctic Current around Greenland. (JournaL Vol. xxvi.) — — ¦ Map to illustrate Kennedy's Route in the. (Journal, Vol. xxiu.) Map to illustrate Dr. Rae's Arctic Explorations. (Journal, Vol. xxv.) Map to iUustrate Capt. Sherard Osborn's Paper on Light in the. (Journal, Vol. xxviu.) Map showing the Coasts explored in 1859, in search of tbe lost ships of Sir John Franklin in 1845. (Journal, Vol. xxxi.) Map of the North Polar Regions : to iUustrate the paper on the origin and migrations of the Greenland Esquimaux by C. R. Markham, Esq. (Journal, Vol. xxxv.) Chart of Coast from Cape York to Smith's Channel. Drawn by Kallihirua (alias Erasmus York). Supplement to the Journal, " Arctic Papers for the Expedition of 1876." Circumpolar Map. (Proceedings, Vol. xxi.) Chart of the Ice-Pield between Spitzbergen and Nova Zembla in 1676. (Proceedings, VoL ix.) The Swedish and Dutch Arctic Expeditions of 1878. (Proceed ings, Vol. i., New Series.) Map of the Barents and Kara Seas, illustrating the Arctic Cam paign of 1879. (Proceedings, Vol. ii., New Series.) Balleny Islands. — ^View of the. Antarctic Ocean. (Journal, Vol. ix.) Deception Island, New South Shetland. — By Lieut. B. N. Kendall, 1829. (Journal, Vol. i.) Franz Josef Land, Map of: from a Survev by JuUus Payer. (Journal, Vol. xU.) South Coast of. (Proceedings, Vol. iii.. New Series, p. 129.) Greenland. — Map illustrating Rink's Paper on tbe Continental Ice of. (Journal, Vol. xxiii.) Prom " Purchas his Pilgrimes." Vol. iii. To illustrate Mr. Markham's Paper. (Journal, Vol. xliii.) South Coast of. — Sketch Chart of the : from the Danish Admiralty Survey, corrected to 1873. Supplement to the Journal, " Arctic Papers for the expedition of 1875." South West. — Sketch Chart of : from the Danish Admiralty Survey, corrected to 1873. With Prof. Rafn's adaptation of the ancient Sites from Ivar Bardsen's Chorography. (Joumal, Vol. xliii.) King William Land. — Showing tbe Line of retreat of the Franklin Expedi tion. (Proceedings, Vol. ii.. New Series.) North-West Passage. — Map to illustrate McClure's Discovery of the. (Journal, Vol. xxiv.) NovAiA Zbmlia. — Map of. (Journal, Vol. viii.) Novaya Zemlya. — The Matyushin Shar (Matotschkin Schar) and part of the East Coast of Novaya Zemlya. (Proceedings, Vol. ii.. New Series.) Smith Sound. — Map to illustrate Dr. Kane's Expedition up. (Joumal, A^ol. xxvi.) 208 Maps. — Europe. Southern Hemisphere. — Part of the Southern Hemisphere, showing recent discoveries. (Journal, Vol. iii.) South Polab Eegions. — To illustrate the Paper by Staff-Commander J. E. Davis. (Journal, Vol. xxxix.) Spitzbeegen. — Map of: to illustrate the Paper by Prof. Nordenskiold and Capt. von Otter. (Journal, Vol. xxxix.) Map to illustrate Petermann's Paper on the Sea of. (Journal, Vol. xxiii.) Fac-simile of the latest Edition of Van Keulen's Chart of. 1707. To illusb-ate Mr. Markham's Paper. (Journal, Vol. xliii.) Zeno Map. — (Fac-simile.) 1. To accompany Mr. Major's Paper on the " Site of the lost Colony of Greenland and the Pre-Columbian Dis coveries of America." (Journal, Vol. xliii.) 2. Sketch Map of tbe Countries referred to in the Zeno narrative. To accompany Mr. Major's Paper. (Journal, Vol. xliii.) III.- EUEOPE. Adriatic Sea. — 1. Appearance of tbe bottom of the. 2. Course of the descending River. 3. Currents in the. (Joumal, Vol. xiv.) Aitkin's Rock. — Track of H. M. Sloop " Onyx," in search of Aitkin's Rock, under the command of Capt. A. T. B. Vidal, r.n., 1830. (Journal, Vol. i.) Albania. — Count Karaczay's Map of. (Journal, Vol. xii.) Athos, MouNT..^(Journal, Vol. vii.) ¦ Map of the Isthmus of. (Journal, Vol. xvii.) Arta, the Gulp op. — Surveyed in 1830. Drawn by Lieut. James Wolfe, E.N. (Journal, Vol. iii.) Argos Amphilochicum. Wall of Limncea, S.W. Side. Ruins of Limnoea. Ruins at Camarina. (Journal, Vol. iii.) Azov, Sea of. — Capt. Sherard Osboi-n's Paper on the. (Joui-nal, Vol. xxvii.) Balkan. — Map to illustrate Jochmus's Journey in the. (Journal, Vol. xxiv.) Bbaufoet, Valley op. — Map to illustrate Prof. Chaix's Paper on tbe. (Journal, Vol. xxv.) Columbeetes Rocks, near the Coast of Valencia, Spain, by Capt. W. H. Smyth, R.N., K.S.F., f.r.s. (Journal, Vol. i.) -Danube, River. — Map to accompany Notes on the Lower Course of the. By Major J. Stokes, r.e., 1859. (Journal, Vol. xxx.) Epihus. — Map of. To accompany the Paper by Major E. Stuart. (Journal, Vol. xxxix.) FiBROB Islands. — Map of the. To illustrate the Eoute of Nicolo Zeno- (Journal, Vol. xliii.) Graham Island. —Sketch of tbe appearance of Graham Island on the 18th of July, 1831, when examined by H.M.S. " Eapid." (Journal, Vol. i.) Geeecb. — Map of the Northern Frontier of. (Journal, Vol. vii.) Maps, etc., to illustrate General Jochmus's Commentaries (seven in number). 1. Taking of Thermus. 2. Defile of M&elaion. 3. Brennus against Tbermopylje, etc. 4. Battle of Marathon. 5. Plan of Sellasia. 6. Antiquities in Laconia, etc. 7. Sketch of Laconia and Cynuria, etc. (Journal, Vol. xxvii.) Maps. — Asia. 209 Iceland. — Map of. To illustrate the Paper by W. L. Watts, Esq. (Journal, Vol. xlvi.) Map to illustrate the Paper by Admiral Irminger. (Journal, Vol. xliv.) KusTBNJE AND THE DANUBE. — ^Map to illustrate Capt. Spratt's Eoute between. (Joumal, Vol. xxvi.) MiLO Gboup, etc. — Map of the Volcanic Group of Milo, etc., and of the Ancient Town of Melos, by Lieut. Leycester. (Journal, Vol. xxii.) MmoA AND NiscEA. — Map of. (Journal, Vol. viii.) Neva. — Tables illustrating a Memoir on tbe Congelation of the Neva. (Journal, Vol. v.) NoEWAY AND Lapland. — Map of the Coasts of. To illustrate Lieut. G. T. Temple's Paper. (Proceedings, Vol. ii., New Series.) Santoein. — Admiralty Map of. (Journal, Vol. xx.) Views of. To illustrate Lieut. Leycester's Paper. (Joumal, Vol. xx.) Ueal Mountains. — Map of the Southern Ural. Communicated by E. L Murchison, Esq. (Journal, Vol. xiii.) IV.— ASIA. Aden. — Map of the vicinity of. To accompany tbe Paper by G. J. Stevens. (Journal, Vol. xliii.) Afghanistan, etc — Map showing Eoute from Peshawur, through Chitral to Faizabad in Badakshan. Prom the Exploration made by a Sapper Havildar during 1870. To accompany the Paper by Major T. G. Mont gomerie, B.E., F.E.G.S. (Journal, Vol. xiii.) 10 Sketches to illustrate Sir Eichard Temple's Paper, " The Highway from the Indus to Candahar." (Proceedings, Vol. ii., New Series.) Map of the Country between Sind and Candahar, showing the course of the proposed Eailway. To illustrate Sir Eichard Temple's Paper. (Pro ceedings, Vol. ii.. New Series.) ¦ 12 Views, etc., illustrating Sir Michael A. Biddulph's Paper, " Pishin and the Eoutes between India and Candahar." (Proceedings, Vol. ii., New Series.) Al Hadhe, Ruins at. — (Journal, Vol. xi.) Amu-Daeia. — Map of the Delta and Mouths of the. Prom a Sketch Map by Admiral A. Boutakoff (Russian Navy). (Journal, Vol. xxvii.) Amij-Daeya, E. — Mouths and Lower Courses of Amu (17tb Century and subsequently). Lower courses of Amii-darya, 1848-59 (after Boutakoff). (Journal, Vol. xiv.) 19 Diagrams, Sections, etc., of the. To illustrate Wood's Notes on the Lower Amii-darya. (Journal, Vol. xiv.) Amur Ri-ver. — Map to illustrate Notes on the. (Journal, Vol. xxviii.) Anti-Libanus. — Sketch Map of the. From Observations taken in 1878, by C. F. Tyrwhitt Drake, f.e.g.s. To accompany Capt. Burton's Paper. (Journal, Vol. xiii.) Aeabia. — Map of. Shewing the Eoutes of W. G. Palgrave, Esq., in 1862-3. (Joumal, Vol. xxxiv.) Map of. (Journal, Vol. xx.) Map to illustrate Wallin's Journeys in. (Journal, Vol. xxiv.) P 210 Maps. — Asia. Arabia. — Map of Part of. Showing the Eoute of Lieut.-CoL Pelly. (Journal, Vol. xxxv.) Map of Northern and Central. To illustrate Mr. Blunt's Paper, " A Visit to Jebel Shammar." (Proceedings, Vol. U., New Series.) ¦ Map of Part of the South Coast of Arabia. (Journal, Vol. ix.) Map of the Southern Coast of. Showing the Eoute of Capt. S. B. MUes and Werner Munzinger in 1870. (Journal, Vol. xU.) Part of South-East Coast of. (Journal, Vol. xv.) South-Bast Coast of. (Journal, Vol. xvi.) Arabia PETR.a;A and Palestine. — Map of Part of. (Journal, Vol. ix.) Aral Sea. — Map to illustrate Butakoffs Survey of the. (Journal, Vol. xxiii.) Aral, Lake. — Southern Part of; according to the Survey of 1873. To illustrate Wood's Notes. (Journal, Vol. xiv.) ' ¦ ¦ After Admiral Butakoff. To illustrate Wood's Notes on Lake Aral. (Journal, Vol. xiv.) Armenia and Asia Minor. — Map of. (Journal, Vol. vi.) Armenia, Kuedistan, and Upper Mesopotamia. — Maps illustrating a Tour in. By J. G. Taylor, H.M. Consul for Kurdistan. (Joumal, Vol. xxxviii.) Asia, Central. — Constructed from the latest English and Eussian docu ments ; adapted to Eecent Astronomical Observations. By J. Arrow- smith. 1872. (Journal, Vol. xiv.) ¦ Map of. To accompany the Paper, by Capt. H. Trotter, r.e., on tbe Geographical Eesults of Sir T. D. Forsyth's Mission to Kashghar, 1873-74. (Journal, Vol. xlviii.) Asia Minor. — Map of part of. From Scutari to Vezir KbprL (Journal, Vol. ix.) Western portion of. (Journal, Vol. vin.) Map of Eoutes in. (Journal, Vol. vii.) Asia Westeen. — Sketch, showing the Eoutes of Lieuts. Conolly and Burnes. (Journal, Vol. iv.) Assam ovee the Patkoi Eange into Hookoong. — Map showing the Eoute from. To illustrate the Paper by H. L. Jenkins, Esq. (Joumal, Vol. xU.) Baghdad to Buseah. — Map to iUustrate Mr. Loftus' Journey from. (Jour nal, Vol. xxvi.) Beluchistan and Easteen Pebsia. — Sketch Map of, to accompany tbe Papers by Col. P. J. Goldsmid, c.b., and J. W. Barns, Esq., c.e. (Journal, Vol. xxxvii.) Bengal, Bay of. — Chart of the : showing the Currents of the S.W. Monsoon. by Lieut. J. A. Heathcote, H.M.I. Navy. (Journal, Vol. xxxii.) Bhamo and Mombin. — Map of tbe country between : showing the route of tbe expedition under the command of Major E. B. Sladen. (Journal, VoL xU.) Bhamo and Mcng-Mau. Eoute Map between. Through the Hills of the Lenna Kahhyens, by Ney EUas, Esq., 1875. (Journal, Vol. xlvi.) Bhawulpore States (Punjab). — ^Map of the, to accompany the Paper by J. W. Barns, Esq., f.g.s. (Journal, VoL xiii.) BoLOR Highlands. — Map to accompany Paper on tbe. By M. Veniukof. (Proceedings, Vol. xiii.) Maps. — Asia. 211 BoLOE Mountains, and the Upper Sources of the Amu Daria, explanatory Map to Article on the Pamir. By M. Veniukof. (Journal, Vol. xxxvi.) BoENEO Island. — Part of the N.W. Coast of Borneo, to illustrate the Paper of Spencer St. John, Esq., H.B.M. Consul-General for Borneo. (Journal, Vol. xxxii.) Noeth. (Proceedings, Vol. UL, New Series, p. 266.) Buema, etc — Map to illustrate Capt. Yule's Paper on the Geography of. (Journal, Vol. xxvii.) Bustae Dependency. — Sketch Map of the, by Capt. T. Holdich, e.e. (Proceedings, Vol. L, New Series.) BusHiE TO Shieaz, and thence to Kazerun. — Map to illustrate General Monteith's and Consul Abbott's Eoute from. (Joumal, Vol. xxvii.) Cambodia. — Map of Part of the Province of Siemrab (Cambodia), to accom pany the Paper by Dr. Bastian. (Journal, Vol. xxxv.) • ETC. — Map of .Cambodia, the Lao Country, etc. : to illustrate the Eoute and Notes of M. Henri Mouhot, 1859-61. (Journal, Vol. xxxii.) Caria and Lyoia. — Map of. By Mr. Hoskyn. (Journal, Vol. xii.) Caucasus. — Map of the. (Journal, Vol. xxi.) China. — Sketch Map of the South-Western Frontiers of China, from a Map compiled by the French Missionaries. (Proceedings, Vol. xv.) Map to iUustrate the journey from Hankow to TaU-fu of Mr. A. E. Margary. (Journal, Vol. xlvi.) Map showing the proposed Overland Trade Eoutes from India and British Burmah to. To accompany tbe Paper by J. Coryton, Esq. (Joumal, VoL xiv.) Central and Southern. — Map of, illustrating Mr. McCarthy's Journey from Chin-Kiang to Bhamo, 1877. (Proceedings, Vol. i., New Series.) Eastben. — Maps to accompany Papers on Journeys in, by G. J. Morrison, m.lce., 1878. (Proceedings, Vol. ii.. New Series.) Noeth and Inneb Mongolia. — Eoute Map of Joumey through, by Dr. Bushell. (Journal, Vol. xUv.) South-Bastben Coast or. — From Sir Eobert Dudley's Arcane del Mare. Vol. u., 1647. (Journal, Vol. xUv.) Westeen and Eastben Tibet. — Eoute Map of Capt. W. J. Gill's Journey in. 1877. (Journal, VoL xlviii.) Chusan. — Map to iUustrate Davis's Paper on. (Journal, Vol. xxiii.) Cochin. — Sketch to iUustrate the Paper on. (Journal, Vol. iii.) Constantinople to Mosul. — Eoute from. (Journal, Vol. x.) CooEG. — Map of. To accompany tbe Paper by George Bidie, M.B. (Journal, Vol. xxxix.) Curia Muria Isles. — Map of. (Journal, Vol. xi.) Cutch, Eunn of, etc — Map to illustrate Sir H. Bartie E. Frere's Notes on tbe. (Journal, Vol. xl.) Damascus, Hauran, and Lebanon. — Map to illustrate the Eev. Mr. Porter's Paper on Damascus, Hauran, and Lebanon. (Journal, Vol. xxvi.) Eastern Archipelago. — (Joumal, Vol. xv.) Eastern Turkistan. — Sketch Map of: showing tbe Hydrography of the Pamir to the East, tbe true Courses of the Yarkand and Karakash Eivers, with all the Routes from Ladak across the Karakoram and adjacent Ranges. To illustrate the Paper of G. W. Hayward. (Journal, Vol. xl.) p2 212 Maps. — Asia. Eastben Tuekistan, Sketch Map of. To iUustrate the Paper hy R. B. Shaw, Esq. (Journal, Vol. xlvi.) El Jemn. — Amphitheatre of. A View. (Journal, Vol. iv.) RvEEBST, Mount, and Deodanga. — Map to illustrate Col. A. S. Waugh's Paper on. (Proceedings, Vol. ii.) Foemosa' Island.— Sketch Map of. To illustrate the Paper by Mr. Robert Swinhoe (Vice Consul). (Journal, Vol. xxxiv.) SouTHEEN.— Sketch map of. To accompany the Paper by J. Thom son, Esq. (Journal, Vol. xliii.) Ganges, Mouths of the.— To illustrate account of the Cossyah Country. (Journal, Vol. ii.) Georgia and Abmenia.— Part of. To Ulustrate Col. Monteith's Journal. (Journal, Vol. iii.) Hauean, etc.— Map to illustrate Mr. Cyril Graham's Explorations East of tbe Haurdn, etc. (Joumal, Vol. xxviii.) Helmund Rivee. — Map of tbe. (Proceedings, VoL i.. New Series.) Himma-lbh Mountains. — Sketch of Part of the. To iUustrate the Paper by Capt. Johnson. (Journal, VoL iv.) Hindu Kush and Passes between the Kabul and Oxus. — (Proceedings, Vol. L, New Series.) India, etc — Sketch Map of North-Eastem India, with Portions of Burmah and China. To accompany tbe Paper by Gen. Sir Arthur Cotton, e.e. (Journal, Vol. xxxvii.) Indus. — Map of the Delta of the. To accompany the Paper by Col. C. W. Tremenheere, cb., e.e. (Joui-nal, Vol. xxxvii.) . Delta of the. — (Journal, Vol. viii.) AND Punjab Rivbes. — A Map of the Indus and Punjab Rivers, with tbe Southern Portion of Rajpootana, by Lieut. Burnes, of tbe Bombay Army. (Joumal, Vol. iii.) Map of the Indus and Punjab Rivers, with the Southern Portion of Rajpootana, by Lieut. Burnes, of the Bombay Army. (Journal, VoL iv.) IsKBNDBEtjN, Bay OF. — Map of. (Journal, Vol. viii.) Japan. — Map of. Reduced from a Japanese Map. (Journal, Vol. xxxii.) ¦ Tbe Island of Yezo. To iUustrate tbe Papers by Capt. T. Blakiston and Com. St. John, b.n. (Journal, Vol. xiii.) Map to iUustrate Mr. Troup's Tour. (Journal, Vol. xiii.) Sketch Map of Eoute from Kioto to Yedo (Japan.) To accompany the Paper by C. W. Lawrence, Esq. (Journal, Vol. xliii.) Map to illustrate a Joumey from the City of Yeddo to the Mountain of Fusi-Yama; performed by Eutherford Alcock, Esq., c.b., 1860. (Journal, Vol. xxxi.) Map of Part of Nipon Island. To accompany Mr. Adams' Eeport on the Central Silk Districts of Japan. (Journal, Vol. xl.) Jask to Bampue. — Eoute Map from. To accompany the Paper by Mr. E. A. Floyer. (Journal, Vol. xlvii.) Jebel Shammar.— Sketch Map of tbe. By W. S. Blunt, Esq. 1879. (Pro ceedings, Vol. ii.. New Series.) Jeeahi Eivbb. — Part of the. (Journal, Vol. x-vi.) Kach'hi Gandava.— Eoutes in. (Journal, Vol. viv.) Maps. — Asia. 213 Kandahab to India. — Sketch Map of a Portion of the march of the Tal — Ch6tidli Field Force from Kandahar to India in the spring of 1879. CompUed from personal observation and from information obtained, by Lieut. R. C. Temple, b.s.c. (Joumal, Vol. xlix.) Kaeun Rivee. — Sketch of the. (Journal, Vol. xiv.) Kashgae. — Map of tbe Route from Badakshan, across the Pamir Steppe to, with the Southern Branch of the Upper Oxus. Prom tbe Survey made by the Mirza, in 1868-69. To accompany the Paper by Major T. G, Montgomerie, e.e., f.e.g.s. (Journal, Vol. xU.) Kashmbbe, &c. — ^Two Sections of the Map of George Ludwig von . Reduced to one fourth. (Prom a tracing sent to the R.G.S. by M. de Khanikof). (Proceedings, Vol. x.) KashmIe. — Map of tbe VaUey of. (Journal, Vol. vi.) Kashmie. — Map of the valley of. From Surveys made by Capt. T. G. Montgomerie, under the direction of tbe Surveyor General of India. To illustrate the Notes of Capt. Godwin Austen and William Purdon, Esq., to which is added a Sketch of surrounding Countries. (Journal, Vol. xxxi.) Khiva. — Khanate of. After Eussian sources by Major Herbert Wood, r.e. (Joumal, Vol. xiv.) Khoeassan. — Map of the Northern Frontier of. With parts of Irak and Mazandar4n. To illustrate Reports by Capt. the Hon. G. Napier. (Journal, Vol. xlvi.) Khuzistan. — Map of. (Journal, Vol. xvi.) Kishm Island. — Map of. To accompany tbe Paper by Lieut. Col. Lewis Pelly. (Journal, Vol. xxxiv.) KoLADYN. — Map to iUustrate Tickell's Voyage up tbe. (Journal, Vol. xxiv.) Kong, or Cassia Rivee. — Reduced from the large Map by Albert S. Bickmore, Esq., M.A. With Sketch Map illustrating Mr. Bickmore's Journey from Canton to Hankow. (Journal, Vol. xxxviii.) Kooloo, Lahoul, and Spiti. — A Map to illustrate Capt. Harcourt's Paper on the Himalayan Valleys of. With a Sketch Map of the Passes from India to Eastern Turkistan. (Journal, Vol. xU.) Koeea, Steait of. — Tsu-sima Island in the Strait of Korea. To illustrate the Paper by Laurence Oliphant, Esq., 1863. (Joumal, Vol. xxxui.) Kuldja Disteict and the Russo-Chinese Feontiee in Turkistan. — Reduced from Col. Walker's Map. (Proceedings, Vol. U., New Series.) Kuma6n and Garhwal.- Map of. (Journal, Vol. xxi.) Kuedistan. — Map of. (Joumal, Vol. xi.) Map of Part of. Illustrating the Joumeys and Eesearches of Mr. Consul Taylor. (Joumal, Vol. xxxv.) Kurdistan and Past op Persia.— Map of. (Journal, Vol. viii.) Kuebacheb to Gwaddb. — Map of tbe Coast from. Showing the Route traversed by Major Goldsmid and Party. (Journal, Vol. xxxiii.) Leh (Ladak) to the City of Yaekund. — Summer Route from. By Capt. T. G. Montgomerie, e.b. (Journal, Vol. xxxvi.) Leh and IlchI. — Map of tbe Country between. Showing the Routes taken by Mr. Johnson, Civil-Assistant G. T. Survey, 1865. (Joumal, Vol. xxxvii.) Madbas Presidency.— The Hill Districts in the. To accompany Mr. C. R. Markham's Paper. (Journal, Vol. xxxvi.) 214 Maps. — Asia. Maghian. — Map of. By M. Fedchenko. (Joumal, VoL xliii.) Mahanuddy Eiver (Central India). — Sketch Map of the Basin of the. To accompany tbe Paper by E. Temple, Esq. (Journal, Vol. xxxv.) Mahavillaganga Eivbb, at Peeadbnia, Ceylon. — A View. (Joumal, VoL iii.) Malabab Coast. — Sketch to illustrate Capt. Carless's Paper on tbe Hurricane off the. (Journal, VoL xix.) Malay Arohipelago. — Map to illustrate a Paper on the Physical Geography of the. By Alfred Eussell Wallace, Esq., 1863. (Joumal, VoL xxxiu.) Maldiva Islands. — From Capt. Horsburgh's Chart, 1814. (Journal, Vol. ii.) Manchuria. — Map of tbe Eussian Possessions in. To accompany tbe Paper by Eev. W. V. Lloyd. (Journal, VoL xxxvii.) Map to accompany the Notes on. By the Eev. Alexander Williamson. (Journal, Vol. xxxix.) Map to accompany Notes of a Journey through. By tbe Archimand rite Palladius. (Journal, Vol. xUi.) &c. — Map to illustrate the Eoutes of Messrs. Michie and Grant, tbe former from Tien-tsin to Moukden in Manchucia, the latter from Peking across the Desert of Gobi to Kiachta. (Journal, VoL xxxiii.) Meditereanean to the Dead Sea. — Map showing the Levelling from. Executed by Capt. Wilson, r.e., under the direction of Sir Henry James, r.e., f.e.s.. Director of the Ordnance Survey. (Joumal, Vol. xxxvi.) Menam and other Siamese Eivers. — Sketch of. From the Surveys and Observations of the American Missionaries. Communicated by Mr. Consul Parkes. 1855. (Proceedings, VoL v.) Mesh-hed to the Heri Rud. — Dr. Forbes' Route from. (Journal, VoL xiv.) Mesopotamia. — Trigonometrical Survey of a part of, from Sheriat-el-Beytha (on the Tigris) to Tel Ibrahim. To accompany tbe Paper by Lieut. J. B. Bewsher. (Journal, Vol. xxxvii.) Midian. — ^Map of tbe Land of. Constructed from Reconnaissances and Surveys made by Officers of tbe Egyptian General Staff, under the command of Capt. R. P. Burton, 1878. (Joumal, Vol. xlix.) MoKHA to San'a. — Map of. (Journal, Vol. vin.) Mongolia, Western. — Map to illustrate a Joumey through. By Ney EUas, Jun., P.B.G.S., July, 1872, to January, 1873. (Journal, Vol. xliii.) Nakab el Hajab. — Map of a Route to the Ruins of, in Arabia. (Journal, Vol. vii.) Nob-Zaisan Lake, and its Neighbouehood (Chinese Taetaey). — To illustrate the Paper of M. Abramof. (Journal, VoL xxxv.) Oman, in Aeabia. — Map of. (Journal, Vol. vu.) Oxus, Uppeb. — 3 Sketches taken from Chinese Map. To iUustrate Col. Yule's Papers. (Journal, Vol. xUi.) Uppee -Region. — Photographic reduction of a Chinese Map of the Upper Oxus Region, -with Autograph Transciptions by Julius Klaproth, to whom it belonged. (Journal, Vol. xiii.) Palestine. — Physical Map of. To accompany the Paper by Major C. W. Wilson, R.E. (Journal, Vol. xliU.) Map to illustrate Mr. Poole's Route in. (Journal, VoL xxvi.) Maps. — Asia. 215 Palestine. — Map to illustrate Robinson's Journey in. (Journal, Vol. xxiv.) Pamie Steppe. — Map of the, and Neighbouring Districts. To illustrate tbe Letters of Col. Gordon and Members of the Kashgar Mission. (Pro ceedings, Vol. xviii.) Paumbum Passage. — Gulf of Manaar, 1833. (Journal, Vol. iv.) Peking. — Plan of the city of. Prom a Survey by Capt. Bouvier, of the French Engineers, 1862. To illustrate the Paper by W. Lockhart, Esq. (Journal, Vol. xxxvi.) Peeak, and Adjacent Native States..— Sketch Map of To illustrate the Paper by W. Barrington D'Almeida. (Journal, Vol. xlvi.) Pebsia. — Map to illustrate Routes from Teheran to Herat, and from Teheran to Bushire. By Capt. Claude Clerk. (Journal, Vol. xxxi.) Eoutes in. (Journal, Vol. xi.) Map to illustrate Consul Abbott's Eoutes in. (Journal, Vol. xxv.) Section from Bushire to Teheran. To accompany the Paper by Major 0. St. John. (Journal, Vol. xxxviii.) ¦ and India. — Sketch to illustrate a Memoir, by E. StirUng, Esq., on tbe Political State of the Countries between Persia and India. (Journal, Vol. V.) Peesian Gulf. — Map of the Eastern Shores of the Persian Gulf. (Journal, Vol. V.) Persia, Eastern. — Map of. To illustrate the Paper by Major-Gen. Sir P. J. Goldsmid. (Journal, Vol. xliii.) Pishin Valley and Upper Basin op the Lora. — Constructed from the surveys and reconnaissances executed by ofiicers attached to the forces serving in Southern Afghanistan, 1879, coUatted witb Major Wilson's Map by W. J. Turner. (Proceedings, Vol. ii.. New Series.) Eed Sea. — Map of tbe. (Journal, Vol. vi.) Eussian and Chinese Frontier. — Map of the. Illustrating the Journey of Semenof to the Tian-Shan Mountains and Eiver Jaxartes, and Golubefs Issyk-kul Expedition. (Journal, Vol. xxxi.) Saghalin. — The Island of. From Russian Authorities. To accompany the Paper by Col. Veniukof. (Journal, Vol. xiii.) Sarawak and Singapur. — Meteorological Observations at. (Diagrams.) (Journal, Vol. xvi.) Seistan. — Map of. To accompany the Paper by Major-Gen. Sir H. C. Rawlinson. (Journal, Vol. xliii.) Shan States. — Sketch Map to illustrate Journal of a Tour to Karen-ni, for the purpose of opening a Trading Road to the Shan Traders, from Mobyay and the adjacent Shan States, through Toungu. Protracted from the Notes, Bearings, etc., of Edward O'Riley, Esq. (Joumal, Vol. xxxii.) Shan-tung. — Sketch Map showing the Mineral and Silk Districts of the Province of. (China.) To accompany the Paper by J. Markbam, Esq., H.M. Consul at Chefoo. (Journal, Vol. xl.) Siam and Cambodia. — Sketch Map from Bangkok in Siam, to Pelombing in Cambodia. To accompany the Journal of D. 0. King, Esq., 1857-8. (Journal, Vol. xxx.) AND THE Adjacent States.— Sketch of. To iUustrate Geographical Notes on Siam, by Harry Parkes, Esq., H.B.M. Consul at Amoy, 1856.. (Proceedings, Vol. v.) Map to illustrate Consul Parkes' Paper on. (Journal, Vol. xxvi.) 216 Maps.— Asia. Siam, Gulf op, and Adjacent Distbicts in Laos and Cambodia. — To illustrate the Journey of Mr. H. G. Kennedy. (Journal, Vol. xxxvii.) SiKHiM. — Map of. To illustrate Dr. Hooker's Paper. (Journal, Vol. xx.) Sinai, Mount. — The Peninsula of. A Sketch from Observations on the ground, by the Eev. P. W. Holland, M.A. (Journal, Vol. xxxix.) Sulimani Mountains on tbe Afghan Frontier of British India. (Proceed ings, Vol. L, New Series.) Syria, etc — Map of. Showing the Eoutes of Dr. Charles T. Beke, 1861-2. (Journal, VoL xxxii.) TABRfz TO GiLAN. — Map of Eoutc from. (Journal, Vol. x.) Theohes, Mount (of Xenophon). — Sketch Map to accompany the Paper by M. Eorit, on the identification of. (Journal, Vol. xl.) Tibet, &o. — Map of the bead Waters of the Kin Char Kiang, Lan Tsan Kiang, Now Kiang, and Great' Eiver of Tibet. Laid down from Chinese Maps by T. T. Cooper. (Proceedings, Vol. xiii.) Maps showing the Eoute Survey from Nepal to Lhasa, and thence through tbe Upper Valley of tbe Brahmaputra, made by Pundit . From the Map compiled by Capt. T. G. Montgomerie, e.e. (Journal, VoL xxxviii.) Map to iUustrate Strachey's Paper on. (Journal, Vol. xxiii.) Geeat. — Map illustrating the Joumey of the Pundit Nain Singh through, from Laddkb to Assam. To accompany the Paper by Capt. H. Trotter, e.b. (Journal, Vol. xlvn.) AND Nepal. — Map showing Eoutes of Native Explorers in. To illustrate the Papers by Mr. Markham and Lieut. Col. T. G. Mont gomerie. (Journal, Vol. xiv.) TiGBis Eivbb. — From Ctesiphon to Mosul. (Journal, Vol. ix.) Teans-Indus.— Sketch Map of tbe Glaciers of the Mustakh Eange (Trans- Indus) and Valley of Skardo, etc. Surveyed by Capt. H. H. Godwin Austen. (Joumal, Vol. xxxiv.) —— Counteies, including Gilgit, Dilail, Yassin, etc. — By Geo. J. W. Hayward. (Journal, Vol. xii.) ¦ Frontier. — Map showing Recent acquisitions to the Geography of the Districts bordering the British Trans-Indus Frontier between Peshawur and Dera Ismael Khan. (Journal, Vol. xxxii.) Trans-Nabyn Countey. — Map to illustrate Baron Osten Sacken's Route, from Vernoe to the. (Central Asia.) (Journal, Vol. xl.) Teavancobe Coast and Back Waters. — Map of Portion of the. Showing the Anchorage at Alipee. To accompany Mr. C. R. Markham's Paper. (Journal, Vol. xxxvi.) Troy. — Map to accompany Dr. Porchhammer's Paper on the Topography of Troy. (Joumal, Vol. xii.) TuLUL EL Sapa.- Route Map of the. From Observations taken in May, 1871, by R. F. Burton, f.e.g.s., and 0. P. Tyrrwhitt Drake. To illus trate Capt. E. P. Burton's Paper. (Journal, Vol. xiii.) Tubcoman Steppe and Northern Khorassan. — To illustrate Sir H. Eaw- linson's Paper, " The Eoad to Merv." (Proceedings, Vol. i.. New Series.) Wuekallay Barrier. —To accompany Mr. C. E. Markham's Paper. (Jour nal, Vol. xxxvi.) Yang-tsze-Kiang, The, from Tung-Ting Lake to Chung-King. — To accom pany tbe Paper by E. Swinhoe, Esq., H.M. Consul. (Joumal, Vol. xl.) Maps. — Africa. 217 Yang-tze-Kli.ng, Map of the Basin of the. Illustrative of a Paper by E. L. Oxenham, f.e.g.s. (Journal, Vol. xiv.) ¦ From Han-kow to Ping-Shan. — From the Survey of Capt. T. Blakiston, E.A., by John Arrowsmith. To illustrate tbe Paper by Lieut.-Col. Henry Andrew Sarel, f.e.g.s. (Joumal, Vol. xxxii.) Map of the Yang-tse-Kiang, or Ta-Kiang, from Han-kow in Hoopeh to Nankin in Kiangsu. Captian Sherard Osborn, e.n., 1858. (Joumal, VoL xxx.) Map of the. (Joumal, Vol. xvii.) Yellow Eivbe. — Map to accompany Mr. Ney Elias' Paper on the New Course of the. (Journal, Vol. xl.) Yemen.- Map of Part of. By Dr. C. MiUingen. (Journal, Vol. xUv.) Map of Part of (from Niebuhr). To accompany the Paper by Dr. 0. MiUingen. (Journal, Vol. xliv.) Zaeafshan Valley. — Map to illustrate the Expedition of Mr. A. Fedchenko to the, in 1869. (Journal, Vol. xl.) Zohab to Khuzistan. — Map of Eoute from. (Journal, Vol. ix.) v.— AFEICA. Abyssinia. — Map of the Countries South of. By Dr. Cbarles Beke. (Joumal, Vol. xiii.) Map of the Countries South of. (Joumal, Vol. xvii.) Map illustrating Dr. Beke's Journey in. (Journal, Vol. xiv.) 1. Map showing the Line of March from the Coast to Adigerat. 2. Line of March from Adigerat to the Eiver Takkazye. 3. Wadela and Dalanta Plateaux and Magdala. To illustrate tbe Paper by C. E. Markham, Esq., on the Geographical Eesults of the Abyssinian Expedition. (Journal, Vol. xxxviii.) Map of Part of. To illustrate Dr. Blanc's Journey from Metemma to Damot. (Journal, Vol. xxxix.) Afab Countey and the Nobtheen Paet op the Abyssinian Highlands. — To illustrate the Journey of W. Munzinger, Esq. (Journal, Vol. xxxix.) Afeica. — Map to illustrate Dr. Livingstone's Explorations in. (Journal, Vol. xxv.) Map to illustrate Mr. Moffat's Journey from Colesberg to Steinkopf, and from Little Namaqualand eastward, along the Orange Eiver. (Joumal, Vol. xxviii.) Map to illustrate Livingstone's Explorations in. (Joumal, Vol. xxiv.) Centbal. — Map to illustrate Mr. Gassiott's Eoute to the Limpopo; also of Mr. Gallon's Expedition into tbe Interior of S.W. Africa from Walfisch Bay, and of Messrs. Livingstone and Oswell's Explorations in Central Africa to the N. of Lake 'Ngami. (Joumal, Vol. xxu.) Map to iUustrate Mr. Macqueen's Paper on. (Journal, Vol. xxxvi.) Map of. (Journal, Vol. xxi.) Map showing the Eoute of Silva Porto from Benguela to Cape Delgado, in 1853-54 ; also the Sources of the Nile and tbe Countries around them, by James Macqueen, Esq. (Journal, Vol. xxx.) 218 Maps. — Africa. Afeica, Centbal, Map to illustrate Dr. Vogel's Joumey to. (Journal, Vol. xxv.) Intebiob op. — Dr. Livingstone's Explorations in. (Journal, Vol. xxvii.) NoBTH. — Map showing the Caravan Eoutes between Tripoli and Ghadamis. To accompany the Account of Ghadamis by C. H. Dickson, Esq. (Journal, Vol. xxx.) Map of. To illustrate the Question, " Is the Quorra the Nigir of the Ancients ? " By W. Leake. (.Toumal, VoL ii.) ¦ ¦ Map to accompany a General Historical Description of the state of Human Society in Northern Central Africa, by Dr. H. Barth. (Jour nal, Vol. xxx.) East Centbal. — Sketch of tbe supposed Eoute of Dr. Livingstone, and probable place of the attack by the Mavite, by J. Kirk, m.d., H.M. Vice-Consul, Zanzibar. (Proceedings, Vol. xi.) • Eastern. — Map to illustrate the Explorations in. By Count Carl Krockow. (Journal, Vol. xxxvi.) Map showing the Eoutes of some Native Caravans from the Coast into the Interior of. From information collected by tbe Rev. T. Wakefield, Missionary at Mambasa ; also of two Personal Journeys to the Southern Galla Country made by the Revs. T. Wakefield and C. New in 1865 and 1866-7. (Journal, Vol. xl.) ¦ ¦ Map of the Routes in Eastern Africa between Zanzibar, tbe Great Lakes, and tbe Nile, Explored and Surveyed by Capt. J. H. Speke, 1867-63. (Journal, Vol. xxxiii.) Bast. — Map of the Routes between Zanzibar and the Great Lakes in Eastern Africa, in 1857, 1858, and 1859, by Capts. R. P. Burton and J. H. Speke. (Journal, Vol. xxix.) The East African Lakes, sho-wing their relation to the Source of the Nile. With Map of the Lake Region : — 1. According to Burton and Speke, May, 1858. 2. Speke, 1869. 3. Speke and Grant, 1863. 4. Sir S. W. Baker, 1864. (Journal, Vol. xxxvii.) ¦ ¦ ¦ ¦ Map to illustrate the progress of the East Africa Expedition. (Joumal, Vol. xxviii.) Sketch Map of the Route of tbe R.G.S. Bast African Expedition from Dar-es-Salaam to Lake Nyassa, 1879. (Proceedings, Vol. ii., New Series.) Map of tbe Route of the R.G.S. Bast African Expedition to Lakes Nyassa and Tanganyika, constructed from Mr. Thompson's Original Map, collated with the Routes of other Explorers, by W. J. Turner. (Proceedings, Vol. ii.. New Series.) Sketch Map of Native Routes from Dar-es-Salaam towards the head of Lake Nyassa. Prom Information obtained by Mr. Keith John son, E.G.S. , Eastern African Expedition, 1879. (Proceedings, Vol. i. New Series.) ¦ Sketch Map of Route from Lake Nyassa to Ugogo. By Mr. H. B. Cotterill. (Proceedings, Vol. xxii.) Equatoeial.- Map Ulustrating M. Du Chaillu's Routes in, 1864-65 (JouiTial, Vol. xxxvi.) West Coast of.— To Ulustrate Capt. Belcher's Observations. (Jour nal, Vol. ii.) Map of. (Journal, Vol. vi.) South.' — Map of: iUustrating tbe Journey of Major Serpo Pinto from Benguella to Natal, 1877-79. (Proceedings, Vol. L, New Series.) Maps.— Africa. 219 Afeica, West Coast of. — Map of Zulu, Amatonga, Natal, and Kaffir Land, from the Sketches of Messrs. Sanderson, Paxton, Rider, and Newling. To iUustrate Papers by Jobn Sanderson, Esq., 1861. (Journal, Vol. xxxn.) Map to illustrate Mr. Anderson's Journey in. (Journal, Vol. xxv.) Sketch to accompany a Trading Trip into tbe Orange River Free States, and the Country of the Transvaal Republic in 1851-52. By Jobn Sanderson, Esq. (Journal, Vol. xxx.) ¦ Sketch to illustrate the Paper by W. D. Cooley, Esq. (Journal, Vol. iii.) ¦ Map of the Central Portion of. Illustrating Dr. Holub's Jour neys, 1873-9. (Proceedings, Vol. ii.. New Series.) Map of. To illustrate the Paper by James Fox Wilson, Esq., and Dr. Livingstone's theory of Ancient Lakes. (Journal, Vol. xxxv.) Tempbeatb. To Ulustrate a Paper by Sir Bartie Frere. (Proceedings, Vol. iii., New Series, p. 64.) South-East. — Map to accompany a Journey from Inbambane to Zoutpansberg, in 1855-6, to which is added the parts of South Africa, adjacent, by J. McQueen, Esq. (Journal, VoL xxxii.) South-Eastben. — Sketch Map of Part of. To illustrate the Journeys of Dr. Lacerda (1798), the Pombeiros (1806-11), and Major Monteiro. (1831-32). In Supplement to Journal, " The Lands of Cazembe," 1873. SouTHBEN. — Outline Map of. To illustrate the Analysis of Capt. Owen's Voyage. (Journal, Vol. iii.) Map of tbe S.W. portion of. (Journal, Vol. viii.) Western. — Map to illustrate Travels in the Yoruba and Nupe Coun tries. Performed by Daniel J. May, Esq., e.n., 1858. (Journal, Vol. xxx.) Albert N'yanza. — Map of. And of tbe Routes leading to its Discovery in 1864, by Samuel White Baker, Esq. (Proceedings, Vol. x.) Map of the. And of the Routes leading to its Discovery in 1864, by Samuel W. Baker, Esq. (Journal, VoL xxxvi.) Bamangwato Country. — Map of the. To illustrate Capt. Patterson's Paper. (Proceedings, Vol. L, New Series.) Baekly to Gubuluwayo (South Africa). — Route Map of A. C. Bailie's Journey from. (Journal, Vol. xlviii.) Bbnzerta. — The Lakes of. (Journal, Vol. xvi.) Berenice. — ^View of the Ruins of. (Journal, Vol. vi.) BiNUE River, Upper. — Map of the. From a Survey by Mr. E. R. Plegel, of the Church Missionary Society's Expedition, 1879. (Proceedings, Vol. ii.. New Series.) BoNAH TO KosTANTiNAH. — Map of Route from. (Journal, Vol. viii.) Bonny and Brass Rivers. — Chart of Creeks and Rivers between. Surveyed by R. D. Boler and R. Knight, Sept. 1874. (Journal, Vol. xlvi.) Cambroons, Mount. — The Vicinity of. From a Drawing by the Rev. T. J. Comber, Baptist Missionary Society, 1877. (Proceedings, Vol. L, New Series.) Cape Colony.— Map of. (Journal, Vol. -vi.) Cape of Good Hope. — Chart of tbe Currents off the. To accompany Capt. Toynbee's Paper " On tbe Specific Gravity, Temperature, and Currents of the Sea," the result of a portion of five Consecutive yearly Voyages 220 Maps.—Africa. from England to India. Projected from tbe Log-books by S. Comm. C. George, Map Curator e.g.s. (Journal, Vol. xxxv.) Cape op Good Hope. Sketch of tbe Cape of Good Hope Colony. (Journal, VoL V.) Chad, Lake, and Neighboueing Regions. — To illustrate the Paper by Dr. Nachtigal. (Joumal, Vol. xM.) Chadda Rivee. — Dr. Baikie's Trip up the. (Journal, Vol. xxv.) Chobb Rivee. — (Proceedings, Vol. iii.. New Series, p. 256.) Congo Rivee. — Reduction of Lieut. Grandy's Map of his Eoute from Ambriz to the Eiver Congo, 1873-4. (Journal, Vol. xlvi.) ¦ Neighbourhood of San Salvador. (Proceedings, Vol. iii., New Series, p. 64.) Damaea Land. — Map of the principal part of. Based on Prismatic Compass Triangulation checked by observed Latitudes. By C. J. Ajidersson, Esq., Cape Town, 1866. (Journal, Vol. xxxvi.) Dae-es-Salam to Kilwa. — The Slave Caravan Eoute from. To accompany the Paper by Capt. F. Elton. (Journal, Vol. xUv.) Egyptian Desebt. — Map of tbe Egyptian Desert between Keneb and Suez, by J. Wilkinson, Esq. (Joumal, Vol. n.) Gambia and Casamanza Eivebs. — Sketch to illustrate Paper on the supposed junction of the Gambia and Casamanza Eivers. (Journal, Vol. iii.) Gasa Countey. — Eoute Map of the. IUustrating the Joumey of Umzila, King of Gasa. Eeduced from the original Map constructed by Mr. St. Vincent Erskine. (Joumal, Vol. xiv.) Jamooe Ri-ver. — Mouths of the. (Journal, Vol. xvi.) JuBB AND Haines Rivers. —Lower Courses of the. (Joumal, Vol. xiv,) KagAi to Tabora. — Map of Route from. By the Rev. C. T. Wilson. (Proceedings, Vol. ii., New Series.) Kilima-ndjabo Mountains. — Map of the Snowy Mountains, KUima-ndjaro, iUustrating the Paper of Baron C. Von der Decken. (Journal, Vol. xxxiv.) Kordofan and Darpue. — Map of Routes in. Constructed from tbe recon naissances made by Officers of the Egyptian General Staff, 1875-76, by W. J. Turner. (Joumal, Vol. xlix.) KwARA, Yiu, AND Chada Eivbrs. — (Joumal, Vol. -viu.) (See also Quorra and Niger.) Limpopo Eiver. — Mouth of the. By St. Vincent W. Erskine. (Joumal, Vol. xxxix.) Map of Eoute from the Tati Settlement to Delagoa Bay. To illustrate the Paper by Capt. P. Elton. (Journal, Vol. xiii.) AND Zambesi Eivers. — Sketch Map of Mr. Baines' Eoutes between tbe. (Joumal, Vol. xii.) LupiGi Eiver. — Map of the two main Mouths of the. From a Sketch by Capt. Wharton, H.M.S. " Shearwater." (Proceedings, Vol. xviii.) Madagascar. — Physical Map of. By tbe Eev. James Sibree, reduced from Dr. Mullens' Map. (Proceedings, Vol. L, New Series.) Map to illustrate CoL Lloyd's Paper. (Joumal, Vol. xx.) Part of. Prom the latest Surveys by Joseph Mullens, d.d. (Journal, Vol. xlvi.) The Central Provinces of. By Joseph Mullens, d.d. (Journal, A'oL xiv.) Maps.— Africa. 221 Madagascar, South-Bast, and the Ibara Country. — By Joseph MuUens, D.D. From the Surveys of Messrs. Sibree, Shaw, and Richardson. (Journal, VoL xlvii.) West-Central. — By Joseph Mullens, d.d. Prom Messrs. Grandidier, Sewell, &c. (Journal, Vol. xlvii.) Mabocco. — From Observations in 1830. (Joumal, Vol. i.) Moselekatse. — Map to illustrate Mr. Moffat's Route to. (Joumal, Vol. xxvi.) Natal. Map of the Colony of. To accompany the Paper by Dr. R. J. Mann. (Journal, Vol. xxxvi.) N'gami, Lake. — Map to iUustrate tbe Route to. (Journal, VoL xx.) Nigee, River. — Country of the. Map to accompany Notes of a Journey from Bida in Nupe, to Kano in Haussa. Performed by Dr. W. B. Baikie, r.n., 1862. (Journal, Vol. xxxvu.) (See also Quorra and Kwara.) Nile and its Western Affluents, between the Albert Nyanza on the South, and the Sobat on the North. Founded on the Astronomical Observations, Bearings, and Distances, of John Petherick, Esq. (Joumal, Vol. xxxv.) Map of the, from Es-suan to Alleis. (Journal, Vol. ix.) Sections of the Valley of the Nile in Egypt. (Journal, Vol. ix.) River. — Sketch Map of Route from Gondokoro to Dufli, by J. Kemp, Esq., Sept., Oct., 1874. (Proceedings, Vol. xix.) Sources of the. Rough Sketch of Countries North and South of the Equator on the Meridian of Khartum. (Proceedings, Vol. v.) Upper Countries of the Nile. To illustrate M. Linant's Journey. (Journal, Vol. ii.) Upper. — Map of the. To illustrate tbe Reports of Col. Gordon and M. Gessi, by W. J. Turner. (Proceedings, Vol. xxi.) Nyassi, or tbe Great Lake of Southern Africa. (Journal, Vol. xv.) Nyassi Lake, the Shire River, &c. — From tbe MS. Map by Dr. Kirk. With Section. (JournaL Yol. xxxv.) Sketch Map of. By Mr. E. D. Young, 1876. (Proceedings, Vol. XX.) Route Survey of the Western Side of (Northern Portion). By Mr. James Stewart, o.B., 1879. (Proceedings, Vol. ii.. New Series.) ¦ Route Survey of the Western Side of. By Mr. Jas. Stewart, c.e., Livingstonia Mission, 1878. (Proceedings, Vol. L, New Series.) AND Tangan-yika. — Routo Survey between. By Mr. Jas. Stewart, c.e., 1879. (Proceedings, Vol. ii.. New Series.) North end of. (Proceedings, Vol. iii.. New Series, p. 320.) Okavango Rivee. — (Proceedings, Vol. iv.. New Series, p. 44.) Old Calabae, oe Ceoss Rivee, The. — (Journal, Vol. xiv.) QuANZA Rivee. — Chart of the. From tbe Bar to the Livingstone Falls. Sur veyed and Drawn by Carl Alexanderson, 1873-74. (Journal, Vol. xlvi.) QuoREA, OE Niger, Ri-vbe. — Map of. (Journal, Vol. xi.) The Course of the Quorra, the Joliba, or Niger of Park, from the Journals of Messrs. Richard and Jobn Lander, with their Route from Badagry to the Northward, in 1830. (Journal, Vol. i.) (See also Kwara and Niger.) Red Sea. — Map of the Red Sea, from the late Survey. (Journal, VoL v.) Regio Aeomatipera. — Sketch of the. To illustrate Mr. Cooley's Paper. (Joumal, Vol. xix.) 222 Maps. — Africa. EuFiGi Rivee. — Track and Soundings of Steam Cutter up the. By Capt. Sulivan, e.n., assisted by Sub-Lieut. P. J. Grassie, e.n., H.M.S. " London," 24th Feb., 1875. (Journal, Vol. xiv.) EuFU, OR KiNGANi Ei-VBE (Eastern Africa). — Map of. To accompany the Paper by Frederick Holmwood, Esq. (Journal, Vol. xlvii.) Sohwa. — Map to iUustrate Dr. Beke's Excursion in. (Joumal, Vol. xii.) Senaar. — Sketch of the Province of. (Journal, Vol. v.) Shire and Zambesi Eivers. — The Course of the Eiver Shire, below Lake Nyassa and the Eiver Zambesi, below Kabrabasa. To illustrate the Papers of Dr. David Livingstone. (Journal, Vol. xxxi.) SoooTRA Island. — Map of the. (Joumal, Vol. v.) SouFPLBUR Point, Mauritius. — (A View). (Joumal, Vol. iii.) Suakin to Ea-sai. — Map showing Route of the Electric Telegraph from. Reduced from the Map by the late Capt. L. Rokeby, b.n. (Journal, Vol. xUv.) Tajurrah to Ank6bab. — Eoute from. (Journal, Vol. x.) TANGAN"nKA AND LovALE. — Eeduction of Lieut. Cameron's Preliminary Map of his Eoute and the adjacent Country between, 1874-5. With contiuuation from tbe Maps of Dr. Livingstone and other travellers. (Proceedings, Vol. xx.) Lake. — Map of. From Ujiji to its Southern extremity. Eeduced from the Map by Lieut. V. Lovett Cameron, e.n. (Joumal, Vol. xiv.) From Ujiji to its Southern extremity. Eeduced from the Map by Lieut. V. L. Cameron, e.n. (Proceedings, Vol. xix.) Teansvaal and the Subbounding Teeeitoeies. — By P. Jeppe, p.e.g.s. (Joumal, Vol. xlvii.) Teipoli to GHADAMfs. — Map to illustrate the Journey from. By Vice- Consul Dickson. (Journal, Vol. xxii.) Uniamesi, Sea of, &c. — By tbe Eev. Messrs. Erbardt and Eebman, of the Church Missionary Society, 1856. (Proceedings, Vol. i.) Usambaba, Southben. — Map of Mr. Keith Johnston's Eoute in, 1879. Eeduced from his original drawing. (Proceedings, Vol. i.. New Series.) Map of. By the Rev. J. P. Farler, b.a. (Proceedings, Vol. L, New Series.) Vei Language. — Inscriptions of the. (Journal, Vol. xx.) Alphabet of tbe. (Journal, Vol. xx.) Victoria Nyanza, Lake. — 1. Stanley's Map of the. Adapted to the Observations and Topography of Capt. Speke and Col. Grant by W. J. Turner. 2. Map of the Victoria Nyanza as delineated by Mr. H. M. Stanley. (Proceedings, Vol. xx.) Map of the North-West Portion of the. Constructed from Col. Grant's Original Map and Bearings, adapted to the Astronomical Observa tions of Capt. Speke, by W. J. Turner. (Journal, Vol. xlvi.) Map of the. Compiled from the Original Maps of Capt. Speke, Col. Grant, and Mr. Stanley ; adapted to the Recorded Observations of Captain Speke by W. J. Turner. (Journal, Vol. xlvi.) White Nile, from Khartum to Eigaf. — By Lieuts. Watson and Cbip- pendall, e.e. (Journal, Vol. xlvi.) PROM Lardo to Ubondogani. — Map of. By Col. Gordon, cb., E.E. Surveyed in 1875-76. (Journal, Vol. xlvi.) Zambesi Eegion, Centbal. —(Proceedings, Vol. iii., New Series, p. 192.) Maps. — America. 223 VI.— AMEEICA AND V^EST INDIES. Amazon Eiver. — Map of tbe. (Joumal, Vol. vi.) America, Beitish Noeth. — Map to illustrate Capt. Synge's proposed Eoute through. (Journal, Vol. xxii.) Centbal. — Map illustrating Fitz-Eoy's Paper on. (Joumal, Vol. xxiii.) ' Map of. (Joumal, Vol. xx.) ¦ Map of Canal. (Journal, Vol. xxi.) Discovery on N.E. Coast of. (Journal, Vol. x.) Noeth. — Sketch showing the proposed Eoute of Capt. Back. (Journal, Vol. ni.) Map of the Country between Lake Superior and Vancouver Island. To illustrate the Papers of the Exploring Expedition under tbe Command of Capt. John Palliser, 1857 to 1860. (Journal, Vol. xxx.) South. — Chart of a Part of South America, Surveyed by Order of The Et. Hon. the Lords Commissioners of the Admiralty, under tbe Direction of Capt. P. P. King, e.n., during tbe years 1826-30. (Journal, VoL i.) Andes. — Map of tbe Bolivian Andes. (Journal, Vol. v.) Map of the Mountains of Llanganati, in tbe Quitonian Andes, by Don Atanasio Guzman. To illustrate a Paper by Eichard Spruce, Esq. (Journal, Vol. xxxi.) Map of Proposed Line of Eailway across the Andes, from Caldera to Fiambala. To accompany Eeport of Mr. E. A. Flint's Survey. Com municated by W. Wheelright Esq. (Journal, VoL xxxi.) Map to iUustrate Extracts from tbe Narrative of a Eoute across the Southern Andes, by Don GuUiermo Cox, 1862-3. (Journal, Vol. xxxiv.) ¦ — — Map showing tbe Projected Eailway Eoute from Buenos Ayres to Chile. To accompany the Paper by E. Crawford, Esq. (Journal, Vol. xliii.) • Map to illustrate Lloyd's Journey across the. (Journal, Vol. xxiv.) Diagrams to illustrate T. J. Hutchinson's Paper, " Across the Andes from Callao." (Proceedings, Vol. xviii.) Anegada, with its Eeefs. — By E. H. Schomburgk. (Journal, Vol. ii.) Aquiey Eivbb. — Map ofthe (an affluent of the Puriis). To accompany Notes by W. Chandless, Esq. (Journal, Vol. xxxvi.) Argentine Eepublic — Map of part of the. To illustrate the Paper by Mr. Consul Hutchinson. (Joumal Vol. xxxiv.) Atacama Desert of (Bolivia). — Map of part of. To accompany the Paper by Mr. Josiah Harding. (Journal, Vol. xlvii.) District op. — Showing the Territory in Dispute between Chili and Bolivia. (Proceedings, Vol. i.. New Series.) Bolivia.— Map of Part of. From the Surveys of J. B. Minohin. To Ulustrate tbe Paper by G. C. Musters (Eetired Com. e.n.). (Jom-nal, Vol. xl-vu.) BeazH;. — Map of the Rivers Arinos, Juruena, and Tapajos. To accompany the Notes of W. Chandless, Esq., 1862. (joumal. Vol. xxxii.) . Map of the Eivers Canuma, Abacaxis, and Maue-assii and its 224 Maps. — America. Tributaries. Eeduced from the Original Map by W. Chandless, Esq. (Journal, Vol. xl.) Beazil, Nobth-East. — Eoute Map of a Joumey through. By James W. Wells, CB. (Journal, Vol. xlvi.) South. — The VaUeys of the Tibagy and Ivahy, Pro-vince of the Parand. By T. P. Bigg- Wither. (Journal, Vol. xlvi.) Beitish Columbia. — 1. Map of. Eeduced from the Original Map by Mr. Alfred Waddington. 2. Sketch Map, showing Proposed Communication between Canada and British Columbia. To accompany the Paper by Mr. Alfred Waddington. (Journal, Vol. xxxviu.) Part of. To iUustrate the Papers of Mr. Justice Begbie, Com. Mayne, r.n., Lieut. Palmer, r.e., and Mr. Dovmie, 1861. (Journal, Vol. xxxi.) Outline Map of Part of. By Lieut. H. S. Palmer, e.b. Eeconnaissance Sketch of Part of Cariboo by Lieut. H. S. Palmer, e.e. (Journal, Vol. xxxiv.) Noeth Ameeican Boundaey. — By Capt. S. Anderson, e.b.. Chief Astronomer, North American Boundary Commission. (Joumal, Vol. xlvi.) Guayana. — Map of. (Journal, Vol. vii.) Map of. (Journal, Vol. vi.) Map of a Portion of. (Joumal, Vol. xv.) Part of. (Joumal, Vol. iv.) Huts of tbe Warrows. (A View.) (Journal, Vol. iv.) Guiana — Sketch Map of. By J. E. Alexander, h.p. (Joumal, Vol. ii.) ¦ Sketch Map of a Portion of the Essequebo and Potaro Eivers. Showing the Position of Kaieteur Pall. To accompany the Paper by C. B. Brown, Esq. (Journal, Vol. xii.) Eeduction of the Map of. Compiled from tbe Surveys executed under Her Majesty's Commission from 1841 to 1844, and under the Direction of the Royal Geographical Society from 1836 to 1839, by Sir R. H. Schomburgk. Revised and Corrected. (Proceedings, Vol. ii., New Series.) Califoenia. — Sketch of the Coast of Upper California (Joumal, Vol. v.) Carthagena to Bogoto. — Section of South America, from Carthagena to Bogoto. — A Spanish MS. found among Mr. Lloyd's Papers. Authority unknown. (Journal, Vol. i.) Central Ameeica. — Map of. (Joumal, Vol. xi.) Columbus. — Map to Ulustrate Capt. Becber's Landfall of. (Journal, Vol. xxvi.) CooMAEOW Fall. — Massaroony Eiver. (View.) (Journal, Vol. iv.) CoEDOBA TO La Eioja. — Eoute from. South America. (Journal, Vol. ix.) CosTABBiCA. — Map of. (Journal, Vol. vi.) Cuzco. — Map of the Environs of. (Journal, Vol. vi.) Plan of. Ancient and Modern. (Journal, Vol. xii.) Daeien. — Map of Part of tbe Isthmus of. To accompany the Paper by M. Lucien de Puydt. (Journal, Vol. xxxviii.) Map to illustrate Provost's Survey of the Isthmus of. (.lournal, Vol. xxiv.) Maps. — America. 225 Daeien, Isthmus of. — Mr. Gisbome's Paper on the. (Journal, VoL xxvii.) EcuADOB. — Sketch Map to illustrate Explorations in. By G. J. Pritchett, 1856-57. (Journal, Vol. xxx.) Falkland Island, East. — From Papers communicated by Woodbine Parish Esq. (Joumal, Vol. iii.) Peobishbe's Voyages. — Map to illustrate Capt. Becber's Paper on Frobisher's Voyages. (Journal, Vol. xii.) Guayana. — Map of. (Journal, VoL x.) Guiana. — Map to illustrate the Chevalier Schomburgk's Eoute in. (Journal, Vol. xu.) HoNDUBAS. — Sketch showing the Position of Lake Yojoa or Taulebe, also the Proposed Eailway between tbe Bay of Honduras and the Bay of Fonseca. To illustrate a paper by E. G. Squier, 1859. (Journal, Vol. xxx.) Hudson's Steaits. — Chart of. (Joumal, Vol. viL) JuBUA EivEB. — Map of tbe. For an estimated distance of 980 Geographioal Miles from its Mouth. By W. Chandless, Esq. (Joumal, Vol. xxxix.) Labbadob. — Chart of the North-East Coast of. To accompany the Paper by Com. W. Chimmo. (Joumal, Vol. xxxviii.) Map of. Showing the Canoe Eoute from Seven Islands to Hamilton Inlet. Map of the Eiver Moisie and adjoining Country. Illustrating the Paper by Prof. H. Y. Hind. (Journal, Vol. xxxiv.) Magdalena, State of, D.S. of Columbia. — Map of the Northern Part of. By Mr. P. A. A. Simons, 1879. (Proceedings, VoL L, New Series.) Massaeoony Eiver, South Amebica. — By W. Hilhouse, Esq., 1830. (Journal, Vol. iv.) ¦ ¦ View on the. Natives Pishing. (Joumal, VoL iv.) Mexico. — Map to illustrate a Journey to the North-Western Provinces of Mexico, by Cbarles Sevin, 1856. (Journal, VoL xxx.) MiExicAN Antiquities. (Journal, Vol. vu.) Mississippi. — Sources of the. 1834. (Journal, Vol. iv.) Mosquito Teebitory. — Map of the. Prom Surveys and Sketches made during several years' residence in the Country. By Charles N. BeU, Esq., 1856. (Joumal, Vol. xxxii.) Newfoundland. — Map of To accompany the Paper by Alexander Murray Esq. (Journal, Vol. xlvii.) Map of. To accompany the Paper by the Eev. J. Morefon. (Joumal, Vol. xxxiv.) Map of Part of. To illustrate the Paper by Staff-Com. G. Eobinson, R.N. (Journal, Vol. xlvii.) Panama, The Isthmus of. — To illustrate the Paper by Laurence Oliphant, Esq. Mouths of the Bayanos Eiver (to accompany Mr. Oliphant's Paper). (Joumal, Vol. xxxv.) Patagonia. — Map of Part of. By Henry L. Jones, Esq., to accompany bis Notes. (Journal, Vol. xxxi.) To illustrate Capt. Musters' Eoute. 1869-70. (Journal, Vol. xU.) Peel Eivbb, Noeth Ameeica. — Sketch Map of the. (Journal, Vol. xv.) Pbbu. — Sketch Map of tbe Province of Caravay, &c. in Southern Peru ; showing the Sources ofthe Eiver Purus. By Clements E. Markham, Esq. (Journal, Vol. xxxi.) Q 226 Maps. — America. Pbbu. — Map showing the Course of the Rivers, S. Gavan and Esquilaya in the Province of Carabaya. To accompany the Paper by Sr. Raimondi. (Journal, Vol. xxxvii.) Map showing the Junction of tbe Rivers Mantaro and Apurimac. To accompany the Paper by Prof. A. Raimondi. (Journal, Vol. xxxviii.) ¦ SouTHEEN. — Map of. (Journal, Vol. xxi.) Map of. To accompany Mr. Markham's Paper. (Journal, Vol. xUv.) PuEUS, Rivee. — Mr. Markham's Route to the. (Journal, Vol. xxv.) Map of the. From near its source to its mouth. By W. Chandless, Esq. (Journal, Vol. xxxvi.) Rio Negeo. — Map to illustrate Wallace's Paper on the. (Journal, Vol. xxii.i) OP Patagonia. — Map of. (Joumal, Vol. vi.) Samana. — Map to illustrate Schomburgk's Paper on. (Journal, Vol. xxiii.) Santa Cbuz Rivee. — Map of. (Journal, VoL vii.) Tabasco and its Tbibutaeies. — Part of the. (Joumal, Vol. xv.) Teeba Cotta. — Heads in. (Journal, Vol. viL) United States. — Map of tbe South-Western Portion of the, and of Sonora and Chihuahua. To illustrate tbe Paper by Dr. W. A. Bell. (Journal, Vol. xxxix.) Ueuguay. — Estancia de San Jorge. Prom a Survey by Don Juan Frugoni, Durazno, 1867. (Proceedings, Vol. ii.,New Series.) UsuMASiNTA Rivee.- — Sketch of the Course of tbe. Central America. To illustrate CoL Galindo's Paper. (Journal, Vol. iii.) Vancouvee Island. — Sketch of the Country between Albemie Canal and Nanaimo. Showing the Line of Road proposed by Com. Mayne, b.n. 1861. (Journal, Vol. xxxii.) ¦ ¦ Map of. To illustrate the Paper of Dr. C. Forbes, r.n. (Joumal, VoL xxxiv.) AND Part of British Columbia. — Map of. To accompany tbe Paper by R. Brown, Esq. (Journal, Vol. xxxix.) Map to illustrate Lieut.-Col. Grant's Paper on. (Journal, Vol. xxvii.) Virgin Islands. — Map of the. (Journal, Vol. v.) West Indies. — 1. Bahama Islands. Antonia de Herrera, 1601. 2. Bahama Islands. Modem. To accompany Mr. Major's Paper. 3. Watling Island. To accompany Mr. Major's Paper. (Journal, Vol. xU.) William the Fourth's Cataract. — View of. (Journal, Vol. vi.) Yncas. — Ttabuantin-Suyu or tbe Empire of tbe (except Quito and CbUe) in its four great divisions of Cbincba-Suyu, Cunti-Suyu, Anti-Suyu, CoUa-Suyu, with their Tribes and Ayllus or Lineages ; also the Routes of the Ynca Conquerers. By Clements R. Markham, cb. (Journal, Vol. xiii.) Yukon ob Kwioh-pak Riveb.— Map of the. To iUustrate Mr. Whymper's Paper. (Joumal, Vol. xxxviii.) Maps of Australia. Til vn.— AUSTEALASIA. Austealia. — Map of. (Journal, Vol. viu.) Central. — Map to illustrate Diaries of Exploration of, by John McDouall Stuart, Esq., 1860 and 1861. (Journal, Vol. xxxi.) ' Map to accompany the Diary of Messrs. Burko and Wills, across Australia to the Gulf of Carpentaria; also Mr. Hewitt's Journal to Cooper's Creek. Constructed chiefly from the Observations and Field- book of W. J. Wills, Esq., 1861. (Journal, Vol. xxxii.) Easteen. — Map of: on wbich are Delineated the Routes of Messrs. Burke and Wills, McKinlay, Landsborough and Walker, &c. (Journal, Vol. xxxiu.) ¦ — — Mobeton Bay, &c. — Sketch Map to Ulustrate Mr. H. S. RusseU's Papers. (Journal, Vol. xv.) North-East. — Map to illustrate the Winds of. To accompany the Paper by Dr. A. Rattray, m.d., r.n. (Journal, Vol. xxxviii.) Map to illustrate tbe Climate and Physical Geography of North- East AustraUa. To accompany tbe Paper by Dr. A. Rattray, m.d., b.n. (Journal, Vol. xxxviii.) Map illustrating" the Overland Expedition from Port Denison to Cape York under the Command of P. and A. Jardine, Esqs. To accompany Mr. Richardson's Paper. (Journal, Vol. xxxvi.) Dr. Leichardt's Exploration in. (Journal, Vol. xvi.) Map of Capt. Sturt's Route. (Journal, Vol. xvii.) Noeth. — Map to complete Diaries of Exploration across Australia (from South to North) by Jobn McDouaU Stuart, Esq., 1861 and 1862. (Journal, Vol. xxxiii.) Map of the N.W. Coast. (Journal, Vol. viii.) Noeth- Westeen. — Map of. To illustrate the Joumal of Exploring Expedition, Commanded by F. T. Gregory, Esq., 1861. (Journal, Vol. xxxii.) Map to illustrate the Route of the North Australian Expedition, and Mr. Wilson's Paper on tbe Physical Geography of N.W. Australia. (Journal, Vol. xxviii.) South. — Sketch to iUustrate Extracts of Explorations made by Surv.- Gen. Freeling, Mr. S. Hack, and others in South AustraUa, 1857. (Proceedings, Vol. ii.) Range of Southern Dialects of. (Journal, Vol xv.) Map of the Explorations from Beltana Station (South Australia), to the City of Perth (Western AustraUa), by Ernest Giles, 1876. (Journal, Vol xlvi.) Map of the South-East Portion of Australia, showing the Progress of Discovery in tbe Interior of New South Wales to 1832. (Journal, Vol. ii.) Map of the South-Eastern Portion of. (Joumal, Vol. vii.) Westeen. — Map to illustrate Mr. Austin's Explorations in. (Journal, Vol. xxvi.) From the Latest Documents received in the Colonial Office, 1832. (Journal, Vol. ii.) Map showing the Explorations to the Eastward and Southward of Hampton Plains. By Alexander Forrest, Assistant Surveyor, 1871. (Journal, Vol. xUi.) Q 2 228 Maps. — New Zealand. Australia, Westeen. — ^Map showing the Route of the Exploring Expedition through tbe Centre of, from Champion Bay, on the West Coast, to the Overland Telegraph Lines between Adelaide and Port Darwin. Com manded by John Forrest, 1874. (Journal, Vol. xiv.) Baecoo and Wabebgo. — Mr. Kennedy's Expedition to the. (Journal, Vol. xxii.) Flindbes' Range, Austealia. — Country to the E. of. (Journal, Vol. xiv.) RrvEB. — Portion of the. To iUustrate the Observations of Com. Norman, r.n. (Journal, Vol. xxxiu.) Liverpool Plains and Moebton Bay. — Map of the Country between. By Com. H. G. Hamilton, e.n. (Journal, Vol. xui.) Melville and Bathubst Islands. — With Coburg Peninsula. (Joumal, Vol. iv.) MuBBAY Rivee. — Country near the Mouth of the River Murray, Australia. (Journal, Vol. iii.) New Guinea. — Chart of the South-East Coast of. To accompany the Paper by Capt. J. Moresby, b.n. (Journal, Vol. xliv.) ¦ Map of tbe Fly River. Drawn from the Original Charts made by Signor L. M. D'Albertis by W. J. Tui-ner. (Proceedings, Vol. L, New Series.) ¦ ¦ Eastern.^ — Map of. To accompany tbe Paper by Capt. J. Moresby, r.n. (Journal, Vol. xiv.) New Zealand. — Map of the Provinces of Canterbury and Otago. To illustrate the Papers of Mr. James M'Kerrow, Dr. J. Haast, and Dr. Hector. (Journal, Vol. xxxiv.) Routes near West Coast of Nelson District. By John Rochfort, Esq., in 1859. (Journal, Vol. xxxii.) Chart of. (Journal, Vol. ii.) Map of the Province of Canterbury, showing the Five Routes between tbe East and West Coasts, with Sections of tbe Routes. To accompany the Paper by Dr. J. Haast. (Journal, Vol. xxxvii.) ¦ Middle Island of. (Journal, Vol. xxi.) Middle Island of. (Journal, Vol. xx.) Otago. — Map to illustrate Mr. Thomson's Survey of. (Journal, Vol. xxviii.) Perth to Euola and Adelaide. — Map showing the Overland Tracks from. By John Forrest, Government Surveyor, 1870. (Journal, Vol. xii.) • RussEL Range (Australia). — Map to iUustrate the Route of the Expedition from. Also of the Settlers' Expedition from Perth to tbe Gasooigne River, and of tbe Expedition to the Murchison River. (Journal, Vol. xxii.) Southern Alps. — Map of the. In the Province of Canterbury, New Zealand. Reduced from the large Map by Julius Haast, Ph.D., p.e.s. (Journal, Vol. xl.) Tenimbee Islands. — Map of the. After Guyot's General Map of the Assistant Residency Banda. Illustrating the recent Discovery of Egeron Strait. To accompany the Paper by Prof. P. J. Veth. (Journal, Vol. xlvUi). Maps.— Atlantic. 229 VIIL— ATLANTIC OCEAN AND ISLANDS. Ascension Island. — ^View from the Mountain Eoad in the Island of Ascension. (Joumal, VoL v.) Atlantic Ocean. — ^With Contour Lines showing approximately the depth of water in fathoms. (Proceedings, Vol. xxi.) ¦ ¦ Sections of. Between St. Thomas and Tenerife. 2. St. Thomas to Bermuda. 3. Bermuda to Halifax. 4. Bermuda to New York. 5. Bermuda to Azores, Azores to Madeira. 6. Section of Equatorial Atlantic. 7. Section of South Atlantic. 8. Section of Mid-Atlantic, taken nearly North and South. 9. Section of North Atlantic, taken nearly North and South. (Proceedings, Vol. xviii.) ¦ Deep Sea Sections. To iUustrate the Paper by Capt. Sherard Osborn, b.n. (Journal, Vol. xii.) ¦ ¦ Sections of. To illustrate a Paper " On the Distribution of Salt in the Ocean, as indicated by the Specific Gravity of its Waters." By J. Y. Buchanan, Chemist and Physicist in the " Challenger " Expedition. (Journal, VoL xlvii.) AND Mediterranean. — 2 Diagrams showing the Temperature of. To illustrate the Paper by Dr. Carpenter " On the Temperature of tbe Deep-Sea Bottom, and the Conditions by which it is determined." (Proceedings, Vol. xxi.) Ocean. — Northern Portion of. With Contour Lines showing approxi mately the depth of water in fathoms. (Proceedings, Vol. xxi.) ¦ ¦ North.— Surveys of H.M.S. " Bulldog " in tbe. To iUustrate the Paper by Capt. Sir F. Leopold McClintock, b.n., f.e.g.s. (Proceedings, Vol. V.) Section of. Between Disco and Valentia. (Proceedings, Vol. xxi.) Surface Temperatures of the. Between Shetland and Greenland, coUeoted by Admiral Irminger. (Joumal, Vol. xl.) AzoEES. — Island of St. Mary. (Joumal, Vol. xv.) Davis Steait and the Atlantic Ocean. — Soundings of H.M.S. " Valorous," 1875. (Proceedings, Vol. xx.) FoEMiGAS Bank, Azoees.' — Sketch to illustrate Capt. Vidal's Paper on the. (Joumal, Vol. xix.) Gulf Steeam. — ^Diagram of tbe. To illustrate the Paper by A. G. Findlay, (Proceedings, Vol. xiii.) IX.— PACIFIC OCEAN AND ISLANDS. Beheing Steait. — Map to iUustrate Capt. CoUinson's Voyage through. (Journal, Vol. xxv.) Chatham Islands. — Map of. (Journal, Vol. xi.) Fiji Islands. — Dr. Macdonald's Explorations in the. (Journal, VoL xxvii.) New Beitain, N.E. Portion.' — (Proceedings, Vol. iii.. New Series, p. 128.) Pacific Ocean, etc. — 12 Sections showing the Temperature of various Parts of the. To illustrate the Summary of Eecent Observations on Ocean 230 Maps.— Pacific. Temperature made in H.M.S. " Challenger " and U.S.S. " Tuscarora " ; with their bearing on the Doctrine of a General Oceanic Circulation sustaiued by difference of Temperature. By W. B. Carpenter, m.d., LL.D., Corresponding Member of the Institute of Prance. (Proceedings, Vol. xix.) Pacific Ocean, Centbal. — Section of. To illustrate a Paper on " The Distribution of Salt in tbe Ocean, as Indicated by tbe Specific Gravity of its Waters." By J. Y. Buchanan, Chemist and Physicist in the " Challenger " Expedition. (Journal, Vol. xlvii.) Eapa-Nui, oe Bastee Island.' — Chart of. To accompany the Paper by J. L. Palmer, Esq., e.n. (Journal, Vol. xL) Sandwich Islands. — Chart of the. To accompany the Paper by the Bishop of Honolulu. (Journal, Vol. xxxviii.) Solomon, New Hebeides, and Santa Cbuz Geoups. — To illustrate the Paper by Lieut. A. H. Markham, r.n. (Journal, Vol. xiii.) X.— INDIAN OCEAN ISLANDS. Cocos OR Keeling Islands. — Map of the : exhibiting the changes tbat have taken place since 1836. (Proceedings, Vol. i.. New Series.) Peter BoTTE Mountain. — Ascent of the. (View.) (Journal, Vol. ui.) ( 231 ) ALPHABETICAL LIST AUTHOES OP PAPEES IN THE EOYAL GEOGEAPHICAL SOCIETY'S 'JOUENALS' AND 'PEOCEEDINGS.' Abbott, K. E. xii. 207 ; xxv. 1 ; xxvii. 149. Proceedings, Vol. iii. 390. Abich, Prof. Hermann, xxi. 1. Abramof, Gen. xxxii. 565 ; xxxv. 58. Proceedings, Vol. ix. 40. Abu Beke es Seddik. vi. 100. Adams, P. 0. xL 339. AiNSWoBTH, W. viii. 185 ; ix. 216 ; X. 275 ; X. 311 ; x. 489 ; xi. 1 ; xi. 21. Alcock, Sir Eutherford. xxxi. 321 ; xxxii. 280. Proceedings, Vols. v. 132 ; vi. 196-200. Albxandee, Capt. J. B. ii. 65 ; vi. 443 ; ViL 439 ; viiL 1. Albxandeeson, Carl. xlvi. 428. Allen, Capt. Wm., e.n. vii. 198 ,- viu. 289 ; xiu. 1 ; xxui. 154, 167, 163. Allen, H. J. Proceedings, Vol. xxi. 258. Allen, Capt. Bird, b.n. xi. 76. Anderson, A. C. xv. 367. Anderson, Jas. xxvi. 18; xxviL 321. Anderson, Dr. J. xl. 286. Pro ceedings, Vol. xiv. 346. Anderson, Capt. S. xlvi. 228. Proceedings, Vol. xx. 274. Anderssen, xxv. 79 ; xxxvi. 247. Proceedings, iv. 63. Andreyeff, A. Proceedings, Vol. xiiL 375. ¦ Arlett, Lieut, vi. 285. Abbowsimth, John. iv.320; xviii. 74. Atkinson. Proceedings, Vol. iii. 127. Austin, Eobert. xxvi. 235. Ayeton, p. xviii. 48. Back, Sir Geo. ii. 336 ; iii. 64 ; v. 405 ; vi. 1 ; vii. 457, 460. Bacon, Dr. Francis, xii. 196. Baikie, Dr. xxv. 108 ; xxxvii. 92. Proceedings, Vols. ii. 83 ; vi. 22 ; vii. 06 ; xi. 49. Bailie, Alex, xlviii. 287. Baily, J. xiv. 127. Baines, T. xxiv. 288 ; xxxvi. 247 ; xii. 100. " ' "" XV. 147. Bakeb, Lieut. Julian, b.n. xliv. 37. Proceedings, Vol. xviii. 131. Bakeb, Sir Samuel, xxxiii. 237; xxxvi. 1. Proceedings, Vols. x. 6, 279 ; XV. 92 ; xviii. 50. Baker, Lieut.-Col. vii. 81. Ball, John. Proceedings (N.S.),Vol. i. 564. ANIST 263. Bankaet, H. xxxix. 339. Barker, W. Burckhardt. vii. 96. Barker, Lieut, xii. 238; xviii. 130. Barns, J. W. xxxvu. 338 ; xiii. 390. Barrow, John. i. 1. Barth, Dr. H., c.b. xxi. 130 ; xxiv. 283; X U. 217. Baeton, Dr. A. xxxii. 26. Basevi, Capt. J. xUi. 368. Bastian, Dr. A. xxxv. 74. Proceed ings, Vol. ix. 85. Beavan, Capt. E. Proceedings (N.S.) VoL i. 727. Bechee, Capt., R.N. xii. 1 ; xxvi. 189. Proceedings, Vol. i. 94. Becroft, Capt. vi. 424; xi. 184; xiv. 260. Bedingfield, Capt., r.n. Proceed ings, Vol. iv. 66 ; vii. 105. 232 Authors of Papers. Beechey, Adm. xxiv. 328. Begbie, M. B. xxxi. 237. Proceed ings, Vol. iv. 33 ; XV. 133. Behm, Dr. Proceedings, Vol. xvii.21. Beke, Dr. xu. 84, 245 ; xiii. 182, 254 ; xiv. 1 ; xvii. 1 ; xx. 289 ; xxxn. 76. Proceedings, Vol. vi. 195. Belchbe, Sir E. ii. 278. Bell, C. N. xxxii. 242. Bell, W. A. xxxix. 96. Proceed ings, Vol. xiii. 140. Bellvillb, a. Proceedings, Vol. xx. 74. Bennet, Capt. Proceedings, Vol. x. 165. Bennett, P. D. vii. 211. Bensusan, M. xxxu. 42. Proceed ings, Vol. vi. 97. Bewshee, Lt., I.N. xxxvii. 160. Pro ceedings, Vol. xi. 165. BicKMOEB, Albert S. xxxviii. 50. Proceedings, Vol. xii. 51. Biddulph, Gen. Sir M. Proceed ings (N.S.), Vol. U. 212. Bidie, Dr. xxxix. 77. Proceedings, xiu. 74. BiGG-WiTHEE, J. xlvi. 263. Pro ceedings, Vol. XX. 466. BiED, Jas. iv. 192. BiSCOE, J., R.N. iu. 105. Blackney, Wm., r.n. xxx. 93. Blakiston, Capt. T. xUi. 77. Pro ceedings, Vol. xvi. 188. Blanohard, H. xviii. 45. Blanoklby, Capt., b.n. iv. 344. Blencowe, Eev. G. Proceedings (N.S.), VoL i. 324. Blunt, W. S. Proceedings (N.S.), Vol. u. 81. BoLBE, R. D. xlvi. 411. Bollabrt,W. xiii. 226; xxi. 99; xxv. 172. Proceedings, Vol. xu. 126. BoTELEB, Capt., E.N. ii. 274. Boutakoff, Admiral. xxiii. 93; xxxvH. 152. Proceedings, Vol. xL 113. BouzA, Don P. ii. 269. Bbadshaw, Dr. B. T. Proceedings (N.S.), UL 208. Beand, Vice-Consul, xxiv. 266. Beandebth, Capt., e.e. v. 243. Beant, Jas. vi. 187 ; x. 341. Breitenbach, Bernard de. ix. 311. Brierly, 0. W. xxu. 97. Beinb, Capt. Lindesay, r.n. xUL 354. Proceedings, Vol. x. 317 ; xvu. 67. Beook, Capt., B.N. viii. 428 ; ix. 507. Bbooke, Jas. viii. 129, 443. Brown, C. B. xii. 77. Proceedings, Vol. XV. 122. Brown, F. C. in. 268. Brown, Rev. G. xMi. 137. Pro ceedings (N.S.), Ui. 213. Brown, Robert, i. 17. Bbown, Rt. xxxix. 121 ; xii. 348. Proceedings, VoL xi. 84 ; xiii. 144, 381. Brunner, T. xx. 344. Beyce, Jas. Proceedings, Vol. xxii. 169. Buchan, A. Proceedings, Vol. xiu. 360. Buchanan, J. Y. xlvii. 72. Pro ceedings, Vol. xxi. 255. Buist, Dr. xxi. 42; xxiv. 227. Proceedings, Vol. iv. 50. Bullock, T. L. Proceedings, Vol. xxi. 266. Buekb, Rt. O'Hara. xxxn. 430. Burnes, Sir A. iv. 88 ; vi. 23, 113 ; vu. 11. Burr, T. xv. 160. Burton, R. P. xxiv. 208 ; xxv. 121, 136 ; xxix, the whole volmne ; xxxiu. 241 ; xxxv. 1 ; xUi. 49, 408 ; xlix. 1. Proceedings, Vol. iii. Ill, 348 ; vi. 49, 64, 238 ; vU. 104 ; ix. 6 ; xvi. 104, 129. Bushell, Rev. R. (Proceedings, Vol. xvi. 167.) Bushell, S. W. xliv. 73. Pro ceedings, Vol. xvui. 149. Butakoff. (See Boutakoff.) Cadell, Capt. xxv. 177. Proceed ings, Vol. vi. 55. Caldwell, H. C. Proceedings, Vol. i. 484. Cameron, Capt. Duncan. Proceed ings, Vol. vi. 5. Cameron, J. Proceedings, Vol. ix. 30. Cameron, Comm. L. V. xiv. 197. Proceedings, Vol. xix. 136, 246; XX. 118, 304. Campbell, Sir Geo. Proceedings, Vol. xi. 54. Campbell, Dr. Jas. xxx. 182. Campbell, Major, iv. 129. Canning, Lord. Proceedings, Vol. iv. 30. Carlesh, Capt. F. G. vUi. 328; xix. 76. Authors of Papers. 233 Caepentee, Dr. C. B. Proceedings, Vol. XV. 54 ; xviU. 301 ; xix. 493 ; xxi. 289. Caeter, H. j. xvi. 187. Chaix, Professor Paul. x. 575 ; xiv. 322; xix. 143; xxiv. 313; xxv. 182. Chandless, W. xxxu. 268 ; xxxvi. 86, 119; xxxix. 296; xL 419. Proceedings, Vol. x. 103 ; xi. 100. Chapman, Jas. Proceedings, Vol. v. 16. Cheadle, Dr. Proceedings, Vol. ix. 17. Chesney, Lieut.-Col. iv. 374 ; vii. 411 ; vin. 228. Chimmo, Comm. W. xxxviii. 258. Proceedings, Vol. i. 265 ; xii. 195 ; xin. 92 ; xv. 384. Chippendale, Lieut. Proceedings, Vol. XX. 67. Christison, Dr. D. Proceedings (N.S.), Vol. U. 663. Christopher, Lieut., i.n., xiv. 76. Clark, Rev. John, xvi. 256. Clarke, Major P. C. H. Proceed ings (N.S.), Vol. ii. 489. Cleghoen, John, xxvii. 230. Clbek, Capt. Claude, xxxi. 37. CocKBUEN, A. S. Proceedings, Vol. xu. 72. Colchestee, Lord. xvU. 130. Collet, C. P., b.n. vii. 203. CoLLiNSON, Lieut.-Col. xxxii. 68. CoLLiNSON, AdmL xvii. 130; xxv. 194. CoLLiNSON, J. Proceedings,Vol.xii.25. COLTHUBST, Miss. xix. 192. Comber, Eev. T. J. Proceedings (N. S.), Vol. i. 226 ; in. 20. Cooley, Mr. Desborough. iii. 310; XV. 185 ; xvi. 138 ; xix. 166 ; xxiv. 266. Cooper, H. T. M. Proceedings, Vol. XX. 78. Cooper, T. T. Proceedings, Vol. xui. 392 ; xiv. 335 ; xv. 163. Coppinger, Dr. Proceedings (N.S.), Vol. u. 552. CoBNEB, A. Proceedings, Vol. xix. 515. Corrie, Dr. A. Proceedings, Vol. xxn. 136. Coryton, J. xiv. 229. Proceedings, Vol. xix. 264. Costa de Macedo, Don J. J. da. xi. 171. CoTTEEiL, H. B. Proceedings, Vol. xxii. 233. Cotton, Sir Arthur, xxx-vii. 231. Proceedings, Vol. xi. 256. Coulter, Dr. J. v. 59. Cox, Don GuUiermo. xxxiv. 205. Craufurd, John, xxiii. 69. Crawford, E. xliu. 46. Proceed ings, Vol. xvu. 67. Creagh, E. p. 1. 21. Crocker, W. M. Proceedings (N.S.), Vol. in. 193. Croft, Capt. J. A. Proceedings, Vol. xviu. 183. Cross, Eobert. Proceedings, Vol. ix. 277. Crowther, Bishop. Proceedings, Vol. xxi. 481. Cruttenden, Capt., i.n. vUi. 267 ; xvUi. 136 ; xix. 49. Cullen, Dr. xxi. 241. Cunningham, Alan. ii. 99. D'Abbadie, M. ix. 317. D'Albeetis. Proceedings, Vol. xx. 343 ; (N. S.) i. 4. D'Almeida, W. B. xlvi. 367. Daleymple, G. B. xxxiu. 3 ; xxxv. 191. Proceedings, Vol. vi. 13 ; vii. 2 ; X. 33. Dalyell, E. a. 0. xxxiu. 234. Darwin, C. ix. 528. Davidson, Mr. John. vi. 429 ; vii. 144. Davis, Capt. J. E. xxxix. 91. Pro ceedings, Vol. xiii. 114. Davis, Sir John. xxiU. 242. Pro ceedings, VoL i. 330. De Bertou, Count, is. 277, 286. De Bode, Baron. xin. 75, 108. Proceedings, Vol. iv. 91. De Crespigny, Lieut. Proceedings, VoL L 206; iL 342; xvL 171; xvii. 133. De Horsey, Capt. A., r.n. xxxiv. 258. Proceedings, Vol. viii. 274. De la Fuente, Don M. B. xxvi. 229. Dempster Brothers. Proceedings, Vol. vi. 11. De Puydt, M. Lucien. xxxviii. 69. Proceedings, Vol. xii. 63. Dickson, Vice-ConsuL xxx. 255. Dieffenbach, E. xi. 196 ; xii. 142. Dilke, Ashton W. Proceedings, Vol. xvui. 246. 234 Authors of Papers. Douglas, Rev. C. xliv. 112. Douglas, Gov. Jas. xxiv. 245. DowNiB, W. xxxi. 249. Du Chaillu, M. xxxvi. 64. Pro ceedings, Vol. V. 108 ; X. 71. Duncan, Mr. John. xvi. 143, 154. Duncan, Professor. Proceedings, Vol. xxii. 68. Dyer, Thistelton. Proceedings, Vol. xxu. 412. Earle, G. W. xi. 108 ; xii. 139 ; XV. 358 ; xvi. 239. Eaton, F. A. Proceedings, VoL vui. 29. Elias, Ney. xl. 1 ; xliU. 108 ; xM. 198. Proceedings, Vol. xiv. 20; xvii. 184 ; xx. 234. Elliot, Adml. Sir C. Proceedings, Vol. i. 261. Elton, Capt. xiii. 1 ; xliv. 227. Proceedings, Vol. xvi. 89 ; xix. 110. Emery, Lieut., b.n. iii. 280. Endeeby, C. Proceedings, Vol. U. 171. Beman, Professor, ix. 508. Eeskine, Capt., R.N. xxi. 222. Erskine, St. Vincent, xxxix. 233 ; xiv. 46 ; xlviii. 25. Proceedings, VoLxiii. 320 ; xix. 110 ; xxii. 127. Escobar, Padre, xi. 89. Ethersey, Lieut, vui. 196. Evans, Capt., e.n Proceedings, Vol. xxii. 188. Eyee, E. j. xiiL 161; xv. 327; xvi. 200. Falconer, Thomas, xiii. 199. Farler, Rev. J. P. Proceedings (N. S.), i. 81. Fedchenko, Mr. xl. 448. Pro ceedings, Vol. XV. 393. Felkin, R. W. Proceedings (N.S.), U. 357. Findlay, A. G. xxiu. 217 ; xxvi. 26 ; xxxvii. 193. Proceedings, Vol. i. 21 ; xi. 232 ; xin. 102. Pitton, W. H. Proceedings, Vol. i. 501. Fitzgerald, Gov. C. xxii. 71. FitzRoy, Capt. U. 316; vi. 311; vU. 114, 143 ; XX. 161 ; xxiiL 171. Floyer, E. A. xlvii. 188. Forbes, C, m.d. xxxiv. 154. Fobbes, Dr. P., E.I.C.S. xiv. 145. Foebbb, Commander C. S., b.n. xxxvi. 173. Proceedings, Vol. x. 169. Fobbes, P. ix. 40'.i. PoEBES, Lieut. P. E. xx. 89. Forbes, H. 0. Proceedings (N.S.), i. 777. Forbes, Dr. Litton, m.d. Proceed ings, VoL xxi. 140. Forchhammer, Dr. P. W. xii. 28. Foebest, Alex. xiii. 388. Foebest, John. xl. 231 ; xii. 361 ; xiv. 249. Proceedings, Vol. xix. 310-481. Forsyth, Sir Douglas. xlvii. 1. Proceedings, Vol. xxi. 27. PBASER,Capt. Proceedings, Vol. vii. 58. Feasek, j. Baillie. viu. 308. French, J. 0. ix. 381. Frere, Sir H. Bartie. xl. 181. Pro ceedings, Vol. xiv. 120 ; xvii. 343 ; (N.S.) iii. 1. Freshfield, Douglas, xxxix. 50. Proceedings, Vol. xiii. 66. Priedrichsthal, Chevalier E. xi. 97. Friend, Commander C, e.n. xxiii. 191. Frome, Capt., r.e. xiv. 283. FoRLONG, Capt. Proceedings, Vol. ViL 58. Fynney, F. B. xlvUi. 16. Pro ceedings, Vol. xxii. 114. Gairdner, Dr. xi. 250. Galindo, Don Juan. iii. 59, 290 ; vL 119. Galton, Francis, xxii. 140; xxxv. 99. Proceedings, Vol. ii. 60; iv. 14 ; ix. 104. Garden, R. J. xxxvii. 182. Pro ceedings, Vol. xi. 159. Gardner, C. J. Proceedings, Vol. siU. 170. Gassiott, H. xxu. 136. Geikie, Prof. Proceedings (N.S.), Vol. i. 422. George, Staff-Comm. Proceedings, Vol. XX. 159. Gerber, H. xUv. 262. Gessi, R. Proceedings, Vol. xx. 50, 470. Gibbons, Surgeon, xi. 136. Giles, Ernest, xlvi. 328. Gill, Capt. xlviii. 57. Proceedings, VoL xxii. 256. Gill, Eev. W. Wyatt. xUv. 15. Pro ceedings, Vol. xviii. 31. Gisborne, Lionel. xxvU. 191. Pro ceedings, Vol. i. 88. Glover, Sir Jobn. Proceedings, Vol. xviii. 286. Authors of Papers. 235 Goad, J. W. Proceedings, Vol. xxii. 272 ; (N. S.) L 694. GoDwiN-AusTEN, Lieut.-Col. xxxi. 30 ; xxxiv. 19 ; xxxvii. 343 ; xUii. 1. Proceedings, Vol. viii. 34 ; xi. 32 ; xvU. 36. Goldsmid, Sir Frederic, xxxiii. 181 : xxxvu. 269; xliiL 65; xliv. 183; Proceedings, Vol. vii. 91 ; xvii. 86. Golubef, Capt. A. xxxi. 366. Goodenough, Dr. Edmund, d.d. i. 101. Gordon,. Col. xlvi. 381, 431. Pro ceedings, Vol. XX. 60 ; xxi. 48, 49, 56, 63. Gordon, Lieut., r.n. xix. 22. Gosselman, Capt. ix. 407. Geabbbg, Count, vii. 243. Graham, CyrU. xxviii. 226. Pro ceedings, Vol. ii. 173. Geandy, Lieut., e.n. Proceedings, Vol. xix. 78. Geant, Lieut.-Colonel J.A., c.b., c.s.i. xUi. 243 ; xlvi. 10. Proceedings, Vol. XX. 34. Geant, W. Colquhoun. xxvii. 268. Proceedings, Vol. i. 487. Geant, C. M. xxxiii. 167. Proceed- iugs. Vol. vn. 27. Gbaves, Capt. T., e.n. viii. 428 ; xix. 152. Geegoey, Capt. Proceedings, VoL xiv. 214. Geegoey, A. C. xxii. 57 ; xxviu. 1-26. Proceedings, Vol. i. 183, 225, 324, 341, 490 ; iiL 34 ; v. 2. Geegoey, P. T. xxxii. 372. Pro ceedings, Vol. V. 121 ; vi. 54. Obey, Capt. viii. 454. Geovee, Capt. xvL 162. GUABEAOINO, M. P. XV. 296. Gubbins, J. H. Proceedings, Vol. xvii. 78. Gunst, Dr. Proceedings, Vol. ix. 289. Gutzlaff, Dr. iiL 291 ; xix. 33, 85; XX. 191. Haast, Dr. Julius. xxxiv. 87 ; xxxvii. 328; xL 433. Proceed ings, Vol. viu. 56. Haenke, Thadeus. v. 90. Haines, Capt., i.n. ix. 125 ; xv. 104 ; xxiv. 225. Hale, Eev. E. Proceedings, Vol. xvi. 450. Hall, Capt. C. P. Proceedings, Vol. vii. 99 ; xv. 382. Hall, Capt. Vine. Proceedings, Vol. xiU. 83. Hamilton, Comm. H. G., e.n., xui. 245. Hamilton, Eear-Admiral E. V., c.b. Proceedings, Vol. ix. 131; xiu. 234 ; xiv. 145. amilton, W. 137 ; XX. 75. Haecouet, a. F. p. xU. 245. Pro ceedings, Vol. XV. 336. Harding, J. xlvii. 250. Haegbbaves, Mr. Proceedings, Vol. viii. 32. Hauslab, Gen. xiv. 34. Havildab, The. xiii. 180. Pro ceedings, xvi. 253. Hay, Capt. J. S. xlvi. 299. Pro ceedings, XX. 476. Hay, E. W. iii. 72. Haywaed, G. W. xL 33; xU. 1; Proceedings, Vol. xiv. 40. Heathcote, Capt., i.n. xxxii. 234. Proceedings, Vol. vi. 101-114. Hectoe, Dr. xxxiv. 96. Proceed ings, VoL iii. 122 ; iv. 73 ; viii. 47 ; ix. 32. Helpman, Lieut, xviii. 38. Henderson, Capt., r.n. xx. 151. Hermesdorf, M. G. xxxii. 536. Herschel, Sir John. xxx. 100. Proceedings, Vol. iii. 174 ; xv. 211. Hickson, W. xxxv. 129. Proceed ings, Vol. ix. 137. Higgin, E. xix. 17. Hilhouse, Wm. iv. 25, 321 ; vii. 446. Hill, Clement. Proceedings, VoL xvU. 337. Hind, H. Y. xxxiv. 82. Proceed ings, Vol. viii. 50. Hines, Eev. H. K. Proceedings, Vol. xi. 80. HiRTH, Dr. P. 1. 6. Hodgson, Pemberton. Proceedings, VoL V. 113. HOFMANN, M. xix. 31. Hogg, John. xx. 38. Holdich, Capt. T. H. Proceedings (N.S.), VoL i. 372 ; UL 65. Holland, Rev. P. W. xxxviii. 237 ; xxxix. 342. Proceedings, Vol. x. 158 ; xu. 190 ; xui. 204. Holmwood, P. xlvii. 253. Holroyd. ix. 163. Holub, Dr. B. Proceedings (N. S.), Vol. ii. 166. 236 Authors of Papers. Hooker, Sir Joseph D. xx. 49. Pro ceedings, Vol. XV. 212. Hooker, Sir Wm. xii. 265. Hope, Percy, xliv. 203. Hopkins, T. xxvi. 158 ; xxvU. 206. Proceedings, Vol. i. 58 ; ii. 357 ; iv. 100. Horsburgh, Capt. ii. 72. Hoskyn, E. xii. 143. Houghton, Lord. Proceedings, Vol. xiv. 88. Howard, P. xxxvi. 227. HowoBTH, H. H. xliii. 240; xUv. 252. Hugel, Baron, vi. 343. Hulton, Dr. xi. 156. Hunt, Carew. xv. 268, 268, Hunt, Commr., e.n. Proceedings, Vol. n. 374. Hutchinson, E. Proceedings (N.S.), Vol. U. 289. Hutchinson, T. J. xxxiv. 226. Huttmann, Wm. xiv. 117. Ibeahim Khan. Proceedings, VoL XV. 387. Illingwoeth, Admiral. Proceedings, Vol. i. 86. Im-Thdrn, E. p. Proceedings (N.S.), Vol. ii. 465. Inglefield, Capt., r.n. Vol. xxui. 136. Ingram, Govr. xvii. 160. Irminger, Admiral xxvi. 36 ; xl. 441 ; xlix. 398. Proceedings, VoL i. 61 ; V. 225 ; xiu. 226. Isbister, G. A. K. xv. 332. Isenberg, Dr. x. 456. Jackson, Colonel J. E. iii. 271 ; iv. 72 ; V. 1, 381. ; vi. 416. Jambs, Colonel Sir Henry, xxx. 106 ; xxxvi. 201. Jameson, Dr. W. xxviii. 337 ; xxxi. 184. Jansen, Commodore. Proceedings, VoL ix. 163. Jaedine, j. xxxvi. 76. Proceed ings, x. 85. Jeffreys, A. P. Proceedings, Vol. xix. 169. Jenkins, H. L. xU. 342. Jeppe, F. xlvii. 217. Jervis, Col. T. B. vii. 127. viu. 202. Jochmus, General, xxiv. 36 ; xxvii. 1. Proceedings, Vol. i. 301, 481. Johnson, A. E. xiv. 112. Johnson, Capt. C. iv. 41. Johnson, J. H., e.n. U. 316. Johnson, W.|H. xxxvii. i. Pro ceedings, Vol. xi. 6. Johnston, A. Keith. Proceedings, VoL xvL 125 ; xx. 494 ; (N.S.) i. 417, 545. Johnston, A. E. xiv. 112. Jones, Lieut. P. T. xviu. 1. Jones, H. L. xxxi. 204. Jxtnker, Dr. Proceedings (N.S.), ni. 301. Kane, Dr. B. K. xxvi. 1. Kaeaczay, Count, xii. 45. Kaye, Lieut.-Gen. Proceedings (N.S.), Vol. i. 244. Kazi, Syud Ahmad, xlvi. 142. Kelley, P. M. xxvi. 174. Pro ceedings, Vol. i. 63. Kemp, J. Proceedings, Vol. xix. 324. Kempthoene, Lieut., i.n. v. 263. Kendal, Lieut., b.n. i. 62. Kennedy, Mr. W. xxiii. 122. Kennedy, H. G. xxxvii. 298. Kennedy, B. B. xxu. 228. Kennedy, Edmund, xix. 193. Kerr, Lord Schomberg. Proceed ings, Vol. iii. 2. Khanikoff, M. xiu. 278 ; xiv. 333. King, Lieut.-Col. Eoss. Proceedings, Vol. xix. 134. King, D. 0. xxx. 177. Proceed ings, Vol. in. 365. King, Dr. J. B. xiv. 260. King, Capt. P. P., b.n. i. 155; vi. 311. Kirk, Dr. E. xii. 221. Kirk, Dr. John, xxxiv. 199 ; xxxv. 154, 167. Proceedings, Vol. viii. 151; ix. 284; xviL 340 ; xviiL74. KoLLER, Baron, xii. 75. Kopsch, H. Proceedings, Vol. xiv. 79. Krapf, Dr. x. 455, 469. Ladislaus, Magyar, xxiv. 271. Lagan, J. E. xvi. 304. Lamprey, Jones, xxxvii. 239. Pro ceedings, Vol. xi. 259. Lander, Ed. i. 179. Landsborough, Wm. Proceedings, Vol. vu. 6, 6, 40, 83, 84. Latham, R. G. xx. 189. Lawbence, C. W. xliii. 54. Pro ceedings, Vol. xvii. 80. Laws, Capt., b.n. i. 175. La-rs, Dr. Proceedings (N. S.), Vol. i. 305. Authors of Papers. 237 Layaed, A. H. xvi. 1. Leake, CoL W. M. ii. 1 ; ix. 1 ; xU. 162. Ledesma, Don V. xxvi. 210. Lefboy, Capt. J. H. xvi. 263. Lefboy, H. M. Proceedings, Vol. viii. 46. Leichhardt, Dr. xvi. 212. Search for, xl. 231. Proceedings, VoL i. 322 ; in. 18, 87 ; x. 58. Leigh, T. S. xix. 7. Leone, Levi, Professor. Proceedings, Vol. xvUi. 117. Lewin, Lieut.-Col. Proceedings, VoL xi. 52. Lewis, Capt. r.e. v. 230. Leyobstbb, Lieut., e.n. xx. i. ; xxu. 201. Lhotsky, Dr. John. ix. 157. Lindley, Jobn. v. 296. Livingstone, Dr. xx. 138 ; xxi. 18; xxn. 163; xxiv. 291; xxv. 218 ; xxvi. 78 ; xxvii. 349 ; xxxL 256; xxxiiL 251; xxxiv. 245. Proceedings, Vol. ii. 116 ; iv. 87 ; V. 128 ; vi. 20 ; vii. 18 ; xii. 175 ; xiv. 8, 16 ; XV. 115, 335 ; xviu. 221. Livingstone, Dr. Search, xiv. 334 ; xvi. 124, 146, 158, 203, 225, 241. Livingstone, C. Proceedings, Vol. xiv. 167. Lloyd, Rev. W., e.n. xxxvii. 212. Proceedings, Vol. xi. 253. Lloyd, Colonel, i. 69 ; xxiii. 196 ; xxiv. 269. Lloyd, xx. 53. Lockhart, W. xxviu. 288 ; xxxvi. 128. Proceedings, Vol. n. 201; X. 154. Loftus, W. K. xxvi. 131 : xxvii. 120. Proceedings, Vol. i. 45, 219. Long, Professor, iii. 257 ; xu. 102. Lovett, Major Beresford. xiii. 202 ; xliv. 145. Proceedings, Vol. xvi. 219, 261. Lowbnsteen, Chevalier, xi. 100. Lushington, Capt. vin. 454. Lynch, Capt. H. B., i.n. ix. 441, 471. Lysaght, Lieut.-Comm., xix. 29. McCarthy, J. Proceedings (N.S.), Vol. i. 489. Macdonald, J. D. xxvii. 232. Macedo, Don J. J. da Costa de. xi. 171. Macfaelanb, R. Proceedings, Vol. ix. 125. Macfaelanb, Eev. S. Proceedings, VoL XX. 253 ; xxi. 350. MacGilliveay, j. xxi. 13. Mackenzie, Bishop. Proceedings, Vol. V. 131. M'Clintock, Sir L. xxxi.i. Proceed ings, Vol. V. 62 ; XV. 102 ; xix. 464. M'CosH, Dr. Proceedings, Vol. v. 47. M'Cluee, Sir R. xxiv. 240. M'Kerrow, Jas. xxxiv. 56. Pro ceedings, Vol. viu. 47. McKinlay, Mr. Proceedings, Vol. vii. 6, 6, 84. Macgowan, D. J. xxxii. 74. MoLeod, Consul. Proceedings, Vol. ii. 363. Macpherson, Duncan. Proceedings, Vol. vu. 95. Macqueen, Mr. Jas. xv. 371 ; xx. 235 ; xxvi. 109 ; xxx. 128, 136, 155, 161. Proceedings, VoL i. 12, 75 ; UL 208, 362. Mahomed Amin. Proceedings, Vol. xiu. 122. Major, R. H. xU. 193 ; xUii. 166 xlix. 412. Proceedings, xi. 246 XV. 210 ; xviL 312. Malden, Prof. H. xv. 351. Man, E. H. 1. 1. Mann, Dr. xxxvii. 48. Proceed ings, Vol. vn. 50 ; xi. 18 ; xvi. 138. Maples, Rev. C. Proceedings (N. S.), Vol. U. 337. Margary, A. R. xlvi. 172 ; Pro ceedings, Vol. XX. 184. Markham, Capt. A. H. xlU. 213. Proceedings, Vol. xvi. 388 ; xxi. 110 ;(N.S.)iL 1,742. Markham, Clements R., c.b. xxv. 151 ; xxxi. 190 ; xxxv. 87 ; xxxvi. 180, 195 ; xxxviU. 1, 12 ; xU. 281 ; xliu. 83; xliv. 127; xiv. 299. Proceedings, Vol. v. 224 ; ix. 88, 138 ; s. 266 ; xi. 78 ; xii. 11, 113, 298 ; XV. 367 ; xvi. 158 ; xvn. 97 ; xviii. 12, 212 ; xix. 327 ; xx. 55, 241 ; xxi. 536. (N. S.) i. 16, 38, 110, 191, 353, 676 ; U. 657 ; ui. 129. Markham, John. xl. 207. Pro ceedings, Vol. xiv. 137. Martin, Capt. Gerald. Proceedings (N.S.), Vol. i. 617. Martin, James, xxxv. 237. Pro ceedings, Vol. X. 86 238 Authors of Papers. Masters, Peter, xv. 236. Mathison, Commr. xx. 136. Maundrell, Eev. H. xxxvii. 108. Mauey, Capt. Proceedings, Vol. v. 22. May, D. j., e.n. xxx. 212. Pro ceedings, Vol. vi. 36. Maynaed, j. H. Proceedings, Vol. XX. 110. Mayne, Lieut., b.n. xxxi. 297; xxxii. 529. Proceedings, Vol. iv. 33 ; vi. 107. Michell, Major, e.b. vi. 168. Michell, Eobert. xxxviii. 429 ; xliii. 263 ; xlvii. 17. Proceedings, Vol. xxi. 122. Michelsen, Dr. xxxii. 565. Michie, A. xxxiii. 153. Proceed ings, Vol. vii. 26. Miles, Capt. xU. 210 ; xUL 61 ; xliv. 163. Proceedings, Vol. xv. 319 ; xvL 149. MiLLEE, General, vi. 174 ; xU. 137. Millingen, C. xliv. 118. Pro ceedings, Vol. xviii. 194. Milton, Viscount. Proceedings, Vol. ix. 17. Milum, Rev. J. Proceedings (N. S.), Vol. iU. 26. Mieambo, P. Broyon. Proceedings, Vol. xxn. 28. MiBZA, The. xii. 132. Proceedings, Vol. XV. 181. Mitchell, Major T. L. vii. 271. Moesta, Carlos, xxviii. 333. Moffat, Dr. xxvi. 84 ; xxviii. 153, 174. Proceedings, Vol. U. 77, 158. Mohammed Sisei. viii. 448. (See Mahomed.) Molyneux, Lieut, xviii. 104. Monteith, Colonel, iii. 1 ; v. 404 ; xxvii. 108. Montgomebie, Major G. T. xxxvi. 167 ; xii. 132 ; xiii. 180 ; xiv. 315, 325, 330; xxxviU. 129; xxxix. 146. Proceedings, Vol. x. 162; xii. 146 ; xui. 130, 183 ; xiv. 207 ; xvi. 253. MooECBOFT, Wm. ii. 253. MoEBSBY, Capt., I.N. V. 398. Moresby, Capt. J., r.n. xliv. 1. Proceedings, Vol. xviii. 22; xix. 225. Moreton, JuUan. xxxiv. 263. Morgan, L. Delmar. xxxix. 311 ; xlviii. 301. Proceedings, Vol. xiv. 229. (N.S.) i. 701 ; iii. 150. Moeier, j. vii. 230. Morrison, G. J. Proceedings (N.S.), Vol. U. 145. Mouat, P. J. xxxu. 109. Proceed ings, Vol. vi. 41. Mouhot, M. Henri, xxxii. 142. Proceedings, Vol. vi. 80. Mullens, Rev. J. xiv. 128 ; xlvii. 47. Proceedings, VoL xix. 182 ; xxi. 155, 233. Muller, Dr. Proceedings, Vol. i. 3. Muller, Dr. Solomon. xx-viiL264. Munful, Mm Munshi. Proceedings, Vol. xiii. 130. MuNziNGEB, Werner, cb. xxxix. 188; xU. 210. Proceedings, Vol. xui. 219. Murchison, Sir Roderick, xiii. 269. Proceedings, Vol. viii. 151: ix. 87. Murphy, Lieut, ii. 93. Murray, A. xl-vii. 267. Musters, Commr., r.n. xii. 69 ; xlvii. 201. Proceedings, Vol. xv. 41 ; xxii. 40. Nachtigal, Dr. xlvi. 396. Nain Singh. (See Pundit.) Napier, Capt. the Hon. G. xlvi. 62. Proceedings, Vol. xx. 166. Naees, Capt. Sir G. Proceedings, Vol. xiv. 75 ; xxi. 96, 274. Nash, G. L. Proceedings, Vol. xxi. 595. Neumeyer, Dr. Proceedings, Vol. xu. 286. New, Eev. C. xiv. 414. Proceedings, Vol. xvi. 167 ; xix. 317. Newbold, Capt. xvi. 331. Nicholson, Sir Cbarles, Bart. Pro ceedings, Vol. xiv. 190. Nlnd, Scott, i. 21. Nordenskiold, Prof, xxxix. 131. Proceedings, Vol. xiii. 151. NoREls, B. XX. 101 ; xxiv. 318. O'CoNNOE, Gov. Proceedings, Vol. i. 42 ; vi. 15. Obested, Magister A. xxi. 96. Oldfield, E. K. vii. 196. Oliphant, Laurence. xxx. 75 ; xxxin. 178 ; xxxv. 142. Proceed ings, VoL in. 162; viL 61: ix. 276. Oliver, Lieut. Proceedings, Vol. vi. 85 ; vii. 68. Authors of Papers. 239 O'ElLEY, Edward, xxxu. 164. Pro ceedings, Vol. vi. 83. Orr, John. xi. 192. Osborn, Adm. Sherard, cb. xxvii. 133 ; xxvUi. 371 ; xxxvi. 279 ; xU. 46. Proceedings, Vol. i. 104, 305 ; in. 55 ; ix. 42 ; xii. 92 ; xv. 28 ; xvi. 227; xvn. 172. Osten Sacken, Baron. xl. 250. Proceedings, Vol. xiv. 221. Oswell, W. 0. xx. 143 ; xxii. 163. Owen, Captain, r.n. i. 66 ; ii. 81. Oxenham, E. L. xiv. 170. Proceed ings, Vol. xix. 244. Page, E. Legh. viii. 317. Palgrave, W. Gifford. xxxiv. 111. Proceedings, Vol. viii. 63 ; xvi. 223. Palladius, Archimandrite, xiii. 142. Palliser, Capt. xxx. 267. Pro ceedings, Vol. ii. 38, 146, 228 ; iii. iv. 73. Palmer, Lieut., e.e. xxxi. 224 ; xxxiv. 171. Proceedings, Vol. iv. 33 ; viii. 87. Palmee, John Linton, e.n. xl. 167. Proceedings, Vol. xiv. 108. Parish, Sir Woodbine. iU. 94 ; iv. 182 ; vi. 136. Paeish, Capt. A. xxvi. 154. Pro ceedings, Vol. i. 36. Parkes, Sir Harry, xxiv. 306 ; xxvi. 71. Proceedings, Vol. i. 13. Parkyns, Mansfield, xx. 264. Pabey, F. xliv. 152. Pattebson, Capt., E. E. Proceedings (N.S.), Vol. i. 240, 509. Payee, JuUus. xiv. 1. Proceedings, Vol. xix. 17. Pelly, Sir Lewis, xxxiv. 251; xxxv. 169, 231. Proceedings, Vol. viii. 18 ; ix. 293. Peney, Dr. Proceedings, Vol. vi. 18. Pentland, J. B. v. 70 ; viu. 427. Pebby, Gerald Eaoul. Proceedings, Vol. vi. 74. Peschueof, M. xxviii. 376. Pro ceedings, VoL ii. 153 ; ui. 92. Peteemann, Dr. A. xvui. 89 ; xx. 232 ; xxii. 118 ; xxiu. 129. Pro ceedings, Vol. ix. 90, 114. Petheeick, Consul, xxxv. 289. Pro ceedings, Vols. iv. 39, 223 ; v. 27, 40, 41 ; vi. 18 ; vii. 20 ; vui. 122. Peytibe, M. viii. 423. Philippi, Dr., e.a. xxv. 158. Phillips, Geo. xliv. 97. Proceed ings, Vol. xviii. 168. Phillips, Capt., e.n. iii. 275. Philpots, B. P. Proceedings, VoL xiu. 372. Pim, Capt. Bedford, b.n. Proceed ings, Vol. vi. 75, 112. Pinto, Major Serpa. Proceedings (N.S.), Vol. L 481. PoEY, Andres, xxv. 291. Pollington, Viscount, x. 445. Poole, H. xxvi. 65. Proceedings, VoL i. 221. PoETEE, Eev. J. L. xxvi. 43. Poston, Hon. C. Proceedings, Vol. xix. 302. Powell, W. Proceedings (N.S.), Vol. in. 84. PowEB, Mrs. Col. V. 243. PowEB, John, xxviii. 349. Prevost, Commr., e.n. xxiv. 249. Peichard, Dr. J. C. ix. 192. Pritchett, G. xxx. 64. Proceed ings, Vol. iii. 93. Prout, Major H. G. xlix. 392. Peudhoe, Lord. v. 38. Pundit, The. xxxviu. 129 ; xlvii. 86. Proceedings, Vol. xxi. 325. Purdon, Wm. xxxi. 14. Proceed ings, Vol. iv. 31. Puydt, M. Lucien de. xxxviii. 69. Proceedings, VoL xii. 63. Quin, Capt. Michael, r.n. xxvi. 232. Eae, Dr. John. xxii. 73 ; xxv. 246. Proceedings, Vol. v. 80 ; vii. 102. Eapinbsqub, C. S. xi. 165. Eafn, Professor, xiv. 316. Eaimondi, Don Antonio. xxxvii. 116 ; xxxviii. 413. Proceedings, Vol. xi. 102 ; xiii. 112. Eandell, W. E. xxxi. 146. Pro ceedings, Vol. iv. 94. Eattray, A. xxxviii. 370 ; xiii. 431. Proceedings, Vol. xii. 313. Eawlinson, Sir Henry, k.c.b. ix. 26 ; X. 1, 65 ; xU. 112 ; xxviL 185; xUi. 482; xliiL 272. Pro ceedings, Vol. i. 39, 280, 351; V. 219 ; X. 134 ; xui. 10 ; xvii. 92, 108, 162 ; xviu. 414 ; (N.S.) i. 106, 161. Eeade, Winwood. Proceedings, Vol. vii. 106. 240 Authors of Papers. Eedlich, E. xUv. 30. Eichards, Admiral Sir G. Proceed ings, Vol. xiv. 259 ; xix. 208. Eiohaedson, Sir John. ix. 117, 121, 331. (AustraUa). xxxvi. 19. Pro ceedings, Vol. X. 32. EiGBY, General. Proceedings, Vol. X. 113. Eink, Dr. H. xxiii. 145; xxviii. 272. Proceedings, Vol. u. 195; vU. 76. Proceedings, Vol. x. is. 295; xviiL 77; xlvii. Robins, J. V. 116. Eobinson, Dr. xxiv. 1. , Murrell W. xiv. 130. ¦ , Staff Commr. G., e.n. 278. Eochfoet, Jobn. xxxii. 294. EoE, J. S. xxii. 1. EoLLESTON, Professor, xlix. 320. EooKB, Capt. xxxvi. 52. Proceed ings, Vol. X. 54. EoEiT, M. P. xl. 463. Eoss, Major E. C. Proceedings, VoL xvi. 139, 219. Eoss, John (Baghdad). ix. 443 ; xi. 121. , John (AustraUa). Proceedings, Vol. XV. 96. Eussell, H. S. xv. 305. St. John, Commander, b.n. xiii. 343. ¦ , Major, xxxviii. 411. ¦ , Spencer, xxxii. 217. Pro ceedings, VoL vi. 83. Sandbbson, John. xxx. 233 ; xxxii. 335. Sarel, Lt.-Col. xxxii. 1. Proceed ings, Vol. vi. 2. Saunders, Trelawny. xiii. 613. . , Commander J. P. xvi. 169. Saussure, Henri de. xxx. 63. Schlagintweit Brothers. Proceed ings, Vol. i. 273. Schmidt, Dr. Proceedings, Vol. x. 118. Sclater, P. L. Proceedings (N.S.), VoL i. 121. Schomburgk, Sir Eobert. ii. 152 ; vi. 224 ; vn. 285, 302 ; x. 159, 191, 248 ; xii. 169, 178 ; xUi. 18 ; xv. 1 ; xxiii. 264 ; xxxi. 302. Proceedings, Vol. V. 118. Schoolcraft, Prof. xii. 259. Schuyler, B. Proceedings, Vol. xviii. 408. SooTT, Amos. xxv. 176. A. J. Proceedings, VoL viu. 110. Scouler, John. xi. 215. Seebohm, H. xlviU. 1. Proceed ings, Vol. xxu. 101. Selby, Lieut. W. B., ln. xiv. 219. Selous, F. C. Proceedings (N.S.), Vol. Ui. 169. Semenof, M. P. P. xxxi. 356 ; xxxv. 213 ; xxxix. 311. Sbveetsof, M. xl. 343. Proceed ings (N.S.), Vol. iL 499. Sevin, C. H. xxx. 1. Seymour, Rear-Admiral Sir George, K.C.B. xix. 20. Shaffebb. Proceedings, Vol. iv. 101 ; V. 94. Shaw, J. B. xU. 373; xlvi. 277. Proceedings, VoL xiv. 124 ; xv.l80; xvi. 242, 395 ; xvu. 196. Shiel, Lieut.-CoL Sir Justin, viii. 54, 430. Sholl, j. B. xxxvi. 203. SiBEEE, Rev. James. Proceedings (N.S.), Vol. i. 646. Simons, F. A. Proceedings (N.S.) Vol, L 689. Simmonds, P. L. Proceedings, Vol.* i. 53. Simpson, Messrs. and Dease. viu. 213 ; ix. 325 ; x. 268. Simpson, W. Proceedings, Vol. xix. 292. SiNCLAiE, Captain. Proceedings, Vol. iv. 79. Skene, Jas. H. xvUi. 139. Skeetchley, j. a. xlviU. 274. Sladen, Major, xii. 267. Proceed ings, Vol. XV. 343. Smith, Dr. A. vi. 394. Smith, Dr. P. P. Proceedings, VoL xxi. 580. Smith, J. H. xxiv. 256. Smith, Lieut. Webber, vii. 61. Smyth, Lieut., b.n. vi. 11. Smyth, Admiral W. H., cb. i. 58 ; xxiv. 328. SOSNOPFSKY, Col. xlvii. 150. Speke, Captain, xxviii. 188 ; xxxiii. 322, 334. Proceedings, Vol. U. 52 ; iii. 348 ; vi. 17 ; vii. 20, 213, 217. Authors of Papers. 241 Spottiswoode, Wm. xxxi. 149. Proceedings, Vol. iv. 97 ; v. 234. Spratt, Admiral, viii. 205 ; xvi. 251 ; xvii. 146 ; xxiv. 238 ; xxvi. 203 ; xxvii. 220. Spruce, Richard, xxxi. 163. Sprye, Capt. Proceedings, Vol. v. 46. Squier, B. G. xxx. 58. Proceed ings, Vol. in. 106. Staley, Rev. D. xxxviii. 361. Proceedings, Vol. xii. 305. Stanley, H. M. Proceedings, VoL xxn. 165, 382. Stanley, Captain Owen, r.n. xii. 262. Stebnitzky, Colonel, xliv. 217. Stephenson, Capt., e.n., cb. Pro ceedings, Vol. xxi. 106. Stevens, Capt. J. xliiL 295. Stewart, Dr. James. Proceedings (N.S.), VoL L 289 j U. 428. Stokes, Admiral, vi. 311 ; xix. 33 ; xxL 25 ; xxvi. 183. Proceedings, Vol. i. 79. Stone, 0. Proceedings, Vol. xx. 92. Stow, J. P. Proceedings, Vol. x. 34. Steachan, E. xlvi. 421. Steachey, Capt. H. xxi. 57 ; xxiii. 1. Stbachey, Gen. Eichard, cs.i. Pro ceedings, Vol. xvi. 443 ; xxi. 179. Steuve, Professor. vUL 406 ; xxxix. 338. Stuaet, Major E. xxxix. 276 ; xlviii. 234. Proceedings, Vol. xxi. 77. Stuaet, Dr. J. L. xxxu. 316. Stuart, Jobn M'Douall. xxxi. 65, 83, 100; xxxu. 340; xxxiu. 276. Proceedings, Vol. v. 55, 104 ; vi. 8 ; vii. 82 ; ix. 21. Stuet, Captain Charles, xiv. 141 ; xvii. 85. Sulivan, Capt. e.n. xiv. 364. Sutherland, Dr. xxv. 256. Suter, Henry, x. 434. Swinhoe, Eobert. xxxiv. 6 ; xl. 268. Proceedings, vin. 23 ; xiv. 83, 235. Sykes, Colonel, viii. 435 ; xxiii. 101 ; xxiv. 328. Symonds, Capt. W. C. viii. 416. Synge, Capt., r.b. xxii. 174. Pro ceedings, Vol. vii. 71. Tanner, Colonel H. Proceedings (N.S.), VoL in. 278. Tayler, J. W. xl. 228. Proceed ings, Vol. iii. 117 ; V. 90 ; xiv. 156. Taylor, J. E. Pructedings, Vol. xi. 97. Taylor, J. G. xxxv. 21 ; xxxviii. 281. Proceedings, VoL ix. 36; xn. 302. Taylor, Lieut., e.a. iii. 99. Temple, Sir Eichard. xxxv. 70. Proceedings, ix. 81 ; (N.S.) U. 629. Temple, Lieut. George, e.n. Pro ceedings (N.S.) iL 273. Temple, Lieut. E. C. xlix. 190 ; 1. 1. Tennant, Professor. Proceedings, Vol. xii. 322. Thomas, W. N. Proceedings, Vol. xvii. 148. Thomson, Dr. A. S. xxiii. 87. Thomson, J. ; xUii. 97 ; Proceedings, Vol. xviL 144; (N.S.)i. 97. Thomson, Joseph, 1. 14. Proceedings (N.S.),VoL i. 668 ; U. 102. 209, 306. Thomson, R. P. Proceedings, Vol. Ui. 2. Thomson, J. T. xxviU. 298. Thomson, W. C. xvi. 106. Thoenton, Richard. xxxiv. 196. Proceedings, Vol. vi. 47 ; ix. 15. Thurburn, Hugh. xxii. 128. Tickell, Capt. xxiv. 86. Tinne, Madame. Proceedings, Vol. viu. 12. Todd, Major D'Arcy. viu. 29, 101. Torrens. Proceedings, Vol. iv. 226. Toynbee, Capt. xxxv. 147. Pro ceedings, Vol. ix. 281. Tebmenheerb, Colonel, xxxvii. 68. Proceedings, Vol. xi. 22. 1'eottbr, Capt. H. xlvii. 86 ; xlviii. 173. Proceedings, Vol. xxn. 287. Troup, J. xiii. 425. Tucker, Admiral, J. R. Proceedings, Vol. xui. 133. Turner, W. J. xlvi. 428. Turner, Rev. D. Proceedings, Vol. xiii. 57. Twyford, A. W. Proceedings, Vol. i. 503. Van de Gehuchte. xxviii. 359. Varnhagbn, M. Proceedings, Vol in. 389. Veniukof, M. xxxii. 560 ; xxxvi. 265, 248 ; xUL 373. Vereker, Hon. H. P. xxxii. 137. Proceedings, vi. 74. E 242 Authors of Papers. Vetch, Capt. vii. 1 ; viii. 157. Veth, Professor. Proceedings (N.S.), Vol. L 759. Vidal, Capt., r.n. L 51 ; xix. 160. Vigne, T. G. ix. 612. Vogel, Dr. xxi. 130 ; xxiv. 276 ; xxv. 237. Proceedings, Vol. U. 30, 79. Von Baer, Professor, viii. 210, 411. Von der Decken, Baron. Proceed ings, Vol. vni. 6 ; x. 28, 109. VoN Hammer, Baron, xii. 261. VoN Krokow, Count, xxxvi. 198. VoN Maltzan, Baron. Proceedings, Vol. xvi. 115. Von Muller, Baron, xx. 275. VoN Wildenbruch, Colonel, xx. 227. Von Wrangbll, Admiral, xviu. 19, 24. Von Wrede, Baron, xiv. 107. Waddington, A. xxxviii. 118. Proceedings, Vol. xii. 121. Wakefield, Rev. J. xl. 303. Pro ceedings, Vol. xvi. 125. Waldegrove, Capt., e.n. iii. 156, 168. Walkee, Mr. (Australia). Proceed ings, Vol. vii. 6, 6, 84. Walker, A . Proceedings, Vol . ix. 33. Walkee, Col. J. T. xxxu. 303. Walkee, Capt. J. B. Proceedings, Vol. xvi. 135. Walkee, R. B. N. Proceedings, Vol. xvii. 354. Wallace, A. R. xxiu. 212; xxx, 172; xxxU. 127; xxxiiL 217. Proceedings, Vol. i. 193 ; ii. 163 ; ui. 358 ; vi. 43 ; vii. 206 ; xxi. 505. Wallich, Dr. Proceedings, Vol. vn. 53. Wallin, Dr. G. A. xx. 293 ; xxiv. 115 ; xxv. 260. Warburton, Col. Egerton. Pro ceedings, Vol. V. 124 ; xviii. 183 ; xix. 41. Wareham, Mr. xii. 21. Warren, Capt. C. xlviii. 283. Pro ceedings, Vol. xix. 155. Washington, Capt., e.n. i. 123; vii. 172 ; viu. 235, 448. Watson, R. G. Proceedings, Vol. vi. 103. Watson, Lieut, xlvi. 417, 424. Watts, W. L. xlvi. 1. Proceedings, Vol. XX. 21. Webb, Capt. W. S. iv. 376. Wells, J. W. xlvi. 308. Wbllsted, Lieut., i.n. v. 129, 286 ; vi. 96 ; vii. 20, 102. Weypeecht, Lieut, xiv. 19. Wheelwright, W. xxxi. 156. Pro ceedings, Vol. iv. 46. White, Robert. Proceedings, Vol. L27. White, T. P. Proceedings, Vol. xiii. 352. Whitelock, Lieut., i.n. viii. 170. Whitley, N. Proceedings, Vol. xiii. 229. Whitney, Asa. xxi. 86. Whymper, P. xxxviii. 219. Pro ceedings, Vol. xii. 186. Whyte, W. A. Proceedings, Vol. xiv. 243. Vf icKHAM, G. H. Proceedings, Vol. xiii. 58. Wickham, Capt., b.n. viu. 460 ; xu. 79. Wilkinson, Sir Gardner, ix. 431 ; xxv. 206. Wilkinson, J. ii. 28. Wilkinson, J. R. Proceedings, Vol. xiii. 134. Williamson, Rev. A. xxxix. 1. Proceedings, Vol. xiu. 26. Wilson, Rev. C. T. Proceedings (N. S.), Vol. ii. 353. Wilson, Major C. W. xUu. 206. Proceedings, Vol. xvii. 326. Wilson, Col. D. iii. 283. Wilson, Capt. J. C, b.n. xxxvi. 244. Wilson, J. Fox. xxxv. 106. Pro ceedings, Vol. ix. 106. Wilson, Capt. J. E. xiii. 118. Wilson, J. S. xxviii. 137. Wolfe, Lieut. J., e.n. iii. 77. Wood, Lieut., i.n. vi. 29 ; x. 530. Wood, Major Herbert, xiv. 367. Woetabet, Dr. xxxu. 100. Weangell, Admiral von. xviu. 19, 24. Yorke, Colonel PhUip. xxi. 35 Young, Sir Allen. Proceedings, Vol. V. 70; ix. 296. Young, E. D., r.n. xxxviii. 111. Proceedings, Vol. xii. 79 ; xx. 451 ; x-\i. 225. Yule, Col. H., cb. xxvii. 64 ; xiii. 438. Proceedings, Vol. i. 269 ; x. 270. Zahetmann, Admiral, v. 102. ( 243 ) GEOGRAPHY BRITISH ASSOCIATION. From 1832 to 1860 Geography was considered with Geology, sometimes with a separate President for the geographioal papers. After 1850 Geography and Ethnology formed a separate Section B. After 1869 Ethnology was placed in a sub-section of Section D, and since that year Section E has been for Geography alone. PEESIDENTS. Geographical Bbanch op Section C. 1831. York .. .. 1832. Oxford 1833. Cambridge.. 1834. Edinburgh.. 1865. Dublin 1836. Bristol 1837. Liverpool .. 1838. Newcastle .. 1839. Birmingham 1840. Glasgow .. 1841. Plymouth .. 1842. Marwhester 1843. Cork .. .. 1844. York .. .. 1845. Cambridge.. 1846. Southampton 1847. Oxford 1848. Swansea .. 1849. Birmingham 1850. Edinburgh.. No sections. !No separate President for the geographical branch. Mr. E. I. Murchison, p.e.s. Mr G. B. Greenough, f.r.s. Lord Prudhoe, Captain, e.n. Mr. G. B. Greenough, f.b.s. Mr. G. B. Greenough, p.e.s. ^ No separate President for the geographical branch. Mr. G. B. Greenough, f.b.s. No separate President for the geographical branch. B 2 244 British Association. PRESIDENTS OF THE GEOGEAPHICAL SECTION OF THE BEITISH ASSOCIATION. 1861. Ipswich 1852. Belfast 1853. Hull .. 1864. Liverpool 1865. Glasgow 1856. Cheltenham 1857. Dublin 1858. Leeds .. 1859. Aberdeen 1860. Oxford 1861. Manchester 1862. Cambridge 1863. Newcastle 1864. .Bai/i .. 1865. Pirmingham 1866. Nottingham 1867. Dundee 1868. Norwich 1869. JJxeter 1870. Liverpool 1871. Edinburgh 1872. Prighton 1873. Pradford 1874. £e^as« 1875. £to« 1876. Glasgow 1877. Plymouth 1878. DwJZm 1879. fi'/j(#eW 1880. Swansea 1881. JorA .. (Section E). Sir Roderick Murchison, f.e.s. Colonel Chesney, f.r.s. Mr. E. G. Latham, f.r.s. Sir Eoderick Murchison, f.r.s. Sir John Eichardson, c.b., f.r.s. Sir Henry Eawlinson, k.c.b., f.r.s. Eev. Dr. J. H. Todd. Sir Eoderick Murchison, f.r.s. Admiral Sir James C. Eoss, f.e.s. Sir Eoderick Murchison, f.e.s. Mr. Jobn Crawfurd, f.e.s. Mr. Francis Galton, f.r.s. Sir Eoderick Murchison, p.e.s. Sir Eoderick Murchison, f.e.s. Sir Henry Eawlinson, k.c.b., p.e.s. Sir Charles Nicholson, Part. Sir Samuel Baker. Captain Eichards, e.n., cb., f.e.s. Sir H. Bartie Frere, g.c.s.i., k.c.b. Sir Roderick Murchison, k.cb., f.e.s. Colonel H. Yule, c.b. Mr. Francis Galton, p.e.s. Sir Rutherford Alcock, k.c.b. Lieut.-Colonel Wilson, cb., p.e.s. Lieut.-General R. Strachey, c.s.i., p.e.s. Captain Evans, b.n., cb., f.e.s. Admiral Sir E. Ommanney, cb., f.r.s. Sir Wyville Thomson, f.e.s. Mr. Clements Markham, c.b., f.b.s. Lieut.-General Sir J. H. Lefroy, k.c.m.g., f.e.s. Sir Joseph D. Hooker, k.c.s.i., cb., f.b.s. British Association. 245 1861. 1852. 1853. 1854.1855.1866.1857.1858.1859.1860. 1861.1862.1863. 1864. 1865.1866. 1867.1868. Ipswich ,. Pdfast '.. . Hull .. . Liverpool Glasgow . . Cheltenham . Dublin . . Leeds Aberdeen Oxford . . Manchester Cambridge Newcastle Path .. . Pirmingham . NottinghamDundee. .. Norwich .. SECEETAEIES OF SECTION E. Geography & Ethnology. Dr. Norton Shaw, Rev. J. Donaldson, Mr. CuU, (Ethn.) Mr. Mac Adam, Mr. CuU, (Ethn.) Rev. H. W. Kemp, Mr. CuU, (Ethn.) Rev. H. Higgins, Dr. Ihne, Mr. Cull, (Ethn.) Dr. Blackie, Mr. CuU, (Ethn) Mr. Hartland, W. H. Rumsey. Mr. Cull, (Ethn.) Mr. Ferguson, Dr. Madden. Mr. Cull, (Ethn.) Mr. F. Galton, Dr. O'CaUaghan, T. Wright, (Ethn.) Prof. Geddes, Mr. CuU, (Ethn.) Captain Burrows, R.N., Dr. Lem- prifere. Dr. Hunt, (Ethn.) W. Spottiswoode, J. Kingsley, Dr. Hunt, (Ethn.) Rev. J. Glover, J. W. Clarke, Dr. Hunt, (Ethn.) 0. R. Markham R. W. Watson, C. Carter Blake, (Ethn.) „ „ H. W. Bates, Capt. Murchison, T. Wright, (Ethn.) „ „ H. W. Bates, S. Evans, G. Jabet, T. Wright, (Ethn.) „ H. W. Bates, R. H. Major, Rev. B. T. Cusins, D. W. Nash, T. Wright, (Ethn.) H. W. Bates, Cyril Graham, S. J. Mackie, R. Sturrock, (Ethn.) C. R. Markham, H. W. Bates, T. Baines, T. Wright, (Ethn.) 1869. Exeter .. 1870. Liverpool 1871. Edinburgh 1872. Brighton.. 1873. Bradford.. 1874. Pelfast .. 1876. Pristol .. 1876. Glasgow .. 1877. Plymouth 1878. Dublin .. 1879. Sheffield .. 1880. Swansea .. (Geography.) C. R. Markham, H. W. Bates, J. H. Thomas. „ „ „ „ A. Mott, D. Buxton. „ „ A. Keith Johnston, A. Buchan, J. H. Thomas. H. W. Bates, A. Keith Johnston, Rev. J. Newton, J. H. Thomas. C. R. Markham, A. Keith Johnston, H. W. Bates. E. C. Rye, E. G. Ravenstein, J. H. Thomas. H. W. Bates, E. C. Rye, P. Tuokett. R. 0. Wood. „ P. E. Fox. E. 0. Rye, John Coles. H. W. Bates, B. C. Rye, C. B. D. Black. 246 Hakluyt Society. THE HAKLUYT SOCIETY (1847-1881.) Presidents. 1847. Sir Roderick Murchison, Bart., k.c.b., f.e-s. 1871. Right Honourable Sir David Dundas. 1877] to iColonel H. Yule, c.b. 1881.J Secretaries. 1847. Mr. Desborough Cooley. 1849. Mr. R. H. Major. 1859' to Mr. Clements Markham, c.b., f.r.s. 1881. 1881. President. Colonel H. Yule, cb., f.b.g.s. Vice-Presidents. Admiral C. R. Drinkwater Bethune, c.b., f.r.g.s. Major-General Sir Henry Rawlinson, k.cb., f.r.g.s. CouncU W. A. Tyssen Amherst, Esq., m.p., F.E.G.S. Rev. Dr. G. P. Badgee, d.c.l., f.e.g.s. J. Baeeow, Esq., p.e.s., f.e.g.s. Walter de Gray Birch, Esq. E. H. Bunbury, Esq., f.r.g.s. Adm. Sir R. Oollinson, k.cb., f.r.g.s. I'he Earl of Ducie, f.r.s., f.e.g.s. Captain P. B. Hankey, e.n. Lieut.-Gen. Sir J. Henry Lefroy, CB., k.c.m.g., f.r.g.s. R. H. Major, Esq., f.s.a., f.r.g.s. Rear-Admiral Mayne, cb., f.r.g.s. E. Delmar Morgan, Esq., p.r.g.s. Admiral Sir Erasmus Ommanney, c.b., f.r.s., f.r.g.s. Lord Arthur Eussell, m.p.. For. Sec. E.G.S. The Lord Stanley of Alderley. Edward Thomas, Esq., f.r.s. Lieut.-Gen. Sir Henry Thuillier, C.S.I., F.B.S., F.R.G.S. Honorary Secretary — C. E. Markham, cb., f.b.s.. Sec. e.g.s. Bankers— Messrs. Eansom, Bouveeie, and Co., 1, PaU Mall East. The Hakluyt Society, which is estabhshed for the purpose of printing rare or unpublished Voyages and Travels, aims at opening by this means an easier Hakluyt Society. 247 access to the sources of a branch of knowledge, which yields to none in importance, and is superior to most in agreeable variety. Tbe narratives of travellers and navigators make us acquainted with the earth, its inhabitants and productions ; they exhibit tbe growth of intercourse among mankind, with its effects on civilisation, and, while instructing, they at tbe same time awaken attention, by recounting the toils and adventures of those who first explored unknown and distant regions. The advantage of an Association of this kind consists not merely in its system of literary co-operation, but also in its economy. The acquirements, taste, and discrimination of a number of individuals, who feel an interest in thesame pursuit, are thus brought to act in voluntary combination, and the ordinary charges of publication are also avoided, so that the volumes pro duced are distributed among the Members (who can alone obtain them) at little more than the cost of printing and paper. The Society expends the whole of its funds in the preparation of works for the Members ; and since the cost of each copy varies inversely as the whole number of copies printed, it is obvious tbat the members are gainers individually by tbe prosperity of the Society, and tbe consequent vigour of its operations. The number of Members is now 240. Gentlemen desirous of becoming Members of the Hakluyt Society should intimate their intention to the Secretary, Mr. Clements K. Markham, cb., F.R.S., 21, Eccleston Square, S.W., or to the Society's Agent for the deUvery of its volumes, Mr. Richards, 37, Great Queen Street, Lincoln's Inn Fields ; when their names will be recorded, and on payment of their subscription of 11. Is. to Mr. Richards, they will receive the volumes issued for the year. New Members have, at present (1881), the privilege of purchasing the publications of the Society for previous years for 251. Is. Qd. Members wishing to purchase back volumes may, witb the consent of the Council, be supplied with them at the rate of 10s. each volume, when they require any number less than one quarter of the whole series, and at the rate of 8s. 6d. a volume when they require any number more than a quarter of the whole series. The Members are requested to bear in mind that the power of the Council to make advantageous arrangements will depend in a great measure on the prompt payment of the subscriptions, which are payable in advance on the 1st of January, and are received by Mr. Richards, 37, Great Queen Street, Lincoln's Inn Fields. Post-Offioe Orders should be made payable to Mr. Thomas Richards, at the West Central Office, High Holborn. WOEKS ALEEADT ISSUED. 1. — The Observations of Sib Richard Hawkins, Knt., In bis Voyage into the South Sea in 1593. Reprinted from tbe edition of 1622, and edited by Capt. C. R. Drinkwater Bethune, r.n., cb. Issued for 1848. (First Edition out of print. See No. 57.) 2. — Select Leteers of Columbus. With Original Documents relating to tbe Discovery of the New World. Tr.inslatcd and Edited by E. H. Major, Esq., of the British Museum. Issued for 184:9. (First Edition out of print. See No. 4:3.) 248 Volumes of the 3. — The Discoverib of the Empire of Guiana, By Sir Walter Ealeigh, Knt. Edited, with copious Explanatory Notes, and a Biographical Memoir, by Sir Eobert H. Schomburgk, Phil.D., &c. Issued for 1850. 4. — Sir Francis Drake his Voyage, 1595. By Thomas Maynarde, together with the Spanish Account of Drake's attack on Puerto Eico. Edited from the Original MSS. by W. D. Cooley, Esq. Issued for 1850. 5. — Narratives of Early Voyages Undertaken for tbe Discovery of a Passage to Cathaia and India, by the North-west, with Selections from the Eecords of the worshipful Pellowshix) of the Merchants of London, trading into the East Indies ; and from MSS. in tbe Library of the British Museum, now first published ; by Thomas EundaU, Esq. Issued for 1861. 6. — The Historie of Travailb into Virginia Britannia, Expressing the Cosmograpbie and Commodities of tbe Country, together with the manners and customs of the people, gathered and observed as well by those who went first thither as collected by William Strachey, Gent., the first Secretary of the Colony ; now first Edited from tbe original manuscript in the British Museum, by R. H. Major, Esq., of the British Museum. Issued for 1851. 7. — Divers Voyages touching the Discovery of America And the Islands adjacent, collected and published by Richard Hakluyt, Prebendary of Bristol in the year 1582. Edited, with Notes and an Intro duction, by John Winter Jones, Esq., of the British Museum. Issued for 1852. 8. — A Collection op Documents on Japan. With a Commentary by Thomas Rundall, Esq. Issued for 1852. 9. — The Discovery and Conquest op Florida, By Don Ferdinando de Soto. Translated out of Portuguese by Richard Hakluyt ; and Edited, with notes and an introduction, by W. B. Rye, Esq., of the British Museum. Issued for 1853. 10. — Notes upon Russia, Being a Translation from. the Earliest Account of that Country, entitled Rerum Muscoviticarum Commentaru, by the Baron Sigismund von Herber- stein. Ambassador from the Court of G ei-many to the Grand Prince Vasiley Ivanovicb, in the years 1617 and 1526. Two Volumes. Translated &,nd Edited, with Notes and an Introduction, by R. H. Major, Esq., of tbe British Museum. VoL 1. Issued for 1853. 11. — The Geography of Hudson's Bay. Being the Remarks of Captain W. Coats, iu many Voyages to tbat locality, between tbe years 1727 and 1751. With an Appendix, containing Extracts Hakluyt Society. 249 from tbe Log of Captain Middleton on bis Voyage for the Discovery of the North-west Passage, in H.M.S. 'Furnace,' in 1741-2. Edited by Jobn Barrow, Esq., f.r.s., f.s.a. Issued for 1864. 12. — Notes upon Russia. Vol. 2. Issued for 1854. 13. — Three Voyages by the North-east, Towards Cathay and China, undertaken by the Dutch in the years 1594, 1595, and 1596, with their Discovery of Spitzbergen, their residence of ten months in Novaya Zemlya, and their sale return in two open boats. By Gerrit de Veer. Edited by C. T. Beke, Esq., Ph.D., f.s.a. (First Edition out of print. See No. 54.) Issued for 1855. 14-15.— The History of the Geeat and Mighty Kingdom op China AND THE Situation theeeof. Compiled by the Padre Juan Gonzalez de Mendoza. And now Eeprinted from the Early Translation of E. Parke. Edited by Sir George T. Staunton, Bart. With an Introduction by R. H. Major, Esq. 2 vols. Issued for 1855. 16. — The World Encompassed by Sir Francis Drake. Being his next Voyage to that to Nombre de Dios. Collated, with an unpublished Manuscript of Francis Fletcher, Chaplain to the Expedition. With Appendices illustrative of the same Voyage, and Introduction by W. S. W. Vaux, Esq., m.a. Issued for 1856. 11. — The Histoey of the Tartab Conquerors who subdued China. Prom the French of tbe P6re D'Orleans, 1688. Translated and Edited by the Earl of Ellesmere. With an Introduction by E. H. Major, Esq. Issued for 1856. 18. — A Collection of Early Documents on Spitzbergen and Greenland, Consisting of : a Translation from tbe German of P. Martin's important work on Spitzbergen, now very rare ; a Translation from Isaac de la Peyrere's Relation de Greenland ; and a rare piece entitled " God's Power and Pro vidence showed in the miraculous preservation and deliverance of eight Englishmen left by mischance in Greenland, anno 1630, nine months and twelve days, faithfully reported by Edward Pelbam." Edited, with Notes, by Adam White, Esq., of the British Museum. Issued for 1857. 19. — The Voyage of Sib Henry Middleton to Bantam and the Maluoo Islands. From tbe rare Edition of 1606. Edited by Bolton Corney, Esq. Issued for 1857. 20. — Russia at the Close of the Sixteenth Century. Comprising " The Russe Commonwealth " by Dr. Giles Fletcher, and Sir Jerome Horeey's Travels, now first printed entire from his manuscript in the British Museum. Edited by E. A. Bond, Esq., of the British Museum. Issued for 1858. 250 Volumes ofthe 21. — The Travels of Girolamo Benzoni in America, in 1542-56. Translated and Edited by Admiral W. H. Smyth, f.r.s., f.s.a. Issued for 1858. 22. — India in the Fifteenth Century. Being a Collection of Narratives of Voyages to India in the century pre ceding the Portuguese discovery of the Cape of Good Hope ; from Latin, Persian, Russian, and Italian Sources, now first translated into English. Edited, with an Introduction, by R. H. Major, Esq., f.s.a. Issued for 1859. 23. — Naeeative of a Voyage to the West Indies and Mexico, In the years 1599-1602, with Maps and Illustrations. By Samuel Champlain. Translated from the original and unpublished Manuscript, with a Bio graphical Notice and Notes by Alice Wilmere. Issued for 1859. 24.— Expeditions into the Valley of the Amazons During the Sixteenth and Seventeenth Centuries : coiitaining the Joumey of Gonzalo Pizarro, from the Eoyal Commentaries of Garoilasso luca de la Vega ; the Voyage of Francisco de Orellana, Irom the General History of Herrera ; and the Voyage of Cristoval de Acufia, from an exceedingly scarce narrative written by himself in 1641. Edited and Translated by Clements R. Markham, Esq. Issued for 1860. 25. — Eaely Indications of Austealia. A Collection of Documents shewing the Early Discoveries of Australia to the time "of Captain Cook. Edited by R. H. Majoi-, Esq., of tbe British Museum, f.s.a. Issued for 1860. 26. — The Embassy of Ruy Gonzalez db Clavijo to the Coubt OP Timoub, 1403-6. Translated, for the first time, with Notes, a Preface, and an Introductory Life of 'i imour Beg. By Clements R. Markham, Esq. Issued for 1861. 27. —Henry Hudson the Navigator. The Original Documents in wbich his career is recorded. Collected, partly Translated, and Annotated, witb an Introduction by Ueorge Asher, ll.d. Issued for 1861. 28. — The Expedition of Uesua and Aguirre, In search of Bl Dorado and Omagua, a.d. 1560-61. Translated from the " Soxta Noticia Historiale" of I'ray Pedro Simon, by W. BoUaert, Esq.; with an introduction by Clements R. Markham, Esq. Issued for 1862. 29. — The Life and Acts of Don Alonzo Enriqubz db Guzman. Translated from a Manuscript in the National Librai-y at Madrid, and edited, with Notes and an Introduction, by Clements E. Markham, Esq. Issued for 1862. Hakluyt Society. 251 30. — Discoveries of the Woeld by Galvano, Prom their first original unto the year of our Lord 1565. Reprinted, with the original Portuguese text, and edited by Vice-Admiral Bethune, c.b. Issued for 1863. 31. — Mabvels described by Feiae Joedanus, Of the Order of Preachers, native of Severac, and Bishop of Columbum ; from a parchment manuscript of the Fourteenth Century, in Latin, the text of which has recently been Translated and Edited by Colonel H. Yule, c.b., F.E.G.S., late of H.M. Bengal Engineers. Issued for 1863, 32. — The Teavels op Ludovico di Vabthema In Syria, Arabia, Persia, India, &c., during tbe Sixteenth Century. Trans lated by J. Winter Jones, Esq., f.s.a., and edited, with Notes and an Introduction, by the Rev. George Percy Badger. Issued for 1864. 33. — The Tbavels of Cibza de Leon in 1632-60 From the Gulf of Darien to the City of La Plata, contained in the first part of his Chronicle of Peru (Antwerp 1654). Translated and edited, with Notes and an Introduction, by Clements R. Markham, Esq. Issued for 1864. 34. — The Naeeative op Pascual de Andagoya. Containing the eariiest notice of Peru. Translated and edited, with Notes and an Introduction, by Clements E. Markham, Esq. Issued for 1865. 36. — The Coasts of East Africa and Malabar In the beginning of the Sixteenth Century, by Duarte Barbosa. Translated from an early Spanish manuscript by tbe Hon. Henry Stanley. Issued for 1865. 36. — Cathay and the Way Thither. Vol. 2. A Collection of all minor notices of China, previous to the Sixteenth Century. Translated and edited by Colonel H. Yule, c.b. Vol. 1. Issued for 1866. 37. — Cathay and the Way Thither. Vol. 2. Issued for 1866. 38. — The Three Voyages op Sir Maetin Frobisher. With a Selection from Letters now in the State Paper OfSoe. Edited by Eear-Admiral ColUnsou, cb. Issued for 1867. 39. — The Philippine Islands. Moluccas, Siam, Cambodia, Japan, and China, at the close of the 16th cen tury. By Antonia de Morga. Translated Irom the Spanish, with Notes, by Lord Stanley of Alderley. Issued for 1868. 40. — The Fifth Letter of Heenan Cortes. To the Emperor Charles V., containing an Account of his Expedition to Honduras in 1525-26. Translated from the Spanish by Don Pascual de Gayangos. Issued for 1868. 252 Volumes of the 41. — The Eoyal Commentaries of the Yncas. By tbe Ynca Garcilasso de la Vega. Translated and Edited, vrith Notes and an Introduction, by Clements E. Markham, Esq. Vol. 1. Issued for 1869. 42. — The Three Voyages op Vasco da Gama And his Viceroyalty, from the Lendas da India of Caspar Correa ; accom panied by original documents. Translated and Edited by the Lord Stanley of Alderley. Issued for 1869. 43. — Select Letters of Christopher Columbus, With other Original Documents, relating to his Four Voyages to tbe New World. Translated and edited by E. H. Major, f.s.a., &o. 2nd Edit. Issued for 1870. 44. — History of the Imams and Seyyids of 'Oman, By Salil-lbn-Razik, from a.d. 661-1856. Translated from the original Arabic, and edited, with Notes, Appendices, and an Introduction, continuing the History down to 1870, by George Percy Badger, f.r.g.s. Issued for 1870. 45. — The Royal Commentaries of the Yncas. Vol. 2. Issued for 1871. 46. — The Canarian, Or Book of the Conquest and Conversion of tbe Canarians in the year 1402, by Messire Jean de Bethenoourt, Kt. Composed by Pierre Bontier and Jean le Verrier. Translated and Edited, with Notes and an Introduction, by R. H. Major, f.s.a. Issued for 1871. 47. — Reports on the Discovery op Peru ; Translated and Edited, with Notes and an Introduction, by Clements R. Markham, c.b. Issued for 1872. 48. — Narratives of the Rites and Laws of the Yncas ; Translated from the original Spanish Manuscripts, and Edited, with Notes and an Introduction, by Clements R. Markbam, cb., f.r.s. Issued for 1872. 49. — Travels to Tana and Persia, By Josasa Barbaro and Ambrogio Contarini ; Edited by Lord Stanley of Alderley ,- and Narratives of other Italian Travels in Persia, Translated and Edited by Charles Grey, Esq. Issued for 1873. 50. — Voyages of the Zbni To the Northern Seas in tbe Fourteenth Century. Translated and Edited by E. H. Major, f.s.a. Issued for 1873. 61. — The Captivity of Hans Stade of Hesse in 1547-55 Among the Wild Tribes of Eastern Brazil ; translated by Albert Tootal, Esq., and annotated by Eichard F. Burton. Issued for 1874. Hakluyt Society. 253 52.— The First Voyage Eound the Woeld by Magellan, Translated from the Accounts of Pigasetta and other contemporary writers. With Notes and an Introduction by Lord Stanley of Alderley. Issued for 1874. 53. — The Commbntaeies op the Geeat Afonso Dalboqubeque, Second Viceroy of India. Translated from the Portuguese Edition of 1774 ; with Notes and Introduction by Walter de Gray Birch, Esq., f.r.s.l. Vol. 1. Issued for 1875. 54. — Three Voyages by the North-East. Second Edition of Gerrit de Veer's Three Voyages to the North Bast by Barents. Edited, with an Introduction, by Lieut. Koolemans Beynen, of the Eoyal Dutch Navy. Issued for 1876. 56. — The Commentaries of the Great Alfonso Dalboquerque. Vol. 2. Issued for 1875. 56. — The Voyages of Sie James Lancaster. With Abstracts of Journal of Voyages preserved in tbe India Office, and the Voyage of Captain Jobn Knight to seek the N.W. Passage. Edited by Clements E. Markham, cb., p.e.s. Issued for 1877. 57. — Second Edition of the Obsbevations of Sib Eichaed Hawkins, Kt., In his Voyage into the South Sea in 1593, with tbe Voyages of his grand father WiUiam, his father Sir John, and his cousin William Hawkins. Edited by Clements E. Markham, cb., f.b.s. Issued for 1877. 58. — The Bondage and Teavels of Johann Schiltberger, From bis capture at tbe battle of Nicopolis in 1396 to his escape and return to Europe in 1427 : translated, from the Heidelberg MS. edited in 1859 by Professor Karl Preidrich Neumann, by Commander J.. Buchan Telfer, r.n. ; with Notes by Professor B. Bruun, and a Preface, Introduction, and Notes by the Translator and Editor. Issued for 1878. 59. — The Voyages and Works of John Davis the Navigator. Edited, vrith an Introduction and Notes, by Captain Albert H. Markham, E.N., F.E.G.S. Issued for 1878. 60. — The Commbntaeies of the Great Afonso Dalboquerque. Vol. 3. Issued for 1879. 61. — The Natural and Moral Histoey op the Indies, By Father Joseph de Acosta : edited, with Notes and an Introduction, by Clements R. Markham, cb., p.e.s. Vol. 1. Issued for 1879. 62. — Histoey of the Indies by Acosta. Vol. 2. Issued for 1880. 254 Hakluyt Society. OTHEE WOEKS UNDEETAKEN BY EDITOES. Voyages of WiUiam BafBn. Edited by Clements E. Markham, c.b., f.e.s. (Nearly ready.) Father Francisco Alvarez. Narrative of the Portuguese Embassy to Abys sinia. 1520. Translated and Edited by Lord Stanley of Alderley. (Nearly ready.) A Manuscript History of Bermuda, in the British Museum (Shane, 750). Edited by Lieut.-General Sir J. Henry Lefroy, k.c.m.g., cb. (In the Press.) Eosmital's Embassy to England, Spain, &o., in 1466. Edited by E. C. Graves, Esq. The Journal of the Pilot Gallego, and other Documents relating to the Voyages of Mendana. Translated and edited by W. A. Tyssen Amherst, Esq. Voyages of John Huigen von Linschoten to the East Indies. Edited by Arthur Burnell, Esq., ll.d. Voyages and Travels of Anthony Jenkinson. Edited by E. Delmar Morgan, Esq. "WOEKS SUGGESTED TO THE COUNCIL FOE PUBLICATION. Journal of the Jesuit Desideri in Tibet. Inedited Letters, &c., of Sir Thomas Eoe during his Embassy to India. The Topographia Christiana of Cosmas Indicopleustes. Bernhard de Breydenbach, 1483-84, a.d. Travels in the Holy Land. FeUx Pabri, 1483. Wanderings in the Holy Land, Egypt, &c. El Edrisi's Geography. Voyage made by Captain Jaques Cartier in 1535 and 1536 to the isles of Canada, Hochlega, and Saguenay. Ca da Mosto. Voyages along the Western Coast of Africa in 1454 : trans lated from the Italian text of 1507. Leo Africanus. J. dos Santos. The History of Eastern Ethiopia. 1607. Joam de Castro. Account of a Voyage made by the Portuguese in 1541 from the city of Goa to Suez. John and Sebastian Cabot. Their Voyages to America. Hakluyt Society. 255 Willoughby and Chancellor. Their Voyages to the North-east, with the Voyages of Burroughs, Pett, and Jackman ; and the Embassy of Sir Dudley Digges to Eussia. Icelandic Sagas narrating the Discovery of America. The Voyages of the Earl of Cumberland, from the Eecords prepared by order of the Countess of Pembroke. La Argentina. An account of the Discovery of tbe Provinces of Eio de la Plata from 1512 to the time of Domingo Martinez de Irala; by Euiz Diaz de Guzman. LONDON : PRINTED BY WILLIAM CLOWES AND SONS, LIMITED, STAILFORD STREET AND CHARING CROSS. YALE UNIVERSITY LIBRARY 3 9002 03055 9372 I I ' ¦ 1